Pre-coding method and transmitter

Information

  • Patent Grant
  • 10707930
  • Patent Number
    10,707,930
  • Date Filed
    Thursday, March 14, 2019
    5 years ago
  • Date Issued
    Tuesday, July 7, 2020
    4 years ago
Abstract
Disclosed is a transmission scheme for transmitting a first modulated signal and a second modulated signal over the same frequency at the same time. According to the transmission scheme, a precoding weight multiplying unit multiplies a baseband signal after a first mapping and a baseband signal after a second mapping by a precoding weight and outputs the first modulated signal and the second modulated signal. In the precoding weight multiplying unit, precoding weights are regularly hopped.
Description
TECHNICAL FIELD

The present invention relates to a precoding scheme, a precoding device, a transmission scheme, a transmission device, a reception scheme, and a reception device that in particular perform communication using a multi-antenna.


BACKGROUND ART

This application is based on Japanese Patent Applications No. 2010-138532, No. 2010-152503, No. 2011-177310, No. 2011-250331, No. 2011-275165, and No. 2011-276456 filed in Japan, the contents of which are hereby incorporated by reference.


Multiple-Input Multiple-Output (MIMO) is a conventional example of a communication scheme using a multi-antenna. In multi-antenna communication, of which MIMO is representative, multiple transmission signals are each modulated, and each modulated signal is transmitted from a different antenna simultaneously in order to increase the transmission speed of data.



FIG. 28 shows an example of the structure of a transmission and reception device when the number of transmit antennas is two, the number of receive antennas is two, and the number of modulated signals for transmission (transmission streams) is two. In the transmission device, encoded data is interleaved, the interleaved data is modulated, and frequency conversion and the like is performed to generate transmission signals, and the transmission signals are transmitted from antennas. In this case, the scheme for simultaneously transmitting different modulated signals from different transmit antennas at the same time and at the same frequency is a spatial multiplexing MIMO system.


In this context, it has been suggested in Patent Literature 1 to use a transmission device provided with a different interleave pattern for each transmit antenna. In other words, the transmission device in FIG. 28 would have two different interleave patterns with respective interleaves (πa, πb). As shown in Non-Patent Literature 1 and Non-Patent Literature 2, reception quality is improved in the reception device by iterative performance of a detection scheme that uses soft values (the MIMO detector in FIG. 28).


Models of actual propagation environments in wireless communications include non-line of sight (NLOS), of which a Rayleigh fading environment is representative, and line of sight (LOS), of which a Rician fading environment is representative. When the transmission device transmits a single modulated signal, and the reception device performs maximal ratio combining on the signals received by a plurality of antennas and then demodulates and decodes the signal resulting from maximal ratio combining, excellent reception quality can be achieved in an LOS environment, in particular in an environment where the Rician factor is large, which indicates the ratio of the received power of direct waves versus the received power of scattered waves. However, depending on the transmission system (for example, spatial multiplexing MIMO system), a problem occurs in that the reception quality deteriorates as the Rician factor increases (see Non-Patent Literature 3).



FIGS. 29A and 29B show an example of simulation results of the Bit Error Rate (BER) characteristics (vertical axis: BER, horizontal axis: signal-to-noise power ratio (SNR)) for data encoded with low-density parity-check (LDPC) code and transmitted over a 2×2 (two transmit antennas, two receive antennas) spatial multiplexing MIMO system in a Rayleigh fading environment and in a Rician fading environment with Rician factors of K=3, 10, and 16 dB. FIG. 29A shows the BER characteristics of Max-log A Posteriori Probability (APP) without iterative detection (see Non-Patent Literature 1 and Non-Patent Literature 2), and FIG. 29B shows the BER characteristics of Max-log-APP with iterative detection (see Non-Patent Literature 1 and Non-Patent Literature 2) (number of iterations: five). As is clear from FIGS. 29A and 29B, regardless of whether iterative detection is performed, reception quality degrades in the spatial multiplexing MIMO system as the Rician factor increases. It is thus clear that the unique problem of “degradation of reception quality upon stabilization of the propagation environment in the spatial multiplexing MIMO system”, which does not exist in a conventional single modulation signal transmission system, occurs in the spatial multiplexing MIMO system.


Broadcast or multicast communication is a service directed towards line-of-sight users. The radio wave propagation environment between the broadcasting station and the reception devices belonging to the users is often an LOS environment. When using a spatial multiplexing MIMO system having the above problem for broadcast or multicast communication, a situation may occur in which the received electric field strength is high at the reception device, but degradation in reception quality makes it impossible to receive the service. In other words, in order to use a spatial multiplexing MIMO system in broadcast or multicast communication in both an NLOS environment and an LOS environment, there is a desire for development of a MIMO system that offers a certain degree of reception quality.


Non-Patent Literature 8 describes a scheme to select a codebook used in precoding (i.e. a precoding matrix, also referred to as a precoding weight matrix) based on feedback information from a communication partner. Non-Patent Literature 8 does not at all disclose, however, a scheme for precoding in an environment in which feedback information cannot be acquired from the communication partner, such as in the above broadcast or multicast communication.


On the other hand, Non-Patent Literature 4 discloses a scheme for hopping the precoding matrix over time. This scheme can be applied even when no feedback information is available. Non-Patent Literature 4 discloses using a unitary matrix as the matrix for precoding and hopping the unitary matrix at random but does not at all disclose a scheme applicable to degradation of reception quality in the above-described LOS environment. Non-Patent Literature 4 simply recites hopping between precoding matrices at random. Obviously, Non-Patent Literature 4 makes no mention whatsoever of a precoding scheme, or a structure of a precoding matrix, for remedying degradation of reception quality in an LOS environment.


CITATION LIST
Patent Literature

Patent Literature 1


WO 2005/050885


Non-Patent Literature

Non-Patent Literature 1


“Achieving near-capacity on a multiple-antenna channel”, IEEE Transaction on Communications, vol. 51, no. 3, pp. 389-399, March 2003.


Non-Patent Literature 2


“Performance analysis and design optimization of LDPC-coded MIMO OFDM systems”, IEEE Trans. Signal Processing, vol. 52, no. 2, pp. 348-361, February 2004.


Non-Patent Literature 3


“BER performance evaluation in 2×2 MIMO spatial multiplexing systems under Rician fading channels”, IEICE Trans. Fundamentals, vol. E91-A, no. 10, pp. 2798-2807, October 2008.


Non-Patent Literature 4


“Turbo space-time codes with time varying linear transformations”, IEEE Trans. Wireless communications, vol. 6, no. 2, pp. 486-493, February 2007.


Non-Patent Literature 5


“Likelihood function for QR-MLD suitable for soft-decision turbo decoding and its performance”, IEICE Trans. Commun., vol. E88-B, no. 1, pp. 47-57, January 2004.


Non-Patent Literature 6


“A tutorial on ‘parallel concatenated (Turbo) coding’, ‘Turbo (iterative) decoding’ and related topics”, The Institute of Electronics, Information, and Communication Engineers, Technical Report IT 98-51.


Non-Patent Literature 7


“Advanced signal processing for PLCs: Wavelet-OFDM”, Proc. of IEEE International symposium on ISPLC 2008, pp. 187-192, 2008.


Non-Patent Literature 8


D. J. Love, and R. W. Heath, Jr., “Limited feedback unitary precoding for spatial multiplexing systems”, IEEE Trans. Inf. Theory, vol. 51, no. 8, pp. 2967-2976, August 2005.


Non-Patent Literature 9


DVB Document A122, Framing structure, channel coding and modulation for a second generation digital terrestrial television broadcasting system, (DVB-T2), June 2008.


Non-Patent Literature 10


L. Vangelista, N. Benvenuto, and S. Tomasin, “Key technologies for next-generation terrestrial digital television standard DVB-T2”, IEEE Commun. Magazine, vol. 47, no. 10, pp. 146-153, October 2009.


Non-Patent Literature 11


T. Ohgane, T. Nishimura, and Y. Ogawa, “Application of space division multiplexing and those performance in a MIMO channel”, IEICE Trans. Commun., vol. 88-B, no. 5, pp. 1843-1851, May 2005.


Non-Patent Literature 12


R. G. Gallager, “Low-density parity-check codes”, IRE Trans. Inform. Theory, IT-8, pp. 21-28, 1962.


Non-Patent Literature 13


D. J. C. Mackay, “Good error-correcting codes based on very sparse matrices”, IEEE Trans. Inform. Theory, vol. 45, no. 2, pp. 399-431, March 1999.


Non-Patent Literature 14


ETSI EN 302 307, “Second generation framing structure, channel coding and modulation systems for broadcasting, interactive services, news gathering and other broadband satellite applications”, v. 1.1.2, June 2006.


Non-Patent Literature 15


Y.-L. Ueng, and C.-C. Cheng, “A fast-convergence decoding method and memory-efficient VLSI decoder architecture for irregular LDPC codes in the IEEE 802.16e standards”, IEEE VTC-2007 Fall, pp. 1255-1259.


SUMMARY OF INVENTION
Technical Problem

It is an object of the present invention to provide a MIMO system that improves reception quality in an LOS environment.


Solution to Problem

To solve the above problem, the present invention provides a precoding method for generating, from a plurality of signals which are based on a selected modulation scheme and represented by in-phase components and quadrature components, a plurality of precoded signals that are transmitted in the same frequency bandwidth at the same time and transmitting the generated precoded signals, the precoding method comprising: selecting one precoding weight matrix from among a plurality of precoding weight matrices by regularly hopping between the matrices; and generating the plurality of precoded signals by multiplying the selected precoding weight matrix by the plurality of signals which are based on the selected modulation scheme, the plurality of precoding weight matrices being nine matrices expressed, using a positive real number a, as Equations 339 through 347 (details are described below).


According to each aspect of the above invention, precoded signals, which are generated by precoding signals by using one precoding weight matrix selected from among a plurality of precoding weight matrices by regularly hopping between the matrices, are transmitted and received. Thus the precoding weight matrix used in the precoding is any of a plurality of precoding weight matrices that have been predetermined. This makes it possible to improve the reception quality in an LOS environment based on the design of the plurality of precoding weight matrices.


Advantageous Effects of Invention

With the above structure, the present invention provides a precoding method, a precoding device, a transmission method, a reception method, a transmission device, and a reception device that remedy degradation of reception quality in an LOS environment, thereby providing high-quality service to LOS users during broadcast or multicast communication.





BRIEF DESCRIPTION OF DRAWINGS


FIG. 1 is an example of the structure of a transmission device and a reception device in a spatial multiplexing MIMO system.



FIG. 2 is an example of a frame structure.



FIG. 3 is an example of the structure of a transmission device when adopting a scheme of hopping between precoding weights.



FIG. 4 is an example of the structure of a transmission device when adopting a scheme of hopping between precoding weights.



FIG. 5 is an example of a frame structure.



FIG. 6 is an example of a scheme of hopping between precoding weights.



FIG. 7 is an example of the structure of a reception device.



FIG. 8 is an example of the structure of a signal processing unit in a reception device.



FIG. 9 is an example of the structure of a signal processing unit in a reception device.



FIG. 10 shows a decoding processing scheme.



FIG. 11 is an example of reception conditions.



FIGS. 12A and 12B are examples of BER characteristics.



FIG. 13 is an example of the structure of a transmission device when adopting a scheme of hopping between precoding weights.



FIG. 14 is an example of the structure of a transmission device when adopting a scheme of hopping between precoding weights.



FIGS. 15A and 15B are examples of a frame structure.



FIGS. 16A and 16B are examples of a frame structure.



FIGS. 17A and 17B are examples of a frame structure.



FIGS. 18A and 18B are examples of a frame structure.



FIGS. 19A and 19B are examples of a frame structure.



FIG. 20 shows positions of poor reception quality points.



FIG. 21 shows positions of poor reception quality points.



FIG. 22 is an example of a frame structure.



FIG. 23 is an example of a frame structure.



FIGS. 24A and 24B are examples of mapping schemes.



FIGS. 25A and 25B are examples of mapping schemes.



FIG. 26 is an example of the structure of a weighting unit.



FIG. 27 is an example of a scheme for reordering symbols.



FIG. 28 is an example of the structure of a transmission device and a reception device in a spatial multiplexing MIMO system.



FIGS. 29A and 29B are examples of BER characteristics.



FIG. 30 is an example of a 2×2 MIMO spatial multiplexing MIMO system.



FIGS. 31A and 31B show positions of poor reception points.



FIG. 32 shows positions of poor reception points.



FIGS. 33A and 33B show positions of poor reception points.



FIG. 34 shows positions of poor reception points.



FIGS. 35A and 35B show positions of poor reception points.



FIG. 36 shows an example of minimum distance characteristics of poor reception points in an imaginary plane.



FIG. 37 shows an example of minimum distance characteristics of poor reception points in an imaginary plane.



FIGS. 38A and 38B show positions of poor reception points.



FIGS. 39A and 39B show positions of poor reception points.



FIG. 40 is an example of the structure of a transmission device in Embodiment 7.



FIG. 41 is an example of the frame structure of a modulated signal transmitted by the transmission device.



FIGS. 42A and 42B show positions of poor reception points.



FIGS. 43A and 43B show positions of poor reception points.



FIGS. 44A and 44B show positions of poor reception points.



FIGS. 45A and 45B show positions of poor reception points.



FIGS. 46A and 46B show positions of poor reception points.



FIGS. 47A and 47B are examples of a frame structure in the time and frequency domains.



FIGS. 48A and 48B are examples of a frame structure in the time and frequency domains.



FIG. 49 shows a signal processing scheme.



FIG. 50 shows the structure of modulated signals when using space-time block coding.



FIG. 51 is a detailed example of a frame structure in the time and frequency domains.



FIG. 52 is an example of the structure of a transmission device.



FIG. 53 is an example of a structure of the modulated signal generating units #1-#M in FIG. 52.



FIG. 54 shows the structure of the OFDM related processors (5207_1 and 5207_2) in FIG. 52.



FIGS. 55A and 55B are detailed examples of a frame structure in the time and frequency domains.



FIG. 56 is an example of the structure of a reception device.



FIG. 57 shows the structure of the OFDM related processors (5600_X and 5600_Y) in FIG. 56.



FIGS. 58A and 58B are detailed examples of a frame structure in the time and frequency domains.



FIG. 59 is an example of a broadcasting system.



FIGS. 60A and 60B show positions of poor reception points.



FIG. 61 is an example of the frame structure.



FIG. 62 is an example of a frame structure in the time and frequency domain.



FIG. 63 is an example of a structure of a transmission device.



FIG. 64 is an example of a frame structure in the frequency and time domain.



FIG. 65 is an example of the frame structure.



FIG. 66 is an example of symbol arrangement scheme.



FIG. 67 is an example of symbol arrangement scheme.



FIG. 68 is an example of symbol arrangement scheme.



FIG. 69 is an example of the frame structure.



FIG. 70 shows a frame structure in the time and frequency domain.



FIG. 71 is an example of a frame structure in the time and frequency domain.



FIG. 72 is an example of a structure of a transmission device.



FIG. 73 is an example of a structure of a reception device.



FIG. 74 is an example of a structure of a reception device.



FIG. 75 is an example of a structure of a reception device.



FIGS. 76A and 76B show examples of a frame structure in a frequency-time domain.



FIGS. 77A and 77B show examples of a frame structure in a frequency-time domain.



FIGS. 78A and 78B show a result of allocating precoding matrices.



FIGS. 79A and 79B show a result of allocating precoding matrices.



FIGS. 80A and 80B show a result of allocating precoding matrices.



FIG. 81 is an example of the structure of a signal processing unit.



FIG. 82 is an example of the structure of a signal processing unit.



FIG. 83 is an example of the structure of the transmission device.



FIG. 84 shows the overall structure of a digital broadcasting system.



FIG. 85 is a block diagram showing an example of the structure of a reception device.



FIG. 86 shows the structure of multiplexed data.



FIG. 87 schematically shows how each stream is multiplexed in the multiplexed data.



FIG. 88 shows in more detail how a video stream is stored in a sequence of PES packets.



FIG. 89 shows the structure of a TS packet and a source packet in multiplexed data.



FIG. 90 shows the data structure of a PMT.



FIG. 91 shows the internal structure of multiplexed data information.



FIG. 92 shows the internal structure of stream attribute information.



FIG. 93 is a structural diagram of a video display and an audio output device.



FIG. 94 is an example of signal point layout for 16QAM.



FIG. 95 is an example of signal point layout for QPSK.



FIG. 96 shows a baseband signal hopping unit.





DESCRIPTION OF EMBODIMENTS

The following describes embodiments of the present invention with reference to the drawings.


Embodiment 1

The following describes the transmission scheme, transmission device, reception scheme, and reception device of the present embodiment.


Prior to describing the present embodiment, an overview is provided of a transmission scheme and decoding scheme in a conventional spatial multiplexing MIMO system.



FIG. 1 shows the structure of an Nt×Nr spatial multiplexing MIMO system. An information vector z is encoded and interleaved. As output of the interleaving, an encoded bit vector u=(u1, . . . , uNt) is acquired. Note that ui=(ui1, . . . , uiM) (where M is the number of transmission bits per symbol). Letting the transmission vector s=(s1, . . . , sNt)T and the transmission signal from transmit antenna #1 be represented as si=map(ui), the normalized transmission energy is represented as E{|si|2}=Es/Nt (Es being the total energy per channel). Furthermore, letting the received vector be y=(y1, . . . , yNr)T, the received vector is represented as in Equation 1.









Math





1














y
=


(


y
1

,





,

y
Nr


)

T







=



H
NtNr


s

+
n








Equation





1







In this Equation, HNtNr is the channel matrix, n=(n1, . . . , nNr)T is the noise vector, and ni is the i.i.d. complex Gaussian random noise with an average value 0 and variance σ2. From the relationship between transmission symbols and reception symbols that is induced at the reception device, the probability for the received vector may be provided as a multi-dimensional Gaussian distribution, as in Equation 2.









Math





2












p


(

y

u

)


=


1


(

2





π






σ
2


)


N
r





exp


(


-

1

2






σ
2









y
-

Hs


(
u
)





2


)







Equation





2







Here, a reception device that performs iterative decoding composed of an outer soft-in/soft-out decoder and a MIMO detector, as in FIG. 1, is considered. The vector of a log-likelihood ratio (L-value) in FIG. 1 is represented as in Equations 3-5.









Math





3












L


(
u
)


=


(


L


(

u
1

)


,





,

L


(

u

N
t


)



)

T





Equation





3






Math





4












L


(

u
i

)


=

(

L


(


u

i





1


,





,

L


(

u
iM

)



)







Equation





4






Math





5












L


(

u
ij

)


=

ln



P


(


u
ij

=

+
1


)



P


(


u
ij

=

-
1


)








Equation





5








<Iterative Detection Scheme>


The following describes iterative detection of MIMO signals in the Nt×Nr spatial multiplexing MIMO system.


The log-likelihood ratio of umn is defined as in Equation 6.









Math





6












L


(


u
mn


y

)


=

ln



P


(


u
mn

=


+
1


y


)



P


(


u
mn

=


-
1


y


)








Equation





6







From Bayes' theorem, Equation 6 can be expressed as Equation 7.









Math





7















L


(


u
mn


y

)


=



ln




p


(


y


u
mn


=

+
1


)





P


(


u
mn

=

+
1


)


/

p


(
y
)






p


(


y


u
mn


=

-
1


)





P


(


u
mn

=

-
1


)


/

p


(
y
)












=




ln



P


(


u
mn

=

+
1


)



P


(


u
mn

=

-
1


)




+

ln



p


(


y


u
mn


=

+
1


)



p


(


y


u
mn


=

-
1


)











=




ln



P


(


u
mn

=

+
1


)



P


(


u
mn

=

-
1


)




+










ln






U

mn
,

+
1







p


(

y

u

)




p


(

u


u
mn


)








U

mn
,

-
1







p


(

y

u

)




p


(

u


u
mn


)













Equation





7







Let Umn,±1={u|umn=±1}. When approximating ln Σaj˜max ln aj, an approximation of Equation 7 can be sought as Equation 8. Note that the above symbol “˜” indicates approximation.














Math





8













L


(


u
mn


y

)





ln



P


(


u
mn

=

+
1


)



P


(


u
mn

=

-
1


)




+


max

Umn
,

+
1





{


ln






p


(

y

u

)



+

P


(

u


u
mn


)



}


-


max

Umn
,

-
1





{


ln






p


(

y

u

)



+

P


(

u


u
mn


)



}







Equation





8







P(u|umn) and ln P(u|umn) in Equation 8 are represented as follows.









Math





9















P


(

u


u
mn


)


=





(
ij
)



(
mn
)





P


(

u
ij

)









=





(
ij
)



(
mn
)






exp


(



u
ij



L


(

u
ij

)



2

)




exp


(


L


(

u
ij

)


2

)


+

exp


(

-


L


(

u
ij

)


2


)












Equation





9






Math





10












ln






P


(

u


u
mn


)



=


(



ij



ln






P


(

u
ij

)




)

-

ln






P


(

u
mn

)








Equation





10






Math





11















ln






P


(

u
ij

)



=





1
2



u
ij



P


(

u
ij

)



-

ln
(


exp


(


L


(

u
ij

)


2

)


+












exp


(

-


L


(

u
ij

)


2


)


)












1
2



u
ij



L


(

u
ij

)



-


1
2





L


(

u
ij

)









for








L


(

u
ij

)






>
2






=







L


(

u
ij

)


2





(



u
ij



sign


(

L


(

u
ij

)


)



-
1

)









Equation





11







Incidentally, the logarithmic probability of the equation defined in Equation 2 is represented in Equation 12.









Math





12












ln






P


(

y

u

)



=



-


N
r

2




ln


(

2





π






σ
2


)



-


1

2






σ
2








y
-

Hs


(
u
)





2







Equation





12







Accordingly, from Equations 7 and 13, in MAP or A Posteriori Probability (APP), the a posteriori L-value is represented as follows.














Math





13













L


(


u
mn


y

)


=

ln






U

mn
,

+
1






exp


{



-

1

2






σ
2









y
-

Hs


(
u
)





2


+



ij



ln






P


(

u
ij

)





}







U

mn
,

-
1






exp


{



-

1

2






σ
2









y
-

Hs


(
u
)





2


+



ij



ln






P


(

u
ij

)





}









Equation





13







Hereinafter, this is referred to as iterative APP decoding. From Equations 8 and 12, in the log-likelihood ratio utilizing Max-Log approximation (Max-Log APP), the a posteriori L-value is represented as follows.














Math





14













L


(


u
mn


y

)






max

Umn
,

+
1





{

Ψ


(

u
,
y
,

L


(
u
)



)


}


-


max

Umn
,

-
1





{

Ψ


(

u
,
y
,

L


(
u
)



)


}







Equation





14











Math





15













Ψ


(

u
,
y
,

L


(
u
)



)


=



-

1

2






σ
2









y
-

Hs


(
u
)





2


+



ij



ln






P


(

u
ij

)









Equation





15







Hereinafter, this is referred to as iterative Max-log APP decoding. The extrinsic information required in an iterative decoding system can be sought by subtracting prior inputs from Equations 13 and 14.


<System Model>



FIG. 28 shows the basic structure of the system that is related to the subsequent description. This system is a 2×2 spatial multiplexing MIMO system. There is an outer encoder for each of streams A and B. The two outer encoders are identical LDPC encoders. (Here, a structure using LDPC encoders as the outer encoders is described as an example, but the error correction coding used by the outer encoder is not limited to LDPC coding. The present invention may similarly be embodied using other error correction coding such as turbo coding, convolutional coding, LDPC convolutional coding, and the like. Furthermore, each outer encoder is described as having a transmit antenna, but the outer encoders are not limited to this structure. A plurality of transmit antennas may be used, and the number of outer encoders may be one. Also, a greater number of outer encoders may be used than the number of transmit antennas.) The streams A and B respectively have interleavers (πa, πb). Here, the modulation scheme is 2h-QAM (with h bits transmitted in one symbol).


The reception device performs iterative detection on the above MIMO signals (iterative APP (or iterative Max-log APP) decoding). Decoding of LDPC codes is performed by, for example, sum-product decoding.



FIG. 2 shows a frame structure and lists the order of symbols after interleaving. In this case, (ia, ja), (ib, jb) are represented by the following Equations.

Math 16
(ia,ja)=πaia,jaa)  Equation 16
Math 17
(ib,jb)=πbib,jba)  Equation 17


In this case, ia, ib indicate the order of symbols after interleaving, ja, jb indicate the bit positions (ja, jb=1, . . . , h) in the modulation scheme, πa, πb indicate the interleavers for the streams A and B, and Ωaia, ja, Ωbib, jb indicate the order of data in streams A and B before interleaving. Note that FIG. 2 shows the frame structure for ia=ib.


<Iterative Decoding>


The following is a detailed description of the algorithms for sum-product decoding used in decoding of LDPC codes and for iterative detection of MIMO signals in the reception device.


Sum-Product Decoding


Let a two-dimensional M×N matrix H={Hmn} be the check matrix for LDPC codes that are targeted for decoding. Subsets A(m), B(n) of the set [1, N]={1, 2, . . . , N} are defined by the following Equations.

Math 18
A(m)≡{n:Hmn=1}  Equation 18
Math 19
B(n)≡{m:Hmn=1}  Equation 19


In these Equations, A(m) represents the set of column indices of 1's in the mth column of the check matrix H, and B(n) represents the set of row indices of 1's in the nth row of the check matrix H. The algorithm for sum-product decoding is as follows.


Step A⋅1 (initialization): let a priori value log-likelihood ratio βmn=0 for all combinations (m, n) satisfying Hmn=1. Assume that the loop variable (the number of iterations) lsum=1 and the maximum number of loops is set to lsum, max.


Step A⋅2 (row processing): the extrinsic value log-likelihood ratio αmn is updated for all combinations (m, n) satisfying Hmn=1 in the order of m=1, 2, . . . , M, using the following updating Equations.














Math





20













α
mn

=


(





n





A


(
m
)



\n





sign


(


λ

n



+

β

mn




)



)

×

f
(





n





A


(
m
)



\n





f


(


λ

n



+

β

mn




)



)






Equation





20











Math





21


















sign


(
x
)




{



1



x

0






-
1




x
<
0










Equation





21











Math





22


















f


(
x
)




ln




exp


(
x
)


+
1



exp


(
x
)


-
1








Equation





22







In these Equations, f represents a Gallager function. Furthermore, the scheme of seeking λn is described in detail later.


Step A⋅3 (column processing): the extrinsic value log-likelihood ratio βmn is updated for all combinations (m, n) satisfying Hmn=1 in the order of n=1, 2, . . . , N, using the following updating Equation.









Math





23












β
mn

=





m





B


(
n
)



\

m





α


m



n







Equation





23







Step A⋅4 (calculating a log-likelihood ratio): the log-likelihood ratio Ln is sought for nϵ[1, N] by the following Equation.









Math





24












L
n

=






m





B


(
n
)



\

m





α


m



n



+

λ
n






Equation





24







Step A⋅5 (count of the number of iterations): if lsum<lsum, max, then lsum is incremented, and processing returns to step A⋅2. If lsum=lsum, max, the sum-product decoding in this round is finished.


The operations in one sum-product decoding have been described. Subsequently, iterative MIMO signal detection is performed. In the variables m, n, αmn, βmn, λn, and Ln, used in the above description of the operations of sum-product decoding, the variables in stream A are ma, na, αamana, βamana, λna, and Lna, and the variables in stream B are mb,nb, αbmbnb, βbmbnb, λnb, and Lnb.


<Iterative MIMO Signal Detection>


The following describes the scheme of seeking λn in iterative MIMO signal detection in detail.


The following Equation holds from Equation 1.









Math





25















y


(
t
)


=


(



y
1



(
t
)


,


y
2



(
t
)



)

T







=




H
22



(
t
)




s


(
t
)



+

n


(
t
)










Equation





25







The following Equations are defined from the frame structures of FIG. 2 and from Equations 16 and 17.

Math 26
naia,jaa  Equation 26
Math 27
nbib,jbb  Equation 27


In this case, na,nbϵ[1, N]. Hereinafter, λna, Lna, λnb, and Lnb, where the number of iterations of iterative MIMO signal detection is k, are represented as λk, na, Lk, na, λk, nb, and Lk, nb.


Step B⋅1 (initial detection; k=0): λ0, na and λ0, nb are sought as follows in the case of initial detection.


In iterative APP decoding:














Math





28













λ

0
,

n
X



=

ln






U

0
,

n
X

,

+
1






exp


{


-

1

2






σ
2










y


(

i
X

)


-



H
22



(

i
X

)




s


(

u


(

i
X

)


)






2


}







U

0
,

n
X

,

-
1






exp


{


-

1

2






σ
2










y


(

i
X

)


-



H
22



(

i
X

)




s


(

u


(

i
X

)


)






2


}









Equation





28







In iterative Max-log APP decoding:














Math





29













λ

0
,

n
X



=



max

U

0
,

n
X

,

+
1






{

Ψ


(


u


(

i
X

)


,

y


(

i
X

)



)


}


-


max

U

0
,

n
X

,

-
1






{

Ψ


(


u


(

i
X

)


,

y


(

i
X

)



)


}







Equation





29











Math





30


















Ψ


(


u


(

i
X

)


,

y


(

i
X

)



)


=


-

1

2






σ
2










y


(

i
X

)


-



H
22



(

i
X

)




s


(

u


(

i
X

)


)






2







Equation





30







Here, let X=a, b. Then, assume that the number of iterations of iterative MIMO signal detection is lmimo=0 and the maximum number of iterations is set to lmimo, max.


Step B⋅2 (iterative detection; the number of iterations k): λk, na and λk, nb, where the number of iterations is k, are represented as in Equations 31-34, from Equations 11, 13-15, 16, and 17. Let (X, Y)=(a, b)(b, a).


In iterative APP decoding:














Math





31













λ

k


,

n
X




=





L


k
-
1

,

Ω

iX
,
jX

X





(

u

Ω

iX
,
jX

X


)


+









ln
















U

k
,

n
X

,

+
1







exp


{



-

1

2






σ
2










y


(

i
X

)


-











H
22



(

i
X

)




s


(

u


(

i
X

)


)






2


+

ρ


(

u

Ω

iX
,
jX

X


)



}

















U

k
,

n
X

,

-
1






exp


{



-

1

2






σ
2










y


(

i
X

)


-











H
22



(

i
X

)




s


(

u


(

i
X

)


)






2


+

ρ


(

u

Ω

iX
,
jX

X


)



}
















Equation





31











Math





32













ρ


(

u

Ω

iX
,
jX

X


)


=






γ
=
1


γ

jX


h








L


k
-
1

,

Ω

iX
,
γ

X





(

u

Ω

iX
,
γ

X


)


2





(



u

Ω

iX
,
γ

X




sign


(


L


k
-
1

,

Ω

iX
,
γ

X





(

u

Ω

iX
,
γ

X


)


)



-
1

)



+




γ
=
1

h








L


k
-
1

,

Ω

iX
,
γ

Y





(

u

Ω

iX
,
γ

Y


)


2





(



u

Ω

iX
,
γ

Y




sign


(


L


k
-
1

,

Ω

iX
,
γ

Y





(

u

Ω

iX
,
γ

Y


)


)



-
1

)








Equation





32







In iterative Max-log APP decoding:














Math





33













λ

k


,

n
X




=



L


k
-
1

,

Ω

iX
,
jX

X





(

u

Ω

iX
,
jX

X


)


+


max

U

k
,

n
X

,

+
1






{

Ψ


(


u


(

i
X

)


,

y


(

i
X

)


,

ρ


(

u

Ω

iX
,
jX

X


)



)


}


-


max

U

k
,

n
X

,

-
1






{

Ψ


(


u


(

i
X

)


,

y


(

i
X

)


,

ρ


(

u

Ω

iX
,
jX

X


)



)


}







Equation





33











Math





34













Ψ


(


u


(

i
X

)


,

y


(

i
X

)


,

ρ


(

u

Ω

iX
,
jX

X


)



)


=



-

1

2






σ
2










y


(

i
X

)


-



H
22



(

i
X

)




s


(

u


(

i
X

)


)






2


+

ρ


(

u

Ω

iX
,
jX

X


)







Equation





34







Step B⋅3 (counting the number of iterations and estimating a codeword): increment lmimo if lmimo<lmimo, max, and return to step B⋅2. Assuming that lmimo=lmimo, max, the estimated codeword is sought as in the following Equation.









Math





35













u
^


n
X


=

{



1




L


l
mimo

,

n
X




0






-
1





L


l
mimo

,

n
X



<
0









Equation





35







Here, let X=a, b.



FIG. 3 is an example of the structure of a transmission device 300 in the present embodiment. An encoder 302A receives information (data) 301A and a frame structure signal 313 as inputs and, in accordance with the frame structure signal 313, performs error correction coding such as convolutional coding, LDPC coding, turbo coding, or the like, outputting encoded data 303A. (The frame structure signal 313 includes information such as the error correction scheme used for error correction coding of data, the coding rate, the block length, and the like. The encoder 302A uses the error correction scheme indicated by the frame structure signal 313. Furthermore, the error correction scheme may be hopped.)


An interleaver 304A receives the encoded data 303A and the frame structure signal 313 as inputs and performs interleaving, i.e. changing the order of the data, to output interleaved data 305A. (The scheme of interleaving may be hopped based on the frame structure signal 313.)


A mapping unit 306A receives the interleaved data 305A and the frame structure signal 313 as inputs, performs modulation such as Quadrature Phase Shift Keying (QPSK), 16 Quadrature Amplitude Modulation (16QAM), 64 Quadrature Amplitude Modulation (64QAM), or the like, and outputs a resulting baseband signal 307A. (The modulation scheme may be hopped based on the frame structure signal 313.)



FIGS. 24A and 24B are an example of a mapping scheme over an I-Q plane, having an in-phase component I and a quadrature component Q, to form a baseband signal in QPSK modulation. For example, as shown in FIG. 24A, if the input data is “00”, the output is I=1.0, Q=1.0. Similarly, for input data of “01”, the output is I=−1.0, Q=1.0, and so forth. FIG. 24B is an example of a different scheme of mapping in an I-Q plane for QPSK modulation than FIG. 24A. The difference between FIG. 24B and FIG. 24A is that the signal points in FIG. 24A have been rotated around the origin to yield the signal points of FIG. 24B. Non-Patent Literature 9 and Non-Patent Literature 10 describe such a constellation rotation scheme, and the Cyclic Q Delay described in Non-Patent Literature 9 and Non-Patent Literature 10 may also be adopted. As another example apart from FIGS. 24A and 24B, FIGS. 25A and 25B show signal point layout in the I-Q plane for 16QAM. The example corresponding to FIG. 24A is shown in FIG. 25A, and the example corresponding to FIG. 24B is shown in FIG. 25B.


An encoder 302B receives information (data) 301B and the frame structure signal 313 as inputs and, in accordance with the frame structure signal 313, performs error correction coding such as convolutional coding, LDPC coding, turbo coding, or the like, outputting encoded data 303B. (The frame structure signal 313 includes information such as the error correction scheme used, the coding rate, the block length, and the like. The error correction scheme indicated by the frame structure signal 313 is used. Furthermore, the error correction scheme may be hopped.)


An interleaver 304B receives the encoded data 303B and the frame structure signal 313 as inputs and performs interleaving, i.e. changing the order of the data, to output interleaved data 305B. (The scheme of interleaving may be hopped based on the frame structure signal 313.)


A mapping unit 306B receives the interleaved data 305B and the frame structure signal 313 as inputs, performs modulation such as Quadrature Phase Shift Keying (QPSK), 16 Quadrature Amplitude Modulation (16QAM), 64 Quadrature Amplitude Modulation (64QAM), or the like, and outputs a resulting baseband signal 307B. (The modulation scheme may be hopped based on the frame structure signal 313.)


A weighting information generating unit 314 receives the frame structure signal 313 as an input and outputs information 315 regarding a weighting scheme based on the frame structure signal 313. The weighting scheme is characterized by regular hopping between weights.


A weighting unit 308A receives the baseband signal 307A, the baseband signal 307B, and the information 315 regarding the weighting scheme, and based on the information 315 regarding the weighting scheme, performs weighting on the baseband signal 307A and the baseband signal 307B and outputs a signal 309A resulting from the weighting. Details on the weighting scheme are provided later.


A wireless unit 310A receives the signal 309A resulting from the weighting as an input and performs processing such as orthogonal modulation, band limiting, frequency conversion, amplification, and the like, outputting a transmission signal 311A. A transmission signal 511A is output as a radio wave from an antenna 312A.


A weighting unit 308B receives the baseband signal 307A, the baseband signal 307B, and the information 315 regarding the weighting scheme, and based on the information 315 regarding the weighting scheme, performs weighting on the baseband signal 307A and the baseband signal 307B and outputs a signal 309B resulting from the weighting.



FIG. 26 shows the structure of a weighting unit. The baseband signal 307A is multiplied by w11(t), yielding w11(t)s1(t), and is multiplied by w21(t), yielding w21(t)s1(t). Similarly, the baseband signal 307B is multiplied by w12(t) to generate w12(t)s2(t) and is multiplied by w22(t) to generate w22(t)s2(t). Next, z1(t)=w11(t)s1(t)+w12(t)s2(t) and z2(t)=w21(t)s1(t)+w22(t)s2(t) are obtained.


Details on the weighting scheme are provided later.


A wireless unit 310B receives the signal 309B resulting from the weighting as an input and performs processing such as orthogonal modulation, band limiting, frequency conversion, amplification, and the like, outputting a transmission signal 311B. A transmission signal 511B is output as a radio wave from an antenna 312B.



FIG. 4 shows an example of the structure of a transmission device 400 that differs from FIG. 3. The differences in FIG. 4 from FIG. 3 are described.


An encoder 402 receives information (data) 401 and the frame structure signal 313 as inputs and, in accordance with the frame structure signal 313, performs error correction coding and outputs encoded data 402.


A distribution unit 404 receives the encoded data 403 as an input, distributes the data 403, and outputs data 405A and data 405B. Note that in FIG. 4, one encoder is shown, but the number of encoders is not limited in this way. The present invention may similarly be embodied when the number of encoders is m (where m is an integer greater than or equal to one) and the distribution unit divides encoded data generated by each encoder into two parts and outputs the divided data.



FIG. 5 shows an example of a frame structure in the time domain for a transmission device according to the present embodiment. A symbol 500_1 is a symbol for notifying the reception device of the transmission scheme. For example, the symbol 500_1 conveys information such as the error correction scheme used for transmitting data symbols, the coding rate, and the modulation scheme used for transmitting data symbols.


The symbol 501_1 is for estimating channel fluctuation for the modulated signal z1(t) (where t is time) transmitted by the transmission device. The symbol 502_1 is the data symbol transmitted as symbol number u (in the time domain) by the modulated signal z1(t), and the symbol 503_1 is the data symbol transmitted as symbol number u+1 by the modulated signal z1(t).


The symbol 501_2 is for estimating channel fluctuation for the modulated signal z2(t) (where t is time) transmitted by the transmission device. The symbol 502_2 is the data symbol transmitted as symbol number u by the modulated signal z2(t), and the symbol 503_2 is the data symbol transmitted as symbol number u+1 by the modulated signal z2(t).


The following describes the relationships between the modulated signals z1(t) and z2(t) transmitted by the transmission device and the received signals r1(t) and r2(t) received by the reception device.


In FIGS. 5, 504#1 and 504#2 indicate transmit antennas in the transmission device, and 505#1 and 505#2 indicate receive antennas in the reception device. The transmission device transmits the modulated signal z1(t) from transmit antenna 504#1 and transmits the modulated signal z2(t) from transmit antenna 504#2. In this case, the modulated signal z1(t) and the modulated signal z2(t) are assumed to occupy the same (a shared/common) frequency (bandwidth). Letting the channel fluctuation for the transmit antennas of the transmission device and the antennas of the reception device be h11(t), h12(t), h21(t), and h22(t), the signal received by the receive antenna 505#1 of the reception device be r1(t), and the signal received by the receive antenna 505#2 of the reception device be r2(t), the following relationship holds.









Math





36












(




r





1


(
t
)







r





2


(
t
)





)

=


(





h
11



(
t
)






h
12



(
t
)








h
21



(
t
)






h
22



(
t
)





)



(




z





1


(
t
)







z





2


(
t
)





)






Equation





36








FIG. 6 relates to the weighting scheme (precoding scheme) in the present embodiment. A weighting unit 600 integrates the weighting units 308A and 308B in FIG. 3. As shown in FIG. 6, a stream s1(t) and a stream s2(t) correspond to the baseband signals 307A and 307B in FIG. 3. In other words, the streams s1(t) and s2(t) are the baseband signal in-phase components I and quadrature components Q when mapped according to a modulation scheme such as QPSK, 16QAM, 64QAM, or the like. As indicated by the frame structure of FIG. 6, the stream s1(t) is represented as s1(u) at symbol number u, as s1(u+1) at symbol number u+1, and so forth. Similarly, the stream s2(t) is represented as s2(u) at symbol number u, as s2(u+1) at symbol number u+1, and so forth. The weighting unit 600 receives the baseband signals 307A (s1(t)) and 307B (s2(t)) and the information 315 regarding weighting information in FIG. 3 as inputs, performs weighting in accordance with the information 315 regarding weighting, and outputs the signals 309A (z1(t)) and 309B (z2(t)) after weighting in FIG. 3. In this case, z1(t) and z2(t) are represented as follows.


For symbol number 4i (where i is an integer greater than or equal to zero):









Math





37












(




z





1


(

4





i

)







z





2


(

4





i

)





)

=


1

2




(




e

j





0





e

j





0







e

j





0





e

j


3
4


π





)



(




s





1


(

4





i

)







s





2


(

4





i

)





)






Equation





37








Here, j is an imaginary unit.


For symbol number 4i+1:









Math





38












(




z





1


(


4





i

+
1

)







z





2


(


4





i

+
1

)





)

=


1

2




(




e

j





0





e

j





0







e

j


3
4


π





e

j





0





)



(




s





1


(


4





i

+
1

)







s





2


(


4





i

+
1

)





)






Equation





38








For symbol number 4i+2:









Math





39












(




z





1


(


4





i

+
2

)







z





2


(


4





i

+
2

)





)

=


1

2




(




e

j





0





e

j






3
4


π







e

j





0





e

j





0





)



(




s





1


(


4





i

+
2

)







s





2


(


4





i

+
2

)





)






Equation





39








For symbol number 4i+3:









Math





40












(




z





1


(


4





i

+
3

)







z





2


(


4





i

+
3

)





)

=


1

2




(




e

j






3
4


π





e

j





0







e

j





0





e

j





0





)



(




s





1


(


4





i

+
3

)







s





2


(


4





i

+
3

)





)






Equation





40







In this way, the weighting unit in FIG. 6 regularly hops between precoding weights over a four-slot period (cycle). (While precoding weights have been described as being hopped between regularly over four slots, the number of slots for regular hopping is not limited to four.)


Incidentally, Non-Patent Literature 4 describes hopping the precoding weights for each slot. This hopping of precoding weights is characterized by being random. On the other hand, in the present embodiment, a certain period (cycle) is provided, and the precoding weights are hopped between regularly. Furthermore, in each 2×2 precoding weight matrix composed of four precoding weights, the absolute value of each of the four precoding weights is equivalent to (1/sqrt(2)), and hopping is regularly performed between precoding weight matrices having this characteristic.


In an LOS environment, if a special precoding matrix is used, reception quality may greatly improve, yet the special precoding matrix differs depending on the conditions of direct waves. In an LOS environment, however, a certain tendency exists, and if precoding matrices are hopped between regularly in accordance with this tendency, the reception quality of data greatly improves. On the other hand, when precoding matrices are hopped between at random, a precoding matrix other than the above-described special precoding matrix may exist, and the possibility of performing precoding only with biased precoding matrices that are not suitable for the LOS environment also exists. Therefore, in an LOS environment, excellent reception quality may not always be obtained. Accordingly, there is a need for a precoding hopping scheme suitable for an LOS environment. The present invention proposes such a precoding scheme.



FIG. 7 is an example of the structure of a reception device 700 in the present embodiment. A wireless unit 703_X receives, as an input, a received signal 702_X received by an antenna 701_X, performs processing such as frequency conversion, quadrature demodulation, and the like, and outputs a baseband signal 704_X.


A channel fluctuation estimating unit 705_1 for the modulated signal z1 transmitted by the transmission device receives the baseband signal 704_X as an input, extracts a reference symbol 501_1 for channel estimation as in FIG. 5, estimates a value corresponding to h11 in Equation 36, and outputs a channel estimation signal 706_1.


A channel fluctuation estimating unit 705_2 for the modulated signal z2 transmitted by the transmission device receives the baseband signal 704_X as an input, extracts a reference symbol 501_2 for channel estimation as in FIG. 5, estimates a value corresponding to h12 in Equation 36, and outputs a channel estimation signal 706_2.


A wireless unit 703_Y receives, as input, a received signal 702_Y received by an antenna 701_Y, performs processing such as frequency conversion, quadrature demodulation, and the like, and outputs a baseband signal 704_Y.


A channel fluctuation estimating unit 707_1 for the modulated signal z1 transmitted by the transmission device receives the baseband signal 704_Y as an input, extracts a reference symbol 501_1 for channel estimation as in FIG. 5, estimates a value corresponding to h21 in Equation 36, and outputs a channel estimation signal 708_1.


A channel fluctuation estimating unit 707_2 for the modulated signal z2 transmitted by the transmission device receives the baseband signal 704_Y as an input, extracts a reference symbol 501_2 for channel estimation as in FIG. 5, estimates a value corresponding to h22 in Equation 36, and outputs a channel estimation signal 708_2.


A control information decoding unit 709 receives the baseband signal 704_X and the baseband signal 704_Y as inputs, detects the symbol 500_1 that indicates the transmission scheme as in FIG. 5, and outputs a signal 710 regarding information on the transmission scheme indicated by the transmission device.


A signal processing unit 711 receives, as inputs, the baseband signals 704_X and 704_Y, the channel estimation signals 706_1, 706_2, 708_1, and 708_2, and the signal 710 regarding information on the transmission scheme indicated by the transmission device, performs detection and decoding, and outputs received data 712_1 and 712_2.


Next, operations by the signal processing unit 711 in FIG. 7 are described in detail. FIG. 8 is an example of the structure of the signal processing unit 711 in the present embodiment. FIG. 8 shows an INNER MIMO detector, a soft-in/soft-out decoder, and a weighting coefficient generating unit as the main elements. Non-Patent Literature 2 and Non-Patent Literature 3 describe the scheme of iterative decoding with this structure. The MIMO system described in Non-Patent Literature 2 and Non-Patent Literature 3 is a spatial multiplexing MIMO system, whereas the present embodiment differs from Non-Patent Literature 2 and Non-Patent Literature 3 by describing a MIMO system that changes precoding weights with time. Letting the (channel) matrix in Equation 36 be H(t), the precoding weight matrix in FIG. 6 be W(t) (where the precoding weight matrix changes over t), the received vector be R(t)=(r1(t),r2(t)T, and the stream vector be S(t)=(s1(t),s2(t)T, the following Equation holds.

Math 41
R(t)=H(t)W(t)S(t)  Equation 41


In this case, the reception device can apply the decoding scheme in Non-Patent Literature 2 and Non-Patent Literature 3 to the received vector R(t) by considering H(t)W(t) as the channel matrix.


Therefore, a weighting coefficient generating unit 819 in FIG. 8 receives, as input, a signal 818 regarding information on the transmission scheme indicated by the transmission device (corresponding to 710 in FIG. 7) and outputs a signal 820 regarding information on weighting coefficients.


An INNER MIMO detector 803 receives the signal 820 regarding information on weighting coefficients as input and, using the signal 820, performs the calculation in Equation 41. Iterative detection and decoding is thus performed. The following describes operations thereof.


In the signal processing unit in FIG. 8, a processing scheme such as that shown in FIG. 10 is necessary for iterative decoding (iterative detection). First, one codeword (or one frame) of the modulated signal (stream) s1 and one codeword (or one frame) of the modulated signal (stream) s2 are decoded. As a result, the Log-Likelihood Ratio (LLR) of each bit of the one codeword (or one frame) of the modulated signal (stream) s1 and of the one codeword (or one frame) of the modulated signal (stream) s2 is obtained from the soft-in/soft-out decoder. Detection and decoding is performed again using the LLR. These operations are performed multiple times (these operations being referred to as iterative decoding (iterative detection)). Hereinafter, description focuses on the scheme of generating the log-likelihood ratio (LLR) of a symbol at a particular time in one frame.


In FIG. 8, a storage unit 815 receives, as inputs, a baseband signal 801X (corresponding to the baseband signal 704_X in FIG. 7), a channel estimation signal group 802X (corresponding to the channel estimation signals 706_1 and 706_2 in FIG. 7), a baseband signal 801Y (corresponding to the baseband signal 704_Y in FIG. 7), and a channel estimation signal group 802Y (corresponding to the channel estimation signals 708_1 and 708_2 in FIG. 7). In order to achieve iterative decoding (iterative detection), the storage unit 815 calculates H(t)W(t) in Equation 41 and stores the calculated matrix as a transformed channel signal group. The storage unit 815 outputs the above signals when necessary as a baseband signal 816X, a transformed channel estimation signal group 817X, a baseband signal 816Y, and a transformed channel estimation signal group 817Y.


Subsequent operations are described separately for initial detection and for iterative decoding (iterative detection).


<Initial Detection>


The INNER MIMO detector 803 receives, as inputs, the baseband signal 801X, the channel estimation signal group 802X, the baseband signal 801Y, and the channel estimation signal group 802Y. Here, the modulation scheme for the modulated signal (stream) s1 and the modulated signal (stream) s2 is described as 16QAM.


The INNER MIMO detector 803 first calculates H(t)W(t) from the channel estimation signal group 802X and the channel estimation signal group 802Y to seek candidate signal points corresponding to the baseband signal 801X. FIG. 11 shows such calculation. In FIG. 11, each black dot (●) is a candidate signal point in the I-Q plane. Since the modulation scheme is 16QAM, there are 256 candidate signal points. (Since FIG. 11 is only for illustration, not all 256 candidate signal points are shown.) Here, letting the four bits transferred by modulated signal s1 be b0, b1, b2, and b3, and the four bits transferred by modulated signal s2 be b4, b5, b6, and b7, candidate signal points corresponding to (b0, b1, b2, b3, b4, b5, b6, b7) in FIG. 11 exist. The squared Euclidian distance is sought between a received signal point 1101 (corresponding to the baseband signal 801X) and each candidate signal point. Each squared Euclidian distance is divided by the noise variance σ2. Accordingly, EX(b0, b1, b2, b3, b4, b5, b6, b7), i.e. the value of the squared Euclidian distance between a candidate signal point corresponding to (b0, b1, b2, b3, b4, b5, b6, b7) and a received signal point, divided by the noise variance, is sought. Note that the baseband signals and the modulated signals s1 and s2 are each complex signals.


Similarly, H(t)W(t) is calculated from the channel estimation signal group 802X and the channel estimation signal group 802Y, candidate signal points corresponding to the baseband signal 801Y are sought, the squared Euclidian distance for the received signal point (corresponding to the baseband signal 801Y) is sought, and the squared Euclidian distance is divided by the noise variance σ2. Accordingly, EY(b0, b1, b2, b3, b4, b5, b6, b7), i.e. the value of the squared Euclidian distance between a candidate signal point corresponding to (b0, b1, b2, b3, b4, b5, b6, b7) and a received signal point, divided by the noise variance, is sought.


Then EX(b0, b1, b2, b3, b4, b5, b6, b7)+EY(b0, b1, b2, b3, b4, b5, b6, b7)=E(b0, b1, b2, b3, b4, b5, b6, b7) is sought.


The INNER MIMO detector 803 outputs E(b0, b1, b2, b3, b4, b5, b6, b7) as a signal 804.


A log-likelihood calculating unit 805A receives the signal 804 as input, calculates the log likelihood for bits b0, b1, b2, and b3, and outputs a log-likelihood signal 806A. Note that during calculation of the log likelihood, the log likelihood for “1” and the log likelihood for “0” are calculated. The calculation scheme is as shown in Equations 28, 29, and 30. Details can be found in Non-Patent Literature 2 and Non-Patent Literature 3.


Similarly, a log-likelihood calculating unit 805B receives the signal 804 as input, calculates the log likelihood for bits b4, b5, b6, and b7, and outputs a log-likelihood signal 806B.


A deinterleaver (807A) receives the log-likelihood signal 806A as an input, performs deinterleaving corresponding to the interleaver (the interleaver (304A) in FIG. 3), and outputs a deinterleaved log-likelihood signal 808A.


Similarly, a deinterleaver (807B) receives the log-likelihood signal 806B as an input, performs deinterleaving corresponding to the interleaver (the interleaver (304B) in FIG. 3), and outputs a deinterleaved log-likelihood signal 808B.


A log-likelihood ratio calculating unit 809A receives the interleaved log-likelihood signal 808A as an input, calculates the log-likelihood ratio (LLR) of the bits encoded by the encoder 302A in FIG. 3, and outputs a log-likelihood ratio signal 810A.


Similarly, a log-likelihood ratio calculating unit 809B receives the interleaved log-likelihood signal 808B as an input, calculates the log-likelihood ratio (LLR) of the bits encoded by the encoder 302B in FIG. 3, and outputs a log-likelihood ratio signal 810B.


A soft-in/soft-out decoder 811A receives the log-likelihood ratio signal 810A as an input, performs decoding, and outputs a decoded log-likelihood ratio 812A.


Similarly, a soft-in/soft-out decoder 811B receives the log-likelihood ratio signal 810B as an input, performs decoding, and outputs a decoded log-likelihood ratio 812B.


<Iterative Decoding (Iterative Detection), Number of Iterations k>


An interleaver (813A) receives the log-likelihood ratio 812A decoded by the soft-in/soft-out decoder in the (k−1)th iteration as an input, performs interleaving, and outputs an interleaved log-likelihood ratio 814A. The interleaving pattern in the interleaver (813A) is similar to the interleaving pattern in the interleaver (304A) in FIG. 3.


An interleaver (813B) receives the log-likelihood ratio 812B decoded by the soft-in/soft-out decoder in the (k−1)th iteration as an input, performs interleaving, and outputs an interleaved log-likelihood ratio 814B. The interleaving pattern in the interleaver (813B) is similar to the interleaving pattern in the interleaver (304B) in FIG. 3.


The INNER MIMO detector 803 receives, as inputs, the baseband signal 816X, the transformed channel estimation signal group 817X, the baseband signal 816Y, the transformed channel estimation signal group 817Y, the interleaved log-likelihood ratio 814A, and the interleaved log-likelihood ratio 814B. The reason for using the baseband signal 816X, the transformed channel estimation signal group 817X, the baseband signal 816Y, and the transformed channel estimation signal group 817Y instead of the baseband signal 801X, the channel estimation signal group 802X, the baseband signal 801Y, and the channel estimation signal group 802Y is because a delay occurs due to iterative decoding.


The difference between operations by the INNER MIMO detector 803 for iterative decoding and for initial detection is the use of the interleaved log-likelihood ratio 814A and the interleaved log-likelihood ratio 814B during signal processing. The INNER MIMO detector 803 first seeks E(b0, b1, b2, b3, b4, b5, b6, b7), as during initial detection. Additionally, coefficients corresponding to Equations 11 and 32 are sought from the interleaved log-likelihood ratio 814A and the interleaved log-likelihood ratio 914B. The value E(b0, b1, b2, b3, b4, b5, b6, b7) is adjusted using the sought coefficients, and the resulting value E′(b0, b1, b2, b3, b4, b5, b6, b7) is output as the signal 804.


The log-likelihood calculating unit 805A receives the signal 804 as input, calculates the log likelihood for bits b0, b1, b2, and b3, and outputs the log-likelihood signal 806A. Note that during calculation of the log likelihood, the log likelihood for “1” and the log likelihood for “0” are calculated. The calculation scheme is as shown in Equations 31, 32, 33, 34, and 35. Details can be found in Non-Patent Literature 2 and Non-Patent Literature 3.


Similarly, the log-likelihood calculating unit 805B receives the signal 804 as input, calculates the log likelihood for bits b4, b5, b6, and b7, and outputs the log-likelihood signal 806B. Operations by the deinterleaver onwards are similar to initial detection.


Note that while FIG. 8 shows the structure of the signal processing unit when performing iterative detection, iterative detection is not always essential for obtaining excellent reception quality, and a structure not including the interleavers 813A and 813B, which are necessary only for iterative detection, is possible. In such a case, the INNER MIMO detector 803 does not perform iterative detection.


The main part of the present embodiment is calculation of H(t)W(t). Note that as shown in Non-Patent Literature 5 and the like, QR decomposition may be used to perform initial detection and iterative detection.


Furthermore, as shown in Non-Patent Literature 11, based on H(t)W(t), linear operation of the Minimum Mean Squared Error (MMSE) and Zero Forcing (ZF) may be performed in order to perform initial detection.



FIG. 9 is the structure of a different signal processing unit than FIG. 8 and is for the modulated signal transmitted by the transmission device in FIG. 4. The difference with FIG. 8 is the number of soft-in/soft-out decoders. A soft-in/soft-out decoder 901 receives, as inputs, the log-likelihood ratio signals 810A and 810B, performs decoding, and outputs a decoded log-likelihood ratio 902. A distribution unit 903 receives the decoded log-likelihood ratio 902 as an input and distributes the log-likelihood ratio 902. Other operations are similar to FIG. 8.



FIGS. 12A and 12B show BER characteristics for a transmission scheme using the precoding weights of the present embodiment under similar conditions to FIGS. 29A and 29B. FIG. 12A shows the BER characteristics of Max-log A Posteriori Probability (APP) without iterative detection (see Non-Patent Literature 1 and Non-Patent Literature 2), and FIG. 12B shows the BER characteristics of Max-log-APP with iterative detection (see Non-Patent Literature 1 and Non-Patent Literature 2) (number of iterations: five). Comparing FIGS. 12A, 12B, 29A, and 29B shows how if the transmission scheme of the present embodiment is used, the BER characteristics when the Rician factor is large greatly improve over the BER characteristics when using spatial multiplexing MIMO system, thereby confirming the usefulness of the scheme in the present embodiment.


As described above, when a transmission device transmits a plurality of modulated signals from a plurality of antennas in a MIMO system, the advantageous effect of improved transmission quality, as compared to conventional spatial multiplexing MIMO system, is achieved in an LOS environment in which direct waves dominate by hopping between precoding weights regularly over time, as in the present embodiment.


In the present embodiment, and in particular with regards to the structure of the reception device, operations have been described for a limited number of antennas, but the present invention may be embodied in the same way even if the number of antennas increases. In other words, the number of antennas in the reception device does not affect the operations or advantageous effects of the present embodiment. Furthermore, in the present embodiment, the example of LDPC coding has particularly been explained, but the present invention is not limited to LDPC coding. Furthermore, with regards to the decoding scheme, the soft-in/soft-out decoders are not limited to the example of sum-product decoding. Another soft-in/soft-out decoding scheme may be used, such as a BCJR algorithm, a SOVA algorithm, a Max-log-MAP algorithm, and the like. Details are provided in Non-Patent Literature 6.


Additionally, in the present embodiment, the example of a single carrier scheme has been described, but the present invention is not limited in this way and may be similarly embodied for multi-carrier transmission. Accordingly, when using a scheme such as spread spectrum communication, Orthogonal Frequency-Division Multiplexing (OFDM), Single Carrier Frequency Division Multiple Access (SC-FDMA), Single Carrier Orthogonal Frequency-Division Multiplexing (SC-OFDM), or wavelet OFDM as described in Non-Patent Literature 7 and the like, for example, the present invention may be similarly embodied. Furthermore, in the present embodiment, symbols other than data symbols, such as pilot symbols (preamble, unique word, and the like), symbols for transmission of control information, and the like, may be arranged in the frame in any way.


The following describes an example of using OFDM as an example of a multi-carrier scheme.



FIG. 13 shows the structure of a transmission device when using OFDM. In FIG. 13, elements that operate in a similar way to FIG. 3 bear the same reference signs.


An OFDM related processor 1301A receives, as input, the weighted signal 309A, performs processing related to OFDM, and outputs a transmission signal 1302A. Similarly, an OFDM related processor 1301B receives, as input, the weighted signal 309B, performs processing related to OFDM, and outputs a transmission signal 1302B.



FIG. 14 shows an example of a structure from the OFDM related processors 1301A and 1301B in FIG. 13 onwards. The part from 1401A to 1410A is related to the part from 1301A to 312A in FIG. 13, and the part from 1401B to 1410B is related to the part from 1301B to 312B in FIG. 13.


A serial/parallel converter 1402A performs serial/parallel conversion on a weighted signal 1401A (corresponding to the weighted signal 309A in FIG. 13) and outputs a parallel signal 1403A.


A reordering unit 1404A receives a parallel signal 1403A as input, performs reordering, and outputs a reordered signal 1405A. Reordering is described in detail later.


An inverse fast Fourier transformer 1406A receives the reordered signal 1405A as an input, performs a fast Fourier transform, and outputs a fast Fourier transformed signal 1407A.


A wireless unit 1408A receives the fast Fourier transformed signal 1407A as an input, performs processing such as frequency conversion, amplification, and the like, and outputs a modulated signal 1409A. The modulated signal 1409A is output as a radio wave from an antenna 1410A.


A serial/parallel converter 1402B performs serial/parallel conversion on a weighted signal 1401B (corresponding to the weighted signal 309B in FIG. 13) and outputs a parallel signal 1403B.


A reordering unit 1404B receives a parallel signal 1403B as input, performs reordering, and outputs a reordered signal 1405B. Reordering is described in detail later.


An inverse fast Fourier transformer 1406B receives the reordered signal 1405B as an input, performs a fast Fourier transform, and outputs a fast Fourier transformed signal 1407B.


A wireless unit 1408B receives the fast Fourier transformed signal 1407B as an input, performs processing such as frequency conversion, amplification, and the like, and outputs a modulated signal 1409B. The modulated signal 1409B is output as a radio wave from an antenna 1410B.


In the transmission device of FIG. 3, since the transmission scheme does not use multi-carrier, precoding hops to form a four-slot period (cycle), as shown in FIG. 6, and the precoded symbols are arranged in the time domain. When using a multi-carrier transmission scheme as in the OFDM scheme shown in FIG. 13, it is of course possible to arrange the precoded symbols in the time domain as in FIG. 3 for each (sub)carrier. In the case of a multi-carrier transmission scheme, however, it is possible to arrange symbols in the frequency domain, or in both the frequency and time domains. The following describes these arrangements.



FIGS. 15A and 15B show an example of a scheme of reordering symbols by reordering units 1401A and 1401B in FIG. 14, the horizontal axis representing frequency, and the vertical axis representing time. The frequency domain runs from (sub)carrier 0 through (sub)carrier 9. The modulated signals z1 and z2 use the same frequency bandwidth at the same time. FIG. 15A shows the reordering scheme for symbols of the modulated signal z1, and FIG. 15B shows the reordering scheme for symbols of the modulated signal z2. Numbers #1, #2, #3, #4, . . . are assigned to in order to the symbols of the weighted signal 1401A which is input into the serial/parallel converter 1402A. At this point, symbols are assigned regularly, as shown in FIG. 15A. The symbols #1, #2, #3, #4, . . . are arranged in order starting from carrier 0. The symbols #1 through #9 are assigned to time $1, and subsequently, the symbols #10 through #19 are assigned to time $2.


Similarly, numbers #1, #2, #3, #4, . . . are assigned in order to the symbols of the weighted signal 1401B which is input into the serial/parallel converter 1402B. At this point, symbols are assigned regularly, as shown in FIG. 15B. The symbols #1, #2, #3, #4, . . . are arranged in order starting from carrier 0. The symbols #1 through #9 are assigned to time $1, and subsequently, the symbols #10 through #19 are assigned to time $2. Note that the modulated signals z1 and z2 are complex signals.


The symbol group 1501 and the symbol group 1502 shown in FIGS. 15A and 15B are the symbols for one period (cycle) when using the precoding weight hopping scheme shown in FIG. 6. Symbol #0 is the symbol when using the precoding weight of slot 4i in FIG. 6. Symbol #1 is the symbol when using the precoding weight of slot 4i+1 in FIG. 6. Symbol #2 is the symbol when using the precoding weight of slot 4i+2 in FIG. 6. Symbol #3 is the symbol when using the precoding weight of slot 4i+3 in FIG. 6. Accordingly, symbol #x is as follows. When x mod 4 is 0, the symbol #x is the symbol when using the precoding weight of slot 4i in FIG. 6. When x mod 4 is 1, the symbol #x is the symbol when using the precoding weight of slot 4i+1 in FIG. 6. When x mod 4 is 2, the symbol #x is the symbol when using the precoding weight of slot 4i+2 in FIG. 6. When x mod 4 is 3, the symbol #x is the symbol when using the precoding weight of slot 4i+3 in FIG. 6.


In this way, when using a multi-carrier transmission scheme such as OFDM, unlike during single carrier transmission, symbols can be arranged in the frequency domain. Furthermore, the ordering of symbols is not limited to the ordering shown in FIGS. 15A and 15B. Other examples are described with reference to FIGS. 16A, 16B, 17A, and 17B.



FIGS. 16A and 16B show an example of a scheme of reordering symbols by the reordering units 1404A and 1404B in FIG. 14, the horizontal axis representing frequency, and the vertical axis representing time, that differs from FIGS. 15A and 15B. FIG. 16A shows the reordering scheme for symbols of the modulated signal z1, and FIG. 16B shows the reordering scheme for symbols of the modulated signal z2. The difference in FIGS. 16A and 16B as compared to FIGS. 15A and 15B is that the reordering scheme of the symbols of the modulated signal z1 differs from the reordering scheme of the symbols of the modulated signal z2. In FIG. 16B, symbols #0 through #5 are assigned to carriers 4 through 9, and symbols #6 through #9 are assigned to carriers 0 through 3. Subsequently, symbols #10 through #19 are assigned regularly in the same way. At this point, as in FIGS. 15A and 15B, the symbol group 1601 and the symbol group 1602 shown in FIGS. 16A and 16B are the symbols for one period (cycle) when using the precoding weight hopping scheme shown in FIG. 6.



FIGS. 17A and 17B show an example of a scheme of reordering symbols by the reordering units 1404A and 1404B in FIG. 14, the horizontal axis representing frequency, and the vertical axis representing time, that differs from FIGS. 15A and 15B. FIG. 17A shows the reordering scheme for symbols of the modulated signal z1, and FIG. 17B shows the reordering scheme for symbols of the modulated signal z2. The difference in FIGS. 17A and 17B as compared to FIGS. 15A and 15B is that whereas the symbols are arranged in order by carrier in FIGS. 15A and 15B, the symbols are not arranged in order by carrier in FIGS. 17A and 17B. It is obvious that, in FIGS. 17A and 17B, the reordering scheme of the symbols of the modulated signal z1 may differ from the reordering scheme of the symbols of the modulated signal z2, as in FIGS. 16A and 16B.



FIGS. 18A and 18B show an example of a scheme of reordering symbols by the reordering units 1404A and 1404B in FIG. 14, the horizontal axis representing frequency, and the vertical axis representing time, that differs from FIGS. 15A through 17B. FIG. 18A shows the reordering scheme for symbols of the modulated signal z1, and FIG. 18B shows the reordering scheme for symbols of the modulated signal z2. In FIGS. 15A through 17B, symbols are arranged in the frequency domain, whereas in FIGS. 18A and 18B, symbols are arranged in both the frequency and time domains.


In FIG. 6, an example has been described of hopping between precoding weights over four slots. Here, however, an example of hopping over eight slots is described. The symbol groups 1801 and 1802 shown in FIGS. 18A and 18B are the symbols for one period (cycle) when using the precoding weight hopping scheme (and are therefore eight-symbol groups). Symbol #0 is the symbol when using the precoding weight of slot 8i. Symbol #1 is the symbol when using the precoding weight of slot 8i+1. Symbol #2 is the symbol when using the precoding weight of slot 8i+2. Symbol #3 is the symbol when using the precoding weight of slot 8i+3. Symbol #4 is the symbol when using the precoding weight of slot 8i+4. Symbol #5 is the symbol when using the precoding weight of slot 8i+5. Symbol #6 is the symbol when using the precoding weight of slot 8i+6. Symbol #7 is the symbol when using the precoding weight of slot 8i+7. Accordingly, symbol #x is as follows. When x mod 8 is 0, the symbol #x is the symbol when using the precoding weight of slot 8i. When x mod 8 is 1, the symbol #x is the symbol when using the precoding weight of slot 8i+1. When x mod 8 is 2, the symbol #x is the symbol when using the precoding weight of slot 8i+2. When x mod 8 is 3, the symbol #x is the symbol when using the precoding weight of slot 8i+3. When x mod 8 is 4, the symbol #x is the symbol when using the precoding weight of slot 8i+4. When x mod 8 is 5, the symbol #x is the symbol when using the precoding weight of slot 8i+5. When x mod 8 is 6, the symbol #x is the symbol when using the precoding weight of slot 8i+6. When x mod 8 is 7, the symbol #x is the symbol when using the precoding weight of slot 8i+7. In the symbol ordering in FIGS. 18A and 18B, four slots in the time domain and two slots in the frequency domain for a total of 4×2=8 slots are used to arrange symbols for one period (cycle). In this case, letting the number of symbols in one period (cycle) be m X n symbols (in other words, m X n precoding weights exist), the number of slots (the number of carriers) in the frequency domain used to arrange symbols in one period (cycle) be n, and the number of slots used in the time domain be m, then m>n should be satisfied. This is because the phase of direct waves fluctuates more slowly in the time domain than in the frequency domain. Therefore, since the precoding weights are changed in the present embodiment to minimize the influence of steady direct waves, it is preferable to reduce the fluctuation in direct waves in the period (cycle) for changing the precoding weights. Accordingly, m>n should be satisfied. Furthermore, considering the above points, rather than reordering symbols only in the frequency domain or only in the time domain, direct waves are more likely to become stable when symbols are reordered in both the frequency and the time domains as in FIGS. 18A and 18B, thereby making it easier to achieve the advantageous effects of the present invention. When symbols are ordered in the frequency domain, however, fluctuations in the frequency domain are abrupt, leading to the possibility of yielding diversity gain. Therefore, reordering in both the frequency and the time domains is not necessarily always the best scheme.



FIGS. 19A and 19B show an example of a scheme of reordering symbols by the reordering units 1404A and 1404B in FIG. 14, the horizontal axis representing frequency, and the vertical axis representing time, that differs from FIGS. 18A and 18B. FIG. 19A shows the reordering scheme for symbols of the modulated signal z1, and FIG. 19B shows the reordering scheme for symbols of the modulated signal z2. As in FIGS. 18A and 18B, FIGS. 19A and 19B show arrangement of symbols using both the frequency and the time axes. The difference as compared to FIGS. 18A and 18B is that, whereas symbols are arranged first in the frequency domain and then in the time domain in FIGS. 18A and 18B, symbols are arranged first in the time domain and then in the frequency domain in FIGS. 19A and 19B. In FIGS. 19A and 19B, the symbol group 1901 and the symbol group 1902 are the symbols for one period (cycle) when using the precoding hopping scheme.


Note that in FIGS. 18A, 18B, 19A, and 19B, as in FIGS. 16A and 16B, the present invention may be similarly embodied, and the advantageous effect of high reception quality achieved, with the symbol arranging scheme of the modulated signal z1 differing from the symbol arranging scheme of the modulated signal z2. Furthermore, in FIGS. 18A, 18B, 19A, and 19B, as in FIGS. 17A and 17B, the present invention may be similarly embodied, and the advantageous effect of high reception quality achieved, without arranging the symbols in order.



FIG. 27 shows an example of a scheme of reordering symbols by the reordering units 1404A and 1404B in FIG. 14, the horizontal axis representing frequency, and the vertical axis representing time, that differs from the above examples. The case of hopping between precoding matrices regularly over four slots, as in Equations 37-40, is considered. The characteristic feature of FIG. 27 is that symbols are arranged in order in the frequency domain, but when progressing in the time domain, symbols are cyclically shifted by n symbols (in the example in FIG. 27, n=1). In the four symbols shown in the symbol group 2710 in the frequency domain in FIG. 27, precoding hops between the precoding matrices of Equations 37-40.


In this case, symbol #0 is precoded using the precoding matrix in Equation 37, symbol #1 is precoded using the precoding matrix in Equation 38, symbol #2 is precoded using the precoding matrix in Equation 39, and symbol #3 is precoded using the precoding matrix in Equation 40.


Similarly, for the symbol group 2720 in the frequency domain, symbol #4 is precoded using the precoding matrix in Equation 37, symbol #5 is precoded using the precoding matrix in Equation 38, symbol #6 is precoded using the precoding matrix in Equation 39, and symbol #7 is precoded using the precoding matrix in Equation 40.


For the symbols at time $1, precoding hops between the above precoding matrices, but in the time domain, symbols are cyclically shifted. Therefore, precoding hops between precoding matrices for the symbol groups 2701, 2702, 2703, and 2704 as follows.


In the symbol group 2701 in the time domain, symbol #0 is precoded using the precoding matrix in Equation 37, symbol #9 is precoded using the precoding matrix in Equation 38, symbol #18 is precoded using the precoding matrix in Equation 39, and symbol #27 is precoded using the precoding matrix in Equation 40.


In the symbol group 2702 in the time domain, symbol #28 is precoded using the precoding matrix in Equation 37, symbol #1 is precoded using the precoding matrix in Equation 38, symbol #10 is precoded using the precoding matrix in Equation 39, and symbol #19 is precoded using the precoding matrix in Equation 40.


In the symbol group 2703 in the time domain, symbol #20 is precoded using the precoding matrix in Equation 37, symbol #29 is precoded using the precoding matrix in Equation 38, symbol #2 is precoded using the precoding matrix in Equation 39, and symbol #11 is precoded using the precoding matrix in Equation 40.


In the symbol group 2704 in the time domain, symbol #12 is precoded using the precoding matrix in Equation 37, symbol #21 is precoded using the precoding matrix in Equation 38, symbol #30 is precoded using the precoding matrix in Equation 39, and symbol #3 is precoded using the precoding matrix in Equation 40.


The characteristic of FIG. 27 is that, for example focusing on symbol #11, the symbols on either side in the frequency domain at the same time (symbols #10 and #12) are both precoded with a different precoding matrix than symbol #11, and the symbols on either side in the time domain in the same carrier (symbols #2 and #20) are both precoded with a different precoding matrix than symbol #11. This is true not only for symbol #11. Any symbol having symbols on either side in the frequency domain and the time domain is characterized in the same way as symbol #11. As a result, precoding matrices are effectively hopped between, and since the influence on stable conditions of direct waves is reduced, the possibility of improved reception quality of data increases.


In FIG. 27, the case of n=1 has been described, but n is not limited in this way. The present invention may be similarly embodied with n=3. Furthermore, in FIG. 27, when symbols are arranged in the frequency domain and time progresses in the time domain, the above characteristic is achieved by cyclically shifting the number of the arranged symbol, but the above characteristic may also be achieved by randomly (or regularly) arranging the symbols.


Embodiment 2

In Embodiment 1, regular hopping of the precoding weights as shown in FIG. 6 has been described. In the present embodiment, a scheme for designing specific precoding weights that differ from the precoding weights in FIG. 6 is described.


In FIG. 6, the scheme for hopping between the precoding weights in Equations 37-40 has been described. By generalizing this scheme, the precoding weights may be changed as follows. (The hopping period (cycle) for the precoding weights has four slots, and Equations are listed similarly to Equations 37-40.)


For symbol number 4i (where i is an integer greater than or equal to zero):









Math





42












(




z





1


(

4





i

)







z





2


(

4





i

)





)

=


1

2




(




e

j







θ
11



(

4





i

)







e

j


(



θ
11



(

4





i

)


+
λ

)








e

j







θ
21



(

4





i

)







e

j


(



θ
21



(

4





i

)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(

4





i

)







s





2


(

4





i

)





)






Equation





42








Here, j is an imaginary unit.


For symbol number 4i+1:














Math





43













(




z





1


(


4

i

+
1

)







z





2


(


4

i

+
1

)





)

=


1

2




(




e

j







θ
11



(


4

i

+
1

)







e

j


(



θ
11



(


4

i

+
1

)


+
λ

)








e

j







θ
21



(


4

i

+
1

)







e

j


(



θ
21



(


4

i

+
1

)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(


4

i

+
1

)







s





2


(


4

i

+
1

)





)






Equation





43








For symbol number 4i+2:














Math





44













(




z





1


(


4

i

+
2

)







z





2


(


4

i

+
2

)





)

=


1

2




(




e

j







θ
11



(


4

i

+
2

)







e

j


(



θ
11



(


4

i

+
2

)


+
λ

)








e

j







θ
21



(


4

i

+
2

)







e

j


(



θ
21



(


4

i

+
2

)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(


4

i

+
2

)







s





2


(


4

i

+
2

)





)






Equation





44








For symbol number 4i+3:














Math





45













(




z





1


(


4

i

+
3

)







z





2


(


4

i

+
3

)





)

=


1

2




(




e

j







θ
11



(


4

i

+
3

)







e

j


(



θ
11



(


4

i

+
3

)


+
λ

)








e

j







θ
21



(


4

i

+
3

)







e

j


(



θ
21



(


4

i

+
3

)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(


4

i

+
3

)







s





2


(


4

i

+
3

)





)






Equation





45








From Equations 36 and 41, the received vector R(t)=(r1(t), r2(t))T can be represented as follows.


For symbol number 4i:














Math





46













(




r





1


(

4

i

)







r





2


(

4

i

)





)

=


1

2




(





h
11



(

4

i

)






h
12



(

4

i

)








h
21



(

4

i

)






h
22



(

4

i

)





)



(




e

j







θ
11



(

4

i

)







e

j


(



θ
11



(

4

i

)


+
λ

)








e

j







θ
21



(

4

i

)







e

j


(



θ
21



(

4

i

)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(

4

i

)







s





2


(

4

i

)





)






Equation





46








For symbol number 4i+1:














Math





47













(




r





1


(


4

i

+
1

)







r





2


(


4

i

+
1

)





)

=


1

2




(





h
11



(


4

i

+
1

)






h
12



(


4

i

+
1

)








h
21



(


4

i

+
1

)






h
22



(


4

i

+
1

)





)



(




e

j







θ
11



(


4

i

+
1

)







e

j


(



θ
11



(


4

i

+
1

)


+
λ

)








e

j







θ
21



(


4

i

+
1

)







e

j


(



θ
21



(


4

i

+
1

)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(


4

i

+
1

)







s





2


(


4

i

+
1

)





)






Equation





47








For symbol number 4i+2:














Math





48













(




r





1


(


4

i

+
2

)







r





2


(


4

i

+
2

)





)

=


1

2




(





h
11



(


4

i

+
2

)






h
12



(


4

i

+
2

)








h
21



(


4

i

+
2

)






h
22



(


4

i

+
2

)





)



(




e

j







θ
11



(


4

i

+
2

)







e

j


(



θ
11



(


4

i

+
2

)


+
λ

)








e

j







θ
21



(


4

i

+
2

)







e

j


(



θ
21



(


4

i

+
2

)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(


4

i

+
2

)







s





2


(


4

i

+
2

)





)






Equation





48








For symbol number 4i+3:














Math





49













(




r





1


(


4

i

+
3

)







r





2


(


4

i

+
3

)





)

=


1

2




(





h
11



(


4

i

+
3

)






h
12



(


4

i

+
3

)








h
21



(


4

i

+
3

)






h
22



(


4

i

+
3

)





)



(




e

j







θ
11



(


4

i

+
3

)







e

j


(



θ
11



(


4

i

+
3

)


+
λ

)








e

j







θ
21



(


4

i

+
3

)







e

j


(



θ
21



(


4

i

+
3

)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(


4

i

+
3

)







s





2


(


4

i

+
3

)





)






Equation





49







In this case, it is assumed that only components of direct waves exist in the channel elements h11(t), h12(t), h21(t), and h22(t), that the amplitude components of the direct waves are all equal, and that fluctuations do not occur over time. With these assumptions, Equations 46-49 can be represented as follows.


For symbol number 4i:














Math





50













(




r





1


(

4

i

)







r





2


(

4

i

)





)

=


1

2




(




Ae

j





0




q





Ae

j





0




q



)



(




e

j







θ
11



(

4

i

)







e

j


(



θ
11



(

4

i

)


+
λ

)








e

j







θ
21



(

4

i

)







e

j


(



θ
21



(

4

i

)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(

4

i

)







s





2


(

4

i

)





)






Equation





50








For symbol number 4i+1:














Math





51













(




r





1


(


4

i

+
1

)







r





2


(


4

i

+
1

)





)

=


1

2




(




Ae

j





0




q





Ae

j





0




q



)



(




e

j







θ
11



(


4

i

+
1

)







e

j


(



θ
11



(


4

i

+
1

)


+
λ

)








e

j







θ
21



(


4

i

+
1

)







e

j


(



θ
21



(


4

i

+
1

)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(


4

i

+
1

)







s





2


(


4

i

+
1

)





)






Equation





51








For symbol number 4i+2:














Math





52













(




r





1


(


4

i

+
2

)







r





2


(


4

i

+
2

)





)

=


1

2




(




Ae

j





0




q





Ae

j





0




q



)



(




e

j







θ
11



(


4

i

+
2

)







e

j


(



θ
11



(


4

i

+
2

)


+
λ

)








e

j







θ
21



(


4

i

+
2

)







e

j


(



θ
21



(


4

i

+
2

)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(


4

i

+
2

)







s





2


(


4

i

+
2

)





)






Equation





52








For symbol number 4i+3:














Math





53













(




r





1


(


4

i

+
3

)







r





2


(


4

i

+
3

)





)

=


1

2




(




Ae

j





0




q





Ae

j





0




q



)



(




e

j







θ
11



(


4

i

+
3

)







e

j


(



θ
11



(


4

i

+
3

)


+
λ

)








e

j







θ
21



(


4

i

+
3

)







e

j


(



θ
21



(


4

i

+
3

)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(


4

i

+
3

)







s





2


(


4

i

+
3

)





)






Equation





53







In Equations 50-53, let A be a positive real number and q be a complex number. The values of A and q are determined in accordance with the positional relationship between the transmission device and the reception device. Equations 50-53 can be represented as follows.


For symbol number 4i:














Math





54













(




r





1


(

4

i

)







r





2


(

4

i

)





)

=


1

2




(




e

j





0







e

j





0





)



(




Ae

j





0




q



)



(




e

j







θ
11



(

4

i

)







e

j


(



θ
11



(

4

i

)


+
λ

)








e

j







θ
21



(

4

i

)







e

j


(



θ
21



(

4

i

)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(

4

i

)







s





2


(

4

i

)





)






Equation





54








For symbol number 4i+1:














Math





55













(




r





1


(


4

i

+
1

)







r





2


(


4

i

+
1

)





)

=


1

2




(




e

j





0







e

j





0





)



(




Ae

j





0




q



)



(




e

j







θ
11



(


4

i

+
1

)







e

j


(



θ
11



(


4

i

+
1

)


+
λ

)








e

j







θ
21



(


4

i

+
1

)







e

j


(



θ
21



(


4

i

+
1

)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(


4

i

+
1

)







s





2


(


4

i

+
1

)





)






Equation





55








For symbol number 4i+2:














Math





56













(




r





1


(


4

i

+
2

)







r





2


(


4

i

+
2

)





)

=


1

2




(




e

j





0







e

j





0





)



(




Ae

j





0




q



)



(




e

j







θ
11



(


4

i

+
2

)







e

j


(



θ
11



(


4

i

+
2

)


+
λ

)








e

j







θ
21



(


4

i

+
2

)







e

j


(



θ
21



(


4

i

+
2

)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(


4

i

+
2

)







s





2


(


4

i

+
2

)





)






Equation





56








For symbol number 4i+3:














Math





57













(




r





1


(


4

i

+
3

)







r





2


(


4

i

+
3

)





)

=


1

2




(




e

j





0







e

j





0





)



(




Ae

j





0




q



)



(




e

j







θ
11



(


4

i

+
3

)







e

j


(



θ
11



(


4

i

+
3

)


+
λ

)








e

j







θ
21



(


4

i

+
3

)







e

j


(



θ
21



(


4

i

+
3

)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(


4

i

+
3

)







s





2


(


4

i

+
3

)





)






Equation





57







As a result, when q is represented as follows, a signal component based on one of s1 and s2 is no longer included in r1 and r2, and therefore one of the signals s1 and s2 can no longer be obtained.


For symbol number 4i:

Math 58
q=−Aej(θ11(4i)-θ21(4i)),−Aej(θ11(4i)-θ21(4i)-δ)  Equation 58

For symbol number 4i+1:

Math 59
q=−Aej(θ11(4i+1)-θ21(4i+1)),−Aej(θ11(4i+1)-θ21(4i+1)-δ)  Equation 59

For symbol number 4i+2:

Math 60
q=−Aej(θ11(4i+2)-θ21(4i+2)),−Aej(θ11(4i+2)-θ21(4i+2)-δ)  Equation 60

For symbol number 4i+3:

Math 61
q=−Aej(θ11(4i+3)-θ21(4i+3)),−Aej(θ11(4i+3)-θ21(4i+3)-δ)  Equation 61


In this case, if q has the same solution in symbol numbers 4i, 4i+1, 4i+2, and 4i+3, then the channel elements of the direct waves do not greatly fluctuate. Therefore, a reception device having channel elements in which the value of q is equivalent to the same solution can no longer obtain excellent reception quality for any of the symbol numbers. Therefore, it is difficult to achieve the ability to correct errors, even if error correction codes are introduced. Accordingly, for q not to have the same solution, the following condition is necessary from Equations 58-61 when focusing on one of two solutions of q which does not include δ.

Math 62
ej(θ11(4i+x)-θ21(4i+x))≠ej(θ11(4i+y)-θ21(4i+y)) for ∀x,∀y (x≠y;x,y=0,1,2,3)  Condition #1

(x is 0, 1, 2, 3; y is 0, 1, 2, 3; and x≠y)


In an example fulfilling Condition #1, values are set as follows:


Example #1

(1) θ11(4i)=θ11(4i+1)=θ11(4i+2)=θ11(4i+3)=0 radians,


(2) θ21(4i)=0 radians,


(3) θ21(4i+1)=π/2 radians,


(4) θ21(4i+2)=π radians, and


(5) θ21(4i+3)=3π/2 radians.


(The above is an example. It suffices for one each of zero radians, π/2 radians, π radians, and 3π/2 radians to exist for the set (θ21(4i), θ21(4i+1), θ21(4i+2), θ21(4i+3)).) In this case, in particular under condition (1), there is no need to perform signal processing (rotation processing) on the baseband signal S1(t), which therefore offers the advantage of a reduction in circuit size. Another example is to set values as follows.


Example #2

(6) θ11(4i)=0 radians,


(7) θ11(4i+1)=π/2 radians,


(8) θ11(4i+2)=π radians,


(9) θ11(4i+3)=3π/2 radians, and


(10) θ21(4i)=θ21(4i+1)=θ21(4i+2)=θ21(4i+3)=0 radians.


(The above is an example. It suffices for one each of zero radians, π/2 radians, π radians, and 3π/2 radians to exist for the set (θ11(4i), θ11(4i+1), θ11(4i+2), θ11(4i+3)).) In this case, in particular under condition (6), there is no need to perform signal processing (rotation processing) on the baseband signal S2(t), which therefore offers the advantage of a reduction in circuit size. Yet another example is as follows.


Example #3

(11) θ11(4i)=θ11(4i+1)=θ11(4i+2)=θ11(4i+3)=0 radians,


(12) θ21(4i)=0 radians,


(13) θ21(4i+1)=π/4 radians,


(14) θ21(4i+2)=π/2 radians, and


(15) θ21(4i+3)=3π/4 radians.


(The above is an example. It suffices for one each of zero radians, π/4 radians, π/2 radians, and 3π/4 radians to exist for the set (θ21(4i), θ21(4i+1), θ21(4i+2), θ21(4i+3)).)


Example #4

(16) θ11(4i)=0 radians,


(17) θ11(4i+1)=π/4 radians,


(18) θ11(4i+2)=π/2 radians,


(19) θ11(4i+3)=3π/4 radians, and


(20) θ21(4i)=θ21(4i+1)=θ21(4i+2)=θ21(4i+3)=0 radians.


(The above is an example. It suffices for one each of zero radians, π/4 radians, π/2 radians, and 3π/4 radians to exist for the set (θ11(4i), θ11(4i+1), θ11(4i+2), θ11(4i+3)).)


While four examples have been shown, the scheme of satisfying Condition #1 is not limited to these examples.


Next, design requirements for not only θ11 and θ12, but also for λ and δ are described. It suffices to set λ to a certain value; it is then necessary to establish requirements for δ. The following describes the design scheme for δ when λ is set to zero radians.


In this case, by defining δ so that π/2 radians ≤|δ|≤π radians, excellent reception quality is achieved, particularly in an LOS environment.


Incidentally, for each of the symbol numbers 4i, 4i+1, 4i+2, and 4i+3, two points q exist where reception quality becomes poor. Therefore, a total of 2×4=8 such points exist. In an LOS environment, in order to prevent reception quality from degrading in a specific reception terminal, these eight points should each have a different solution. In this case, in addition to Condition #1, Condition #2 is necessary.

Math 63
ej(θ11(4i+x)-θ21(4i+x))≠ej(θ11(4i+y)-θ21(4i+y)-δ) for ∀x,∀y (x,y=0,1,2,3)
and
ej(θ11(4i+x)-θ21(4i+x)-δ)≠ej(θ11(4i+y)-θ21(4i+y)-δ) for ∀x,∀y (x≠y;x,y=0,1,2,3)  Condition #2


Additionally, the phase of these eight points should be evenly distributed (since the phase of a direct wave is considered to have a high probability of even distribution). The following describes the design scheme for δ to satisfy this requirement.


In the case of example #1 and example #2, the phase becomes even at the points at which reception quality is poor by setting δ to ±3π/4 radians. For example, letting δ be 3π/4 radians in example #1 (and letting A be a positive real number), then each of the four slots, points at which reception quality becomes poor exist once, as shown in FIG. 20. In the case of example #3 and example #4, the phase becomes even at the points at which reception quality is poor by setting δ to ±π radians. For example, letting δ be π radians in example #3, then in each of the four slots, points at which reception quality becomes poor exist once, as shown in FIG. 21. (If the element q in the channel matrix H exists at the points shown in FIGS. 20 and 21, reception quality degrades.)


With the above structure, excellent reception quality is achieved in an LOS environment. Above, an example of changing precoding weights in a four-slot period (cycle) is described, but below, changing precoding weights in an N-slot period (cycle) is described. Making the same considerations as in Embodiment 1 and in the above description, processing represented as below is performed on each symbol number.


For symbol number Ni (where i is an integer greater than or equal to zero):









Math





64












(




z





1


(
Ni
)







z





2


(
Ni
)





)

=


1

2




(




e

j







θ
11



(
Ni
)







e

j


(



θ
11



(
Ni
)


+
λ

)








e

j







θ
21



(
Ni
)







e

j


(



θ
21



(
Ni
)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(
Ni
)







s





2


(
Ni
)





)






Equation





62








Here, j is an imaginary unit.


For symbol number Ni+1:














Math





65













(




z





1


(

Ni
+
1

)







z





2


(

Ni
+
1

)





)

=


1

2




(




e

j







θ
11



(

Ni
+
1

)







e

j


(



θ
11



(

Ni
+
1

)


+
λ

)








e

j







θ
21



(

Ni
+
1

)







e

j


(



θ
21



(

Ni
+
1

)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(

Ni
+
1

)







s





2


(

Ni
+
1

)





)






Equation





63







When generalized, this equation is as follows.


For symbol number Ni+k (k=0, 1, . . . , N−1):














Math





66













(




z





1


(

Ni
+
k

)







z





2


(

Ni
+
k

)





)

=


1

2




(




e

j







θ
11



(

Ni
+
k

)







e

j


(



θ
11



(

Ni
+
k

)


+
λ

)








e

j







θ
21



(

Ni
+
k

)







e

j


(



θ
21



(

Ni
+
k

)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(

Ni
+
k

)







s





2


(

Ni
+
k

)





)






Equation





64







Furthermore, for symbol number Ni+N−1:














Math





67













(




z





1


(

Ni
+
N
-
1

)







z





2


(

Ni
+
N
-
1

)





)

=


1

2




(




e

j







θ
11



(

Ni
+
N
-
1

)







e

j


(



θ
11



(

Ni
+
N
-
1

)


+
λ

)








e

j







θ
21



(

Ni
+
N
-
1

)







e

j


(



θ
21



(

Ni
+
N
-
1

)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(

Ni
+
N
-
1

)







s





2


(

Ni
+
N
-
1

)





)






Equation





65








Accordingly, r1 and r2 are represented as follows.


For symbol number Ni (where i is an integer greater than or equal to zero):














Math





68













(




r





1


(
Ni
)







r





2


(
Ni
)





)

=


1

2




(





h
11



(
Ni
)






h
12



(
Ni
)








h
21



(
Ni
)






h
22



(
Ni
)





)



(




e

j







θ
11



(
Ni
)







e

j


(



θ
11



(
Ni
)


+
λ

)








e

j







θ
21



(
Ni
)







e

j


(



θ
21



(
Ni
)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(
Ni
)







s





2


(
Ni
)





)






Equation





66








Here, j is an imaginary unit.


For symbol number Ni+1:














Math





69













(




r





1


(

Ni
+
1

)







r





2


(

Ni
+
1

)





)

=


1

2




(





h
11



(

Ni
+
1

)






h
12



(

Ni
+
1

)








h
21



(

Ni
+
1

)






h
22



(

Ni
+
1

)





)



(




e

j







θ
11



(

Ni
+
1

)







e

j


(



θ
11



(

Ni
+
1

)


+
λ

)








e

j







θ
21



(

Ni
+
1

)







e

j


(



θ
21



(

Ni
+
1

)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(

Ni
+
1

)







s





2


(

Ni
+
1

)





)






Equation





67







When generalized, this equation is as follows.


For symbol number Ni+k (k=0, 1, . . . , N−1):














Math





70













(




r





1


(

Ni
+
k

)







r





2


(

Ni
+
k

)





)

=


1

2




(





h
11



(

Ni
+
k

)






h
12



(

Ni
+
k

)








h
21



(

Ni
+
k

)






h
22



(

Ni
+
k

)





)



(




e

j







θ
11



(

Ni
+
k

)







e

j


(



θ
11



(

Ni
+
k

)


+
λ

)








e

j







θ
21



(

Ni
+
k

)







e

j


(



θ
21



(

Ni
+
k

)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(

Ni
+
k

)







s





2


(

Ni
+
k

)





)






Equation





68







Furthermore, for symbol number Ni+N−1:














Math





71













(




r





1


(

Ni
+
N
-
1

)







r





2


(

Ni
+
N
-
1

)





)

=


1

2




(





h
11



(

Ni
+
N
-
1

)






h
12



(

Ni
+
N
-
1

)








h
21



(

Ni
+
N
-
1

)






h
22



(

Ni
+
N
-
1

)





)



(




e

j







θ
11



(

Ni
+
N
-
1

)







e

j


(



θ
11



(

Ni
+
N
-
1

)


+
λ

)








e

j







θ
21



(

Ni
+
N
-
1

)







e

j


(



θ
21



(

Ni
+
N
-
1

)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(

Ni
+
N
-
1

)







s





2


(

Ni
+
N
-
1

)





)






Equation





69







In this case, it is assumed that only components of direct waves exist in the channel elements h11(t), h12(t), h21(t), and h22(t), that the amplitude components of the direct waves are all equal, and that fluctuations do not occur over time. With these assumptions, Equations 66-69 can be represented as follows.


For symbol number Ni (where i is an integer greater than or equal to zero):














Math





72













(




r





1


(
Ni
)







r





2


(
Ni
)





)

=


1

2




(




Ae

j





0




q





Ae

j





0




q



)



(




e

j







θ
11



(
Ni
)







e

j


(



θ
11



(
Ni
)


+
λ

)








e

j







θ
21



(
Ni
)







e

j


(



θ
21



(
Ni
)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(
Ni
)







s





2


(
Ni
)





)






Equation





70







Here, j is an imaginary unit.


For symbol number Ni+1:














Math





73













(




r





1


(

Ni
+
1

)







r





2


(

Ni
+
1

)





)

=


1

2




(




Ae

j





0




q





Ae

j





0




q



)



(




e

j







θ
11



(

Ni
+
1

)







e

j


(



θ
11



(

Ni
+
1

)


+
λ

)








e

j







θ
21



(

Ni
+
1

)







e

j


(



θ
21



(

Ni
+
1

)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(

Ni
+
1

)







s





2


(

Ni
+
1

)





)






Equation





71







When generalized, this equation is as follows.


For symbol number Ni+k (k=0, 1, . . . , N−1):














Math





74













(




r





1


(

Ni
+
k

)







r





2


(

Ni
+
k

)





)

=


1

2




(




Ae

j





0




q





Ae

j





0




q



)



(




e

j







θ
11



(

Ni
+
k

)







e

j


(



θ
11



(

Ni
+
k

)


+
λ

)








e

j







θ
21



(

Ni
+
k

)







e

j


(



θ
21



(

Ni
+
k

)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(

Ni
+
k

)







s





2


(

Ni
+
k

)





)






Equation





72







Furthermore, for symbol number Ni+N−1:














Math





75













(




r





1


(

Ni
+
N
-
1

)







r





2


(

Ni
+
N
-
1

)





)

=


1

2




(




Ae

j





0




q





Ae

j





0




q



)



(




e

j







θ
11



(

Ni
+
N
-
1

)







e

j


(



θ
11



(

Ni
+
N
-
1

)


+
λ

)








e

j







θ
21



(

Ni
+
N
-
1

)







e

j


(



θ
21



(

Ni
+
N
-
1

)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(

Ni
+
N
-
1

)







s





2


(

Ni
+
N
-
1

)





)






Equation





73







In Equations 70-73, let A be a real number and q be a complex number. The values of A and q are determined in accordance with the positional relationship between the transmission device and the reception device. Equations 70-73 can be represented as follows.


For symbol number Ni (where i is an integer greater than or equal to zero):














Math





76













(




r





1


(
Ni
)







r





2


(
Ni
)





)

=


1

2




(




e

j





0







e

j





0





)



(


Ae

j





0







q

)



(




e

j







θ
11



(
Ni
)







e

j


(



θ
11



(
Ni
)


+
λ

)








e

j







θ
21



(
Ni
)







e

j


(



θ
21



(
Ni
)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(
Ni
)







s





2


(
Ni
)





)






Equation





74








Here, j is an imaginary unit.


For symbol number Ni+1:














Math





77













(




r





1


(

Ni
+
1

)







r





2


(

Ni
+
1

)





)

=


1

2




(




e

j





0







e

j





0





)



(


Ae

j





0







q

)



(




e

j







θ
11



(

Ni
+
1

)







e

j


(



θ
11



(

Ni
+
1

)


+
λ

)








e

j







θ
21



(

Ni
+
1

)







e

j


(



θ
21



(

Ni
+
1

)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(

Ni
+
1

)







s





2


(

Ni
+
1

)





)






Equation





75







When generalized, this equation is as follows.


For symbol number Ni+k (k=0, 1, . . . , N−1):














Math





78













(




r





1


(

Ni
+
k

)







r





2


(

Ni
+
k

)





)

=


1

2




(




e

j





0







e

j





0





)



(


Ae

j





0







q

)



(




e

j







θ
11



(

Ni
+
k

)







e

j


(



θ
11



(

Ni
+
k

)


+
λ

)








e

j







θ
21



(

Ni
+
k

)







e

j


(



θ
21



(

Ni
+
k

)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(

Ni
+
k

)







s





2


(

Ni
+
k

)





)






Equation





76







Furthermore, for symbol number Ni+N−1:














Math





79













(




r





1


(

Ni
+
N
-
1

)







r





2


(

Ni
+
N
-
1

)





)

=


1

2




(




e

j





0







e

j





0





)



(




Ae

j





0




q



)



(




e

j







θ
11



(

Ni
+
N
-
1

)







e

j


(



θ
11



(

Ni
+
N
-
1

)


+
λ

)








e

j







θ
21



(

Ni
+
N
-
1

)







e

j


(



θ
21



(

Ni
+
N
-
1

)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(

Ni
+
N
-
1

)












s





2


(

Ni
+
N
-
1

)






)






Equation





77







As a result, when q is represented as follows, a signal component based on one of s1 and s2 is no longer included in r1 and r2, and therefore one of the signals s1 and s2 can no longer be obtained.


For symbol number Ni (where i is an integer greater than or equal to zero):

Math 80
q=−Aej(θ11(Ni)-θ21(Ni)),−Aej(θ11(Ni)-θ21(Ni)-δ)  Equation 78

For symbol number Ni+1:

Math 81
q=−Aej(θ11(Ni+1)-θ21(Ni+1)),−Aej(θ11(Ni+1)-θ21(Ni+1)-δ)  Equation 79


When generalized, this equation is as follows.


For symbol number Ni+k (k=0, 1, . . . , N−1):

Math 82
q=−Aej(θ11(Ni+k)-θ21(Ni+k)),−Aej(θ11(Ni+k)-θ21(Ni+k)-δ)  Equation 80


Furthermore, for symbol number Ni+N−1:

Math 83
q=−Aej(θ11(Ni+N-1)-θ21(Ni+N-1)), −Aej(θ11(Ni+N-1)-θ21(Ni+N-1)-δ)  Equation 81


In this case, if q has the same solution in symbol numbers Ni through Ni+N−1, then since the channel elements of the direct waves do not greatly fluctuate, a reception device having channel elements in which the value of q is equivalent to this same solution can no longer obtain excellent reception quality for any of the symbol numbers. Therefore, it is difficult to achieve the ability to correct errors, even if error correction codes are introduced. Accordingly, for q not to have the same solution, the following condition is necessary from Equations 78-81 when focusing on one of two solutions of q which does not include δ.

Math 84
ej(θ11(Ni+x)-θ21(Ni+x))≠ej(θ11(Ni+y)-θ21(Ni+y)) for ∀x,∀y(x≠y;x,y=0,1,2, . . . ,N−2,N−1)  Condition #3

(x is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; y is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; and x≠y)


Next, design requirements for not only θ11 and θ12, but also for λ and δ are described. It suffices to set λ to a certain value; it is then necessary to establish requirements for δ. The following describes the design scheme for δ when λ is set to zero radians.


In this case, similar to the scheme of changing the precoding weights in a four-slot period (cycle), by defining δ so that π/2 radians ≤|δ|≤π radians, excellent reception quality is achieved, particularly in an LOS environment.


In each symbol number Ni through Ni+N−1, two points labeled q exist where reception quality becomes poor, and therefore 2N such points exist. In an LOS environment, in order to achieve excellent characteristics, these 2N points should each have a different solution. In this case, in addition to Condition #3, Condition #4 is necessary.

Math 85
ej(θ11(Ni+x)-θ21(Ni+x))≠ej(θ11(Ni+y)-θ21(Ni+y)-δ) for ∀x,∀y (x,y=0,1,2, . . . ,N−2,N−1)
and
ej(θ11(Ni+x)-θ21(Ni+x)-δ)≠ej(θ11(Ni+y)-θ21(Ni+y)-δ) for ∀x,∀y (x≠y;x,y=0,1,2, . . . ,N−2,N−1)   Condition #4


Additionally, the phase of these 2N points should be evenly distributed (since the phase of a direct wave at each reception device is considered to have a high probability of even distribution).


As described above, when a transmission device transmits a plurality of modulated signals from a plurality of antennas in a MIMO system, the advantageous effect of improved transmission quality, as compared to conventional spatial multiplexing MIMO system, is achieved in an LOS environment in which direct waves dominate by hopping between precoding weights regularly over time.


In the present embodiment, the structure of the reception device is as described in Embodiment 1, and in particular with regards to the structure of the reception device, operations have been described for a limited number of antennas, but the present invention may be embodied in the same way even if the number of antennas increases. In other words, the number of antennas in the reception device does not affect the operations or advantageous effects of the present embodiment. Furthermore, in the present embodiment, similar to Embodiment 1, the error correction codes are not limited.


In the present embodiment, in contrast with Embodiment 1, the scheme of changing the precoding weights in the time domain has been described. As described in Embodiment 1, however, the present invention may be similarly embodied by changing the precoding weights by using a multi-carrier transmission scheme and arranging symbols in the frequency domain and the frequency-time domain. Furthermore, in the present embodiment, symbols other than data symbols, such as pilot symbols (preamble, unique word, and the like), symbols for control information, and the like, may be arranged in the frame in any way.


Embodiment 3

In Embodiment 1 and Embodiment 2, the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding weights has been described for the case where the amplitude of each element in the precoding weight matrix is equivalent. In the present embodiment, however, an example that does not satisfy this condition is described.


For the sake of contrast with Embodiment 2, the case of changing precoding weights over an N-slot period (cycle) is described. Making the same considerations as in Embodiment 1 and Embodiment 2, processing represented as below is performed on each symbol number. Let β be a positive real number, and β≠1.


For symbol number Ni (where i is an integer greater than or equal to zero):














Math





86













(




z





1


(
Ni
)







z





2


(
Ni
)





)

=


1



β
2

+
1





(




e

j







θ
11



(
Ni
)







β
×

e

j


(



θ
11



(
Ni
)


+
λ

)









β
×

e

j







θ
21



(
Ni
)








e

j


(



θ
21



(
Ni
)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(
Ni
)












s





2


(
Ni
)






)






Equation





82







Here, j is an imaginary unit.


For symbol number Ni+1:














Math





87













(




z





1


(

Ni
+
1

)







z





2


(

Ni
+
1

)





)

=


1



β
2

+
1





(




e

j







θ
11



(

Ni
+
1

)







β
×

e

j


(



θ
11



(

Ni
+
1

)


+
λ

)









β
×

e

j







θ
21



(

Ni
+
1

)








e

j


(



θ
21



(

Ni
+
1

)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(

Ni
+
1

)












s





2


(

Ni
+
1

)






)






Equation





83







When generalized, this equation is as follows.


For symbol number Ni+k (k=0, 1, . . . , N−1):














Math





88













(




z





1


(

Ni
+
k

)







z





2


(

Ni
+
k

)





)

=


1



β
2

+
1





(




e

j







θ
11



(

Ni
+
k

)







β
×

e

j


(



θ
11



(

Ni
+
k

)


+
λ

)









β
×

e

j







θ
21



(

Ni
+
k

)








e

j


(



θ
21



(

Ni
+
k

)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(

Ni
+
k

)












s





2


(

Ni
+
k

)






)






Equation





84







Furthermore, for symbol number Ni+N−1:














Math





89













(




z





1


(

Ni
+
N
-
1

)







z





2


(

Ni
+
N
-
1

)





)

=


1



β
2

+
1





(




e

j







θ
11



(

Ni
+
N
-
1

)







β
×

e

j


(



θ
11



(

Ni
+
N
-
1

)


+
λ

)









β
×

e

j







θ
21



(

Ni
+
N
-
1

)








e

j


(



θ
21



(

Ni
+
N
-
1

)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(

Ni
+
N
-
1

)












s





2


(

Ni
+
N
-
1

)






)






Equation





85







Accordingly, r1 and r2 are represented as follows.


For symbol number Ni (where i is an integer greater than or equal to zero):














Math





90













(




r





1


(
Ni
)







r





2


(
Ni
)





)

=


1



β
2

+
1





(





h
11



(
Ni
)






h
12



(
Ni
)








h
21



(
Ni
)






h
22



(
Ni
)





)



(




e

j







θ
11



(
Ni
)







β
×

e

j


(



θ
11



(
Ni
)


+
λ

)









β
×

e

j







θ
21



(
Ni
)








e

j


(



θ
21



(
Ni
)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(
Ni
)












s





2


(
Ni
)






)






Equation





86







Here, j is an imaginary unit.


For symbol number Ni+1:














Math





91













(




r





1


(

Ni
+
1

)







r





2


(

Ni
+
1

)





)

=


1



β
2

+
1





(





h
11



(

Ni
+
1

)






h
12



(

Ni
+
1

)








h
21



(

Ni
+
1

)






h
22



(

Ni
+
1

)





)



(




e

j







θ
11



(

Ni
+
1

)







β
×

e

j


(



θ
11



(

Ni
+
1

)


+
λ

)









β
×

e

j







θ
21



(

Ni
+
1

)








e

j


(



θ
21



(

Ni
+
1

)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(

Ni
+
1

)












s





2


(

Ni
+
1

)






)






Equation





87







When generalized, this equation is as follows.


For symbol number Ni+k (k=0, 1, . . . , N−1):














Math





92













(




r





1


(

Ni
+
k

)







r





2


(

Ni
+
k

)





)

=


1



β
2

+
1





(





h
11



(

Ni
+
k

)






h
12



(

Ni
+
k

)








h
21



(

Ni
+
k

)






h
22



(

Ni
+
k

)





)



(




e

j







θ
11



(

Ni
+
k

)







β
×

e

j


(



θ
11



(

Ni
+
k

)


+
λ

)









β
×

e

j







θ
21



(

Ni
+
k

)








e

j


(



θ
21



(

Ni
+
k

)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(

Ni
+
k

)












s





2


(

Ni
+
k

)






)






Equation





88







When generalized, this equation is as follows.


For symbol number Ni+N−1:














Math





93













(




r





1


(

Ni
+
N
-
1

)







r





2


(

Ni
+
N
-
1

)





)

=


1



β
2

+
1





(





h
11



(

Ni
+
N
-
1

)






h
12



(

Ni
+
N
-
1

)








h
21



(

Ni
+
N
-
1

)






h
22



(

Ni
+
N
-
1

)





)



(




e

j







θ
11



(

Ni
+
N
-
1

)







β
×

e

j


(



θ
11



(

Ni
+
N
-
1

)


+
λ

)









β
×

e

j







θ
21



(

Ni
+
N
-
1

)








e

j


(



θ
21



(

Ni
+
N
-
1

)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(

Ni
+
N
-
1

)












s





2


(

Ni
+
N
-
1

)






)






Equation





89







In this case, it is assumed that only components of direct waves exist in the channel elements h11(t), h12(t), h21(t), and h22(t), that the amplitude components of the direct waves are all equal, and that fluctuations do not occur over time. With these assumptions, Equations 86-89 can be represented as follows.


For symbol number Ni (where i is an integer greater than or equal to zero):














Math





94













(




r





1


(
Ni
)







r





2


(
Ni
)





)

=


1



β
2

+
1





(




Ae

j





0




q





Ae

j





0




q



)



(




e

j







θ
11



(
Ni
)







β
×

e

j


(



θ
11



(
Ni
)


+
λ

)









β
×

e

j







θ
21



(
Ni
)








e

j


(



θ
21



(
Ni
)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(
Ni
)












s





2


(
Ni
)






)






Equation





90







Here, j is an imaginary unit.


For symbol number Ni+1:














Math





95













(




r





1


(

Ni
+
1

)







r





2


(

Ni
+
1

)





)

=


1



β
2

+
1





(




Ae

j





0




q





Ae

j





0




q



)



(




e

j







θ
11



(

Ni
+
1

)







β
×

e

j


(



θ
11



(

Ni
+
1

)


+
λ

)









β
×

e

j







θ
21



(

Ni
+
1

)








e

j


(



θ
21



(

Ni
+
1

)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(

Ni
+
1

)












s





2


(

Ni
+
1

)






)






Equation





91







When generalized, this equation is as follows.


For symbol number Ni+k (k=0, 1, . . . , N−1):














Math





96













(




r





1


(

Ni
+
k

)







r





2


(

Ni
+
k

)





)

=


1



β
2

+
1





(




Ae

j





0




q





Ae

j





0




q



)



(




e

j







θ
11



(

Ni
+
k

)







β
×

e

j


(



θ
11



(

Ni
+
k

)


+
λ

)









β
×

e

j







θ
21



(

Ni
+
k

)








e

j


(



θ
21



(

Ni
+
k

)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(

Ni
+
k

)












s





2


(

Ni
+
k

)






)






Equation





92







Furthermore, for symbol number Ni+N−1:














Math





97













(




r





1


(

Ni
+
N
-
1

)







r





2


(

Ni
+
N
-
1

)





)

=


1



β
2

+
1





(




Ae

j





0




q





Ae

j





0




q



)



(




e

j







θ
11



(

Ni
+
N
-
1

)







β
×

e

j


(



θ
11



(

Ni
+
N
-
1

)


+
λ

)









β
×

e

j







θ
21



(

Ni
+
N
-
1

)








e

j


(



θ
21



(

Ni
+
N
-
1

)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(

Ni
+
N
-
1

)












s





2


(

Ni
+
N
-
1

)






)






Equation





93







In Equations 90-93, let A be a real number and q be a complex number. Equations 90-93 can be represented as follows.


For symbol number Ni (where i is an integer greater than or equal to zero):














Math





98













(




r





1


(
Ni
)







r





2


(
Ni
)





)

=


1



β
2

+
1





(




e

j





0







e

j





0





)



(




Ae

j





0




q



)



(




e

j







θ
11



(
Ni
)







β
×

e

j


(



θ
11



(
Ni
)


+
λ

)









β
×

e

j







θ
21



(
Ni
)








e

j


(



θ
21



(
Ni
)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(
Ni
)












s





2


(
Ni
)






)






Equation





94







Here, j is an imaginary unit.


For symbol number Ni+1:














Math





99













(




r





1


(

Ni
+
1

)







r





2


(

Ni
+
1

)





)

=


1



β
2

+
1





(




e

j





0







e

j





0





)



(




Ae

j





0




q



)



(




e

j







θ
11



(

Ni
+
1

)







β
×

e

j


(



θ
11



(

Ni
+
1

)


+
λ

)









β
×

e

j







θ
21



(

Ni
+
1

)








e

j


(



θ
21



(

Ni
+
1

)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(

Ni
+
1

)












s





2


(

Ni
+
1

)






)






Equation





95







When generalized, this equation is as follows.


For symbol number Ni+k (k=0, 1, . . . , N−1):














Math





100













(




r





1


(

Ni
+
k

)







r





2


(

Ni
+
k

)





)

=


1



β
2

+
1





(




e

j





0







e

j





0





)



(




A






e

j





0





q



)



(




e

j







θ
11



(

Ni
+
k

)







β
×

e

j


(



θ
11



(

Ni
+
k

)


+
λ

)









β
×

e

j







θ
21



(

Ni
+
k

)








e

j


(



θ
21



(

Ni
+
k

)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(

Ni
+
k

)







s





2


(

Ni
+
k

)





)






Equation





96







Furthermore, for symbol number Ni+N−1:














Math





101













(




r





1


(

Ni
+
N
-
1

)







r





2


(

Ni
+
N
-
1

)





)

=


1



β
2

+
1





(




e

j





0







e

j





0





)



(




A






e

j





0





q



)



(




e

j







θ
11



(

Ni
+
N
-
1

)







β
×

e

j


(



θ
11



(

Ni
+
N
-
1

)


+
λ

)









β
×

e

j







θ
21



(

Ni
+
N
-
1

)








e

j


(



θ
21



(

Ni
+
N
-
1

)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(

Ni
+
N
-
1

)







s





2


(

Ni
+
N
-
1

)





)






Equation





97







As a result, when q is represented as follows, one of the signals s1 and s2 can no longer be obtained.


For symbol number Ni (where i is an integer greater than or equal to zero):









Math





102












q
=


-

A
β




e

j


(



θ
11



(
Ni
)


-


θ
21



(
Ni
)



)





,


-




A






β






e

j


(



θ
11



(
Ni
)


-


θ
21



(
Ni
)


-
δ

)








Equation





98








For symbol number Ni+1:









Math





103












q
=


-

A
β




e

j


(



θ
11



(

Ni
+
1

)


-


θ
21



(

Ni
+
1

)



)





,






-




A






β






e

j


(



θ
11



(

Ni
+
1

)


-


θ
21



(

Ni
+
1

)


-
δ

)








Equation





99







When generalized, this equation is as follows.


For symbol number Ni+k (k=0, 1, . . . , N−1):









Math





104












q
=


-

A
β




e

j


(



θ
11



(

Ni
+
k

)


-


θ
21



(

Ni
+
k

)



)





,






-




A






β






e

j


(



θ
11



(

Ni
+
k

)


-


θ
21



(

Ni
+
k

)


-
δ

)








Equation





100







Furthermore, for symbol number Ni+N−1:









Math





105












q
=


-

A
β




e

j


(



θ
11



(

Ni
+
N
-
1

)


-


θ
21



(

Ni
+
N
-
1

)



)





,






-




A






β






e

j


(



θ
11



(

Ni
+
N
-
1

)


-


θ
21



(

Ni
+
N
-
1

)


-
δ

)








Equation





101







In this case, if q has the same solution in symbol numbers Ni through Ni+N−1, then since the channel elements of the direct waves do not greatly fluctuate, excellent reception quality can no longer be obtained for any of the symbol numbers. Therefore, it is difficult to achieve the ability to correct errors, even if error correction codes are introduced. Accordingly, for q not to have the same solution, the following condition is necessary from Equations 98-101 when focusing on one of two solutions of q which does not include δ.

Math 106
ej(θ11(Ni+x)-θ21(Ni+x))≠ej(θ11(Ni+y)-θ21(Ni+y)) for ∀x,∀y (x≠y; x, y=0,1,2, . . . , N−2, N−1)   Condition #5

(x is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; y is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; and x≠y)


Next, design requirements for not only θ11 and θ12, but also for λ and δ are described. It suffices to set λ to a certain value; it is then necessary to establish requirements for δ. The following describes the design scheme for δ when λ is set to zero radians.


In this case, similar to the scheme of changing the precoding weights in a four-slot period (cycle), by defining δ so that π/2 radians ≤|δ|≤π radians, excellent reception quality is achieved, particularly in an LOS environment.


In each of symbol numbers Ni through Ni+N−1, two points q exist where reception quality becomes poor, and therefore 2N such points exist. In an LOS environment, in order to achieve excellent characteristics, these 2N points should each have a different solution. In this case, in addition to Condition #5, considering that β is a positive real number, and β≠1, Condition #6 is necessary.

Math 107
ej(θ11(Ni+x)-θ21(Ni+x)-δ)≠ej(θ11(Ni+y)-θ21(Ni+y)-δ) for ∀x,∀y (x≠y; x, y=0,1,2, . . . , N−2, N−1)   Condition #6


As described above, when a transmission device transmits a plurality of modulated signals from a plurality of antennas in a MIMO system, the advantageous effect of improved transmission quality, as compared to conventional spatial multiplexing MIMO system, is achieved in an LOS environment in which direct waves dominate by hopping between precoding weights regularly over time.


In the present embodiment, the structure of the reception device is as described in Embodiment 1, and in particular with regards to the structure of the reception device, operations have been described for a limited number of antennas, but the present invention may be embodied in the same way even if the number of antennas increases. In other words, the number of antennas in the reception device does not affect the operations or advantageous effects of the present embodiment. Furthermore, in the present embodiment, similar to Embodiment 1, the error correction codes are not limited.


In the present embodiment, in contrast with Embodiment 1, the scheme of changing the precoding weights in the time domain has been described. As described in Embodiment 1, however, the present invention may be similarly embodied by changing the precoding weights by using a multi-carrier transmission scheme and arranging symbols in the frequency domain and the frequency-time domain. Furthermore, in the present embodiment, symbols other than data symbols, such as pilot symbols (preamble, unique word, and the like), symbols for control information, and the like, may be arranged in the frame in any way.


Embodiment 4

In Embodiment 3, the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding weights has been described for the example of two types of amplitudes for each element in the precoding weight matrix, 1 and β.


In this case, the following is ignored.






Math





108









1



β
2

+
1














Next, the example of changing the value of β by slot is described. For the sake of contrast with Embodiment 3, the case of changing precoding weights over a 2×N-slot period (cycle) is described.


Making the same considerations as in Embodiment 1, Embodiment 2, and Embodiment 3, processing represented as below is performed on symbol numbers. Let β be a positive real number, and β≠1. Furthermore, let α be a positive real number, and α≠β.


For symbol number 2Ni (where i is an integer greater than or equal to zero):














Math





109













(




z





1


(

2

Ni

)







z





2


(

2

Ni

)





)

=


1



β
2

+
1





(




e

j







θ
11



(

2

Ni

)







β
×

e

j


(



θ
11



(

2

Ni

)


+
λ

)









β
×

e

j







θ
21



(

2

Ni

)








e

j


(



θ
21



(

2

Ni

)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(
Ni
)







s





2


(
Ni
)





)






Equation





102








Here, j is an imaginary unit.


For symbol number 2Ni+1:














Math





110













(




z





1


(


2

Ni

+
1

)







z





2


(


2

Ni

+
1

)





)

=


1



β
2

+
1





(




e

j







θ
11



(


2

Ni

+
1

)







β
×

e

j


(



θ
11



(


2

Ni

+
1

)


+
λ

)









β
×

e

j







θ
21



(


2

Ni

+
1

)








e

j


(



θ
21



(


2

Ni

+
1

)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(


2

Ni

+
1

)







s





2


(


2

Ni

+
1

)





)






Equation





103







When generalized, this equation is as follows.


For symbol number 2Ni+k (k=0, 1, . . . , N−1):














Math





111













(




z





1


(


2

Ni

+
k

)







z





2


(


2

Ni

+
k

)





)

=


1



β
2

+
1





(




e

j







θ
11



(


2

Ni

+
k

)







β
×

e

j


(



θ
11



(


2

Ni

+
k

)


+
λ

)









β
×

e

j







θ
21



(


2

Ni

+
k

)








e

j


(



θ
21



(


2

Ni

+
k

)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(


2

Ni

+
k

)







s





2


(


2

Ni

+
k

)





)






Equation





104







Furthermore, for symbol number 2Ni+N−1:














Math





112













(




z





1


(


2

Ni

+
N
-
1

)







z





2


(


2

Ni

+
N
-
1

)





)

=


1



β
2

+
1





(




e

j







θ
11



(


2

Ni

+
N
-
1

)







β
×

e

j


(



θ
11



(


2

Ni

+
N
-
1

)


+
λ

)









β
×

e

j







θ
21



(


2

Ni

+
N
-
1

)








e

j


(



θ
21



(


2

Ni

+
N
-
1

)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(


2

Ni

+
N
-
1

)







s





2


(


2

Ni

+
N
-
1

)





)






Equation





105








For symbol number 2Ni+N (where i is an integer greater than or equal to zero):














Math





113













(




z





1


(


2

Ni

+
N

)







z





2


(


2

Ni

+
N

)





)

=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j







θ
11



(


2

Ni

+
N

)







α
×

e

j


(



θ
11



(


2

Ni

+
N

)


+
λ

)









α
×

e

j







θ
21



(


2

Ni

+
N

)








e

j


(



θ
21



(


2

Ni

+
N

)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(


2

Ni

+
N

)







s





2


(


2

Ni

+
N

)





)






Equation





106







Here, j is an imaginary unit.


For symbol number 2Ni+N+1:














Math





114













(




z





1


(


2

Ni

+
N
+
1

)







z





2


(


2

Ni

+
N
+
1

)





)

=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j







θ
11



(


2

Ni

+
N
+
1

)







α
×

e

j


(



θ
11



(


2

Ni

+
N
+
1

)


+
λ

)









α
×

e

j







θ
21



(


2

Ni

+
N
+
1

)








e

j


(



θ
21



(


2

Ni

+
N
+
1

)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(


2

Ni

+
N
+
1

)







s





2


(


2

Ni

+
N
+
1

)





)






Equation





107







When generalized, this equation is as follows.


For symbol number 2Ni+N+k (k=0, 1, . . . , N−1):














Math





115













(




z





1


(


2

Ni

+
N
+
k

)







z





2


(


2

Ni

+
N
+
k

)





)

=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j







θ
11



(


2

Ni

+
N
+
k

)







α
×

e

j


(



θ
11



(


2

Ni

+
N
+
k

)


+
λ

)









α
×

e

j







θ
21



(


2

Ni

+
N
+
k

)








e

j


(



θ
21



(


2

Ni

+
N
+
k

)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(


2

Ni

+
N
+
k

)







s





2


(


2

Ni

+
N
+
k

)





)






Equation





108







Furthermore, for symbol number 2Ni+2N−1:














Math





116













(




z





1


(


2

Ni

+

2

N

-
1

)







z





2


(


2

Ni

+

2

N

-
1

)





)

=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j







θ
11



(


2

Ni

+

2

N

-
1

)







α
×

e

j


(



θ
11



(


2

Ni

+

2

N

-
1

)


+
λ

)









α
×

e

j







θ
21



(


2

Ni

+

2

N

-
1

)








e

j


(



θ
21



(


2

Ni

+

2

N

-
1

)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(


2

Ni

+

2

N

-
1

)







s





2


(


2

Ni

+

2

N

-
1

)





)






Equation





109







Accordingly, r1 and r2 are represented as follows.


For symbol number 2Ni (where i is an integer greater than or equal to zero):














Math





117













(




r





1


(

2

Ni

)







r





2


(

2

Ni

)





)

=


1



β
2

+
1





(





h
11



(

2

Ni

)






h
12



(

2

Ni

)








h
21



(

2

Ni

)






h
22



(

2

Ni

)





)



(




e

j







θ
11



(

2

Ni

)







β
×

e

(



θ
11



(

2

Ni

)


+
λ

)








β
×

e


θ
21



(

2

Ni

)







e

j


(



θ
21



(

2

Ni

)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(

2

Ni

)







s





2


(

2

Ni

)





)






Equation





110







Here, j is an imaginary unit.


For symbol number 2Ni+1:














Math





118













(




r





1


(


2

Ni

+
1

)







r





2


(


2

Ni

+
1

)





)

=


1



β
2

+
1





(





h
11



(


2

Ni

+
1

)






h
12



(


2

Ni

+
1

)








h
21



(


2

Ni

+
1

)






h
22



(


2

Ni

+
1

)





)



(




e

j







θ
11



(


2

Ni

+
1

)







β
×

e

(



θ
11



(


2

Ni

+
1

)


+
λ

)








β
×

e


θ
21



(


2

Ni

+
1

)







e

j


(



θ
21



(


2

Ni

+
1

)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(


2

Ni

+
1

)







s





2


(


2

Ni

+
1

)





)






Equation





111







When generalized, this equation is as follows.


For symbol number 2Ni+k (k=0, 1, . . . , N−1):














Math





119













(




r





1


(


2

Ni

+
k

)







r





2


(


2

Ni

+
k

)





)

=


1



β
2

+
1





(





h
11



(


2

Ni

+
k

)






h
12



(


2

Ni

+
k

)








h
21



(


2

Ni

+
k

)






h
22



(


2

Ni

+
k

)





)



(




e

j







θ
11



(


2

Ni

+
k

)







β
×

e

(



θ
11



(


2

Ni

+
k

)


+
λ

)








β
×

e


θ
21



(


2

Ni

+
k

)







e

j


(



θ
21



(


2

Ni

+
k

)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(


2

Ni

+
k

)







s





2


(


2

Ni

+
k

)





)






Equation





112







Furthermore, for symbol number 2Ni+N−1:














Math





120













(




r





1


(


2

Ni

+
N
-
1

)







r





2


(


2

Ni

+
N
-
1

)





)

=


1



β
2

+
1





(





h
11



(


2

Ni

+
N
-
1

)






h
12



(


2

Ni

+
N
-
1

)








h
21



(


2

Ni

+
N
-
1

)






h
22



(


2

Ni

+
N
-
1

)





)



(




e

j







θ
11



(


2

Ni

+
N
-
1

)







β
×

e

(



θ
11



(


2

Ni

+
N
-
1

)


+
λ

)








β
×

e


θ
21



(


2

Ni

+
N
-
1

)







e

j


(



θ
21



(


2

Ni

+
N
-
1

)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(


2

Ni

+
N
-
1

)







s





2


(


2

Ni

+
N
-
1

)





)






Equation





113








For symbol number 2Ni+N (where i is an integer greater than or equal to zero):














Math





121













(




r





1


(


2

Ni

+
N

)







r





2


(


2

Ni

+
N

)





)

=


1



α
2

+
1





(





h
11



(


2

Ni

+
N

)






h
12



(


2

Ni

+
N

)








h
21



(


2

Ni

+
N

)






h
22



(


2

Ni

+
N

)





)



(




e

j







θ
11



(


2

Ni

+
N

)







α
×

e

(



θ
11



(


2

Ni

+
N

)


+
λ

)








α
×

e


θ
21



(


2

Ni

+
N

)







e

j


(



θ
21



(


2

Ni

+
N

)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(


2

Ni

+
N

)







s





2


(


2

Ni

+
N

)





)






Equation





114








Here, j is an imaginary unit.


For symbol number 2Ni+N+1:














Math





122













(




r





1


(


2

Ni

+
N
+
1

)







r





2


(


2

Ni

+
N
+
1

)





)

=


1



α
2

+
1





(





h
11



(


2

Ni

+
N
+
1

)






h
12



(


2

Ni

+
N
+
1

)








h
21



(


2

Ni

+
N
+
1

)






h
22



(


2

Ni

+
N
+
1

)





)



(




e

j







θ
11



(


2

Ni

+
N
+
1

)







α
×

e

(



θ
11



(


2

Ni

+
N
+
1

)


+
λ

)








α
×

e


θ
21



(


2

Ni

+
N
+
1

)







e

j


(



θ
21



(


2

Ni

+
N
+
1

)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(


2

Ni

+
N
+
1

)







s





2


(


2

Ni

+
N
+
1

)





)






Equation





115







When generalized, this equation is as follows.


For symbol number 2Ni+N+k (k=0, 1, . . . , N−1):














Math





123













(




r





1


(


2

Ni

+
N
+
k

)







r





2


(


2

Ni

+
N
+
k

)





)

=


1



α
2

+
1





(





h
11



(


2

Ni

+
N
+
k

)






h
12



(


2

Ni

+
N
+
k

)








h
21



(


2

Ni

+
N
+
k

)






h
22



(


2

Ni

+
N
+
k

)





)



(




e

j







θ
11



(


2

Ni

+
N
+
k

)







α
×

e

(



θ
11



(


2

Ni

+
N
+
k

)


+
λ

)








α
×

e


θ
21



(


2

Ni

+
N
+
k

)







e

j


(



θ
21



(


2

Ni

+
N
+
k

)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(


2

Ni

+
N
+
k

)







s





2


(


2

Ni

+
N
+
k

)





)






Equation





116







When generalized, this equation is as follows.


For symbol number 2Ni+2N−1:














Math





124













(




r





1


(


2

Ni

+

2

N

-
1

)







r





2


(


2

Ni

+

2

N

-
1

)





)

=


1



α
2

+
1





(





h
11



(


2

Ni

+

2

N

-
1

)






h
12



(


2

Ni

+

2

N

-
1

)








h
21



(


2

Ni

+

2

N

-
1

)






h
22



(


2

Ni

+

2

N

-
1

)





)



(




e

j







θ
11



(


2

Ni

+

2

N

-
1

)







α
×

e

(



θ
11



(


2

Ni

+

2

N

-
1

)


+
λ

)








α
×

e


θ
21



(


2

Ni

+

2

N

-
1

)







e

j


(



θ
21



(


2

Ni

+

2

N

-
1

)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(


2

Ni

+

2

N

-
1

)







s





2


(


2

Ni

+

2

N

-
1

)





)






Equation





117







In this case, it is assumed that only components of direct waves exist in the channel elements h11(t), h12(t), h21(t), and h22(t), that the amplitude components of the direct waves are all equal, and that fluctuations do not occur over time. With these assumptions, Equations 110-117 can be represented as follows.


For symbol number 2Ni (where i is an integer greater than or equal to zero):














Math





125













(




r





1


(

2

Ni

)







r





2


(

2

Ni

)





)

=


1



β
2

+
1





(




Ae

j





0




q





Ae

j





0




q



)



(




e

j







θ
11



(

2

Ni

)







β
×

e

(



θ
11



(

2

Ni

)


+
λ

)








β
×

e


θ
21



(

2

Ni

)







e

j


(



θ
21



(

2

Ni

)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(

2

Ni

)







s





2


(

2

Ni

)





)






Equation





118







Here, j is an imaginary unit.


For symbol number 2Ni+1:














Math





126













(




r





1


(


2

Ni

+
1

)







r





2


(


2

Ni

+
1

)





)

=


1



β
2

+
1





(




Ae

j





0




q





Ae

j





0




q



)



(




e

j







θ
11



(


2

Ni

+
1

)







β
×

e

(



θ
11



(


2

Ni

+
1

)


+
λ

)








β
×

e


θ
21



(


2

Ni

+
1

)







e

j


(



θ
21



(


2

Ni

+
1

)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(


2

Ni

+
1

)







s





2


(


2

Ni

+
1

)





)






Equation





119







When generalized, this equation is as follows.


For symbol number 2Ni+k (k=0, 1, . . . , N−1):














Math





127













(




r





1


(


2

Ni

+
k

)







r





2


(


2

Ni

+
k

)





)

=


1



β
2

+
1





(




Ae

j





0




q





Ae

j





0




q



)



(




e

j







θ
11



(


2

Ni

+
k

)







β
×

e

(



θ
11



(


2

Ni

+
k

)


+
λ

)








β
×

e


θ
21



(


2

Ni

+
k

)







e

j


(



θ
21



(


2

Ni

+
k

)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(


2

Ni

+
k

)







s





2


(


2

Ni

+
k

)





)






Equation





120







Furthermore, for symbol number 2Ni+N−1:














Math





128













(




r





1


(


2

Ni

+
N
-
1

)







r





2


(


2

Ni

+
N
-
1

)





)

=


1



β
2

+
1





(




Ae

j





0




q





Ae

j





0




q



)



(




e

j







θ
11



(


2

Ni

+
N
-
1

)







β
×

e

(



θ
11



(


2

Ni

+
N
-
1

)


+
λ

)








β
×

e


θ
21



(


2

Ni

+
N
-
1

)







e

j


(



θ
21



(


2

Ni

+
N
-
1

)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(


2

Ni

+
N
-
1

)







s





2


(


2

Ni

+
N
-
1

)





)






Equation





121








For symbol number 2Ni+N (where i is an integer greater than or equal to zero):














Math





129













(




r





1


(


2

Ni

+
N

)







r





2


(


2

Ni

+
N

)





)

=


1



α
2

+
1





(




Ae

j





0




q





Ae

j





0




q



)



(




e

j







θ
11



(


2

Ni

+
N

)







α
×

e

(



θ
11



(


2

Ni

+
N

)


+
λ

)








α
×

e


θ
21



(


2

Ni

+
N

)







e

j


(



θ
21



(


2

Ni

+
N

)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(


2

Ni

+
N

)







s





2


(


2

Ni

+
N

)





)






Equation





122







Here, j is an imaginary unit.


For symbol number 2Ni+N+1:














Math





130













(




r





1


(


2

Ni

+
N
+
1

)







r





2


(


2

Ni

+
N
+
1

)





)

=


1



α
2

+
1





(




Ae

j





0




q





Ae

j





0




q



)



(




e

j







θ
11



(


2

Ni

+
N
+
1

)







α
×

e

(



θ
11



(


2

Ni

+
N
+
1

)


+
λ

)








α
×

e


θ
21



(


2

Ni

+
N
+
1

)







e

j


(



θ
21



(


2

Ni

+
N
+
1

)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(


2

Ni

+
N
+
1

)







s





2


(


2

Ni

+
N
+
1

)





)






Equation





123







When generalized, this equation is as follows.


For symbol number 2Ni+N+k (k=0, 1, . . . , N−1):














Math





131













(




r





1


(


2

Ni

+
N
+
k

)







r





2


(


2

Ni

+
N
+
k

)





)

=


1



α
2

+
1





(




Ae

j





0




q





Ae

j





0




q



)



(




e

j







θ
11



(


2

Ni

+
N
+
k

)







α
×

e

(



θ
11



(


2

Ni

+
N
+
k

)


+
λ

)








α
×

e


θ
21



(


2

Ni

+
N
+
k

)







e

j


(



θ
21



(


2

Ni

+
N
+
k

)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(


2

Ni

+
N
+
k

)







s





2


(


2

Ni

+
N
+
k

)





)






Equation





124







Furthermore, for symbol number 2Ni+2N−1:














Math





132













(




r





1


(


2

Ni

+

2

N

-
1

)







r





2


(


2

Ni

+

2

N

-
1

)





)

=


1



α
2

+
1





(




Ae

j





0




q





Ae

j





0




q



)



(




e

j







θ
11



(


2

Ni

+

2

N

-
1

)







α
×

e

j


(



θ
11



(


2

Ni

+

2

N

-
1

)


+
λ

)









α
×

e

j







θ
21



(


2

Ni

+

2

N

-
1

)








e

j


(



θ
21



(


2

Ni

+

2

N

-
1

)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(


2

Ni

+

2

N

-
1

)







s





2


(


2

Ni

+

2

N

-
1

)





)






Equation





125







In Equations 118-125, let A be a real number and q be a complex number. Equations 118-125 can be represented as follows.


For symbol number 2Ni (where i is an integer greater than or equal to zero):














Math





133













(




r





1


(

2

Ni

)







r





2


(

2

Ni

)





)

=


1



β
2

+
1





(




e

j





0







e

j





0





)



(




Ae

j





0




q



)



(




e

j







θ
11



(

2

Ni

)







β
×

e

j


(



θ
11



(

2

Ni

)


+
λ

)









β
×

e

j







θ
21



(

2

Ni

)








e

j


(



θ
21



(

2

Ni

)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(

2

Ni

)







s





2


(

2

Ni

)





)






Equation





126







Here, j is an imaginary unit.


For symbol number 2Ni+1:














Math





134













(




r





1


(


2

Ni

+
1

)







r





2


(


2

Ni

+
1

)





)

=


1



β
2

+
1





(




e

j





0







e

j





0





)



(




Ae

j





0




q



)



(




e

j







θ
11



(


2

Ni

+
1

)







β
×

e

j


(



θ
11



(


2

Ni

+
1

)


+
λ

)









β
×

e

j







θ
21



(


2

Ni

+
1

)








e

j


(



θ
21



(


2

Ni

+
1

)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(


2

Ni

+
1

)







s





2


(


2

Ni

+
1

)





)






Equation





127







When generalized, this equation is as follows.


For symbol number 2Ni+k (k=0, 1, . . . , N−1):














Math





135













(




r





1


(


2

Ni

+
k

)







r





2


(


2

Ni

+
k

)





)

=


1



β
2

+
1





(




e

j





0







e

j





0





)



(




Ae

j





0




q



)



(




e

j







θ
11



(


2

Ni

+
k

)







β
×

e

j


(



θ
11



(


2

Ni

+
k

)


+
λ

)









β
×

e

j







θ
21



(


2

Ni

+
k

)








e

j


(



θ
21



(


2

Ni

+
k

)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(


2

Ni

+
k

)







s





2


(


2

Ni

+
k

)





)






Equation





128







Furthermore, for symbol number 2Ni+N−1:














Math





136













(




r





1


(


2

Ni

+
N
-
1

)







r





2


(


2

Ni

+
N
-
1

)





)

=


1



β
2

+
1





(




e

j





0







e

j





0





)



(




Ae

j





0




q



)



(




e

j







θ
11



(


2

Ni

+
N
-
1

)







β
×

e

j


(



θ
11



(


2

Ni

+
N
-
1

)


+
λ

)









β
×

e

j







θ
21



(


2

Ni

+
N
-
1

)








e

j


(



θ
21



(


2

Ni

+
N
-
1

)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(


2

Ni

+
N
-
1

)







s





2


(


2

Ni

+
N
-
1

)





)






Equation





129








For symbol number 2Ni+N (where i is an integer greater than or equal to zero):














Math





137













(




r





1


(


2

Ni

+
N

)







r





2


(


2

Ni

+
N

)





)

=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0







e

j





0





)



(




Ae

j





0




q



)



(




e

j







θ
11



(


2

Ni

+
N

)







α
×

e

j


(



θ
11



(


2

Ni

+
N

)


+
λ

)









α
×

e

j







θ
21



(


2

Ni

+
N

)








e

j


(



θ
21



(


2

Ni

+
N

)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(


2

Ni

+
N

)







s





2


(


2

Ni

+
N

)





)






Equation





130







Here, j is an imaginary unit.


For symbol number 2Ni+N+1:














Math





138













(




r





1


(


2

Ni

+
N
+
1

)







r





2


(


2

Ni

+
N
+
1

)





)

=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0







e

j





0





)



(




Ae

j





0




q



)



(




e

j







θ
11



(


2

Ni

+
N
+
1

)







α
×

e

j


(



θ
11



(


2

Ni

+
N
+
1

)


+
λ

)









α
×

e

j







θ
21



(


2

Ni

+
N
+
1

)








e

j


(



θ
21



(


2

Ni

+
N
+
1

)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(


2

Ni

+
N
+
1

)







s





2


(


2

Ni

+
N
+
1

)





)






Equation





131







When generalized, this equation is as follows.


For symbol number 2Ni+N+k (k=0, 1, . . . , N−1):














Math





139













(




r





1


(


2

Ni

+
N
+
k

)







r





2


(


2

Ni

+
N
+
k

)





)

=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0







e

j





0





)



(




Ae

j





0




q



)



(




e

j







θ
11



(


2

Ni

+
N
+
k

)







α
×

e

j


(



θ
11



(


2

Ni

+
N
+
k

)


+
λ

)









α
×

e

j







θ
21



(


2

Ni

+
N
+
k

)








e

j


(



θ
21



(


2

Ni

+
N
+
k

)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(


2

Ni

+
N
+
k

)







s





2


(


2

Ni

+
N
+
k

)





)






Equation





132







Furthermore, for symbol number 2Ni+2N−1:














Math





140













(




r





1


(


2

Ni

+

2

N

-
1

)







r





2


(


2

Ni

+

2

N

-
1

)





)

=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0







e

j





0





)



(




Ae

j





0




q



)



(




e

j







θ
11



(


2

Ni

+

2

N

-
1

)







α
×

e

j


(



θ
11



(


2

Ni

+

2

N

-
1

)


+
λ

)









α
×

e

j







θ
21



(


2

Ni

+

2

N

-
1

)








e

j


(



θ
21



(


2

Ni

+

2

N

-
1

)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(


2

Ni

+

2

N

-
1

)







s





2


(


2

Ni

+

2

N

-
1

)





)






Equation





133







As a result, when q is represented as follows, one of the signals s1 and s2 can no longer be obtained.


For symbol number 2Ni (where i is an integer greater than or equal to zero):









Math





141












q
=


-

A
β




e

j


(



θ
11



(

2

Ni

)


-


θ
21



(

2

Ni

)



)





,


-
A








βe






j


(



θ
11



(

2

Ni

)


-


θ
21



(

2

Ni

)


-
δ

)








Equation





134








For symbol number 2Ni+1:









Math





142












q
=


-

A
β




e

j


(



θ
11



(


2

Ni

+
1

)


-


θ
21



(


2

Ni

+
1

)



)





,






-
A








βe






j


(



θ
11



(


2

Ni

+
1

)


-


θ
21



(


2

Ni

+
1

)


-
δ

)








Equation





135







When generalized, this equation is as follows.


For symbol number 2Ni+k (k=0, 1, . . . , N−1):









Math





143












q
=


-

A
β




e

j


(



θ
11



(


2

Ni

+
k

)


-


θ
21



(


2

Ni

+
k

)



)





,






-
A








βe






j


(



θ
11



(


2

Ni

+
k

)


-


θ
21



(


2

Ni

+
k

)


-
δ

)








Equation





136







Furthermore, for symbol number 2Ni+N−1:









Math





144












q
=


-

A
β




e

j


(



θ
11



(


2

Ni

+
N
-
1

)


-


θ
21



(


2

Ni

+
N
-
1

)



)





,






-
A








βe






j


(



θ
11



(


2

Ni

+
N
-
1

)


-


θ
21



(


2

Ni

+
N
-
1

)


-
δ

)








Equation





137








For symbol number 2Ni+N (where i is an integer greater than or equal to zero):









Math





145












q
=


-

A
α




e

j


(



θ
11



(


2

Ni

+
N

)


-


θ
21



(


2

Ni

+
N

)



)





,






-
A






α







e






j


(



θ
11



(


2

Ni

+
N

)


-


θ
21



(


2

Ni

+
N

)


-
δ

)








Equation





138








For symbol number 2Ni+N+1:









Math





146












q
=


-

A
α




e

j


(



θ
11



(


2

Ni

+
N
+
1

)


-


θ
21



(


2

Ni

+
N
+
1

)



)





,






-
A






α







e






j


(



θ
11



(


2

Ni

+
N
+
1

)


-


θ
21



(


2

Ni

+
N
+
1

)


-
δ

)








Equation





139







When generalized, this equation is as follows.


For symbol number 2Ni+N+k (k=0, 1, . . . , N−1):









Math





147












q
=


-

A
α




e

j


(



θ
11



(


2

Ni

+
N
+
k

)


-


θ
21



(


2

Ni

+
N
+
k

)



)





,






-
A






α






e

j


(



θ
11



(


2

Ni

+
N
+
k

)


-


θ
21



(


2

Ni

+
N
+
k

)


-
δ

)








Equation





140







Furthermore, for symbol number 2Ni+2N−1:









Math





148












q
=


-

A
α




e

j


(



θ
11



(


2

Ni

+

2

N

-
1

)


-


θ
21



(


2

Ni

+

2

N

-
1

)



)





,






-
A






α






e

j


(



θ
11



(


2

Ni

+

2

N

-
1

)


-


θ
21



(


2

Ni

+

2

N

-
1

)


-
δ

)








Equation





141







In this case, if q has the same solution in symbol numbers 2Ni through 2Ni+N−1, then since the channel elements of the direct waves do not greatly fluctuate, excellent reception quality can no longer be obtained for any of the symbol numbers. Therefore, it is difficult to achieve the ability to correct errors, even if error correction codes are introduced. Accordingly, for q not to have the same solution, Condition #7 or Condition #8 becomes necessary from Equations 134-141 and from the fact that α≠β when focusing on one of two solutions of q which does not include δ.

Math 149
ej(θ11(2Ni+x)-θ21(2Ni+x))≠ej(θ11(2Ni+y)-θ21(2Ni+y)) for ∀x,∀y (x≠y; x, y=0,1,2, . . . , N−2, N−1)   Condition #7

(x is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; y is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; and x≠y)


and

ej(θ11(2Ni+N+x)-θ21(2Ni+N+x))≠ej(θ11(2Ni+N+y)-θ21(2Ni+N+y)) for ∀x,∀y (x≠y; x, y=0,1,2, . . . , N−2, N−1)

(x is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; y is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; and x≠y)

Math 150
ej(θ11(2Ni+x)-θ21(2Ni+x))≠ej(θ11(2Ni+y)-θ21(2Ni+y)) for ∀x,∀y (x≠y; x, y=0,1,2, . . . , 2N−2, 2N−1)   Condition #8


In this case, Condition #8 is similar to the conditions described in Embodiment 1 through Embodiment 3. However, with regards to Condition #7, since α≠β, the solution not including δ among the two solutions of q is a different solution.


Next, design requirements for not only θ11 and θ12, but also for λ and δ are described. It suffices to set λ to a certain value; it is then necessary to establish requirements for δ. The following describes the design scheme for δ when λ is set to zero radians.


In this case, similar to the scheme of changing the precoding weights in a four-slot period (cycle), by defining δ so that π/2 radians ≤|δ|≤π radians, excellent reception quality is achieved, particularly in an LOS environment.


In symbol numbers 2Ni through 2Ni+2N−1, two points q exist where reception quality becomes poor, and therefore 4N such points exist. In an LOS environment, in order to achieve excellent characteristics, these 4N points should each have a different solution. In this case, focusing on amplitude, the following condition is necessary for Condition #7 or Condition #8, since α≠β.









Math





151











α


1
β





Condition





#9







As described above, when a transmission device transmits a plurality of modulated signals from a plurality of antennas in a MIMO system, the advantageous effect of improved transmission quality, as compared to conventional spatial multiplexing MIMO system, is achieved in an LOS environment in which direct waves dominate by hopping between precoding weights regularly over time.


In the present embodiment, the structure of the reception device is as described in Embodiment 1, and in particular with regards to the structure of the reception device, operations have been described for a limited number of antennas, but the present invention may be embodied in the same way even if the number of antennas increases. In other words, the number of antennas in the reception device does not affect the operations or advantageous effects of the present embodiment. Furthermore, in the present embodiment, similar to Embodiment 1, the error correction codes are not limited.


In the present embodiment, in contrast with Embodiment 1, the scheme of changing the precoding weights in the time domain has been described. As described in Embodiment 1, however, the present invention may be similarly embodied by changing the precoding weights by using a multi-carrier transmission scheme and arranging symbols in the frequency domain and the frequency-time domain. Furthermore, in the present embodiment, symbols other than data symbols, such as pilot symbols (preamble, unique word, and the like), symbols for control information, and the like, may be arranged in the frame in any way.


Embodiment 5

In Embodiment 1 through Embodiment 4, the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding weights has been described. In the present embodiment, a modification of this scheme is described.


In Embodiment 1 through Embodiment 4, the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding weights as in FIG. 6 has been described. In the present embodiment, a scheme of regularly hopping between precoding weights that differs from FIG. 6 is described.


As in FIG. 6, this scheme hops between four different precoding weights (matrices). FIG. 22 shows the hopping scheme that differs from FIG. 6. In FIG. 22, four different precoding weights (matrices) are represented as W1, W2, W3, and W4. (For example, W1 is the precoding weight (matrix) in Equation 37, W2 is the precoding weight (matrix) in Equation 38, W3 is the precoding weight (matrix) in Equation 39, and W4 is the precoding weight (matrix) in Equation 40.) In FIG. 3, elements that operate in a similar way to FIG. 3 and FIG. 6 bear the same reference signs.


The parts unique to FIG. 22 are as follows.


The first period (cycle) 2201, the second period (cycle) 2202, the third period (cycle) 2203, . . . are all four-slot period (cycle)s.


A different precoding weight matrix is used in each of the four slots, i.e. W1, W2, W3, and W4 are each used once.


It is not necessary for W1, W2, W3, and W4 to be in the same order in the first period (cycle) 2201, the second period (cycle) 2202, the third period (cycle) 2203, . . . .


In order to implement this scheme, a precoding weight generating unit 2200 receives, as an input, a signal regarding a weighting scheme and outputs information 2210 regarding precoding weights in order for each period (cycle). The weighting unit 600 receives, as inputs, this information, s1(t), and s2(t), performs weighting, and outputs z1(t) and z2(t).



FIG. 23 shows a different weighting scheme than FIG. 22 for the above precoding scheme. In FIG. 23, the difference from FIG. 22 is that a similar scheme to FIG. 22 is achieved by providing a reordering unit after the weighting unit and by reordering signals.


In FIG. 23, the precoding weight generating unit 2200 receives, as an input, information 315 regarding a weighting scheme and outputs information 2210 on precoding weights in the order of precoding weights W1, W2, W3, W4, W1, W2, W3, W4, . . . . Accordingly, the weighting unit 600 uses the precoding weights in the order of precoding weights W1, W2, W3, W4, W1, W2, W3, W4, . . . and outputs precoded signals 2300A and 2300B.


A reordering unit 2300 receives, as inputs, the precoded signals 2300A and 2300B, reorders the precoded signals 2300A and 2300B in the order of the first period (cycle) 2201, the second period (cycle) 2202, and the third period (cycle) 2203 in FIG. 23, and outputs z1(t) and z2(t).


Note that in the above description, the period (cycle) for hopping between precoding weights has been described as having four slots for the sake of comparison with FIG. 6. As in Embodiment 1 through Embodiment 4, however, the present invention may be similarly embodied with a period (cycle) having other than four slots.


Furthermore, in Embodiment 1 through Embodiment 4, and in the above precoding scheme, within the period (cycle), the value of δ and β has been described as being the same for each slot, but the value of δ and β may change in each slot.


As described above, when a transmission device transmits a plurality of modulated signals from a plurality of antennas in a MIMO system, the advantageous effect of improved transmission quality, as compared to conventional spatial multiplexing MIMO system, is achieved in an LOS environment in which direct waves dominate by hopping between precoding weights regularly over time.


In the present embodiment, the structure of the reception device is as described in Embodiment 1, and in particular with regards to the structure of the reception device, operations have been described for a limited number of antennas, but the present invention may be embodied in the same way even if the number of antennas increases. In other words, the number of antennas in the reception device does not affect the operations or advantageous effects of the present embodiment. Furthermore, in the present embodiment, similar to Embodiment 1, the error correction codes are not limited.


In the present embodiment, in contrast with Embodiment 1, the scheme of changing the precoding weights in the time domain has been described. As described in Embodiment 1, however, the present invention may be similarly embodied by changing the precoding weights by using a multi-carrier transmission scheme and arranging symbols in the frequency domain and the frequency-time domain. Furthermore, in the present embodiment, symbols other than data symbols, such as pilot symbols (preamble, unique word, and the like), symbols for control information, and the like, may be arranged in the frame in any way.


Embodiment 6

In Embodiments 1-4, a scheme for regularly hopping between precoding weights has been described. In the present embodiment, a scheme for regularly hopping between precoding weights is again described, including the content that has been described in Embodiments 1-4.


First, out of consideration of an LOS environment, a scheme of designing a precoding matrix is described for a 2×2 spatial multiplexing MIMO system that adopts precoding in which feedback from a communication partner is not available.



FIG. 30 shows a model of a 2×2 spatial multiplexing MIMO system that adopts precoding in which feedback from a communication partner is not available. An information vector z is encoded and interleaved. As output of the interleaving, an encoded bit vector u(p)=(u1(p), u2(p)) is acquired (where p is the slot time). Let ui(p)=(ui1(p), . . . , uih(p)) (where h is the number of transmission bits per symbol). Letting a signal after modulation (mapping) be s(p)=(s1(p), s2(p))T and a precoding matrix be F(p), a precoded symbol x(p)=(x1(p), x2(p))T is represented by the following equation.









Math





152















x


(
p
)


=




(



x
1



(
p
)


,


x
2



(
p
)



)

T







=




F


(
p
)




s


(
p
)










Equation





142







Accordingly, letting a received vector be y(p)=(y1(p), y2(p))T, the received vector y(p) is represented by the following equation.









Math





153















y


(
p
)


=




(



y
1



(
p
)


,


y
2



(
p
)



)

T







=





H


(
p
)




F


(
p
)




s


(
p
)



+

n


(
p
)










Equation





143







In this Equation, H(p) is the channel matrix, n(p)=(n1(p), n2(p))T is the noise vector, and ni(p) is the i.i.d. complex Gaussian random noise with an average value 0 and variance σ2. Letting the Rician factor be K, the above equation can be represented as follows.









Math





154















y


(
p
)


=




(



y
1



(
p
)


,


y
2



(
p
)



)

T







=



(




K

K
+
1






H
d



(
p
)



+















1

K
+
1






H
s



(
p
)



)



F


(
p
)




s


(
p
)



+

n


(
p
)









Equation





144







In this equation, Hd(p) is the channel matrix for the direct wave components, and Hs(p) is the channel matrix for the scattered wave components. Accordingly, the channel matrix H(p) is represented as follows.









Math





155















H


(
p
)


=






K

K
+
1






H
d



(
p
)



+



1

K
+
1






H
s



(
p
)










=






K

K
+
1





(




h

11
,
d





h

12
,
d







h

21
,
d





h

22
,
d





)


+












1

K
+
1





(





h

11
,
s




(
p
)






h

12
,
s




(
p
)








h

21
,
s




(
p
)






h

22
,
s




(
p
)





)









Equation





145







In Equation 145, it is assumed that the direct wave environment is uniquely determined by the positional relationship between transmitters, and that the channel matrix Hd(p) for the direct wave components does not fluctuate with time. Furthermore, in the channel matrix Hd(p) for the direct wave components, it is assumed that as compared to the interval between transmitting antennas, the probability of an environment with a sufficiently long distance between transmission and reception devices is high, and therefore that the channel matrix for the direct wave components can be treated as a non-singular matrix. Accordingly, the channel matrix Hd(p) is represented as follows.









Math





156
















H
d



(
p
)


=



(




h

11
,
d





h

12
,
d







h

21
,
d





h

22
,
d





)







=



(




Ae

j





ψ




q





Ae

j





ψ




q



)








Equation





146







In this equation, let A be a positive real number and q be a complex number. Subsequently, out of consideration of an LOS environment, a scheme of designing a precoding matrix is described for a 2×2 spatial multiplexing MIMO system that adopts precoding in which feedback from a communication partner is not available.


From Equations 144 and 145, it is difficult to seek a precoding matrix without appropriate feedback in conditions including scattered waves, since it is difficult to perform analysis under conditions including scattered waves. Additionally, in a NLOS environment, little degradation in reception quality of data occurs as compared to an LOS environment. Therefore, the following describes a scheme of designing precoding matrices without appropriate feedback in an LOS environment (precoding matrices for a precoding scheme that hops between precoding matrices over time).


As described above, since it is difficult to perform analysis under conditions including scattered waves, an appropriate precoding matrix for a channel matrix including components of only direct waves is sought from Equations 144 and 145. Therefore, in Equation 144, the case when the channel matrix includes components of only direct waves is considered. It follows that from Equation 146, Equation 144 can be represented as follows.









Math





157















(





y
1



(
p
)








y
2



(
p
)





)

=






H
d



(
p
)




F


(
p
)




s


(
p
)



+

n


(
p
)









=





(




Ae

j





ψ




q





Ae

j





ψ




q



)


F


(
p
)



s


(
p
)



+

n


(
p
)










Equation





147







In this equation, a unitary matrix is used as the precoding matrix. Accordingly, the precoding matrix is represented as follows.









Math





158












F


(
p
)


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j







θ
11



(
p
)







α
×

e

j


(



θ
11



(
p
)


+
λ

)









α
×

e

j







θ
21



(
p
)








e

j


(



θ
21



(
p
)


+
λ
+
π

)






)






Equation





148







In this equation, λ is a fixed value. Therefore, Equation 147 can be represented as follows.














Math





159













(





y
1



(
p
)








y
2



(
p
)





)

=



1



α
2

+
1





(




Ae

j





ψ




q





Ae

j





ψ




q



)



(




e

j







θ
11



(
p
)







α
×

e

j


(



θ
11



(
p
)


+
λ

)









α
×

e

j







θ
21



(
p
)








e

j


(



θ
21



(
p
)


+
λ
+
π

)






)



(




s





1


(
p
)







s





2


(
p
)





)


+

n


(
p
)







Equation





149







As is clear from Equation 149, when the reception device performs linear operation of Zero Forcing (ZF) or the Minimum Mean Squared Error (MMSE), the transmitted bit cannot be determined by s1(p), s2(p). Therefore, the iterative APP (or iterative Max-log APP) or APP (or Max-log APP) described in Embodiment 1 is performed (hereafter referred to as Maximum Likelihood (ML) calculation), the log-likelihood ratio of each bit transmitted in s1(p), s2(p) is sought, and decoding with error correction codes is performed. Accordingly, the following describes a scheme of designing a precoding matrix without appropriate feedback in an LOS environment for a reception device that performs ML calculation.


The precoding in Equation 149 is considered. The right-hand side and left-hand side of the first line are multiplied by e−jΨ, and similarly the right-hand side and left-hand side of the second line are multiplied by e−jΨ. The following equation represents the result.









Math





160















(




e


-
j






ψ






y
1



(
p
)







e


-
j






ψ






y
2



(
p
)





)

=




e


-
j






ψ




{


1



α
2

+
1





(




Ae

j





ψ




q





Ae

j





ψ




q



)













(




e

j







θ
11



(
p
)







α
×

e

j


(



θ
11



(
p
)


+
λ

)









α
×

e

j







θ
21



(
p
)








e

j


(



θ
21



(
p
)


+
λ
+
π

)






)











(




s





1


(
p
)







s





2


(
p
)





)

+

n


(
p
)



}






=




1



α
2

+
1





(




Ae

j





0






e


-
j






ψ



q






Ae

j





0






e


-
j






ψ



q




)











(




e

j







θ
11



(
p
)







α
×

e

j


(



θ
11



(
p
)


+
λ

)









α
×

e

j







θ
21



(
p
)








e

j


(



θ
21



(
p
)


+
λ
+
π

)






)











(




s





1


(
p
)







s





2


(
p
)





)

+


e


-
j






ψ




n


(
p
)











Equation





150







e−jΨy1(p), e−jΨy2(p), and e−jΨq are respectively redefined as y1(p), y2(p), and q. Furthermore, since e−jΨn(p)=(e−jΨn1(p), e−jΨn2(p))T, and e−jΨn1(p), e−jΨn2(p) are the independent identically distributed (i.i.d.) complex Gaussian random noise with an average value 0 and variance σ2, e−jΨn(p) is redefined as n(p). As a result, generality is not lost by restating Equation 150 as Equation 151.














Math





161













(





y
1



(
p
)








y
2



(
p
)





)

=



1



α
2

+
1





(




Ae

j





0




q





Ae

j





0




q



)



(




e

j







θ
11



(
p
)







α
×

e

j


(



θ
11



(
p
)


+
λ

)









α
×

e

j







θ
21



(
p
)








e

j


(



θ
21



(
p
)


+
λ
+
π

)






)



(




s





1


(
p
)







s





2


(
p
)





)


+

n


(
p
)







Equation





151







Next, Equation 151 is transformed into Equation 152 for the sake of clarity.














Math





162













(





y
1



(
p
)








y
2



(
p
)





)

=



1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0







e

j





0





)



(




Ae

j





0




q



)



(




e

j







θ
11



(
p
)







α
×

e

j


(



θ
11



(
p
)


+
λ

)









α
×

e

j







θ
21



(
p
)








e

j


(



θ
21



(
p
)


+
λ
+
π

)






)



(




s





1


(
p
)







s





2


(
p
)





)


+

n


(
p
)







Equation





152







In this case, letting the minimum Euclidian distance between a received signal point and a received candidate signal point be dmin2, then a poor point has a minimum value of zero for dmin2, and two values of q exist at which conditions are poor in that all of the bits transmitted by s1(p) and all of the bits transmitted by s2(p) being eliminated.


In Equation 152, when s1(p) does not exist.









Math





163











q
=


-

A
α




e

j


(



θ
11



(
p
)


-


θ
21



(
p
)



)








Equation





149







In Equation 152, when s2(p) does not exist.

Math 164
q=−Aαej(θ11(p)-θ21(p)-π)  Equation 154


(Hereinafter, the values of q satisfying Equations 153 and 154 are respectively referred to as “poor reception points for s1 and s2”).


When Equation 153 is satisfied, since all of the bits transmitted by s1(p) are eliminated, the received log-likelihood ratio cannot be sought for any of the bits transmitted by s1(p). When Equation 154 is satisfied, since all of the bits transmitted by s2(p) are eliminated, the received log-likelihood ratio cannot be sought for any of the bits transmitted by s2(p).


A broadcast/multicast transmission system that does not change the precoding matrix is now considered. In this case, a system model is considered in which a base station transmits modulated signals using a precoding scheme that does not hop between precoding matrices, and a plurality of terminals (Γ terminals) receive the modulated signals transmitted by the base station.


It is considered that the conditions of direct waves between the base station and the terminals change little over time. Therefore, from Equations 153 and 154, for a terminal that is in a position fitting the conditions of Equation 155 or Equation 156 and that is in an LOS environment where the Rician factor is large, the possibility of degradation in the reception quality of data exists. Accordingly, to resolve this problem, it is necessary to change the precoding matrix over time.









Math





165











q



-

A
α




e

j


(



θ
11



(
p
)


-


θ
21



(
p
)



)








Equation





155






Math





166











q



-
A







αe

j


(



θ
11



(
p
)


-


θ
21



(
p
)


-
π

)








Equation





156







A scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices over a time period (cycle) with N slots (hereinafter referred to as a precoding hopping scheme) is considered.


Since there are N slots in the time period (cycle), N varieties of precoding matrices F[i] based on Equation 148 are prepared (i=0, 1, . . . , N−1). In this case, the precoding matrices F[i] are represented as follows.









Math





167












F


[
i
]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j







θ
11



[
i
]







α
×

e

j


(



θ
11



[
i
]


+
λ

)









α
×

e

j







θ
21



[
i
]








e

j


(



θ
21



[
i
]


+
λ
+
π

)






)






Equation





157







In this equation, let α not change over time, and let λ also not change over time (though change over time may be allowed).


As in Embodiment 1, F[i] is the precoding matrix used to obtain a precoded signal x (p=N×k+i) in Equation 142 for time N×k+i (where k is an integer equal to or greater than 0, and i=0, 1, . . . , N−1). The same is true below as well.


At this point, based on Equations 153 and 154, design conditions such as the following are important for the precoding matrices for precoding hopping.

Math 168
Condition #10
ej(θ11[x]-θ21[x])≠ej(θ11[y]-θ21[y]) for ∀x, ∀y (x≠y; x, y=0, 1, . . . , N−1)  Equation 158
Math 169
Condition #11
ej(θ11[x]-θ21[x]-π)≠ej(θ11[y]-θ21[y]-π) for ∀x, ∀y (x≠y; x, y=0, 1, . . . , N−1)  Equation 159


From Condition #10, in all of the Γ terminals, there is one slot or less having poor reception points for s1 among the N slots in a time period (cycle). Accordingly, the log-likelihood ratio for bits transmitted by s1(p) can be obtained for at least N−1 slots. Similarly, from Condition #11, in all of the Γ terminals, there is one slot or less having poor reception points for s2 among the N slots in a time period (cycle). Accordingly, the log-likelihood ratio for bits transmitted by s2(p) can be obtained for at least N−1 slots.


In this way, by providing the precoding matrix design model of Condition #10 and Condition #11, the number of bits for which the log-likelihood ratio is obtained among the bits transmitted by s1(p), and the number of bits for which the log-likelihood ratio is obtained among the bits transmitted by s2(p) is guaranteed to be equal to or greater than a fixed number in all of the Γ terminals. Therefore, in all of the Γ terminals, it is considered that degradation of data reception quality is moderated in an LOS environment where the Rician factor is large.


The following shows an example of a precoding matrix in the precoding hopping scheme.


The probability density distribution of the phase of a direct wave can be considered to be evenly distributed over [0 2π]. Therefore, the probability density distribution of the phase of q in Equations 151 and 152 can also be considered to be evenly distributed over [0 2π]. Accordingly, the following is established as a condition for providing fair data reception quality insofar as possible for Γ terminals in the same LOS environment in which only the phase of q differs.


Condition #12


When using a precoding hopping scheme with an N-slot time period (cycle), among the N slots in the time period (cycle), the poor reception points for s1 are arranged to have an even distribution in terms of phase, and the poor reception points for s2 are arranged to have an even distribution in terms of phase.


The following describes an example of a precoding matrix in the precoding hopping scheme based on Condition #10 through Condition #12. Let α=1.0 in the precoding matrix in Equation 157.


Example #5

Let the number of slots N in the time period (cycle) be 8. In order to satisfy Condition #10 through Condition #12, precoding matrices for a precoding hopping scheme with an N=8 time period (cycle) are provided as in the following equation.









Math





170












F


[
i
]


=


1

2




(




e

j





0





e

j





0







e

j



i





π

4






e

j


(



i





π

4

+
π

)






)






Equation





160







Here, j is an imaginary unit, and i=0, 1, . . . , 7. Instead of Equation 160, Equation 161 may be provided (where λ and θ11[i] do not change over time (though change may be allowed)).









Math





171












F


[
i
]


=


1

2




(




e

j







θ
11



[
i
]







e

j


(



θ
11



[
i
]


+
λ

)








e

j


(



θ
11



[
i
]


+


i





π

4


)






e

j


(



θ
11



[
i
]


+


i





π

4

+
λ
+
π

)






)






Equation





161







Accordingly, the poor reception points for s1 and s2 become as in FIGS. 31A and 31B. (In FIGS. 31A and 31B, the horizontal axis is the real axis, and the vertical axis is the imaginary axis.) Instead of Equations 160 and 161, Equations 162 and 163 may be provided (where i=0, 1, . . . , 7, and where λ and θ11[i] do not change over time (though change may be allowed)).









Math





172












F


[
i
]


=


1

2




(




e

j





0





e

j





0







e

j


(

-


i





π

4


)






e

j


(


-


i





π

4


+
π

)






)






Equation





162






Math





173












F


[
i
]


=


1

2




(




e

j







θ
11



[
i
]







e

j


(



θ
11



[
i
]


+
λ

)








e

j


(



θ
11



[
i
]


-


i





π

4


)






e

j


(



θ
11



[
i
]


-


i





π

4

+
λ
+
π

)






)






Equation





163







Next, the following is established as a condition, different from Condition #12, for providing fair data reception quality insofar as possible for Γ terminals in the same LOS environment in which only the phase of q differs.


Condition #13


When using a precoding hopping scheme with an N-slot time period (cycle), in addition to the condition

Math 174
ej(θ11[x]-θ21[x])≠ej(θ11[y]-θ21[y]-π) for ∀x,∀y (x, y=0,1, . . . , N−1)  Equation 164

the poor reception points for s1 and the poor reception points for s2 are arranged to be in an even distribution with respect to phase in the N slots in the time period (cycle).


The following describes an example of a precoding matrix in the precoding hopping scheme based on Condition #10, Condition #11, and Condition #13. Let α=1.0 in the precoding matrix in Equation 157.


Example #6

Let the number of slots N in the time period (cycle) be 4. Precoding matrices for a precoding hopping scheme with an N=4 time period (cycle) are provided as in the following equation.









Math





175












F


[
i
]


=


1

2




(




e

j





0





e

j





0







e

j



i





π

4






e

j


(



i





π

4

+
π

)






)






Equation





165







Here, j is an imaginary unit, and i=0, 1, 2, 3. Instead of Equation 165, Equation 166 may be provided (where λ and θ11[i] do not change over time (though change may be allowed)).









Math





176












F


[
i
]


=


1

2




(




e

j







θ
11



[
i
]







e

j


(



θ
11



[
i
]


+
λ

)








e

j


(



θ
11



[
i
]


+


i





π

4


)






e

j


(



θ
11



[
i
]


+


i





π

4

+
λ
+
π

)






)






Equation





166







Accordingly, the poor reception points for s1 and s2 become as in FIG. 32. (In FIG. 32, the horizontal axis is the real axis, and the vertical axis is the imaginary axis.) Instead of Equations 165 and 166, Equations 167 and 168 may be provided (where i=0, 1, 2, 3, and where λ and θ11[i] do not change over time (though change may be allowed)).









Math





177












F


[
i
]


=


1

2




(




e

j





0





e

j





0







e

j


(

-


i





π

4


)






e

j


(


-


i





π

4


+
π

)






)






Equation





167






Math





178












F


[
i
]


=


1

2




(




e

j







θ
11



[
i
]







e

j


(



θ
11



[
i
]


+
λ

)








e

j


(



θ
11



[
i
]


-


i





π

4


)






e

j


(



θ
11



[
i
]


-


i





π

4

+
λ
+
π

)






)






Equation





168







Next, a precoding hopping scheme using a non-unitary matrix is described.


Based on Equation 148, the precoding matrices presently under consideration are represented as follows.









Math





179












F


(
p
)


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j







θ
11



(
p
)







α
×

e

j


(



θ
11



(
p
)


+
λ

)









α
×

e

j







θ
21



(
p
)








e

j


(



θ
21



(
p
)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)






Equation





169







Equations corresponding to Equations 151 and 152 are represented as follows.














Math





180













(





y
1



(
p
)








y
2



(
p
)





)

=



1



α
2

+
1





(




Ae

j





0




q





Ae

j





0




q



)



(




e

j







θ
11



(
p
)







α
×

e

j


(



θ
11



(
p
)


+
λ

)









α
×

e

j







θ
21



(
p
)








e

j


(



θ
21



(
p
)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(
p
)







s





2


(
p
)





)


+

n


(
p
)







Equation





170











Math





181













(





y
1



(
p
)








y
2



(
p
)





)

=



1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0







e

j





0





)



(




Ae

j





0




q



)



(




e

j







θ
11



(
p
)







α
×

e

j


(



θ
11



(
p
)


+
λ

)









α
×

e

j







θ
21



(
p
)








e

j


(



θ
21



(
p
)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(
p
)







s





2


(
p
)





)


+

n


(
p
)







Equation





171







In this case, there are two q at which the minimum value dmin2 of the Euclidian distance between a received signal point and a received candidate signal point is zero.


In Equation 171, when s1(p) does not exist:









Math





182











q
=


-

A
α




e

j


(



θ
11



(
p
)


-


θ
21



(
p
)



)








Equation





172







In Equation 171, when s2(p) does not exist:

Math 183
q=−Aαej(θ11(p)-θ21(p)-δ)  Equation 173


In the precoding hopping scheme for an N-slot time period (cycle), by referring to Equation 169, N varieties of the precoding matrix F[i] are represented as follows.









Math





184












F


[
i
]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j







θ
11



[
i
]







α
×

e

j


(



θ
11



[
i
]


+
λ

)









α
×

e

j







θ
21



[
i
]








e

j


(



θ
21



[
i
]


+
λ
+
δ

)






)






Equation





174







In this equation, let α and δ not change over time. At this point, based on Equations 34 and 35, design conditions such as the following are provided for the precoding matrices for precoding hopping.

Math 185
Condition #14
ej(θ11[x]-θ21[x])≠ej(θ11[y]-θ21[y]) for ∀x, ∀y (x≠y; x, y=0, 1, . . . , N−1)  Equation 175
Math 186
Condition #15
ej(θ11[x]-θ21[x]-δ)≠ej(θ11[y]-θ21[y]-δ) for ∀x, ∀y (x≠y; x, y=0, 1, . . . , N−1)  Equation 176


Example #7

Let α=1.0 in the precoding matrix in Equation 174. Let the number of slots N in the time period (cycle) be 16. In order to satisfy Condition #12, Condition #14, and Condition #15, precoding matrices for a precoding hopping scheme with an N=16 time period (cycle) are provided as in the following equations.


For i=0, 1, . . . , 7:









Math





187












F


[
i
]


=


1

2




(




e

j





0





e

j





0







e

j



i





π

4






e

j


(



i





π

4

+


7

π

8


)






)






Equation





177








For i=8, 9, . . . , 15:









Math





188












F


[
i
]


=


1

2




(




e

j



i





π

4






e

j


(



i





π

4

+


7

π

8


)








e

j





0





e

j





0





)






Equation





178







Furthermore, a precoding matrix that differs from Equations 177 and 178 can be provided as follows.


For i=0, 1, . . . , 7:









Math





189












F


[
i
]


=


1

2




(




e

j







θ
11



[
i
]







e

j


(



θ
11



[
i
]


+
λ

)








e

j


(



θ
11



[
i
]


+


i





π

4


)






e

j


(



θ
11



[
i
]


+


i





π

4

+
λ
+


7

π

8


)






)






Equation





179








For i=8, 9, . . . , 15:









Math





190












F


[
i
]


=


1

2




(




e

j


(



θ
11



[
i
]


+


i





π

4


)






e

j


(



θ
11



[
i
]


+


i





π

4

+
λ
+


7

π

8


)








e

j







θ
11



[
i
]







e

j


(



θ
11



[
i
]


+
λ

)






)






Equation





180







Accordingly, the poor reception points for s1 and s2 become as in FIGS. 33A and 33B.


(In FIGS. 33A and 33B, the horizontal axis is the real axis, and the vertical axis is the imaginary axis.) Instead of Equations 177 and 178, and Equations 179 and 180, precoding matrices may be provided as below.


For i=0, 1, . . . , 7:









Math





191












F


[
i
]


=


1

2




(




e

j





θ





e

j





θ







e

j


(

-


i





π

4


)






e

j


(


-


i





π

4


+


7

π

8


)






)






Equation





181








For i=8, 9, . . . , 15:









Math





192












F


[
i
]


=


1

2




(




e

j


(

-


i





π

4


)






e

j


(


-


i





π

4


+


7

π

8


)








e

j





0





e

j





0





)






Equation





182







or


For i=0, 1, . . . , 7:









Math





193












F


[
i
]


=


1

2




(




e

j







θ
11



[
i
]







e

j


(



θ
11



[
i
]


+
λ

)








e

j






(



θ
11



[
i
]


-


i





π

4


)






e

j


(



θ
11



[
i
]


-


i





π

4

+
λ
+


7

π

8


)






)






Equation





183








For i=8, 9, . . . , 15:









Math





194












F


[
i
]


=


1

2




(




e

j


(



θ
11



[
i
]


-


i





π

4


)






e

j


(



θ
11



[
i
]


-


i





π

4

+
λ
+


7

π

8


)








e

j







θ
11



[
i
]







e

j






(



θ
11



[
i
]


+
λ

)






)






Equation





184








(In Equations 177-184, 7π/8 may be changed to −7π/8.)


Next, the following is established as a condition, different from Condition #12, for providing fair data reception quality insofar as possible for Γ terminals in the same LOS environment in which only the phase of q differs.


Condition #16


When using a precoding hopping scheme with an N-slot time period (cycle), the following condition is set:

Math 195
ej(θ11[x]-θ21[x])≠ej(θ11[y]-θ21[y]-δ) for ∀x,∀y (x, y=0,1, . . . , N−1)  Equation 185


and the poor reception points for s1 and the poor reception points for s2 are arranged to be in an even distribution with respect to phase in the N slots in the time period (cycle).


The following describes an example of a precoding matrix in the precoding hopping scheme based on Condition #14, Condition #15, and Condition #16. Let α=1.0 in the precoding matrix in Equation 174.


Example #8

Let the number of slots N in the time period (cycle) be 8. Precoding matrices for a precoding hopping scheme with an N=8 time period (cycle) are provided as in the following equation.









Math





196












F


[
i
]


=


1

2




(




e

j





0





e

j





0







e

j



i





π

4






e

j


(



i





π

4

+


7

π

8


)






)






Equation





186







Here, i=0, 1, . . . , 7.


Furthermore, a precoding matrix that differs from Equation 186 can be provided as follows (where i=0, 1, . . . , 7, and where λ and θ11[i] do not change over time (though change may be allowed)).









Math





197












F


[
i
]


=


1

2




(




e

j







θ
11



[
i
]







e

j






(



θ
11



[
i
]


+
λ

)








e

j


(



θ
11



[
i
]


+


i





π

4


)






e

j


(



θ
11



[
i
]


+


i





π

4

+
λ
+


7

π

8


)






)






Equation





187







Accordingly, the poor reception points for s1 and s2 become as in FIG. 34. Instead of Equations 186 and 187, precoding matrices may be provided as follows (where i=0, 1, . . . , 7, and where λ and θ11[i] do not change over time (though change may be allowed)).









Math





198












F


[
i
]


=


1

2




(




e

j





0





e

j





0







e

j


(

-


i





π

4


)






e

j


(


-


i





π

4


+


7

π

8


)






)






Equation





188





or










Math





199












F


[
i
]


=


1

2




(




e

j







θ
11



[
i
]







e

j






(



θ
11



[
i
]


+
λ

)








e

j


(



θ
11



[
i
]


-


i





π

4


)






e

j


(



θ
11



[
i
]


-


i





π

4

+
λ
+


7

π

8


)






)






Equation





189








(In Equations 186-189, 7π/8 may be changed to −7π/8.)


Next, in the precoding matrix of Equation 174, a precoding hopping scheme that differs from Example #7 and Example #8 by letting α≠1, and by taking into consideration the distance in the complex plane between poor reception points, is examined.


In this case, the precoding hopping scheme for an N-slot time period (cycle) of Equation 174 is used, and from Condition #14, in all of the Γ terminals, there is one slot or less having poor reception points for s1 among the N slots in a time period (cycle). Accordingly, the log-likelihood ratio for bits transmitted by s1(p) can be obtained for at least N−1 slots. Similarly, from Condition #15, in all of the Γ terminals, there is one slot or less having poor reception points for s2 among the N slots in a time period (cycle). Accordingly, the log-likelihood ratio for bits transmitted by s2(p) can be obtained for at least N−1 slots.


Therefore, it is clear that a larger value for N in the N-slot time period (cycle) increases the number of slots in which the log-likelihood ratio can be obtained.


Incidentally, since the influence of scattered wave components is also present in an actual channel model, it is considered that when the number of slots N in the time period (cycle) is fixed, there is a possibility of improved data reception quality if the minimum distance in the complex plane between poor reception points is as large as possible. Accordingly, in the context of Example #7 and Example #8, precoding hopping schemes in which α≠1 and which improve on Example #7 and Example #8 are considered. The precoding scheme that improves on Example #8 is easier to understand and is therefore described first.


Example #9

From Equation 186, the precoding matrices in an N=8 time period (cycle) precoding hopping scheme that improves on Example #8 are provided in the following equation.









Math





200












F


[
i
]


=


i



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j



i





π

4







e

j


(



i





π

4

+


7

π

8


)






)






Equation





190







Here, i=0, 1, . . . , 7. Furthermore, precoding matrices that differ from Equation 190 can be provided as follows (where i=0, 1, . . . , 7, and where λ and θ11[i] do not change over time (though change may be allowed)).









Math





201












F


[
i
]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j







θ
11



[
i
]







α
×

e

j


(



θ
11



[
i
]


+
λ

)









α
×

e

j


(



θ
11



[
i
]


+


i





π

4


)







e

j


(



θ
11



[
i
]


+


i





π

4

+
λ
+


7

π

8


)






)






Equation





191





or










Math





202












F


[
i
]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j


(

-


i





π

4


)







e

j


(


-


i





π

4


+


7

π

8


)






)






Equation





192





or










Math





203












F


[
i
]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j







θ
11



[
i
]







α
×

e

j






(



θ
11



[
i
]


+
λ

)









α
×

e

j


(



θ
11



[
i
]


-


i





π

4


)







e

j


(



θ
11



[
i
]


-


i





π

4

+
λ
+


7

π

8


)






)






Equation





193





or










Math





204












F


[
i
]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j


(


i





π

4

)







e

j


(



i





π

4

-


7

π

8


)






)






Equation





194





or










Math





205












F


[
i
]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j







θ
11



[
i
]







α
×

e

j






(



θ
11



[
i
]


+
λ

)









α
×

e

j


(



θ
11



[
i
]


+


i





π

4


)







e

j


(



θ
11



[
i
]


+


i





π

4

+
λ
-


7

π

8


)






)






Equation





195





or










Math





206












F


[
i
]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j


(

-


i





π

4


)







e

j


(


-


i





π

4


-


7

π

8


)






)






Equation





196





or










Math





207












F


[
i
]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j







θ
11



[
i
]







α
×

e

j






(



θ
11



[
i
]


+
λ

)









α
×

e

j


(



θ
11



[
i
]


-


i





π

4


)







e

j


(



θ
11



[
i
]


-


i





π

4

+
λ
-


7

π

8


)






)






Equation





197







Therefore, the poor reception points for s1 and s2 are represented as in FIG. 35A when α<1.0 and as in FIG. 35B when α>1.0.


(i) When α<1.0


When α<1.0, the minimum distance in the complex plane between poor reception points is represented as min{d#1,#2, d#1,#3} when focusing on the distance (d#1,#2) between poor reception points #1 and #2 and the distance (d#1,#3) between poor reception points #1 and #3. In this case, the relationship between α and d#1,#2 and between α and d#1,#3 is shown in FIG. 36. The α which makes min{d#1,#2, d#1,#3} the largest is as follows.









Math





208














α
=



1



cos


(

π
8

)


+


3



sin


(

π
8

)















0.7938







Equation





198







The min{d#1,#2, d#1,#3} in this case is as follows.









Math





209















min


{


d

#1
,
#2


,

d

#1
,
#3



}


=




2



A

sin



(

π
8

)






cos


(

π
8

)


+


3



sin


(

π
8

)
















0.6076

A








Equation





199







Therefore, the precoding scheme using the value of α in Equation 198 for Equations 190-197 is effective. Setting the value of α as in Equation 198 is one appropriate scheme for obtaining excellent data reception quality. Setting α to be a value near Equation 198, however, may similarly allow for excellent data reception quality. Accordingly, the value to which α is set is not limited to Equation 198.


(ii) When α>1.0


When α>1.0, the minimum distance in the complex plane between poor reception points is represented as min{d#4,#5, d#4,#6} when focusing on the distance (d#4,#5) between poor reception points #4 and #5 and the distance (d#4,#6) between poor reception points #4 and #6. In this case, the relationship between α and d#4,#5 and between α and d#4,#6 is shown in FIG. 37. The α which makes min{d#4,#5, d#4,#6} the largest is as follows.









Math





210














α
=





cos


(

π
8

)


+


3



sin


(

π
8

)














1.2596







Equation





200







The min{d#4,#5, d#4,#6} in this case is as follows.









Math





211















min


{


d

#4
,
#5


,

d

#4
,
#6



}


=




2



A

sin



(

π
8

)






cos


(

π
8

)


+


3



sin


(

π
8

)
















0.6076

A








Equation





201







Therefore, the precoding scheme using the value of α in Equation 200 for Equations 190-197 is effective. Setting the value of α as in Equation 200 is one appropriate scheme for obtaining excellent data reception quality. Setting α to be a value near Equation 200, however, may similarly allow for excellent data reception quality. Accordingly, the value to which α is set is not limited to Equation 200.


Example #10

Based on consideration of Example #9, the precoding matrices in an N=16 time period (cycle) precoding hopping scheme that improves on Example #7 are provided in the following equations (where λ and θ11[i] do not change over time (though change may be allowed)).


For i=0, 1, . . . , 7:









Math





212












F


[
i
]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j



i





π

4







e

j


(



i





π

4

+


7

π

8


)






)






Equation





202








For i=8, 9, . . . , 15:









Math





213












F


[
i
]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




a
×

e

j



i





π

4







e

(



i





π

4

+


7

π

8


)







e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0






)






Equation





203







or


For i=0, 1, . . . , 7:









Math





214












F


[
i
]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j







θ
11



[
i
]







α
×

e

j


(



θ
11



[
i
]


+
λ

)









α
×

e

j


(



θ
11



[
i
]


+


i





π

4


)







e

j


(



θ
11



[
i
]


+


i





π

4

+
λ
+


7

π

8


)






)






Equation





204








For i=8, 9, . . . , 15:









Math





215












F


[
i
]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




a
×

e

j


(



θ
11



[
i
]


+


i





π

4


)







e

j


(



θ
11



[
i
]


+


i





π

4

+


7

π

8


)








e

j







θ
11



[
i
]







α
×

e

j


(



θ
11



[
i
]


+
λ

)







)






Equation





205







or


For i=0, 1, . . . , 7:









Math





216












F


[
i
]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j


(

-


i





π

4


)







e

j


(


-


i





π

4


+


7

π

8


)






)






Equation





206








For i=8, 9, . . . , 15:









Math





217












F


[
i
]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




α
×

e

j


(

-


i





π

4


)







e

j


(


-


i





π

4


+


7

π

8


)








e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0






)






Equation





207







or


For i=0, 1, . . . , 7:









Math





218












F


[
i
]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j







θ
11



[
i
]







α
×

e

j


(



θ
11



[
i
]


+
λ

)









α
×

e

j


(



θ
11



[
i
]


-


i





π

4


)







e

j


(



θ
11



[
i
]


-


i





π

4

+
λ
+


7

π

8


)






)






Equation





208








For i=8, 9, . . . , 15:









Math





219












F


[
i
]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




a
×

e

j


(



θ
11



[
i
]


-


i





π

4


)







e

j


(



θ
11



[
i
]


-


i





π

4

+
λ
+


7

π

8


)








e

j







θ
11



[
i
]







α
×

e

j


(



θ
11



[
i
]


+
λ

)







)






Equation





209







or


For i=0, 1, . . . , 7:









Math





220












F


[
i
]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j



i





π

4







e

j


(



i





π

4

-


7

π

8


)






)






Equation





210








For i=8, 9, . . . , 15:









Math





221












F


[
i
]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




α
×

e

j



i





π

4







e

j


(



i





π

4

-


7

π

8


)








e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0






)






Equation





211







or


For i=0, 1, . . . , 7:









Math





222












F


[
i
]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j







θ
11



[
i
]







α
×

e

j


(



θ
11



[
i
]


+
λ

)









α
×

e

j


(



θ
11



[
i
]


+


i





π

4


)







e

j


(



θ
11



[
i
]


-


i





π

4

+
λ
+


7

π

8


)






)






Equation





212








For i=8, 9, . . . , 15:









Math





223












F


[
i
]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




a
×

e

j


(



θ
11



[
i
]


+


i





π

4


)







e

j


(



θ
11



[
i
]


+


i





π

4

+
λ
-


7

π

8


)








e

j







θ
11



[
i
]







α
×

e

j


(



θ
11



[
i
]


+
λ

)







)






Equation





213







or


For i=0, 1, . . . , 7:









Math





224












F


[
i
]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j


(

-


i





π

4


)







e

j


(


-


i





π

4


-


7

π

8


)






)






Equation





214








For i=8, 9, . . . , 15:









Math





225












F


[
i
]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




α
×

e

j


(

-


i





π

4


)







e

j


(


-


i





π

4


-


7

π

8


)








e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0






)






Equation





215







or


For i=0, 1, . . . , 7:









Math





226












F


[
i
]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j







θ
11



[
i
]







α
×

e

j


(



θ
11



[
i
]


+
λ

)









α
×

e

j


(



θ
11



[
i
]


-


i





π

4


)







e

j


(



θ
11



[
i
]


-


i





π

4

+
λ
-


7

π

8


)






)






Equation





216








For i=8, 9, . . . , 15:









Math





227












F


[
i
]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




a
×

e

j


(



θ
11



[
i
]


-


i





π

4


)







e

j


(



θ
11



[
i
]


-


i





π

4

+
λ
-


7

π

8


)








e

j







θ
11



[
i
]







α
×

e

j


(



θ
11



[
i
]


+
λ

)







)






Equation





217







The value of α in Equation 198 and in Equation 200 is appropriate for obtaining excellent data reception quality. The poor reception points for s1 are represented as in FIGS. 38A and 38B when α<1.0 and as in FIGS. 39A and 39B when α>1.0.


In the present embodiment, the scheme of structuring N different precoding matrices for a precoding hopping scheme with an N-slot time period (cycle) has been described. In this case, as the N different precoding matrices, F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[N−2], F[N−1] are prepared. In the present embodiment, an example of a single carrier transmission scheme has been described, and therefore the case of arranging symbols in the order F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[N−2], F[N−1] in the time domain (or the frequency domain) has been described. The present invention is not, however, limited in this way, and the N different precoding matrices F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[N−2], F[N−1] generated in the present embodiment may be adapted to a multi-carrier transmission scheme such as an OFDM transmission scheme or the like. As in Embodiment 1, as a scheme of adaption in this case, precoding weights may be changed by arranging symbols in the frequency domain and in the frequency-time domain. Note that a precoding hopping scheme with an N-slot time period (cycle) has been described, but the same advantageous effects may be obtained by randomly using N different precoding matrices. In other words, the N different precoding matrices do not necessarily need to be used in a regular period (cycle).


Examples #5 through #10 have been shown based on Conditions #10 through #16. However, in order to achieve a precoding matrix hopping scheme with a longer period (cycle), the period (cycle) for hopping between precoding matrices may be lengthened by, for example, selecting a plurality of examples from Examples #5 through #10 and using the precoding matrices indicated in the selected examples. For example, a precoding matrix hopping scheme with a longer period (cycle) may be achieved by using the precoding matrices indicated in Example #7 and the precoding matrices indicated in Example #10. In this case, Conditions #10 through #16 are not necessarily observed. (In Equation 158 of Condition #10, Equation 159 of Condition #11, Equation 164 of Condition #13, Equation 175 of Condition #14, and Equation 176 of Condition #15, it becomes important for providing excellent reception quality for the conditions “all x and all y” to be “existing x and existing y”.) When viewed from a different perspective, in the precoding matrix hopping scheme over an N-slot period (cycle) (where N is a large natural number), the probability of providing excellent reception quality increases when the precoding matrices of one of Examples #5 through #10 are included.


Embodiment 7

The present embodiment describes the structure of a reception device for receiving modulated signals transmitted by a transmission scheme that regularly hops between precoding matrices as described in Embodiments 1-6.


In Embodiment 1, the following scheme has been described. A transmission device that transmits modulated signals, using a transmission scheme that regularly hops between precoding matrices, transmits information regarding the precoding matrices. Based on this information, a reception device obtains information on the regular precoding matrix hopping used in the transmitted frames, decodes the precoding, performs detection, obtains the log-likelihood ratio for the transmitted bits, and subsequently performs error correction decoding.


The present embodiment describes the structure of a reception device, and a scheme of hopping between precoding matrices, that differ from the above structure and scheme.



FIG. 40 is an example of the structure of a transmission device in the present embodiment. Elements that operate in a similar way to FIG. 3 bear the same reference signs. An encoder group (4002) receives transmission bits (4001) as input. The encoder group (4002), as described in Embodiment 1, includes a plurality of encoders for error correction coding, and based on the frame structure signal 313, a certain number of encoders operate, such as one encoder, two encoders, or four encoders.


When one encoder operates, the transmission bits (4001) are encoded to yield encoded transmission bits. The encoded transmission bits are allocated into two parts, and the encoder group (4002) outputs allocated bits (4003A) and allocated bits (4003B).


When two encoders operate, the transmission bits (4001) are divided in two (referred to as divided bits A and B). The first encoder receives the divided bits A as input, encodes the divided bits A, and outputs the encoded bits as allocated bits (4003A). The second encoder receives the divided bits B as input, encodes the divided bits B, and outputs the encoded bits as allocated bits (4003B).


When four encoders operate, the transmission bits (4001) are divided in four (referred to as divided bits A, B, C, and D). The first encoder receives the divided bits A as input, encodes the divided bits A, and outputs the encoded bits A. The second encoder receives the divided bits B as input, encodes the divided bits B, and outputs the encoded bits B. The third encoder receives the divided bits C as input, encodes the divided bits C, and outputs the encoded bits C. The fourth encoder receives the divided bits D as input, encodes the divided bits D, and outputs the encoded bits D. The encoded bits A, B, C, and D are divided into allocated bits (4003A) and allocated bits (4003B).


The transmission device supports a transmission scheme such as, for example, the following Table 1 (Table 1A and Table 1B).














TABLE 1A





Number of







modulated







transmission







signals


Error

Precoding


(number of
Modu-
Number
correction

matrix


transmit
lation
of en-
coding
Transmission
hopping


antennas)
scheme
coders
scheme
information
scheme







1
QPSK
1
A
00000000






B
00000001






C
00000010




16QAM
1
A
00000011






B
00000100






C
00000101




64QAM
1
A
00000110






B
00000111






C
00001000




256QAM
1
A
00001001






B
00001010






C
00001011




1024QAM
1
A
00001100






B
00001101






C
00001110






















TABLE 1B





Number of







modulated







transmission


Error

Pre-


signals


correc-

coding


(number of

Number
tion

matrix


transmit
Modulation
of en-
coding
Transmission
hopping


antennas)
scheme
coders
scheme
information
scheme







2
#1: QPSK,
1
A
00001111
D



#2: QPSK

B
00010000
D





C
00010001
D




2
A
00010010
E





B
00010011
E





C
00010100
E



#1: QPSK,
1
A
00010101
D



#2: 16QAM

B
00010110
D





C
00010111
D




2
A
00011000
E





B
00011001
E





C
00011010
E



#1: 16QAM,
1
A
00011011
D



#2: 16QAM

B
00011100
D





C
00011101
D




2
A
00011110
E





B
00011111
E





C
00100000
E



#1: 16QAM,
1
A
00100001
D



#2: 64QAM

B
00100010
D





C
00100011
D




2
A
00100100
E





B
00100101
E





C
00100110
E



#1: 64QAM,
1
A
00100111
F



#2: 64QAM

B
00101000
F





C
00101001
F




2
A
00101010
G





B
00101011
G





C
00101100
G



#1: 64QAM,
1
A
00101101
F



#2: 256QAM

B
00101110
F





C
00101111
F




2
A
00110000
G





B
00110001
G





C
00110010
G



#1: 256QAM,
1
A
00110011
F



#2: 256QAM

B
00110100
F





C
00110101
F




2
A
00110110
G





B
00110111
G





C
00111000
G




4
A
00111001
H





B
00111010
H





C
00111011
H



#1: 256QAM,
1
A
00111100
F



#2: 1024QAM

B
00111101
F





C
00111110
F




2
A
00111111
G





B
01000000
G





C
01000001
G




4
A
01000010
H





B
01000011
H





C
01000100
H



#1: 1024QAM,
1
A
01000101
F



#2: 1024QAM

B
01000110
F





C
01000111
F




2
A
01001000
G





B
01001001
G





C
01001010
G




4
A
01001011
H





B
01001100
H





C
01001101
H









As shown in Table 1, transmission of a one-stream signal and transmission of a two-stream signal are supported as the number of transmission signals (number of transmit antennas). Furthermore, QPSK, 16QAM, 64QAM, 256QAM, and 1024QAM are supported as the modulation scheme. In particular, when the number of transmission signals is two, it is possible to set separate modulation schemes for stream #1 and stream #2. For example, “#1: 256QAM, #2: 1024QAM” in Table 1 indicates that “the modulation scheme of stream #1 is 256QAM, and the modulation scheme of stream #2 is 1024QAM” (other entries in the table are similarly expressed). Three types of error correction coding schemes, A, B, and C, are supported. In this case, A, B, and C may all be different coding schemes. A, B, and C may also be different coding rates, and A, B, and C may be coding schemes with different block sizes.


The pieces of transmission information in Table 1 are allocated to modes that define a “number of transmission signals”, “modulation scheme”, “number of encoders”, and “error correction coding scheme”. Accordingly, in the case of “number of transmission signals: 2”, “modulation scheme: #1: 1024QAM, #2: 1024QAM”, “number of encoders: 4”, and “error correction coding scheme: C”, for example, the transmission information is set to 01001101. In the frame, the transmission device transmits the transmission information and the transmission data. When transmitting the transmission data, in particular when the “number of transmission signals” is two, a “precoding matrix hopping scheme” is used in accordance with Table 1. In Table 1, five types of the “precoding matrix hopping scheme”, D, E, F, G, and H, are prepared. The precoding matrix hopping scheme is set to one of these five types in accordance with Table 1. The following, for example, are ways of implementing the five different types.


Prepare Five Different Precoding Matrices.


Use five different types of period (cycle)s, for example a four-slot period (cycle) for D, an eight-slot period (cycle) for E, Use both different precoding matrices and different period (cycle)s.



FIG. 41 shows an example of a frame structure of a modulated signal transmitted by the transmission device in FIG. 40. The transmission device is assumed to support settings for both a mode to transmit two modulated signals, z1(t) and z2(t), and for a mode to transmit one modulated signal.


In FIG. 41, the symbol (4100) is a symbol for transmitting the “transmission information” shown in Table 1. The symbols (4101_1) and (4101_2) are reference (pilot) symbols for channel estimation. The symbols (4102_1, 4103_1) are data transmission symbols for transmitting the modulated signal z1(t). The symbols (4102_2, 4103_2) are data transmission symbols for transmitting the modulated signal z2(t). The symbol (4102_1) and the symbol (4102_2) are transmitted at the same time along the same (shared/common) frequency, and the symbol (4103_1) and the symbol (4103_2) are transmitted at the same time along the same (shared/common) frequency. The symbols (4102_1, 4103_1) and the symbols (4102_2, 4103_2) are the symbols after precoding matrix calculation using the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices described in Embodiments 1-4 and Embodiment 6 (therefore, as described in Embodiment 1, the structure of the streams s1(t) and s2(t) is as in FIG. 6).


Furthermore, in FIG. 41, the symbol (4104) is a symbol for transmitting the “transmission information” shown in Table 1. The symbol (4105) is a reference (pilot) symbol for channel estimation. The symbols (4106, 4107) are data transmission symbols for transmitting the modulated signal z1(t). The data transmission symbols for transmitting the modulated signal z1(t) are not precoded, since the number of transmission signals is one.


Accordingly, the transmission device in FIG. 40 generates and transmits modulated signals in accordance with Table 1 and the frame structure in FIG. 41. In FIG. 40, the frame structure signal 313 includes information regarding the “number of transmission signals”, “modulation scheme”, “number of encoders”, and “error correction coding scheme” set based on Table 1. The encoder (4002), the mapping units 306A, B, and the weighting units 308A, B receive the frame structure signal as an input and operate based on the “number of transmission signals”, “modulation scheme”, “number of encoders”, and “error correction coding scheme” that are set based on Table 1. “Transmission information” corresponding to the set “number of transmission signals”, “modulation scheme”, “number of encoders”, and “error correction coding scheme” is also transmitted to the reception device.


The structure of the reception device may be represented similarly to FIG. 7 of Embodiment 1. The difference with Embodiment 1 is as follows: since the transmission device and the reception device store the information in Table 1 in advance, the transmission device does not need to transmit information for regularly hopping between precoding matrices, but rather transmits “transmission information” corresponding to the “number of transmission signals”, “modulation scheme”, “number of encoders”, and “error correction coding scheme”, and the reception device obtains information for regularly hopping between precoding matrices from Table 1 by receiving the “transmission information”. Accordingly, by the control information decoding unit 709 obtaining the “transmission information” transmitted by the transmission device in FIG. 40, the reception device in FIG. 7 obtains, from the information corresponding to Table 1, a signal 710 regarding information on the transmission scheme, as notified by the transmission device, which includes information for regularly hopping between precoding matrices. Therefore, when the number of transmission signals is two, the signal processing unit 711 can perform detection based on a precoding matrix hopping pattern to obtain received log-likelihood ratios.


Note that in the above description, “transmission information” is set with respect to the “number of transmission signals”, “modulation scheme”, “number of encoders”, and “error correction coding scheme” as in Table 1, and the precoding matrix hopping scheme is set with respect to the “transmission information”. However, it is not necessary to set the “transmission information” with respect to the “number of transmission signals”, “modulation scheme”, “number of encoders”, and “error correction coding scheme”. For example, as in Table 2, the “transmission information” may be set with respect to the “number of transmission signals” and “modulation scheme”, and the precoding matrix hopping scheme may be set with respect to the “transmission information”.












TABLE 2





Number of





modulated


Precoding


transmission signals


matrix


(number of transmit
Modulation
Transmission
hopping


antennas)
scheme
information
scheme







1
QPSK
00000




16QAM
00001




64QAM
00010




256QAM
00011




1024QAM
00100



2
#1: QPSK,
10000
D



#2: QPSK





#1: QPSK,
10001
E



#2: 16QAM





#1: 16QAM,
10010
E



#2: 16QAM





#1: 16QAM,
10011
E



#2: 64QAM





#1: 64QAM,
10100
F



#2: 64QAM





#1: 64QAM,
10101
F



#2: 256QAM





#1: 256QAM,
10110
G



#2: 256QAM





#1: 256QAM,
10111
G



#2: 1024QAM





#1: 1024QAM,
11000
H



#2: 1024QAM









In this context, the “transmission information” and the scheme of setting the precoding matrix hopping scheme is not limited to Tables 1 and 2. As long as a rule is determined in advance for hopping the precoding matrix hopping scheme based on transmission parameters, such as the “number of transmission signals”, “modulation scheme”, “number of encoders”, “error correction coding scheme”, or the like (as long as the transmission device and the reception device share a predetermined rule, or in other words, if the precoding matrix hopping scheme is hopped based on any of the transmission parameters (or on any plurality of transmission parameters)), the transmission device does not need to transmit information regarding the precoding matrix hopping scheme. The reception device can identify the precoding matrix hopping scheme used by the transmission device by identifying the information on the transmission parameters and can therefore accurately perform decoding and detection. Note that in Tables 1 and 2, a transmission scheme that regularly hops between precoding matrices is used when the number of modulated transmission signals is two, but a transmission scheme that regularly hops between precoding matrices may be used when the number of modulated transmission signals is two or greater.


Accordingly, if the transmission device and reception device share a table regarding transmission patterns that includes information on precoding hopping schemes, the transmission device need not transmit information regarding the precoding hopping scheme, transmitting instead control information that does not include information regarding the precoding hopping scheme, and the reception device can infer the precoding hopping scheme by acquiring this control information.


As described above, in the present embodiment, the transmission device does not transmit information directly related to the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices. Rather, a scheme has been described wherein the reception device infers information regarding precoding for the “scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices” used by the transmission device. This scheme yields the advantageous effect of improved transmission efficiency of data as a result of the transmission device not transmitting information directly related to the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices.


Note that the present embodiment has been described as changing precoding weights in the time domain, but as described in Embodiment 1, the present invention may be similarly embodied when using a multi-carrier transmission scheme such as OFDM or the like.


In particular, when the precoding hopping scheme only changes depending on the number of transmission signals, the reception device can learn the precoding hopping scheme by acquiring information, transmitted by the transmission device, on the number of transmission signals.


In the present description, it is considered that a communications/broadcasting device such as a broadcast station, a base station, an access point, a terminal, a mobile phone, or the like is provided with the transmission device, and that a communications device such as a television, radio, terminal, personal computer, mobile phone, access point, base station, or the like is provided with the reception device. Additionally, it is considered that the transmission device and the reception device in the present description have a communications function and are capable of being connected via some sort of interface to a device for executing applications for a television, radio, personal computer, mobile phone, or the like.


Furthermore, in the present embodiment, symbols other than data symbols, such as pilot symbols (preamble, unique word, postamble, reference symbol, and the like), symbols for control information, and the like may be arranged in the frame in any way. While the terms “pilot symbol” and “symbols for control information” have been used here, any term may be used, since the function itself is what is important.


It suffices for a pilot symbol, for example, to be a known symbol modulated with PSK modulation in the transmission and reception devices (or for the reception device to be able to synchronize in order to know the symbol transmitted by the transmission device). The reception device uses this symbol for frequency synchronization, time synchronization, channel estimation (estimation of Channel State Information (CSI) for each modulated signal), detection of signals, and the like.


A symbol for control information is for transmitting information other than data (of applications or the like) that needs to be transmitted to the communication partner for achieving communication (for example, the modulation scheme, error correction coding scheme, coding rate of the error correction coding scheme, setting information in the upper layer, and the like).


Note that the present invention is not limited to the above Embodiments 1-5 and may be embodied with a variety of modifications. For example, the above embodiments describe communications devices, but the present invention is not limited to these devices and may be implemented as software for the corresponding communications scheme.


Furthermore, a precoding hopping scheme used in a scheme of transmitting two modulated signals from two antennas has been described, but the present invention is not limited in this way. The present invention may be also embodied as a precoding hopping scheme for similarly changing precoding weights (matrices) in the context of a scheme whereby four mapped signals are precoded to generate four modulated signals that are transmitted from four antennas, or more generally, whereby N mapped signals are precoded to generate N modulated signals that are transmitted from N antennas.


In the description, terms such as “precoding” and “precoding weight” are used, but any other terms may be used. What matters in the present invention is the actual signal processing.


Different data may be transmitted in streams s1(t) and s2(t), or the same data may be transmitted.


Each of the transmit antennas of the transmission device and the receive antennas of the reception device shown in the figures may be formed by a plurality of antennas.


Programs for executing the above transmission scheme may, for example, be stored in advance in Read Only Memory (ROM) and be caused to operate by a Central Processing Unit (CPU).


Furthermore, the programs for executing the above transmission scheme may be stored in a computer-readable recording medium, the programs stored in the recording medium may be loaded in the Random Access Memory (RAM) of the computer, and the computer may be caused to operate in accordance with the programs.


The components in the above embodiments may be typically assembled as a Large Scale Integration (LSI), a type of integrated circuit. Individual components may respectively be made into discrete chips, or part or all of the components in each embodiment may be made into one chip. While an LSI has been referred to, the terms Integrated Circuit (IC), system LSI, super LSI, or ultra LSI may be used depending on the degree of integration. Furthermore, the scheme for assembling integrated circuits is not limited to LSI, and a dedicated circuit or a general-purpose processor may be used. A Field Programmable Gate Array (FPGA), which is programmable after the LSI is manufactured, or a reconfigurable processor, which allows reconfiguration of the connections and settings of circuit cells inside the LSI, may be used.


Furthermore, if technology for forming integrated circuits that replaces LSIs emerges, owing to advances in semiconductor technology or to another derivative technology, the integration of functional blocks may naturally be accomplished using such technology. The application of biotechnology or the like is possible.


Embodiment 8

The present embodiment describes an application of the scheme described in Embodiments 1-4 and Embodiment 6 for regularly hopping between precoding weights.



FIG. 6 relates to the weighting scheme (precoding scheme) in the present embodiment. The weighting unit 600 integrates the weighting units 308A and 308B in FIG. 3. As shown in FIG. 6, the stream s1(t) and the stream s2(t) correspond to the baseband signals 307A and 307B in FIG. 3. In other words, the streams s1(t) and s2(t) are the baseband signal in-phase components I and quadrature components Q when mapped according to a modulation scheme such as QPSK, 16QAM, 64QAM, or the like. As indicated by the frame structure of FIG. 6, the stream s1(t) is represented as s1(u) at symbol number u, as s1(u+1) at symbol number u+1, and so forth. Similarly, the stream s2(t) is represented as s2(u) at symbol number u, as s2(u+1) at symbol number u+1, and so forth. The weighting unit 600 receives the baseband signals 307A (s1(t)) and 307B (s2(t)) and the information 315 regarding weighting information in FIG. 3 as inputs, performs weighting in accordance with the information 315 regarding weighting, and outputs the signals 309A (z1(t)) and 309B (z2(t)) after weighting in FIG. 3.


At this point, when for example a precoding matrix hopping scheme with an N=8 period (cycle) as in Example #8 in Embodiment 6 is used, z1(t) and z2(t) are represented as follows.


For symbol number 8i (where i is an integer greater than or equal to zero):









Math





228












(




z





1


(

8

i

)







z





2


(

8

i

)





)

=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j







i





π

4







e

j


(



k





π

4

+


7

π

8


)






)



(




s





1


(

8

i

)







s





2


(

8

i

)





)






Equation





218







Here, j is an imaginary unit, and k=0.


For symbol number 8i+1:














Math





229













(




z





1


(


8

i

+
1

)







z





2


(


8

i

+
1

)





)

=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j







i





π

4







e

j


(



k





π

4

+


7

π

8


)






)



(




s





1


(


8

i

+
1

)







s





2


(


8

i

+
1

)





)






Equation





219







Here, k=1.


For symbol number 8i+2:














Math





230













(




z





1


(


8

i

+
2

)







z





2


(


8

i

+
2

)





)

=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j







i





π

4







e

j


(



k





π

4

+


7

π

8


)






)



(




s





1


(


8

i

+
2

)







s





2


(


8

i

+
2

)





)






Equation





220







Here, k=2.


For symbol number 8i+3:














Math





231













(




z





1


(


8

i

+
3

)







z





2


(


8

i

+
3

)





)

=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j







i





π

4







e

j


(



k





π

4

+


7

π

8


)






)



(




s





1


(


8

i

+
3

)







s





2


(


8

i

+
3

)





)






Equation





221







Here, k=3.


For symbol number 8i+4:














Math





232













(




z





1


(


8

i

+
4

)







z





2


(


8

i

+
4

)





)

=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j







i





π

4







e

j


(



k





π

4

+


7

π

8


)






)



(




s





1


(


8

i

+
4

)







s





2


(


8

i

+
4

)





)






Equation





222







Here, k=4.


For symbol number 8i+5:














Math





233













(




z





1


(


8

i

+
5

)







z





2


(


8

i

+
5

)





)

=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j







i





π

4







e

j


(



k





π

4

+


7

π

8


)






)



(




s





1


(


8

i

+
5

)







s





2


(


8

i

+
5

)





)






Equation





223







Here, k=5.


For symbol number 8i+6:














Math





234













(




z





1


(


8

i

+
6

)







z





2


(


8

i

+
6

)





)

=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j







i





π

4







e

j


(



k





π

4

+


7

π

8


)






)



(




s





1


(


8

i

+
6

)







s





2


(


8

i

+
6

)





)






Equation





224







Here, k=6.


For symbol number 8i+7:














Math





235













(




z





1


(


8

i

+
7

)







z





2


(


8

i

+
7

)





)

=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j







i





π

4







e

j


(



k





π

4

+


7

π

8


)






)



(




s





1


(


8

i

+
7

)







s





2


(


8

i

+
7

)





)






Equation





225







Here, k=7.


The symbol numbers shown here can be considered to indicate time. As described in other embodiments, in Equation 225, for example, z1(8i+7) and z2(8i+7) at time 8i+7 are signals at the same time, and the transmission device transmits z1(8i+7) and z2(8i+7) over the same (shared/common) frequency. In other words, letting the signals at time T be s1(T), s2(T), z1(T), and z2(T), then z1(T) and z2(T) are sought from some sort of precoding matrices and from s1(T) and s2(T), and the transmission device transmits z1(T) and z2(T) over the same (shared/common) frequency (at the same time). Furthermore, in the case of using a multi-carrier transmission scheme such as OFDM or the like, and letting signals corresponding to s1, s2, z1, and z2 for (sub)carrier L and time T be s1(T, L), s2(T, L), z1(T, L), and z2(T, L), then z1(T, L) and z2(T, L) are sought from some sort of precoding matrices and from s1(T, L) and s2(T, L), and the transmission device transmits z1(T, L) and z2(T, L) over the same (shared/common) frequency (at the same time).


In this case, the appropriate value of α is given by Equation 198 or Equation 200.


The present embodiment describes a precoding hopping scheme that increases period (cycle) size, based on the above-described precoding matrices of Equation 190.


Letting the period (cycle) of the precoding hopping scheme be 8M, 8M different precoding matrices are represented as follows.














Math





236













F


[


8
×
k

+
i

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j


(



i





π

4

+


k





π


4

M



)







e

j


(



i





π

4

+


k





π


4

M


+


7

π

8


)






)






Equation





226







In this case, i=0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, and k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1.


For example, letting M=2 and α<1, the poor reception points for s1 (◯) and for s2 (□) at k=0 are represented as in FIG. 42A. Similarly, the poor reception points for s1 (◯) and for s2 (□) at k=1 are represented as in FIG. 42B. In this way, based on the precoding matrices in Equation 190, the poor reception points are as in FIG. 42A, and by using, as the precoding matrices, the matrices yielded by multiplying each term in the second line on the right-hand side of Equation 190 by ejX (see Equation 226), the poor reception points are rotated with respect to FIG. 42A (see FIG. 42B). (Note that the poor reception points in FIG. 42A and FIG. 42B do not overlap. Even when multiplying by ejX, the poor reception points should not overlap, as in this case. Furthermore, the matrices yielded by multiplying each term in the first line on the right-hand side of Equation 190, rather than in the second line on the right-hand side of Equation 190, by ejX may be used as the precoding matrices.) In this case, the precoding matrices F[0]-F[15] are represented as follows.














Math





237













F


[


8
×
k

+
i

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j


(



i





π

4

+
Xk

)







e

j


(



i





π

4

+
Xk
+


7

π

8


)






)






Equation





227







Here, i=0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, and k=0, 1.


In this case, when M=2, precoding matrices F[0]-F[15] are generated (the precoding matrices F[0]-F[15] may be in any order, and the matrices F[0]-F[15] may each be different). Symbol number 16i may be precoded using F[0], symbol number 16i+1 may be precoded using F[1], . . . , and symbol number 16i+h may be precoded using F[h], for example (h=0, 1, 2, . . . , 14, 15). (In this case, as described in previous embodiments, precoding matrices need not be hopped between regularly.)


Summarizing the above considerations, with reference to Equations 82-85, N-period (cycle) precoding matrices are represented by the following equation.









Math





238












F


[
i
]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j







θ
11



(
i
)







α
×

e

j


(



θ
11



(
i
)


+
λ

)









α
×

e

j







θ
21



(
i
)








e

j


(



θ
21



(
i
)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)






Equation





228







Here, since the period (cycle) has N slots, i=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1. Furthermore, the N×M period (cycle) precoding matrices based on Equation 228 are represented by the following equation.














Math





239













F


[


N
×
k

+
i

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j







θ
11



(
i
)







α
×

e

j


(



θ
11



(
i
)


+
λ

)









α
×

e

j






(



θ
21



(
i
)


+

X
k


)







e

j


(



θ
21



(
i
)


+

X
k

+
λ
+
δ

)






)






Equation





229







In this case, i=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1, and k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1.


Precoding matrices F[0]-F[N×M−1] are thus generated (the precoding matrices F[0]-F[N×M−1] may be in any order for the N×M slots in the period (cycle)). Symbol number N×M×i may be precoded using F[0], symbol number N×M×i+1 may be precoded using F[1], . . . , and symbol number N×M×i+h may be precoded using F[h], for example (h=0, 1, 2, . . . , N×M−2, N×M−1). (In this case, as described in previous embodiments, precoding matrices need not be hopped between regularly.)


Generating the precoding matrices in this way achieves a precoding matrix hopping scheme with a large period (cycle), allowing for the position of poor reception points to be easily changed, which may lead to improved data reception quality. Note that while the N×M period (cycle) precoding matrices have been set to Equation 229, the N×M period (cycle) precoding matrices may be set to the following equation, as described above.














Math





240













F


[


N
×
k

+
i

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j






(



θ
11



(
i
)


+

X
k


)






α
×

e

j


(



θ
11



(
i
)


+

X
k

+
λ

)









α
×

e

j







θ
21



(
i
)








e

j


(



θ
21



(
i
)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)






Equation





230







In this case, i=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1, and k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1.


In Equations 229 and 230, when 0 radians ≤δ<2π radians, the matrices are a unitary matrix when δ=π radians and are a non-unitary matrix when δ ≠π radians. In the present scheme, use of a non-unitary matrix for π/2 radians ≤|δ|<π radians is one characteristic structure (the conditions for δ being similar to other embodiments), and excellent data reception quality is obtained. Use of a unitary matrix is another structure, and as described in detail in Embodiment 10 and Embodiment 16, if N is an odd number in Equations 229 and 230, the probability of obtaining excellent data reception quality increases.


Embodiment 9

The present embodiment describes a scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices using a unitary matrix.


As described in Embodiment 8, in the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices over a period (cycle) with N slots, the precoding matrices prepared for the N slots with reference to Equations 82-85 are represented as follows.









Math





241












F


[
i
]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j







θ
11



(
i
)







α
×

e

j


(



θ
11



(
i
)


+
λ

)









α
×

e

j







θ
21



(
i
)








e

j


(



θ
21



(
i
)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)






Equation





231







In this case, i=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1. (Let α>0) Since a unitary matrix is used in the present embodiment, the precoding matrices in Equation 231 may be represented as follows.









Math





242












F


[
i
]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j







θ
11



(
i
)







α
×

e

j


(



θ
11



(
i
)


+
λ

)









α
×

e

j







θ
21



(
i
)








e

j


(



θ
21



(
i
)


+
λ
+
π

)






)






Equation





232







In this case, i=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1. (Let α>0.) From Condition #5 (Math 106) and Condition #6 (Math 107) in Embodiment 3, the following condition is important for achieving excellent data reception quality.

Math 243
ej(θ11(x)-θ21(x))≠ej(θ11(y)-θ21(y)) for ∀x,∀y (x≠y; x, y=0,1,2, . . . , N−2, N−1)  Condition #17


(x is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; y is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; and x≠y)

Math 244
ej(θ11(x)-θ21(x)-π)≠ej(θ11(y)-θ21(y)-π) for ∀x,∀y (x≠y; x, y=0,1,2, . . . , N−2, N−1)  Condition #18


(x is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; y is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; and x≠y)


Embodiment 6 describes the distance between poor reception points. In order to increase the distance between poor reception points, it is important for the number of slots N to be an odd number three or greater. The following explains this point.


In order to distribute the poor reception points evenly with regards to phase in the complex plane, as described in Embodiment 6, Condition #19 and Condition #20 are provided.









Math





245














e

j


(



θ
11



(

x
+
1

)


-


θ
21



(

x
+
1

)



)




e

j


(



θ
11



(
x
)


-


θ
21



(
x
)



)




=

e

j


(


2

π

N

)










for








x


(


x
=
0

,
1
,
2
,





,

N
-
2


)








Condition





#19






Math





246














e

j


(



θ
11



(

x
+
1

)


-


θ
21



(

x
+
1

)



)




e

j


(



θ
11



(
x
)


-


θ
21



(
x
)



)




=

e

j


(

-


2

π

N


)










for








x


(


x
=
0

,
1
,
2
,





,

N
-
2


)








Condition





#20







In other words, Condition #19 means that the difference in phase is 2π/N radians. On the other hand, Condition #20 means that the difference in phase is −2π/N radians.


Letting θ11(0)-θ21(0)=0 radians, and letting α<1, the distribution of poor reception points for s1 and for s2 in the complex plane for an N=3 period (cycle) is shown in FIG. 43A, and the distribution of poor reception points for s1 and for s2 in the complex plane for an N=4 period (cycle) is shown in FIG. 43B. Letting θ11(0)-θ21(0)=0 radians, and letting α>1, the distribution of poor reception points for s1 and for s2 in the complex plane for an N=3 period (cycle) is shown in FIG. 44A, and the distribution of poor reception points for s1 and for s2 in the complex plane for an N=4 period (cycle) is shown in FIG. 44B.


In this case, when considering the phase between a line segment from the origin to a poor reception point and a half line along the real axis defined by real ≥0 (see FIG. 43A), then for either α>1 or α<1, when N=4, the case always occurs wherein the phase for the poor reception points for s1 and the phase for the poor reception points for s2 are the same value. (See 4301, 4302 in FIG. 43B, and 4401, 4402 in FIG. 44B.) In this case, in the complex plane, the distance between poor reception points becomes small. On the other hand, when N=3, the phase for the poor reception points for s1 and the phase for the poor reception points for s2 are never the same value.


Based on the above, considering how the case always occurs wherein the phase for the poor reception points for s1 and the phase for the poor reception points for s2 are the same value when the number of slots N in the period (cycle) is an even number, setting the number of slots N in the period (cycle) to an odd number increases the probability of a greater distance between poor reception points in the complex plane as compared to when the number of slots N in the period (cycle) is an even number. However, when the number of slots N in the period (cycle) is small, for example when N≤16, the minimum distance between poor reception points in the complex plane can be guaranteed to be a certain length, since the number of poor reception points is small. Accordingly, when N≤16, even if N is an even number, cases do exist where data reception quality can be guaranteed.


Therefore, in the scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices based on Equation 232, when the number of slots N in the period (cycle) is set to an odd number, the probability of improving data reception quality is high. Precoding matrices F[0]-F[N−1] are generated based on Equation 232 (the precoding matrices F[0]-F[N−1] may be in any order for the N slots in the period (cycle)). Symbol number Ni may be precoded using F[0], symbol number Ni+1 may be precoded using F[1], . . . , and symbol number N×i+h may be precoded using F[h], for example (h=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1). (In this case, as described in previous embodiments, precoding matrices need not be hopped between regularly.) Furthermore, when the modulation scheme for both s1 and s2 is 16QAM, if α is set as follows,









Math





247











α
=



2

+
4



2

+
2






Equation





233







the advantageous effect of increasing the minimum distance between 16×16=256 signal points in the I-Q plane for a specific LOS environment may be achieved.


In the present embodiment, the scheme of structuring N different precoding matrices for a precoding hopping scheme with an N-slot time period (cycle) has been described. In this case, as the N different precoding matrices, F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[N−2], F[N−1] are prepared. In the present embodiment, an example of a single carrier transmission scheme has been described, and therefore the case of arranging symbols in the order F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[N−2], F[N−1] in the time domain (or the frequency domain) has been described. The present invention is not, however, limited in this way, and the N different precoding matrices F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[N−2], F[N−1] generated in the present embodiment may be adapted to a multi-carrier transmission scheme such as an OFDM transmission scheme or the like. As in Embodiment 1, as a scheme of adaption in this case, precoding weights may be changed by arranging symbols in the frequency domain and in the frequency-time domain. Note that a precoding hopping scheme with an N-slot time period (cycle) has been described, but the same advantageous effects may be obtained by randomly using N different precoding matrices. In other words, the N different precoding matrices do not necessarily need to be used in a regular period (cycle).


Furthermore, in the precoding matrix hopping scheme over an H-slot period (cycle) (H being a natural number larger than the number of slots N in the period (cycle) of the above scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices), when the N different precoding matrices of the present embodiment are included, the probability of excellent reception quality increases. In this case, Condition #17 and Condition #18 can be replaced by the following conditions. (The number of slots in the period (cycle) is considered to be N)

Math 248
ej(θ11(x)-θ21(x))≠ej(θ11(y)-θ21(y)) for ∃x,∃y (x≠y; x, y=0,1,2, . . . , N−2, N−1)  Condition #17′

(x is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; y is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; and x≠y)

Math 249
ej(θ11(x)-θ21(x)-π)≠ej(θ11(y)-θ21(y)-π) for ∃x,∃y (x≠y; x, y=0,1,2, . . . , N−2, N−1)  Condition #18′


(x is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; y is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; and x≠y)


Embodiment 10

The present embodiment describes a scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices using a unitary matrix that differs from the example in Embodiment 9.


In the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices over a period (cycle) with 2N slots, the precoding matrices prepared for the 2N slots are represented as follows.









Math





250














for





i

=
0

,
1
,
2
,





,

N
-
2

,

N
-

1


:











F


[
i
]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j







θ
11



(
i
)







α
×

e

j


(



θ
11



(
i
)


+
λ

)









α
×

e

j







θ
21



(
i
)








e

j


(



θ
21



(
i
)


+
λ
+
π

)






)







Equation





234







Let α be a fixed value (not depending on i), where α>0.









Math





251














for





i

=
N

,

N
+
1

,

N
+
2

,





,


2

N

-
2

,


2

N

-

1


:











F


[
i
]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




α
×

e

j







θ
11



(
i
)








e

j


(



θ
11



(
i
)


+
λ

)








e

j







θ
21



(
i
)







α
×

e

j


(



θ
21



(
i
)


+
λ
+
π

)







)







Equation





235







Let α be a fixed value (not depending on i), where α>0. (Let the α in Equation 234 and the α in Equation 235 be the same value.)


From Condition #5 (Math 106) and Condition #6 (Math 107) in Embodiment 3, the following conditions are important in Equation 234 for achieving excellent data reception quality.

Math 252
ej(θ11(x)-θ21(x))≠ej(θ11(y)-θ21(y)) for ∀x,∀y (x≠y; x, y=0,1,2, . . . , N−2, N−1)  Condition #21


(x is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; y is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; and x≠y)

Math 253
ej(θ11(x)-θ21(x)-π)≠ej(θ11(y)-θ21(y)-π) for ∀x,∀y (x≠y; x, y=0,1,2, . . . , N−2, N−1)  Condition #22

(x is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; y is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; and x≠y)


Addition of the following condition is considered.

Math 254
θ11(x)=θ11(x+N) for ∀x (x=0,1,2, . . . , N−2, N−1)
and
θ21(y)=θ21(y+N) for ∀y (y=0,1,2, . . . , N−2, N−1)  Condition #23


Next, in order to distribute the poor reception points evenly with regards to phase in the complex plane, as described in Embodiment 6, Condition #24 and Condition #25 are provided.









Math





255














e

j


(



θ
11



(

x
+
1

)


-


θ
21



(

x
+
1

)



)




e

j


(



θ
11



(
x
)


-


θ
21



(
x
)



)




=

e

j


(


2

π

N

)










for








x


(


x
=
0

,
1
,
2
,





,

N
-
2


)








Condition





#24






Math





256














e

j


(



θ
11



(

x
+
1

)


-


θ
21



(

x
+
1

)



)




e

j


(



θ
11



(
x
)


-


θ
21



(
x
)



)




=

e

j


(

-


2

π

N


)










for








x


(


x
=
0

,
1
,
2
,





,

N
-
2


)








Condition





#25







In other words, Condition #24 means that the difference in phase is 2π/N radians. On the other hand, Condition #25 means that the difference in phase is −2π/N radians.


Letting θ11(0)-θ21(0)=0 radians, and letting α>1, the distribution of poor reception points for s1 and for s2 in the complex plane when N=4 is shown in FIGS. 45A and 45B. As is clear from FIGS. 45A and 45B, in the complex plane, the minimum distance between poor reception points for s1 is kept large, and similarly, the minimum distance between poor reception points for s2 is also kept large. Similar conditions are created when α<1. Furthermore, making the same considerations as in Embodiment 9, the probability of a greater distance between poor reception points in the complex plane increases when N is an odd number as compared to when N is an even number. However, when N is small, for example when N≤16, the minimum distance between poor reception points in the complex plane can be guaranteed to be a certain length, since the number of poor reception points is small. Accordingly, when N≤16, even if N is an even number, cases do exist where data reception quality can be guaranteed.


Therefore, in the scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices based on Equations 234 and 235, when N is set to an odd number, the probability of improving data reception quality is high. Precoding matrices F[0]-F[2N−1] are generated based on Equations 234 and 235 (the precoding matrices F[0]-F[2N−1] may be arranged in any order for the 2N slots in the period (cycle)). Symbol number 2Ni may be precoded using F[0], symbol number 2Ni+1 may be precoded using F[1], . . . , and symbol number 2N×i+h may be precoded using F[h], for example (h=0, 1, 2, . . . , 2N−2, 2N−1). (In this case, as described in previous embodiments, precoding matrices need not be hopped between regularly.) Furthermore, when the modulation scheme for both s1 and s2 is 16QAM, if α is set as in Equation 233, the advantageous effect of increasing the minimum distance between 16×16=256 signal points in the I-Q plane for a specific LOS environment may be achieved.


The following conditions are possible as conditions differing from Condition #23:

Math 257
ej(θ11(x)-θ21(x))≠ej(θ11(y)-θ21(y)) for ∀x,∀y (x≠y; x, y=N, N+1, N+2, . . . ,2N−2,2N−1)  Condition #26


(where x is N, N+1, N+2, . . . , 2N−2, 2N−1; y is N, N+1, N+2, . . . , 2N−2, 2N−1; and x≠y)

Math 258
ej(θ11(x)-θ21(x)-π)≠ej(θ11(y)-θ21(y)-π) for ∀x,∀y (x≠y; x, y=N, N+1, N+2, . . . , 2N−2, 2N−1)   Condition #27


(where x is N, N+1, N+2, . . . , 2N−2, 2N−1; y is N, N+1, N+2, . . . , 2N−2, 2N−1; and x≠y)


In this case, by satisfying Condition #21, Condition #22, Condition #26, and Condition #27, the distance in the complex plane between poor reception points for s1 is increased, as is the distance between poor reception points for s2, thereby achieving excellent data reception quality.


In the present embodiment, the scheme of structuring 2N different precoding matrices for a precoding hopping scheme with a 2N-slot time period (cycle) has been described. In this case, as the 2N different precoding matrices, F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[2N−2], F[2N−1] are prepared. In the present embodiment, an example of a single carrier transmission scheme has been described, and therefore the case of arranging symbols in the order F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[2N−2], F[2N−1] in the time domain (or the frequency domain) has been described. The present invention is not, however, limited in this way, and the 2N different precoding matrices F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[2N−2], F[2N−1] generated in the present embodiment may be adapted to a multi-carrier transmission scheme such as an OFDM transmission scheme or the like. As in Embodiment 1, as a scheme of adaption in this case, precoding weights may be changed by arranging symbols in the frequency domain and in the frequency-time domain. Note that a precoding hopping scheme with a 2N-slot time period (cycle) has been described, but the same advantageous effects may be obtained by randomly using 2N different precoding matrices. In other words, the 2N different precoding matrices do not necessarily need to be used in a regular period (cycle).


Furthermore, in the precoding matrix hopping scheme over an H-slot period (cycle) (H being a natural number larger than the number of slots 2N in the period (cycle) of the above scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices), when the 2N different precoding matrices of the present embodiment are included, the probability of excellent reception quality increases.


Embodiment 11

The present embodiment describes a scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices using a non-unitary matrix.


In the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices over a period (cycle) with 2N slots, the precoding matrices prepared for the 2N slots are represented as follows.









Math





259














for





i

=
0

,
1
,
2
,





,

N
-
2

,

N
-

1


:











F


[
i
]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j







θ
11



(
i
)







α
×

e

j


(



θ
11



(
i
)


+
λ

)









α
×

e

j







θ
21



(
i
)








e

j


(



θ
21



(
i
)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)







Equation





236







Let α be a fixed value (not depending on i), where α>0. Furthermore, let δ ≠π radians.









Math





260














for





i

=
N

,

N
+
1

,

N
+
2

,





,


2

N

-
2

,


2

N

-

1


:











F


[
i
]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




α
×

e

j






(



θ
11



(
i
)


+
λ

)







e

j







θ
11



(
i
)









e

j






(



θ
21



(
i
)


+
λ
+
δ

)






α
×

e

j







θ
21



(
i
)








)







Equation





237







Let α be a fixed value (not depending on i), where α>0. (Let the α in Equation 236 and the α in Equation 237 be the same value.)


From Condition #5 (Math 106) and Condition #6 (Math 107) in Embodiment 3, the following conditions are important in Equation 236 for achieving excellent data reception quality.

Math 261
ej(θ11(x)-θ21(x))≠ej(θ11(y)-θ21(y)) for ∀x,∀y (x≠y; x, y=0,1,2, . . . , N−2, N−1)  Condition #28


(x is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; y is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; and x≠y)

Math 262
ej(θ11(x)-θ21(x)-δ)≠ej(θ11(y)-θ21(y)-δ) for ∀x,∀y (x≠y; x, y=0,1,2, . . . , N−2, N−1)  Condition #29


(x is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; y is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; and x≠y)


Addition of the following condition is considered.

Math 263
θ11(x)=θ11(x+N) for ∀x (x=0,1,2, . . . , N−2, N−1)
and
θ21(y)=θ21(y+N) for ∀y (y=0,1,2, . . . , N−2, N−1)  Condition #30


Note that instead of Equation 237, the precoding matrices in the following Equation may be provided.









Math





264














for





i

=
N

,

N
+
1

,

N
+
2

,





,


2

N

-
2

,


2

N

-

1


:











F


[
i
]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




α
×

e

j







θ
11



(
i
)








e

j






(



θ
11



(
i
)


+
λ

)








e

j







θ
21



(
i
)







α
×

e

j






(



θ
21



(
i
)


+
λ
-
δ

)







)







Equation





238







Let α be a fixed value (not depending on i), where α>0. (Let the α in Equation 236 and the α in Equation 238 be the same value.)


As an example, in order to distribute the poor reception points evenly with regards to phase in the complex plane, as described in Embodiment 6, Condition #31 and Condition #32 are provided.









Math





265














e

j


(



θ
11



(

x
+
1

)


-


θ
21



(

x
+
1

)



)




e

j


(



θ
11



(
x
)


-


θ
21



(
x
)



)




=

e

j


(


2

π

N

)










for








x


(


x
=
0

,
1
,
2
,





,

N
-
2


)








Condition





#31






Math





266














e

j


(



θ
11



(

x
+
1

)


-


θ
21



(

x
+
1

)



)




e

j


(



θ
11



(
x
)


-


θ
21



(
x
)



)




=

e

j


(

-


2

π

N


)










for








x


(


x
=
0

,
1
,
2
,





,

N
-
2


)








Condition





#32







In other words, Condition #31 means that the difference in phase is 2π/N radians. On the other hand, Condition #32 means that the difference in phase is −2π/N radians.


Letting θ11(0)-θ21(0)=0 radians, letting α>1, and letting δ=(3π)/4 radians, the distribution of poor reception points for s1 and for s2 in the complex plane when N=4 is shown in FIGS. 46A and 46B. With these settings, the period (cycle) for hopping between precoding matrices is increased, and the minimum distance between poor reception points for s1, as well as the minimum distance between poor reception points for s2, in the complex plane is kept large, thereby achieving excellent reception quality. An example in which α>1, 6=(3π)/4 radians, and N=4 has been described, but the present invention is not limited in this way. Similar advantageous effects may be obtained for π/2 radians ≤|δ|<π radians, α>0, and α≠1.


The following conditions are possible as conditions differing from Condition #30:

Math 267
ej(θ11(x)-θ21(x))≠ej(θ11(y)-θ21(y)) for ∀x,∀y (x≠y; x, y=N, N+1, N+2, . . . , 2N−2, 2N−1)  Condition #33

(where x is N, N+1, N+2, . . . , 2N−2, 2N−1; y is N, N+1, N+2, . . . , 2N−2, 2N−1; and x≠y)

Math 268
ej(θ11(x)-θ21(x)-π)≠ej(θ11(y)-θ21(y)-π) for ∀x,∀y (x≠y; x, y=N, N+1, N+2, . . . , 2N−2, 2N−1)   Condition #34

(where x is N, N+1, N+2, . . . , 2N−2, 2N−1; y is N, N+1, N+2, . . . , 2N−2, 2N−1; and x≠y)


In this case, by satisfying Condition #28, Condition #29, Condition #33, and Condition #34, the distance in the complex plane between poor reception points for s1 is increased, as is the distance between poor reception points for s2, thereby achieving excellent data reception quality.


In the present embodiment, the scheme of structuring 2N different precoding matrices for a precoding hopping scheme with a 2N-slot time period (cycle) has been described. In this case, as the 2N different precoding matrices, F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[2N−2], F[2N−1] are prepared. In the present embodiment, an example of a single carrier transmission scheme has been described, and therefore the case of arranging symbols in the order F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[2N−2], F[2N−1] in the time domain (or the frequency domain) has been described. The present invention is not, however, limited in this way, and the 2N different precoding matrices F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[2N−2], F[2N−1] generated in the present embodiment may be adapted to a multi-carrier transmission scheme such as an OFDM transmission scheme or the like. As in Embodiment 1, as a scheme of adaption in this case, precoding weights may be changed by arranging symbols in the frequency domain and in the frequency-time domain. Note that a precoding hopping scheme with a 2N-slot time period (cycle) has been described, but the same advantageous effects may be obtained by randomly using 2N different precoding matrices. In other words, the 2N different precoding matrices do not necessarily need to be used in a regular period (cycle).


Furthermore, in the precoding matrix hopping scheme over an H-slot period (cycle) (H being a natural number larger than the number of slots 2N in the period (cycle) of the above scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices), when the 2N different precoding matrices of the present embodiment are included, the probability of excellent reception quality increases.


Embodiment 12

The present embodiment describes a scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices using a non-unitary matrix.


In the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices over a period (cycle) with N slots, the precoding matrices prepared for the N slots are represented as follows.









Math





269












F


[
i
]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j







θ
11



(
i
)







α
×

e

j


(



θ
11



(
i
)


+
λ

)









α
×

e

j







θ
21



(
i
)








e

j


(



θ
21



(
i
)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)






Equation





239








Let α be a fixed value (not depending on i), where α>0. Furthermore, let δ≠π radians (a fixed value not depending on i), and i=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1.


From Condition #5 (Math 106) and Condition #6 (Math 107) in Embodiment 3, the following conditions are important in Equation 239 for achieving excellent data reception quality.

Math 270
ej(θ11(x)-θ21(x))≠ej(θ11(y)-θ21(y)) for ∀x,∀y (x≠y; x, y=0,1,2, . . . , N−2, N−1)  Condition #35

(x is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; y is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; and x≠y)

Math 271
ej(θ11(x)-θ21(x)-δ)≠ej(θ11(y)-θ21(y)-δ) for ∀x,∀y (x≠y; x, y=0,1,2, . . . , N−2, N−1)  Condition #36

(x is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; y is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; and x≠y)


As an example, in order to distribute the poor reception points evenly with regards to phase in the complex plane, as described in Embodiment 6, Condition #37 and Condition #38 are provided.









Math





272














e

j


(



θ
11



(

x
+
1

)


-


θ
21



(

x
+
1

)



)




e

j


(



θ
11



(
x
)


-


θ
21



(
x
)



)




=

e

j


(


2

π

N

)










for








x


(


x
=
0

,
1
,
2
,





,

N
-
2


)








Condition





#37






Math





273














e

j


(



θ
11



(

x
+
1

)


-


θ
21



(

x
+
1

)



)




e

j


(



θ
11



(
x
)


-


θ
21



(
x
)



)




=

e

j


(

-


2

π

N


)










for








x


(


x
=
0

,
1
,
2
,





,

N
-
2


)








Condition





#38







In other words, Condition #37 means that the difference in phase is 2π/N radians. On the other hand, Condition #38 means that the difference in phase is −2π/N radians.


In this case, if π/2 radians ≤|δ|<π radians, α>0, and α≠1, the distance in the complex plane between poor reception points for s1 is increased, as is the distance between poor reception points for s2, thereby achieving excellent data reception quality. Note that Condition #37 and Condition #38 are not always necessary.


In the present embodiment, the scheme of structuring N different precoding matrices for a precoding hopping scheme with an N-slot time period (cycle) has been described. In this case, as the N different precoding matrices, F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[N−2], F[N−1] are prepared. In the present embodiment, an example of a single carrier transmission scheme has been described, and therefore the case of arranging symbols in the order F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[N−2], F[N−1] in the time domain (or the frequency domain) has been described. The present invention is not, however, limited in this way, and the N different precoding matrices F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[N−2], F[N−1] generated in the present embodiment may be adapted to a multi-carrier transmission scheme such as an OFDM transmission scheme or the like. As in Embodiment 1, as a scheme of adaption in this case, precoding weights may be changed by arranging symbols in the frequency domain and in the frequency-time domain. Note that a precoding hopping scheme with an N-slot time period (cycle) has been described, but the same advantageous effects may be obtained by randomly using N different precoding matrices. In other words, the N different precoding matrices do not necessarily need to be used in a regular period (cycle).


Furthermore, in the precoding matrix hopping scheme over an H-slot period (cycle) (H being a natural number larger than the number of slots N in the period (cycle) of the above scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices), when the N different precoding matrices of the present embodiment are included, the probability of excellent reception quality increases. In this case, Condition #35 and Condition #36 can be replaced by the following conditions. (The number of slots in the period (cycle) is considered to be N)

Math 274
ej(θ11(x)-θ21(x))≠ej(θ11(y)-θ21(y)) for ∃x,∃y (x≠y; x, y=0,1,2, . . . , N−2, N−1)  Condition #35′

(x is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; y is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; and x≠y)

Math 275
ej(θ11(x)-θ21(x)-δ)≠ej(θ11(y)-θ21(y)-δ) for ∃x,∃y (x≠y; x, y=0,1,2, . . . , N−2, N−1)  Condition #36′

(x is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; y is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; and x≠y)


Embodiment 13

The present embodiment describes a different example than Embodiment 8.


In the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices over a period (cycle) with 2N slots, the precoding matrices prepared for the 2N slots are represented as follows.









Math





276














for





i

=
0

,
1
,
2
,





,

N
-
2

,

N
-

1


:











F


[
i
]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j







θ
11



(
i
)







α
×

e

j






(



θ
11



(
i
)


+
λ

)









α
×

e

j







θ
21



(
i
)








e

j






(



θ
21



(
i
)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)







Equation





240








Let α be a fixed value (not depending on i), where α>0. Furthermore, let δ≠π radians.









Math





277














for





i

=
N

,

N
+
1

,

N
+
2

,





,


2

N

-
2

,


2

N

-

1


:











F


[
i
]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




α
×

e

j






(



θ
11



(
i
)


+
λ

)







e

j







θ
11



(
i
)









e

j






(



θ
21



(
i
)


+
λ
+
δ

)






α
×

e

j







θ
21



(
i
)








)







Equation





241







Let α be a fixed value (not depending on i), where α>0. (Let the α in Equation 240 and the α in Equation 241 be the same value.)


Furthermore, the 2×N×M period (cycle) precoding matrices based on Equations 240 and 241 are represented by the following equations.














Math





278




















for





i

=
0

,
1
,
2
,





,

N
-
2

,

N
-

1


:











F


[


2
×
N
×
k

+
i

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j







θ
11



(
i
)







α
×

e

j






(



θ
11



(
i
)


+
λ

)









α
×

e

j






(



θ
21



(
i
)


+

X
k


)







e

j






(



θ
21



(
i
)


+

X
k

+
λ
+
δ

)






)








Equation





242







In this case, k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1.














Math





279




















for





i

=
N

,

N
+
1

,

N
+
2

,





,


2

N

-
2

,


2

N

-

1


:











F


[


2
×
N
×
k

+
i

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




α
×

e

j






(



θ
11



(
i
)


+
λ

)







e

j
(


θ
11



(
i
)









e

j






(



θ
21



(
i
)


+
λ
+
δ
+

Y
k


)






α
×

e

j







θ
21



(

i
+

Y
k


)








)








Equation





243







In this case, k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1. Furthermore, Xk=Yk may be true, or Xk≠Yk may be true.


Precoding matrices F[0]-F[2×N×M−1] are thus generated (the precoding matrices F[0]-F[2×N×M−1] may be in any order for the 2×N×M slots in the period (cycle)). Symbol number 2×N×M×i may be precoded using F[0], symbol number 2×N×M×i+1 may be precoded using F[1], . . . , and symbol number 2×N×M×i+h may be precoded using F[h], for example (h=0, 1, 2, . . . , 2×N×M−2, 2×N×M−1). (In this case, as described in previous embodiments, precoding matrices need not be hopped between regularly.) Generating the precoding matrices in this way achieves a precoding matrix hopping scheme with a large period (cycle), allowing for the position of poor reception points to be easily changed, which may lead to improved data reception quality.


The 2×N×M period (cycle) precoding matrices in Equation 242 may be changed to the following equation.














Math





280




















for





i

=
0

,
1
,
2
,





,

N
-
2

,

N
-

1


:











F


[


2
×
N
×
k

+
i

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j


(



θ
11



(
i
)


+

X
k


)






α
×

e

j


(



θ
11



(
i
)


+

X
k

+
λ

)









α
×

e

j







θ
21



(
i
)








e

j


(



θ
21



(
i
)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)








Equation





244







In this case, k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1.


The 2×N×M period (cycle) precoding matrices in Equation 243 may also be changed to any of Equations 245-247.














Math





281




















for





i

=
N

,

N
+
1

,

N
+
2

,





,


2

N

-
2

,


2

N

-

1


:











F


[


2
×
N
×
k

+
i

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




α
×

e

j


(



θ
11



(
i
)


+
λ
+

Y
k


)







e

j







θ
11



(

i
+

Y
k


)









e

j


(



θ
21



(
i
)


+
λ
+
δ

)






α
×

e

j







θ
21



(
i
)








)








Equation





245







In this case, k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1.














Math





282




















for





i

=
N

,

N
+
1

,

N
+
2

,





,


2

N

-
2

,


2

N

-

1


:











F


[


2
×
N
×
k

+
i

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




α
×

e

j







θ
11



(
i
)








e

j






(



θ
11



(
i
)


+
λ

)








e

j







θ
21



(

i
+

Y
k


)







α
×

e

j


(



θ
21



(
i
)


+
λ
-
δ
+

Y
k


)







)








Equation





246







In this case, k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1.














Math





283




















for





i

=
N

,

N
+
1

,

N
+
2

,





,


2

N

-
2

,


2

N

-

1


:











F


[


2
×
N
×
k

+
i

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




α
×

e

j







θ
11



(

i
+

Y
k


)








e

j


(



θ
11



(
i
)


+
λ
+

Y
k


)








e

j







θ
21



(
i
)







α
×

e

j


(



θ
21



(
i
)


+
λ
-
δ

)







)








Equation





247







In this case, k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1.


Focusing on poor reception points, if Equations 242 through 247 satisfy the following conditions,

Math 284
ej(θ11(x)-θ21(x))≠ej(θ11(y)-θ21(y)) for ∀x,∀y (x≠y; x, y=0,1,2, . . . , N−2, N−1)  Condition #39


(x is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; y is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; and x≠y)

Math 285
ej(θ11(x)-θ21(x)-δ)≠ej(θ11(y)-θ21(y)-δ) for ∀x,∀y (x≠y; x, y=0,1,2, . . . , N−2, N−1)  Condition #40


(x is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; y is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; and x≠y)

Math 286
θ11(x)=θ11(x+N) for ∀x (x=0,1,2, . . . , N−2, N−1)
and
θ21(y)=θ21(y+N) for ∀y (y=0,1,2, . . . , N−2, N−1)  Condition #41


then excellent data reception quality is achieved. Note that in Embodiment 8, Condition #39 and Condition #40 should be satisfied.


Focusing on Xk and Yk, if Equations 242 through 247 satisfy the following conditions,

Math 287
Xa≠Xb+2×s×π for ∀a,∀b (a≠b; a, b=0,1,2, . . . , M−2, M−1)  Condition #42


(a is 0, 1, 2, . . . , M−2, M−1; b is 0, 1, 2, . . . , M−2, M−1; and a≠b.)


(Here, s is an integer)

Math 288
Ya≠Yb+2×u×π for ∀a,∀b (a≠b; a, b=0,1,2, . . . , M−2, M−1)  Condition #43

(a is 0, 1, 2, . . . , M−2, M−1; b is 0, 1, 2, . . . , M−2, M−1; and a≠b.)


(Here, u is an integer.)


then excellent data reception quality is achieved. Note that in Embodiment 8, Condition #42 should be satisfied.


In Equations 242 and 247, when 0 radians ≤δ<2π radians, the matrices are a unitary matrix when δ=π radians and are a non-unitary matrix when δ≠π radians. In the present scheme, use of a non-unitary matrix for π/2 radians ≤|δ|<π radians is one characteristic structure, and excellent data reception quality is obtained. Use of a unitary matrix is another structure, and as described in detail in Embodiment 10 and Embodiment 16, if N is an odd number in Equations 242 through 247, the probability of obtaining excellent data reception quality increases.


Embodiment 14

The present embodiment describes an example of differentiating between usage of a unitary matrix and a non-unitary matrix as the precoding matrix in the scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices.


The following describes an example that uses a two-by-two precoding matrix (letting each element be a complex number), i.e. the case when two modulated signals (s1(t) and s2(t)) that are based on a modulation scheme are precoded, and the two precoded signals are transmitted by two antennas.


When transmitting data using a scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices, the mapping units 306A and 306B in the transmission device in FIG. 3 and FIG. 13 hop the modulation scheme in accordance with the frame structure signal 313. The relationship between the modulation level (the number of signal points for the modulation scheme in the I-Q plane) of the modulation scheme and the precoding matrices is described.


The advantage of the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices is that, as described in Embodiment 6, excellent data reception quality is achieved in an LOS environment. In particular, when the reception device performs ML calculation or applies APP (or Max-log APP) based on ML calculation, the advantageous effect is considerable. Incidentally, ML calculation greatly impacts circuit scale (calculation scale) in accordance with the modulation level of the modulation scheme. For example, when two precoded signals are transmitted from two antennas, and the same modulation scheme is used for two modulated signals (signals based on the modulation scheme before precoding), the number of candidate signal points in the I-Q plane (received signal points 1101 in FIG. 11) is 4×4=16 when the modulation scheme is QPSK, 16 16=256 when the modulation scheme is 16QAM, 64×64=4096 when the modulation scheme is 64QAM, 256×256=65,536 when the modulation scheme is 256QAM, and 1024×1024=1,048,576 when the modulation scheme is 256QAM. In order to keep the calculation scale of the reception device down to a certain circuit size, when the modulation scheme is QPSK, 16QAM, or 64QAM, ML calculation ((Max-log) APP based on ML calculation) is used, and when the modulation scheme is 256QAM or 1024QAM, linear operation such as MMSE or ZF is used in the reception device. (In some cases, ML calculation may be used for 256QAM.)


When such a reception device is assumed, consideration of the Signal-to-Noise Power Ratio (SNR) after separation of multiple signals indicates that a unitary matrix is appropriate as the precoding matrix when the reception device performs linear operation such as MMSE or ZF, whereas either a unitary matrix or a non-unitary matrix may be used when the reception device performs ML calculation. Taking any of the above embodiments into consideration, when two precoded signals are transmitted from two antennas, the same modulation scheme is used for two modulated signals (signals based on the modulation scheme before precoding), a non-unitary matrix is used as the precoding matrix in the scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices, the modulation level of the modulation scheme is equal to or less than 64 (or equal to or less than 256), and a unitary matrix is used when the modulation level is greater than 64 (or greater than 256), then for all of the modulation schemes supported by the transmission system, there is an increased probability of achieving the advantageous effect whereby excellent data reception quality is achieved for any of the modulation schemes while reducing the circuit scale of the reception device.


When the modulation level of the modulation scheme is equal to or less than 64 (or equal to or less than 256) as well, in some cases use of a unitary matrix may be preferable. Based on this consideration, when a plurality of modulation schemes are supported in which the modulation level is equal to or less than 64 (or equal to or less than 256), it is important that in some cases, in some of the plurality of supported modulation schemes where the modulation level is equal to or less than 64, a non-unitary matrix is used as the precoding matrix in the scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices.


The case of transmitting two precoded signals from two antennas has been described above as an example, but the present invention is not limited in this way. In the case when N precoded signals are transmitted from N antennas, and the same modulation scheme is used for N modulated signals (signals based on the modulation scheme before precoding), a threshold RN may be established for the modulation level of the modulation scheme. When a plurality of modulation schemes for which the modulation level is equal to or less than RN are supported, in some of the plurality of supported modulation schemes where the modulation level is equal to or less than βN, a non-unitary matrix is used as the precoding matrices in the scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices, whereas for modulation schemes for which the modulation level is greater than βN, a unitary matrix is used. In this way, for all of the modulation schemes supported by the transmission system, there is an increased probability of achieving the advantageous effect whereby excellent data reception quality is achieved for any of the modulation schemes while reducing the circuit scale of the reception device. (When the modulation level of the modulation scheme is equal to or less than βN, a non-unitary matrix may always be used as the precoding matrix in the scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices.)


In the above description, the same modulation scheme has been described as being used in the modulation scheme for simultaneously transmitting N modulated signals. The following, however, describes the case in which two or more modulation schemes are used for simultaneously transmitting N modulated signals.


As an example, the case in which two precoded signals are transmitted by two antennas is described. The two modulated signals (signals based on the modulation scheme before precoding) are either modulated with the same modulation scheme, or when modulated with different modulation schemes, are modulated with a modulation scheme having a modulation level of 2a1 or a modulation level of 2a2. In this case, when the reception device uses ML calculation ((Max-log) APP based on ML calculation), the number of candidate signal points in the I-Q plane (received signal points 1101 in FIG. 11) is 2a1×2a2=2a1+a2. As described above, in order to achieve excellent data reception quality while reducing the circuit scale of the reception device, a threshold 2β may be provided for 2a1+a2, and when 2a1+a2≤2β, a non-unitary matrix may be used as the precoding matrix in the scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices, whereas a unitary matrix may be used when 2a1+a2>2β.


Furthermore, when 2a1+a2≤2β, in some cases use of a unitary matrix may be preferable. Based on this consideration, when a plurality of combinations of modulation schemes are supported for which 2a1+a2≤2β, it is important that in some of the supported combinations of modulation schemes for which 2a1+a2≤2β, a non-unitary matrix is used as the precoding matrix in the scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices.


As an example, the case in which two precoded signals are transmitted by two antennas has been described, but the present invention is not limited in this way. For example, N modulated signals (signals based on the modulation scheme before precoding) may be either modulated with the same modulation scheme or, when modulated with different modulation schemes, the modulation level of the modulation scheme for the ith modulated signal may be 2ai (where i=1, 2, . . . , N−1, N).


In this case, when the reception device uses ML calculation ((Max-log) APP based on ML calculation), the number of candidate signal points in the I-Q plane (received signal points 1101 in FIG. 11) is 2a1×2a2× . . . ×2ai× . . . ×2aN=2a1+a2+ . . . +ai+ . . . +aN. As described above, in order to achieve excellent data reception quality while reducing the circuit scale of the reception device, a threshold 2β may be provided for 2a1+a2+ . . . +ai+ . . . +aN.









Math





289













2


a





1

+

a





2

+

+
ai
+

+
aN


=


2
Y



2
β








where






Y
=




i
=
1

N



a
i







Condition





#44








When a plurality of combinations of a modulation schemes satisfying Condition #44 are supported, in some of the supported combinations of modulation schemes satisfying Condition #44, a non-unitary matrix is used as the precoding matrix in the scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices.









Math





290













2


a





1

+

a





2

+

+
ai
+

+
aN


=


2
Y

>

2
β








where






Y
=




i
=
1

N



a
i







Condition





#45







By using a unitary matrix in all of the combinations of modulation schemes satisfying Condition #45, then for all of the modulation schemes supported by the transmission system, there is an increased probability of achieving the advantageous effect whereby excellent data reception quality is achieved while reducing the circuit scale of the reception device for any of the combinations of modulation schemes. (A non-unitary matrix may be used as the precoding matrix in the scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices in all of the supported combinations of modulation schemes satisfying Condition #44.)


Embodiment 15

The present embodiment describes an example of a system that adopts a scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices using a multi-carrier transmission scheme such as OFDM.



FIGS. 47A and 47B show an example according to the present embodiment of frame structure in the time and frequency domains for a signal transmitted by a broadcast station (base station) in a system that adopts a scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices using a multi-carrier transmission scheme such as OFDM. (The frame structure is set to extend from time $1 to time $T.) FIG. 47A shows the frame structure in the time and frequency domains for the stream s1 described in Embodiment 1, and FIG. 47B shows the frame structure in the time and frequency domains for the stream s2 described in Embodiment 1. Symbols at the same time and the same (sub)carrier in stream s1 and stream s2 are transmitted by a plurality of antennas at the same time and the same frequency.


In FIGS. 47A and 47B, the (sub)carriers used when using OFDM are divided as follows: a carrier group #A composed of (sub)carrier a−(sub)carrier a+Na, a carrier group #B composed of (sub)carrier b−(sub)carrier b+Nb, a carrier group #C composed of (sub)carrier c−(sub)carrier c+Nc, a carrier group #D composed of (sub)carrier d−(sub)carrier d+Nd, . . . . In each subcarrier group, a plurality of transmission schemes are assumed to be supported. By supporting a plurality of transmission schemes, it is possible to effectively capitalize on the advantages of the transmission schemes. For example, in FIGS. 47A and 47B, a spatial multiplexing MIMO system, or a MIMO system with a fixed precoding matrix is used for carrier group #A, a MIMO system that regularly hops between precoding matrices is used for carrier group #B, only stream s1 is transmitted in carrier group #C, and space-time block coding is used to transmit carrier group #D.



FIGS. 48A and 48B show an example according to the present embodiment of frame structure in the time and frequency domains for a signal transmitted by a broadcast station (base station) in a system that adopts a scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices using a multi-carrier transmission scheme such as OFDM. FIGS. 48A and 48B show a frame structure at a different time than FIGS. 47A and 47B, from time $X to time $X+T′. In FIGS. 48A and 48B, as in FIGS. 47A and 47B, the (sub)carriers used when using OFDM are divided as follows: a carrier group #A composed of (sub)carrier a−(sub)carrier a+Na, a carrier group #B composed of (sub)carrier b−(sub)carrier b+Nb, a carrier group #C composed of (sub)carrier c−(sub)carrier c+Nc, a carrier group #D composed of (sub)carrier d−(sub)carrier d+Nd, . . . . The difference between FIGS. 47A and 47B and FIGS. 48A and 48B is that in some carrier groups, the transmission scheme used in FIGS. 47A and 47B differs from the transmission scheme used in FIGS. 48A and 48B. In FIGS. 48A and 48B, space-time block coding is used to transmit carrier group #A, a MIMO system that regularly hops between precoding matrices is used for carrier group #B, a MIMO system that regularly hops between precoding matrices is used for carrier group #C, and only stream s1 is transmitted in carrier group #D.


Next, the supported transmission schemes are described.



FIG. 49 shows a signal processing scheme when using a spatial multiplexing MIMO system or a MIMO system with a fixed precoding matrix. FIG. 49 bears the same numbers as in FIG. 6.


A weighting unit 600, which is a baseband signal in accordance with a certain modulation scheme, receives as inputs a stream s1(t) (307A), a stream s2(t) (307B), and information 315 regarding the weighting scheme, and outputs a modulated signal z1(t) (309A) after weighting and a modulated signal z2(t) (309B) after weighting. Here, when the information 315 regarding the weighting scheme indicates a spatial multiplexing MIMO system, the signal processing in scheme #1 of FIG. 49 is performed. Specifically, the following processing is performed.









Math





291















(




z





1


(
t
)







z





2


(
t
)





)

=




(




e

j





0




0




0



e

j





0





)



(




s





1


(
t
)







s





2


(
t
)





)








=





(



1


0




0


1



)



(




s





1


(
t
)







s





2


(
t
)





)


=

(




s





1


(
t
)







s





2


(
t
)





)









Equation





250







When a scheme for transmitting one modulated signal is supported, from the standpoint of transmission power, Equation 250 may be represented as Equation 251.









Math





292















(




z





1


(
t
)







z





2


(
t
)





)

=




1

2




(




e

j





0




0




0



e

j





0





)



(




s





1


(
t
)







s





2


(
t
)





)








=





1

2




(



1


0




0


1



)



(




s





1


(
t
)







s





2


(
t
)





)


=

(





1

2



s





1


(
t
)








1

2



s





2


(
t
)





)









Equation





251







When the information 315 regarding the weighting scheme indicates a MIMO system in which precoding matrices are regularly hopped between, signal processing in scheme #2, for example, of FIG. 49 is performed. Specifically, the following processing is performed.














Math





293













(




z





1


(
t
)







z





2


(
t
)





)

=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j






θ
11






α
×

e

j


(


θ
11

+
λ

)









α
×

e

j






θ
21







e

j


(


θ
21

+
λ
+
δ

)






)



(




s





1


(
t
)







s





2


(
t
)





)






Equation





252







Here, θ11, θ12, λ, and δ are fixed values.



FIG. 50 shows the structure of modulated signals when using space-time block coding. A space-time block coding unit (5002) in FIG. 50 receives, as input, a baseband signal based on a certain modulation signal. For example, the space-time block coding unit (5002) receives symbol s1, symbol s2, . . . as inputs. As shown in FIG. 50, space-time block coding is performed, z1 (5003A) becomes “s1 as symbol #0”, “−s2* as symbol #0”, “s3 as symbol #2”, “−s4* as symbol #3” . . . , and z2(5003B) becomes “s2 as symbol #0”, “s1* as symbol #1”, “s4 as symbol #2”, “s3* as symbol #3” . . . . In this case, symbol #X in z1 and symbol #X in z2 are transmitted from the antennas at the same time, over the same frequency.


In FIGS. 47A, 47B, 48A, and 48B, only symbols transmitting data are shown. In practice, however, it is necessary to transmit information such as the transmission scheme, modulation scheme, error correction scheme, and the like. For example, as in FIG. 51, these pieces of information can be transmitted to a communication partner by regular transmission with only one modulated signal z1. It is also necessary to transmit symbols for estimation of channel fluctuation, i.e. for the reception device to estimate channel fluctuation (for example, a pilot symbol, reference symbol, preamble, a Phase Shift Keying (PSK) symbol known at the transmission and reception sides, and the like). In FIGS. 47A, 47B, 48A, and 48B, these symbols are omitted. In practice, however, symbols for estimating channel fluctuation are included in the frame structure in the time and frequency domains. Accordingly, each carrier group is not composed only of symbols for transmitting data. (The same is true for Embodiment 1 as well.)



FIG. 52 is an example of the structure of a transmission device in a broadcast station (base station) according to the present embodiment. A transmission scheme determining unit (5205) determines the number of carriers, modulation scheme, error correction scheme, coding rate for error correction coding, transmission scheme, and the like for each carrier group and outputs a control signal (5206).


A modulated signal generating unit #1 (5201_1) receives, as input, information (5200_1) and the control signal (5206) and, based on the information on the transmission scheme in the control signal (5206), outputs a modulated signal z1 (5202_1) and a modulated signal z2 (5203_1) in the carrier group #A of FIGS. 47A, 47B, 48A, and 48B.


Similarly, a modulated signal generating unit #2 (5201_2) receives, as input, information (5200_2) and the control signal (5206) and, based on the information on the transmission scheme in the control signal (5206), outputs a modulated signal z1 (5202_2) and a modulated signal z2 (5203_2) in the carrier group #B of FIGS. 47A, 47B, 48A, and 48B.


Similarly, a modulated signal generating unit #3 (5201_3) receives, as input, information (5200_3) and the control signal (5206) and, based on the information on the transmission scheme in the control signal (5206), outputs a modulated signal z1 (5202_3) and a modulated signal z2 (5203_3) in the carrier group #C of FIGS. 47A, 47B, 48A, and 48B.


Similarly, a modulated signal generating unit #4 (5201_4) receives, as input, information (5200_4) and the control signal (5206) and, based on the information on the transmission scheme in the control signal (5206), outputs a modulated signal z1 (5202_4) and a modulated signal z2 (5203_4) in the carrier group #D of FIGS. 47A, 47B, 48A, and 48B.


While not shown in the figures, the same is true for modulated signal generating unit #5 through modulated signal generating unit #M−1.


Similarly, a modulated signal generating unit #M (5201_M) receives, as input, information (5200_M) and the control signal (5206) and, based on the information on the transmission scheme in the control signal (5206), outputs a modulated signal z1 (5202_M) and a modulated signal z2 (5203_M) in a certain carrier group.


An OFDM related processor (5207_1) receives, as inputs, the modulated signal z1 (5202_1) in carrier group #A, the modulated signal z1 (5202_2) in carrier group #B, the modulated signal z1 (5202_3) in carrier group #C, the modulated signal z1 (5202_4) in carrier group #D, . . . , the modulated signal z1 (5202_M) in a certain carrier group #M, and the control signal (5206), performs processing such as reordering, inverse Fourier transform, frequency conversion, amplification, and the like, and outputs a transmission signal (5208_1). The transmission signal (5208_1) is output as a radio wave from an antenna (5209_1).


Similarly, an OFDM related processor (5207_2) receives, as inputs, the modulated signal z1 (5203_1) in carrier group #A, the modulated signal z1 (5203_2) in carrier group #B, the modulated signal z1 (5203_3) in carrier group #C, the modulated signal z1 (5203_4) in carrier group #D, . . . , the modulated signal z1 (5203_M) in a certain carrier group #M, and the control signal (5206), performs processing such as reordering, inverse Fourier transform, frequency conversion, amplification, and the like, and outputs a transmission signal (5208_2). The transmission signal (5208_2) is output as a radio wave from an antenna (5209_2).



FIG. 53 shows an example of a structure of the modulated signal generating units #1-#M in FIG. 52. An error correction encoder (5302) receives, as inputs, information (5300) and a control signal (5301) and, in accordance with the control signal (5301), sets the error correction coding scheme and the coding rate for error correction coding, performs error correction coding, and outputs data (5303) after error correction coding. (In accordance with the setting of the error correction coding scheme and the coding rate for error correction coding, when using LDPC coding, turbo coding, or convolutional coding, for example, depending on the coding rate, puncturing may be performed to achieve the coding rate.)


An interleaver (5304) receives, as input, error correction coded data (5303) and the control signal (5301) and, in accordance with information on the interleaving scheme included in the control signal (5301), reorders the error correction coded data (5303) and outputs interleaved data (5305).


A mapping unit (5306_1) receives, as input, the interleaved data (5305) and the control signal (5301) and, in accordance with the information on the modulation scheme included in the control signal (5301), performs mapping and outputs a baseband signal (5307_1).


Similarly, a mapping unit (5306_2) receives, as input, the interleaved data (5305) and the control signal (5301) and, in accordance with the information on the modulation scheme included in the control signal (5301), performs mapping and outputs a baseband signal (5307_2).


A signal processing unit (5308) receives, as input, the baseband signal (5307_1), the baseband signal (5307_2), and the control signal (5301) and, based on information on the transmission scheme (for example, in this embodiment, a spatial multiplexing MIMO system, a MIMO scheme using a fixed precoding matrix, a MIMO scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices, space-time block coding, or a transmission scheme for transmitting only stream s1) included in the control signal (5301), performs signal processing. The signal processing unit (5308) outputs a processed signal z1 (5309_1) and a processed signal z2 (5309_2). Note that when the transmission scheme for transmitting only stream s1 is selected, the signal processing unit (5308) does not output the processed signal z2 (5309_2). Furthermore, in FIG. 53, one error correction encoder is shown, but the present invention is not limited in this way. For example, as shown in FIG. 3, a plurality of encoders may be provided.



FIG. 54 shows an example of the structure of the OFDM related processors (5207_1 and 5207_2) in FIG. 52. Elements that operate in a similar way to FIG. 14 bear the same reference signs. A reordering unit (5402A) receives, as input, the modulated signal z1 (5400_1) in carrier group #A, the modulated signal z1 (5400_2) in carrier group #B, the modulated signal z1 (5400_3) in carrier group #C, the modulated signal z1 (5400_4) in carrier group #D, . . . , the modulated signal z1 (5400_M) in a certain carrier group, and a control signal (5403), performs reordering, and output reordered signals 1405A and 1405B. Note that in FIGS. 47A, 47B, 48A, 48B, and 51, an example of allocation of the carrier groups is described as being formed by groups of subcarriers, but the present invention is not limited in this way. Carrier groups may be formed by discrete subcarriers at each time interval. Furthermore, in FIGS. 47A, 47B, 48A, 48B, and 51, an example has been described in which the number of carriers in each carrier group does not change over time, but the present invention is not limited in this way. This point will be described separately below.



FIGS. 55A and 55B show an example of frame structure in the time and frequency domains for a scheme of setting the transmission scheme for each carrier group, as in FIGS. 47A, 47B, 48A, 48B, and 51. In FIGS. 55A and 55B, control information symbols are labeled 5500, individual control information symbols are labeled 5501, data symbols are labeled 5502, and pilot symbols are labeled 5503. Furthermore, FIG. 55A shows the frame structure in the time and frequency domains for stream s1, and FIG. 55B shows the frame structure in the time and frequency domains for stream s2.


The control information symbols are for transmitting control information shared by the carrier group and are composed of symbols for the transmission and reception devices to perform frequency and time synchronization, information regarding the allocation of (sub)carriers, and the like. The control information symbols are set to be transmitted from only stream s1 at time $1.


The individual control information symbols are for transmitting control information on individual subcarrier groups and are composed of information on the transmission scheme, modulation scheme, error correction coding scheme, coding rate for error correction coding, block size of error correction codes, and the like for the data symbols, information on the insertion scheme of pilot symbols, information on the transmission power of pilot symbols, and the like. The individual control information symbols are set to be transmitted from only stream s1 at time $1.


The data symbols are for transmitting data (information), and as described with reference to FIGS. 47A through 50, are symbols of one of the following transmission schemes, for example: a spatial multiplexing MIMO system, a MIMO scheme using a fixed precoding matrix, a MIMO scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices, space-time block coding, or a transmission scheme for transmitting only stream s1. Note that in carrier group #A, carrier group #B, carrier group #C, and carrier group #D, data symbols are shown in stream s2, but when the transmission scheme for transmitting only stream s1 is used, in some cases there are no data symbols in stream s2.


The pilot symbols are for the reception device to perform channel estimation, i.e. to estimate fluctuation corresponding to h11(t), h12(t), h21(t), and h22(t) in Equation 36.


(In this embodiment, since a multi-carrier transmission scheme such as an OFDM scheme is used, the pilot symbols are for estimating fluctuation corresponding to h11(t), h12(t), h21(t), and h22(t) in each subcarrier.) Accordingly, the PSK transmission scheme, for example, is used for the pilot symbols, which are structured to form a pattern known by the transmission and reception devices. Furthermore, the reception device may use the pilot symbols for estimation of frequency offset, estimation of phase distortion, and time synchronization.



FIG. 56 shows an example of the structure of a reception device for receiving modulated signals transmitted by the transmission device in FIG. 52. Elements that operate in a similar way to FIG. 7 bear the same reference signs.


In FIG. 56, an OFDM related processor (5600_X) receives, as input, a received signal 702_X, performs predetermined processing, and outputs a processed signal 704_X. Similarly, an OFDM related processor (5600_Y) receives, as input, a received signal 702_Y, performs predetermined processing, and outputs a processed signal 704_Y.


The control information decoding unit 709 in FIG. 56 receives, as input, the processed signals 704_X and 704_Y, extracts the control information symbols and individual control information symbols in FIGS. 55A and 55B to obtain the control information transmitted by these symbols, and outputs a control signal 710 that includes the obtained information.


The channel fluctuation estimating unit 705_1 for the modulated signal z1 receives, as inputs, the processed signal 704_X and the control signal 710, performs channel estimation in the carrier group required by the reception device (the desired carrier group), and outputs a channel estimation signal 706_1.


Similarly, the channel fluctuation estimating unit 705_2 for the modulated signal z2 receives, as inputs, the processed signal 704_X and the control signal 710, performs channel estimation in the carrier group required by the reception device (the desired carrier group), and outputs a channel estimation signal 706_2.


Similarly, the channel fluctuation estimating unit 705_1 for the modulated signal z1 receives, as inputs, the processed signal 704_Y and the control signal 710, performs channel estimation in the carrier group required by the reception device (the desired carrier group), and outputs a channel estimation signal 708_1.


Similarly, the channel fluctuation estimating unit 705_2 for the modulated signal z2 receives, as inputs, the processed signal 704_Y and the control signal 710, performs channel estimation in the carrier group required by the reception device (the desired carrier group), and outputs a channel estimation signal 708_2.


The signal processing unit 711 receives, as inputs, the signals 706_1, 706_2, 708_1, 708_2, 704_X, 704_Y, and the control signal 710. Based on the information included in the control signal 710 on the transmission scheme, modulation scheme, error correction coding scheme, coding rate for error correction coding, block size of error correction codes, and the like for the data symbols transmitted in the desired carrier group, the signal processing unit 711 demodulates and decodes the data symbols and outputs received data 712.



FIG. 57 shows the structure of the OFDM related processors (5600_X, 5600_Y) in FIG. 56. A frequency converter (5701) receives, as input, a received signal (5700), performs frequency conversion, and outputs a frequency converted signal (5702).


A Fourier transformer (5703) receives, as input, the frequency converted signal (5702), performs a Fourier transform, and outputs a Fourier transformed signal (5704).


As described above, when using a multi-carrier transmission scheme such as an OFDM scheme, carriers are divided into a plurality of carrier groups, and the transmission scheme is set for each carrier group, thereby allowing for the reception quality and transmission speed to be set for each carrier group, which yields the advantageous effect of construction of a flexible system. In this case, as described in other embodiments, allowing for choice of a scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices offers the advantages of obtaining high reception quality, as well as high transmission speed, in an LOS environment. While in the present embodiment, the transmission schemes to which a carrier group can be set are “a spatial multiplexing MIMO system, a MIMO scheme using a fixed precoding matrix, a MIMO scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices, space-time block coding, or a transmission scheme for transmitting only stream s1”, but the transmission schemes are not limited in this way. Furthermore, the space-time coding is not limited to the scheme described with reference to FIG. 50, nor is the MIMO scheme using a fixed precoding matrix limited to scheme #2 in FIG. 49, as any structure with a fixed precoding matrix is acceptable. In the present embodiment, the case of two antennas in the transmission device has been described, but when the number of antennas is larger than two as well, the same advantageous effects may be achieved by allowing for selection of a transmission scheme for each carrier group from among “a spatial multiplexing MIMO system, a MIMO scheme using a fixed precoding matrix, a MIMO scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices, space-time block coding, or a transmission scheme for transmitting only stream s1”.



FIGS. 58A and 58B show a scheme of allocation into carrier groups that differs from FIGS. 47A, 47B, 48A, 48B, and 51. In FIGS. 47A, 47B, 48A, 48B, 51, 55A, and 55B, carrier groups have described as being formed by groups of subcarriers. In FIGS. 58A and 58B, on the other hand, the carriers in a carrier group are arranged discretely. FIGS. 58A and 58B show an example of frame structure in the time and frequency domains that differs from FIGS. 47A, 47B, 48A, 48B, 51, 55A, and 55B. FIGS. 58A and 58B show the frame structure for carriers 1 through H, times $1 through $K. Elements that are similar to FIGS. 55A and 55B bear the same reference signs. Among the data symbols in FIGS. 58A and 58B, the “A” symbols are symbols in carrier group A, the “B” symbols are symbols in carrier group B, the “C” symbols are symbols in carrier group C, and the “D” symbols are symbols in carrier group D. The carrier groups can thus be similarly implemented by discrete arrangement along (sub)carriers, and the same carrier need not always be used in the time domain. This type of arrangement yields the advantageous effect of obtaining time and frequency diversity gain.


In FIGS. 47A, 47B, 48A, 48B, 51, 58A, and 58B, the control information symbols and the individual control information symbols are allocated to the same time in each carrier group, but these symbols may be allocated to different times. Furthermore, the number of (sub)carriers used by a carrier group may change over time.


Embodiment 16

Like Embodiment 10, the present embodiment describes a scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices using a unitary matrix when N is an odd number.


In the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices over a period (cycle) with 2N slots, the precoding matrices prepared for the 2N slots are represented as follows.









Math





294














for





i

=
0

,
1
,
2
,





,

N
-
2

,

N
-

1


:











F


[
i
]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j







θ
11



(
i
)







α
×

e

j


(



θ
11



(
i
)


+
λ

)









α
×

e

j







θ
21



(
i
)








e

j


(



θ
21



(
i
)


+
λ
+
π

)






)







Equation





253







Let α be a fixed value (not depending on i), where α>0.









Math





295














for





i

=
N

,

N
+
1

,

N
+
2

,





,


2

N

-
2

,


2

N

-

1


:











F


[
i
]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




α
×

e

j







θ
11



(
i
)








e

j


(



θ
11



(
i
)


+
λ

)








e

j







θ
21



(
i
)







α
×

e

j


(



θ
21



(
i
)


+
λ
+
π

)







)







Equation





254







Let α be a fixed value (not depending on i), where α>0. (Let the α in Equation 253 and the α in Equation 254 be the same value.)


From Condition #5 (Math 106) and Condition #6 (Math 107) in Embodiment 3, the following conditions are important in Equation 253 for achieving excellent data reception quality.

Math 296
ej(θ11(x)-θ21(x))≠ej(θ11(y)-θ21(y)) for ∀x,∀y (x≠y; x, y=0,1,2, . . . , N−2, N−1)  Condition #46


(x is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; y is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; and x≠y)

Math 297
ej(θ11(x)-θ21(x)-π)≠ej(θ11(y)-θ21(y)-π) for ∀x,∀y (x≠y; x, y=0,1,2, . . . , N−2, N−1)  Condition #47


(x is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; y is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; and x≠y)


Addition of the following condition is considered.

Math 298
θ11(x)=θ11(x+N) for ∀x (x=0,1,2, . . . , N−2, N−1)
and
θ21(y)=θ21(y+N) for ∀y (y=0,1,2, . . . , N−2, N−1)  Condition #48


Next, in order to distribute the poor reception points evenly with regards to phase in the complex plane, as described in Embodiment 6, Condition #49 and Condition #50 are provided.









Math





299














e

j


(



θ
11



(

x
+
1

)


-


θ
21



(

x
+
1

)



)




e

j


(



θ
11



(
x
)


-


θ
21



(
x
)



)




=

e

j


(


2

π

N

)










for








x


(


x
=
0

,
1
,
2
,





,

N
-
2


)








Condition





#49






Math





300














e

j


(



θ
11



(

x
+
1

)


-


θ
21



(

x
+
1

)



)




e

j


(



θ
11



(
x
)


-


θ
21



(
x
)



)




=

e

j


(

-


2

π

N


)










for








x


(


x
=
0

,
1
,
2
,





,

N
-
2


)








Condition





#50







In other words, Condition #49 means that the difference in phase is 2π/N radians. On the other hand, Condition #50 means that the difference in phase is −2π/N radians.


Letting θ11(0)-θ21(0)=0 radians, and letting α>1, the distribution of poor reception points for s1 and for s2 in the complex plane for N=3 is shown in FIGS. 60A and 60B. As is clear from FIGS. 60A and 60B, in the complex plane, the minimum distance between poor reception points for s1 is kept large, and similarly, the minimum distance between poor reception points for s2 is also kept large. Similar conditions are created when α<1. Furthermore, upon comparison with FIGS. 45A and 45B in Embodiment 10, making the same considerations as in Embodiment 9, the probability of a greater distance between poor reception points in the complex plane increases when N is an odd number as compared to when N is an even number. However, when N is small, for example when N≤16, the minimum distance between poor reception points in the complex plane can be guaranteed to be a certain length, since the number of poor reception points is small. Accordingly, when N≤16, even if N is an even number, cases do exist where data reception quality can be guaranteed.


Therefore, in the scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices based on Equations 253 and 254, when N is set to an odd number, the probability of improving data reception quality is high. Precoding matrices F[0]-F[2N−1] are generated based on Equations 253 and 254 (the precoding matrices F[0]-F[2N−1] may be in any order for the 2N slots in the period (cycle)). Symbol number 2Ni may be precoded using F[0], symbol number 2Ni+1 may be precoded using F[1], . . . , and symbol number 2N×i+h may be precoded using F[h], for example (h=0, 1, 2, . . . , 2N−2, 2N−1). (In this case, as described in previous embodiments, precoding matrices need not be hopped between regularly.) Furthermore, when the modulation scheme for both s1 and s2 is 16QAM, if α is set as in Equation 233, the advantageous effect of increasing the minimum distance between 16×16=256 signal points in the I-Q plane for a specific LOS environment may be achieved.


The following conditions are possible as conditions differing from Condition #48:

Math 301
ej(θ11(x)-θ21(x))≠ej(θ11(y)-θ21(y)) for ∀x,∀y (x≠y; x, y=N, N+1, N+2, . . . , 2N−2, 2N−1)  Condition #51

(where x is N,N+1, N+2, . . . , 2N−2, 2N−1; y is N,N+1, N+2, . . . , 2N−2, 2N−1; and x≠y)

Math 302
ej(θ11(x)-θ21(x)-π)≠ej(θ11(y)-θ21(y)-π) for ∀x,∀y (x≠y; x, y=N, N+1, N+2, . . . , 2N−2, 2N−1)   Condition #52

(where x is N,N+1, N+2, . . . , 2N−2, 2N−1; y is N,N+1, N+2, . . . , 2N−2, 2N−1; and x≠y)


In this case, by satisfying Condition #46, Condition #47, Condition #51, and Condition #52, the distance in the complex plane between poor reception points for s1 is increased, as is the distance between poor reception points for s2, thereby achieving excellent data reception quality.


In the present embodiment, the scheme of structuring 2N different precoding matrices for a precoding hopping scheme with a 2N-slot time period (cycle) has been described. In this case, as the 2N different precoding matrices, F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[2N−2], F[2N−1] are prepared. In the present embodiment, an example of a single carrier transmission scheme has been described, and therefore the case of arranging symbols in the order F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[2N−2], F[2N−1] in the time domain (or the frequency domain) has been described. The present invention is not, however, limited in this way, and the 2N different precoding matrices F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[2N−2], F[2N−1] generated in the present embodiment may be adapted to a multi-carrier transmission scheme such as an OFDM transmission scheme or the like. As in Embodiment 1, as a scheme of adaption in this case, precoding weights may be changed by arranging symbols in the frequency domain and in the frequency-time domain. Note that a precoding hopping scheme with a 2N-slot time period (cycle) has been described, but the same advantageous effects may be obtained by randomly using 2N different precoding matrices. In other words, the 2N different precoding matrices do not necessarily need to be used in a regular period (cycle).


Furthermore, in the precoding matrix hopping scheme over an H-slot period (cycle) (H being a natural number larger than the number of slots 2N in the period (cycle) of the above scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices), when the 2N different precoding matrices of the present embodiment are included, the probability of excellent reception quality increases.


Embodiment 17

The present embodiment describes a concrete example of the scheme of regularly changing precoding weights, based on Embodiment 8.



FIG. 6 relates to the weighting scheme (precoding scheme) in the present embodiment. The weighting unit 600 integrates the weighting units 308A and 308B in FIG. 3. As shown in FIG. 6, the stream s1(t) and the stream s2(t) correspond to the baseband signals 307A and 307B in FIG. 3. In other words, the streams s1(t) and s2(t) are the baseband signal in-phase components I and quadrature components Q when mapped according to a modulation scheme such as QPSK, 16QAM, 64QAM, or the like. As indicated by the frame structure of FIG. 6, in the stream s1(t), a signal at symbol number u is represented as s1(u), a signal at symbol number u+1 as s1(u+1), and so forth. Similarly, in the stream s2(t), a signal at symbol number u is represented as s2(u), a signal at symbol number u+1 as s2(u+1), and so forth. The weighting unit 600 receives the baseband signals 307A (s1(t)) and 307B (s2(t)) and the information 315 regarding weighting information in FIG. 3 as inputs, performs weighting in accordance with the information 315 regarding weighting, and outputs the signals 309A (z1(t)) and 309B (z2(t)) after weighting in FIG. 3.


At this point, when for example a precoding matrix hopping scheme with an N=8 period (cycle) as in Example #8 in Embodiment 6 is used, z1(t) and z2(t) are represented as follows. For symbol number 8i (where i is an integer greater than or equal to zero):









Math





303












(




z





1


(

8

i

)







z





2


(

8

i

)





)

=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j







i





π

4







e

j


(



k





π

4

+


7

π

8


)






)



(




s





1


(

8

i

)







s





2


(

8

i

)





)






Equation





255







Here, j is an imaginary unit, and k=0.


For symbol number 8i+1:














Math





304













(




z





1


(


8

i

+
1

)







z





2


(


8

i

+
1

)





)

=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j







i





π

4







e

j


(



k





π

4

+


7

π

8


)






)



(




s





1


(


8

i

+
1

)







s





2


(


8

i

+
1

)





)






Equation





256







Here, k=1.


For symbol number 8i+2:














Math





305













(




z





1


(


8

i

+
2

)







z





2


(


8

i

+
2

)





)

=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j







i





π

4







e

j


(



k





π

4

+


7

π

8


)






)



(




s





1


(


8

i

+
2

)







s





2


(


8

i

+
2

)





)






Equation





257







Here, k=2.


For symbol number 8i+3:














Math





306













(




z





1


(


8

i

+
3

)







z





2


(


8

i

+
3

)





)

=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j







i





π

4







e

j


(



k





π

4

+


7

π

8


)






)



(




s





1


(


8

i

+
3

)







s





2


(


8

i

+
3

)





)






Equation





258







Here, k=3.


For symbol number 8i+4:














Math





307













(




z





1


(


8

i

+
4

)







z





2


(


8

i

+
4

)





)

=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j







i





π

4







e

j


(



k





π

4

+


7

π

8


)






)



(




s





1


(


8

i

+
4

)







s





2


(


8

i

+
4

)





)






Equation





259







Here, k=4.


For symbol number 8i+5:














Math





308













(




z





1


(


8

i

+
5

)







z





2


(


8

i

+
5

)





)

=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j







i





π

4







e

j


(



k





π

4

+


7

π

8


)






)



(




s





1


(


8

i

+
5

)







s





2


(


8

i

+
5

)





)






Equation





260







Here, k=5.


For symbol number 8i+6:














Math





309













(




z





1


(


8

i

+
6

)







z





2


(


8

i

+
6

)





)

=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j







i





π

4







e

j


(



k





π

4

+


7

π

8


)






)



(




s





1


(


8

i

+
6

)







s





2


(


8

i

+
6

)





)






Equation





261







Here, k=6.


For symbol number 8i+7:














Math





310













(




z





1


(


8

i

+
7

)







z





2


(


8

i

+
7

)





)

=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j







i





π

4







e

j


(



k





π

4

+


7

π

8


)






)



(




s





1


(


8

i

+
7

)







s





2


(


8

i

+
7

)





)






Equation





262







Here, k=7.


The symbol numbers shown here can be considered to indicate time. As described in other embodiments, in Equation 262, for example, z1(8i+7) and z2(8i+7) at time 8i+7 are signals at the same time, and the transmission device transmits z1(8i+7) and z2(8i+7) over the same (shared/common) frequency. In other words, letting the signals at time T be s1(T), s2(T), z1(T), and z2(T), then z1(T) and z2(T) are sought from some sort of precoding matrices and from s1(T) and s2(T), and the transmission device transmits z1(T) and z2(T) over the same (shared/common) frequency (at the same time). Furthermore, in the case of using a multi-carrier transmission scheme such as OFDM or the like, and letting signals corresponding to s1, s2, z1, and z2 for (sub)carrier L and time T be s1(T, L), s2(T, L), z1(T, L), and z2(T, L), then z1(T, L) and z2(T, L) are sought from some sort of precoding matrices and from s1(T, L) and s2(T, L), and the transmission device transmits z1(T, L) and z2(T, L) over the same (shared/common) frequency (at the same time). In this case, the appropriate value of α is given by Equation 198 or Equation 200. Also, different values of α may be set in Equations 255-262. That is to say, when two equations (Equations X and Y) are extracted from Equations 255-262, the value of α given by Equation X may be different from the value of α given by Equation Y.


The present embodiment describes a precoding hopping scheme that increases period (cycle) size, based on the above-described precoding matrices of Equation 190.


Letting the period (cycle) of the precoding hopping scheme be 8M, 8M different precoding matrices are represented as follows.














Math





311













F


[


8
×
k

+
i

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j


(



i





π

4

+


k





π


4

M



)







e

j


(



i





π

4

+


k





π


4

M


+


7

π

8


)






)






Equation





263







In this case, i=0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, and k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1.


For example, letting M=2 and α<1, the poor reception points for s1 (◯) and for s2 (□) at k=0 are represented as in FIG. 42A. Similarly, the poor reception points for s1 (◯) and for s2 (□) at k=1 are represented as in FIG. 42B. In this way, based on the precoding matrices in Equation 190, the poor reception points are as in FIG. 42A, and by using, as the precoding matrices, the matrices yielded by multiplying each term in the second line on the right-hand side of Equation 190 by ejX (see Equation 226), the poor reception points are rotated with respect to FIG. 42A (see FIG. 42B). (Note that the poor reception points in FIG. 42A and FIG. 42B do not overlap. Even when multiplying by ejX, the poor reception points should not overlap, as in this case. Furthermore, the matrices yielded by multiplying each term in the first line on the right-hand side of Equation 190, rather than in the second line on the right-hand side of Equation 190, by ejX may be used as the precoding matrices.) In this case, the precoding matrices F[0]-F[15] are represented as follows.














Math





312













F


[


8
×
k

+
i

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j


(



i





π

4

+
Xk

)







e

j


(



i





π

4

+
Xk
+


7

π

8


)






)






Equation





264







Here, i=0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, and k=0, 1.


In this case, when M=2, precoding matrices F[0]-F[15] are generated (the precoding matrices F[0]-F[15] may be in any order. Also, matrices F[0]-F[15] may be different matrices). Symbol number 16i may be precoded using F[0], symbol number 16i+1 may be precoded using F[1], . . . , and symbol number 16i+h may be precoded using F[h], for example (h=0, 1, 2, . . . , 14, 15). (In this case, as described in previous embodiments, precoding matrices need not be hopped between regularly.) Summarizing the above considerations, with reference to Equations 82-85, N-period (cycle) precoding matrices are represented by the following equation.









Math





313












F


[
i
]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j







θ
11



(
i
)







α
×

e

j


(



θ
11



(
i
)


+
λ

)









α
×

e

j







θ
21



(
i
)








e

j


(



θ
21



(
i
)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)






Equation





265







Here, since the period (cycle) has N slots, i=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1. Furthermore, the N×M period (cycle) precoding matrices based on Equation 265 are represented by the following equation.














Math





314













F


[


N
×
k

+
i

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j







θ
11



(
i
)







α
×

e

j


(



θ
11



(
i
)


+
λ

)









α
×

e

j






(



θ
21



(
i
)


+

X
k


)







e

j


(



θ
21



(
i
)


+

X
k

+
λ
+
δ

)






)






Equation





266







In this case, i=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1, and k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1.


In this case, precoding matrices F[0]-F[N×M−1] are generated. (Precoding matrices F[0]-F[N×M−1] may be in any order for the N×M slots in the period (cycle)). Symbol number N×M×i may be precoded using F[0], symbol number N×M×i+1 may be precoded using F[1], . . . , and symbol number N×M×i+h may be precoded using F[h], for example (h=0, 1, 2, . . . , N×M−2, N×M−1). (In this case, as described in previous embodiments, precoding matrices need not be hopped between regularly.)


Generating the precoding matrices in this way achieves a precoding matrix hopping scheme with a large period (cycle), allowing for the position of poor reception points to be easily changed, which may lead to improved data reception quality. Note that while the N×M period (cycle) precoding matrices have been set to Equation 266, the N×M period (cycle) precoding matrices may be set to the following equation, as described above.














Math





315













F


[


N
×
k

+
i

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j






(



θ
11



(
i
)


+

X
k


)






α
×

e

j


(



θ
11



(
i
)


+

X
k

+
λ

)









α
×

e

j







θ
21



(
i
)








e

j


(



θ
21



(
i
)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)






Equation





267







In this case, i=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1, and k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1.


In Equations 265 and 266, when 0 radians ≤δ<2π radians, the matrices are a unitary matrix when δ=π radians and are a non-unitary matrix when δ ≠π radians. In the present scheme, use of a non-unitary matrix for π/2 radians ≤|δ|<π radians is one characteristic structure (the conditions for δ being similar to other embodiments), and excellent data reception quality is obtained. However, not limited to this, a unitary matrix may be used instead.


In the present embodiment, as one example of the case where λ is treated as a fixed value, a case where λ=0 radians is described. However, in view of the mapping according to the modulation scheme, λ may be set to a fixed value defined as λ=π/2 radians, λ=π radians, or λ=(3π)/2 radians. (For example, λ may be set to a fixed value defined as λ=π radians in the precoding matrices of the precoding scheme in which hopping between precoding matrices is performed regularly.) With this structure, as is the case where λ is set to a value defined as λ=0 radians, a reduction in circuit size is achieved.


Embodiment 18

The present embodiment describes a scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices using a unitary matrix based on Embodiment 9.


As described in Embodiment 8, in the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices over a period (cycle) with N slots, the precoding matrices prepared for the N slots with reference to Equations 82-85 are represented as follows.









Math





316












F


[
i
]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j







θ
11



(
i
)







α
×

e

j


(



θ
11



(
i
)


+
λ

)









α
×

e

j







θ
21



(
i
)








e

j


(



θ
21



(
i
)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)






Equation





268







In this case, i=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1. (α>0.) Since a unitary matrix is used in the present embodiment, the precoding matrices in Equation 268 may be represented as follows.









Math





317












F


[
i
]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j







θ
11



(
i
)







α
×

e

j


(



θ
11



(
i
)


+
λ

)









α
×

e

j







θ
21



(
i
)








e

j


(



θ
21



(
i
)


+
λ
+
π

)






)






Equation





269







In this case, i=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1. (α>0.) From Condition #5 (Math 106) and Condition #6 (Math 107) in Embodiment 3, the following condition is important for achieving excellent data reception quality.

Math 318
ej(θ11(x)-θ21(x))≠ej(θ11(y)-θ21(y)) for ∀x,∀y (x≠y; x, y=0,1,2, . . . , N−2, N−1)  Condition #53

(x is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; y is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; and x≠y)

Math 319
ej(θ11(x)-θ21(x)-π)≠ej(θ11(y)-θ21(y)-π) for ∀x,∀y (x≠y; x, y=0,1,2, . . . , N−2, N−1) (x is 0,1,2, . . . , N−2, N−1; y is 0,1,2, . . . , N−2, N−1; and x≠y)  Condition #54


Embodiment 6 has described the distance between poor reception points. In order to increase the distance between poor reception points, it is important for the number of slots N to be an odd number three or greater. The following explains this point.


In order to distribute the poor reception points evenly with regards to phase in the complex plane, as described in Embodiment 6, Condition #55 and Condition #56 are provided.









Math





320














e

j


(



θ
11



(

x
+
1

)


-


θ
21



(

x
+
1

)



)




e

j


(



θ
11



(
x
)


-


θ
21



(
x
)



)




=

e

j


(


2

π

N

)










for








x


(


x
=
0

,
1
,
2
,





,

N
-
2


)








Condition





#55






Math





321














e

j


(



θ
11



(

x
+
1

)


-


θ
21



(

x
+
1

)



)




e

j


(



θ
11



(
x
)


-


θ
21



(
x
)



)




=

e

j


(

-


2

π

N


)










for








x


(


x
=
0

,
1
,
2
,





,

N
-
2


)








Condition





#56







Letting θ11(0)-θ21(0)=0 radians, and letting α<1, the distribution of poor reception points for s1 and for s2 in the complex plane for an N=3 period (cycle) is shown in FIG. 43A, and the distribution of poor reception points for s1 and for s2 in the complex plane for an N=4 period (cycle) is shown in FIG. 43B. Letting θ11(0)-θ21(0)=0 radians, and letting α>1, the distribution of poor reception points for s1 and for s2 in the complex plane for an N=3 period (cycle) is shown in FIG. 44A, and the distribution of poor reception points for s1 and for s2 in the complex plane for an N=4 period (cycle) is shown in FIG. 44B.


In this case, when considering the phase between a line segment from the origin to a poor reception point and a half line along the real axis defined by real ≥0 (see FIG. 43A), then for either α>1 or α<1, when N=4, the case always occurs wherein the phase for the poor reception points for s1 and the phase for the poor reception points for s2 are the same value. (See 4301, 4302 in FIG. 43B, and 4401, 4402 in FIG. 44B.) In this case, in the complex plane, the distance between poor reception points becomes small. On the other hand, when N=3, the phase for the poor reception points for s1 and the phase for the poor reception points for s2 are never the same value.


Based on the above, considering how the case always occurs wherein the phase for the poor reception points for s1 and the phase for the poor reception points for s2 are the same value when the number of slots N in the period (cycle) is an even number, setting the number of slots N in the period (cycle) to an odd number increases the probability of a greater distance between poor reception points in the complex plane as compared to when the number of slots N in the period (cycle) is an even number. However, when the number of slots N in the period (cycle) is small, for example when N≤16, the minimum distance between poor reception points in the complex plane can be guaranteed to be a certain length, since the number of poor reception points is small. Accordingly, when N≤16, even if N is an even number, cases do exist where data reception quality can be guaranteed.


Therefore, in the scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices based on Equation 269, when the number of slots N in the period (cycle) is set to an odd number, the probability of improving data reception quality is high. Precoding matrices F[0]-F[N−1] are generated based on Equation 269 (the precoding matrices F[0]-F[N−1] may be in any order for the N slots in the period (cycle)). Symbol number Ni may be precoded using F[0], symbol number Ni+1 may be precoded using F[1], . . . , and symbol number N×i+h may be precoded using F[h], for example (h=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1). (In this case, as described in previous embodiments, precoding matrices need not be hopped between regularly.) Furthermore, when the modulation scheme for both s1 and s2 is 16QAM, if α is set as follows,









Math





322











α
=



2

+
4



2

+
2






Equation





270








the advantageous effect of increasing the minimum distance between 16×16=256 signal points in the I-Q plane for a specific LOS environment may be achieved.



FIG. 94 shows signal point layout in the I-Q plane for 16QAM. In FIG. 94, signal point 9400 is a signal point when bits to be transmitted (input bits) b0-b3 represent a value “(b0, b1, b2, b3)=(1, 0, 0, 0)” (as shown in FIG. 94), and its coordinates in the I-Q plane are (−3×g, 3×g). With regard to the signal points other than signal point 9400, the bits to be transmitted and the coordinates in the I-Q plane can be identified from FIG. 94.



FIG. 95 shows signal point layout in the I-Q plane for QPSK. In FIG. 95, signal point 9500 is a signal point when bits to be transmitted (input bits) b0 and b1 represent a value “(b0, b1)=(1, 0)” (as shown in FIG. 95), and its coordinates in the I-Q plane are (−1×g, 1×g). With regard to the signal points other than signal point 9500, the bits to be transmitted and the coordinates in the I-Q plane can be identified from FIG. 95.


Also, when the modulation scheme for s1 is QPSK modulation and the modulation scheme for s2 is 16QAM, if α is set as follows,









Math





323











α
=



2

+
3
+

5




2

+
3
-

5







Equation





271








the advantageous effect of increasing the minimum distance between candidate signal points in the I-Q plane for a specific LOS environment may be achieved.


Note that a signal point layout in the I-Q plane for 16QAM is shown in FIG. 94, and a signal point layout in the I-Q plane for QPSK is shown in FIG. 95. Here, if g in FIG. 94 is set as follows,









Math





324











g
=

z

10






Equation





272








h in FIG. 94 is obtained as follows.









Math





325











h
=

z

2






Equation





273







As an example of the precoding matrices prepared for the N slots based on Equation 269, the following matrices are considered:









Math





326












F


[

i
=
0

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j





0






e

j





π





)






Equation





274






Math





327












F


[

i
=
1

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j


2
5


π






e

j


(



2
5


π

+
π

)






)






Equation





275






Math





328












F


[

i
=
2

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j


4
5


π






e

j


(



4
5


π

+
π

)






)






Equation





276






Math





329












F


[

i
=
3

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j


6
5


π






e

j


(



6
5


π

+
π

)






)






Equation





277






Math





330












F


[

i
=
4

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j


8
5


π






e

j


(



8
5


π

+
π

)






)






Equation





278







Note that, in order to restrict the calculation scale of the above precoding in the transmission device, θ11(i)=0 radians and λ=0 radians may be set in Equation 269. In this case, however, in Equation 269, λ may vary depending on i, or may be the same value. That is to say, in Equation 269, λ in F[i=x] and X F[i=y] (x≠y) may be the same value or may be different values.


As the value to which α is set, the above-described set value is one of effective values. However, not limited to this, α may be set, for example, for each value of i in the precoding matrix F[i] as described in Embodiment 17. (That is to say, in F[i], α is not necessarily be always set to a constant value for i).


In the present embodiment, the scheme of structuring N different precoding matrices for a precoding hopping scheme with an N-slot time period (cycle) has been described. In this case, as the N different precoding matrices, F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[N−2], F[N−1] are prepared. In the single carrier transmission scheme, symbols are arranged in the order F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[N−2], F[N−1] in the time domain (or the frequency domain in the case of the multi-carrier transmission scheme). The present invention is not, however, limited in this way, and the N different precoding matrices F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[N−2], F[N−1] generated in the present embodiment may be adapted to a multi-carrier transmission scheme such as an OFDM transmission scheme or the like. As in Embodiment 1, as a scheme of adaptation in this case, precoding weights may be changed by arranging symbols in the frequency domain and in the frequency-time domain. Note that a precoding hopping scheme with an N-slot time period (cycle) has been described, but the same advantageous effects may be obtained by randomly using N different precoding matrices. In other words, the N different precoding matrices do not necessarily need to be used in a regular period (cycle).


Furthermore, in the precoding matrix hopping scheme over an H-slot period (cycle) (H being a natural number larger than the number of slots N in the period (cycle) of the above scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices), when the N different precoding matrices of the present embodiment are included, the probability of excellent reception quality increases. In this case, Condition #55 and Condition #56 can be replaced by the following conditions. (The number of slots in the period (cycle) is considered to be N)

Math 331
ej(θ11(x)-θ21(x))≠ej(θ11(y)-θ21(y)) for ∃x,∃y (x≠y; x, y=0,1,2, . . . , N−2, N−1)  Condition #55′

(x is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; y is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; and x≠y)

Math 332
ej(θ11(x)-θ21(x)-π)≠ej(θ11(y)-θ21(y)-π) for ∃x,∃y (x≠y; x, y=0,1,2, . . . , N−2, N−1)  Condition #56′

(x is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; y is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; and x≠y)


In the present embodiment, as one example of the case where λ is treated as a fixed value, a case where λ=0 radians is described. However, in view of the mapping according to the modulation scheme, λ may be set to a fixed value defined as λ=π/2 radians, λ=π radians, or λ=(3π)/2 radians. (For example, λ may be set to a fixed value defined as λ=π radians in the precoding matrices of the precoding scheme in which hopping between precoding matrices is performed regularly.) With this structure, as is the case where λ is set to a value defined as λ=0 radians, a reduction in circuit size is achieved.


Embodiment 19

The present embodiment describes a scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices using a unitary matrix based on Embodiment 10.


In the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices over a period (cycle) with 2N slots, the precoding matrices prepared for the 2N slots are represented as follows.









Math





333














When





i

=
0

,
1
,
2
,





,

N
-
2

,

N
-

1


:











F


[
i
]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j







θ
11



(
i
)







α
×

e

j


(



θ
11



(
i
)


+
λ

)









α
×

e

j







θ
21



(
i
)








e

j


(



θ
21



(
i
)


+
λ
+
π

)






)







Equation





279








α>0, and α is a fixed value (regardless of i).









Math





334














When





i

=
N

,

N
+
1

,

N
+
2

,





,


2

N

-
2

,


2

N

-

1


:











F


[
i
]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




α
×

e

j







θ
11



(
i
)








e

j


(



θ
11



(
i
)


+
λ

)








e

j







θ
21



(
i
)







α
×

e

j


(



θ
21



(
i
)


+
λ
+
π

)







)







Equation





380








α>0, and α is a fixed value (regardless of i).


(The value of α in Equation 279 is the same as the value of α in Equation 280)


(The value of α may be set as α<0.)


From Condition #5 (Math 106) and Condition #6 (Math 107) in Embodiment 3, the following condition is important for achieving excellent data reception quality.

Math 335
ej(θ11(x)-θ21(x))≠ej(θ11(y)-θ21(y)) for ∀x,∀y (x≠y; x, y=0,1,2, . . . , N−2, N−1)  Condition #57

(x is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; y is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; and x≠y)

Math 336
ej(θ11(x)-θ21(x)-π)≠ej(θ11(y)-θ21(y)-π) for ∀x,∀y (x≠y; x, y=0,1,2, . . . , N−2, N−1) (x is 0,1,2, . . . , N−2, N−1; y is 0,1,2, . . . , N−2, N−1; and x≠y)  Condition #58


Addition of the following condition is considered.

Math 337
θ11(x)=θ11(x+N) for ∀x (x=0,1,2, . . . , N−2, N−1)
and
θ21(y)=θ21(y+N) for ∀y (y=0,1,2, . . . , N−2, N−1)  Condition #59


Next, in order to distribute the poor reception points evenly with regards to phase in the complex plane, as described in Embodiment 6, Condition #60 and Condition #61 are provided.









Math





338














e

j


(



θ
11



(

x
+
1

)


-


θ
21



(

x
+
1

)



)




e

j


(



θ
11



(
x
)


-


θ
21



(
x
)



)




=

e

j


(


2

π

N

)










for








x


(


x
=
0

,
1
,
2
,





,

N
-
2


)








Condition





#60






Math





339














e

j


(



θ
11



(

x
+
1

)


-


θ
21



(

x
+
1

)



)




e

j


(



θ
11



(
x
)


-


θ
21



(
x
)



)




=

e

j


(

-


2

π

N


)










for








x


(


x
=
0

,
1
,
2
,





,

N
-
2


)








Condition





#61







Letting θ11(0)-θ21(0)=0 radians, and letting α>1, the distribution of poor reception points for s1 and for s2 in the complex plane for N=4 is shown in FIGS. 43A and 43B. As is clear from FIGS. 43A and 43B, in the complex plane, the minimum distance between poor reception points for s1 is kept large, and similarly, the minimum distance between poor reception points for s2 is also kept large. Similar conditions are created when α<1. Furthermore, making the same considerations as in Embodiment 9, the probability of a greater distance between poor reception points in the complex plane increases when N is an odd number as compared to when N is an even number. However, when N is small, for example when N≤16, the minimum distance between poor reception points in the complex plane can be guaranteed to be a certain length, since the number of poor reception points is small. Accordingly, when N≤16, even if N is an even number, cases do exist where data reception quality can be guaranteed.


Therefore, in the scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices based on Equations 279 and 280, when N is set to an odd number, the probability of improving data reception quality is high. Note that precoding matrices F[0]-F[2N−1] have been generated based on Equations 279 and 280. (The precoding matrices F[0]-F[2N−1] may be in any order for the 2N slots in the period (cycle)). Symbol number 2Ni may be precoded using F[0], symbol number 2Ni+1 may be precoded using F[1], . . . , and symbol number 2N×i+h may be precoded using F[h], for example (h=0, 1, 2, . . . , 2N−2, 2N−1). (In this case, as described in previous embodiments, precoding matrices need not be hopped between regularly.) Furthermore, when the modulation scheme for both s1 and s2 is 16QAM, if α is set as in Equation 270, the advantageous effect of increasing the minimum distance between 16×16=256 signal points in the I-Q plane for a specific LOS environment may be achieved.


Also, when the modulation scheme for s1 is QPSK modulation and the modulation scheme for s2 is 16QAM, if α is set as in Equation 271, the advantageous effect of increasing the minimum distance between candidate signal points in the I-Q plane for a specific LOS environment may be achieved. Note that a signal point layout in the I-Q plane for 16QAM is shown in FIG. 60, and a signal point layout in the I-Q plane for QPSK is shown in FIG. 94. Here, if “g” in FIG. 60 is set as in Equation 272, follows, “h” in FIG. 94 is obtained as in Equation 273.


The following conditions are possible as conditions differing from Condition #59:

Math 340
ej(θ11(x)-θ21(x))≠ej(θ11(y)-θ21(y)) for ∀x,∀y (x≠y; x, y=N, N+1, N+2, . . . , 2N−2, 2N−1)  Condition #62

(x is N, N+1, N+2, . . . , 2N−2, 2N−1; y is N, N+1, N+2, . . . , 2N−2, 2N−1; and x≠y)

Math 341
ej(θ11(x)-θ21(x)-π)≠ej(θ11(y)-θ21(y)-π) for θx,∀y (x≠y; x, y=N, N+1, N+2, . . . , 2N−2, 2N−1)   Condition #63

(x is N, N+1, N+2, . . . , 2N−2, 2N−1; y is N, N+1, N+2, . . . , 2N−2, 2N−1; and x≠y.)


In this case, by satisfying Condition #57 and Condition #58 and Condition #62 and Condition #63, the distance in the complex plane between poor reception points for s1 is increased, as is the distance between poor reception points for s2, thereby achieving excellent data reception quality.


As an example of the precoding matrices prepared for the 2N slots based on Equations 279 and 280, the following matrices are considered when N=15:









Math





342












F


[

i
=
0

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j





0






e

j





π





)






Equation





281






Math





343












F


[

i
=
1

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j


2
15


π






e

j


(



2
15


π

+
π

)






)






Equation





282






Math





344












F


[

i
=
2

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j


4
15


π






e

j


(



4
15


π

+
π

)






)






Equation





283






Math





345












F


[

i
=
3

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j


6
15


π






e

j


(



6
15


π

+
π

)






)






Equation





284






Math





346












F


[

i
=
4

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j


8
15


π






e

j


(



8
15


π

+
π

)






)






Equation





285






Math





347












F


[

i
=
5

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j


10
15


π






e

j


(



10
15


π

+
π

)






)






Equation





286






Math





348












F


[

i
=
6

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j


12
15


π






e

j


(



12
15


π

+
π

)






)






Equation





287






Math





349












F


[

i
=
7

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j


14
15


π






e

j


(



14
15


π

+
π

)






)






Equation





288






Math





350












F


[

i
=
8

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j


16
15


π






e

j


(



16
15


π

+
π

)






)






Equation





289






Math





351












F


[

i
=
9

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j


18
15


π






e

j


(



18
15


π

+
π

)






)






Equation





290






Math





352












F


[

i
=
10

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j


20
15


π






e

j


(



20
15


π

+
π

)






)






Equation





291






Math





353












F


[

i
=
11

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j


22
15


π






e

j


(



22
15


π

+
π

)






)






Equation





292






Math





354












F


[

i
=
12

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j


24
15


π






e

j


(



24
15


π

+
π

)






)






Equation





293






Math





355












F


[

i
=
13

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j


26
15


π






e

j


(



26
15


π

+
π

)






)






Equation





294






Math





356












F


[

i
=
14

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j


28
15


π






e

j


(



28
15


π

+
π

)






)






Equation





295






Math





357












F


[

i
=
15

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




α
×

e

j





0






e

j





π







e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0






)






Equation





296






Math





358












F


[

i
=
16

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




α
×

e

j


2
15


π






e

j


(



2
15


π

+
π

)








e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0






)






Equation





297






Math





359












F


[

i
=
17

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




α
×

e

j


4
15


π






e

j


(



4
15


π

+
π

)








e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0






)






Equation





298






Math





360












F


[

i
=
18

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




α
×

e

j


6
15


π






e

j


(



6
15


π

+
π

)








e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0






)






Equation





299






Math





361












F


[

i
=
19

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




α
×

e

j


8
15


π






e

j


(



8
15


π

+
π

)








e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0






)






Equation





300






Math





362












F


[

i
=
20

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




α
×

e

j


10
15


π






e

j


(



10
15


π

+
π

)








e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0






)






Equation





301






Math





363












F


[

i
=
21

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




α
×

e

j


12
15


π






e

j


(



12
15


π

+
π

)








e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0






)






Equation





302






Math





364












F


[

i
=
22

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




α
×

e

j


14
15


π






e

j


(



14
15


π

+
π

)








e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0






)






Equation





303






Math





365












F


[

i
=
23

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




α
×

e

j


16
15


π






e

j


(



16
15


π

+
π

)








e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0






)






Equation





304






Math





366












F


[

i
=
24

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




α
×

e

j


18
15


π






e

j


(



18
15


π

+
π

)








e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0






)






Equation





305






Math





367












F


[

i
=
25

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




α
×

e

j


20
15


π






e

j


(



20
15


π

+
π

)








e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0






)






Equation





306






Math





368












F


[

i
=
26

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




α
×

e

j


22
15


π






e

j


(



22
15


π

+
π

)








e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0






)






Equation





307






Math





369












F


[

i
=
27

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




α
×

e

j


24
15


π






e

j


(



24
15


π

+
π

)








e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0






)






Equation





308






Math





370












F


[

i
=
28

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




α
×

e

j


26
15


π






e

j


(



26
15


π

+
π

)








e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0






)






Equation





309






Math





371












F


[

i
=
29

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




α
×

e

j


28
15


π






e

j


(



28
15


π

+
π

)








e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0






)






Equation





310







Note that, in order to restrict the calculation scale of the above precoding in the transmission device, θ11(i)=0 radians and λ=0 radians may be set in Equation 279, and θ21(i)=0 radians and λ=0 radians may be set in Equation 280.


In this case, however, in Equations 279 and 280, λ may be set as a value that varies depending on i, or may be set as the same value. That is to say, in Equations 279 and 280, λ in F[i=x] and λ in F[i=y] (x≠y) may be the same value or may be different values. As another scheme, λ is set as a fixed value in Equation 279, λ is set as a fixed value in Equation 280, and the fixed values of λ in Equations 279 and 280 are set as different values. (As still another scheme, the fixed values of λ in Equations 279 and 280 are used.)


As the value to which α is set, the above-described set value is one of effective values. However, not limited to this, α may be set, for example, for each value of i in the precoding matrix F[i] as described in Embodiment 17. (That is to say, in F[i], α is not necessarily be always set to a constant value for i.)


In the present embodiment, the scheme of structuring 2N different precoding matrices for a precoding hopping scheme with a 2N-slot time period (cycle) has been described. In this case, as the 2N different precoding matrices, F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[2N−2], F[2N−1] are prepared. In the single carrier transmission scheme, symbols are arranged in the order F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[2N−2], F[2N−1] in the time domain (or the frequency domain in the case of the multi-carrier transmission scheme). The present invention is not, however, limited in this way, and the 2N different precoding matrices F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[2N−2], F[2N−1] generated in the present embodiment may be adapted to a multi-carrier transmission scheme such as an OFDM transmission scheme or the like. As in Embodiment 1, as a scheme of adaptation in this case, precoding weights may be changed by arranging symbols in the frequency domain and in the frequency-time domain. Note that a precoding hopping scheme with a 2N-slot time period (cycle) has been described, but the same advantageous effects may be obtained by randomly using 2N different precoding matrices. In other words, the 2N different precoding matrices do not necessarily need to be used in a regular period (cycle).


Furthermore, in the precoding matrix hopping scheme over an H-slot period (cycle) (H being a natural number larger than the number of slots 2N in the period (cycle) of the above scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices), when the 2N different precoding matrices of the present embodiment are included, the probability of excellent reception quality increases.


In the present embodiment, as one example of the case where λ is treated as a fixed value, a case where λ=0 radians is described. However, in view of the mapping according to the modulation scheme, λ may be set to a fixed value defined as λ=π/2 radians, λ=π radians, or λ=(3π)/2 radians. (For example, λ may be set to a fixed value defined as λ=π radians in the precoding matrices of the precoding scheme in which hopping between precoding matrices is performed regularly.) With this structure, as is the case where λ is set to a value defined as λ=0 radians, a reduction in circuit size is achieved.


Embodiment 20

The present embodiment describes a scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices using a unitary matrix based on Embodiment 13.


In the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices over a period (cycle) with 2N slots, the precoding matrices prepared for the 2N slots are represented as follows.









Math





372














When





i

=
0

,
1
,
2
,





,

N
-
2

,

N
-

1


:











F


[
i
]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j







θ
11



(
i
)







α
×

e

j


(



θ
11



(
i
)


+
λ

)









α
×

e

j







θ
21



(
i
)








e

j


(



θ
21



(
i
)


+
λ
+
δ

)






)







Equation





311







Let α be a fixed value (not depending on i), where α>0.









Math





373














When





i

=
N

,

N
+
1

,

N
+
2

,





,


2

N

-
2

,


2

N

-

1


:











F


[
i
]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




α
×

e

j


(



θ
11



(
i
)


+
λ

)







e

j







θ
11



(
i
)









e

j


(



θ
21



(
i
)


+
λ
+
δ

)






α
×

e

j







θ
21



(
i
)








)







Equation





312







Let α be a fixed value (not depending on i), where α>0. (The value of α may be set as α<0.)


Furthermore, the 2×N×M period (cycle) precoding matrices based on Equations 311 and 312 are represented by the following equations.














Math





374




















When





i

=
0

,
1
,
2
,





,

N
-
2

,

N
-

1


:











F


[


2
×
N
×
k

+
i

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j







θ
11



(
i
)







α
×

e

j


(



θ
11



(
i
)


+
λ

)









α
×

e

j


(



θ
21



(
i
)


+

X
k


)







e

j


(



θ
21



(
i
)


+

X
k

+
λ
+
δ

)






)








Equation





313







In this case, k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1.














Math





375




















When





i

=
N

,

N
+
1

,

N
+
2

,





,


2

N

-
2

,


2

N

-

1


:











F


[


2
×
N
×
k

+
i

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




α
×

e

j


(



θ
11



(
i
)


+
λ

)







e

j







θ
11



(
i
)









e

j


(



θ
21



(
i
)


+
λ
+
δ
+

Y
k


)






α
×

e

j







θ
21



(

i
+

Y
k


)








)








Equation





314







In this case, k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1. Furthermore, Xk=Yk may be true, or Xk≠Yk may be true.


In this case, precoding matrices F[0]-F[2N×M−1] are generated. (Precoding matrices F[0]-F[2×N×M−1] may be in any order for the 2×N×M slots in the period (cycle)). Symbol number 2×N×M×i may be precoded using F[0], symbol number 2×N×M×i+1 may be precoded using F[1], . . . , and symbol number 2×N×M×i+h may be precoded using F[h], for example (h=0, 1, 2, . . . , 2×N×M−2, 2×N×M−1). (In this case, as described in previous embodiments, precoding matrices need not be hopped between regularly.)


Generating the precoding matrices in this way achieves a precoding matrix hopping scheme with a large period (cycle), allowing for the position of poor reception points to be easily changed, which may lead to improved data reception quality.


The 2×N×M period (cycle) precoding matrices in Equation 313 may be changed to the following equation.














Math





376




















When





i

=
N

,

N
+
1

,

N
+
2

,





,


2

N

-
2

,


2

N

-

1


:











F


[


2
×
N
×
k

+
i

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




α
×

e

j


(



θ
11



(
i
)


+
λ

)







e

j







θ
11



(
i
)









e

j


(



θ
21



(
i
)


+
λ
+
δ
+

Y
k


)






α
×

e

j


(



θ
21



(
i
)


+

Y
k


)







)








Equation





315







In this case, k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1.


The 2×N×M period (cycle) precoding matrices in Equation 314 may also be changed to any of Equations 316-318.














Math





377




















When





i

=
N

,

N
+
1

,

N
+
2

,





,


2

N

-
2

,


2

N

-

1


:











F


[


2
×
N
×
k

+
i

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




α
×

e

j


(



θ
11



(
i
)


+
λ
+

Y
k


)







e

j


(



θ
11



(
i
)


+

Y
k


)








e

j


(



θ
21



(
i
)


+
λ
+
δ

)






α
×

e

j







θ
21



(
i
)








)








Equation





316







In this case, k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1.














Math





378




















When





i

=
N

,

N
+
1

,

N
+
2

,





,


2

N

-
2

,


2

N

-

1


:











F


[


2
×
N
×
k

+
i

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




α
×

e

j







θ
11



(
i
)








e

j


(



θ
11



(
i
)


+
λ

)








e

j


(



θ
21



(
i
)


+

Y
k


)






α
×

e

j


(



θ
21



(
i
)


+
λ
-
δ
+

Y
k


)







)








Equation





317







In this case, k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1.














Math





379




















When





i

=
N

,

N
+
1

,

N
+
2

,





,


2

N

-
2

,


2

N

-

1


:











F


[


2
×
N
×
k

+
i

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




α
×

e

j


(



θ
11



(
i
)


+

Y
k


)







e

j


(



θ
11



(
i
)


+
λ
+

Y
k


)








e

j







θ
21



(
i
)







α
×

e

j


(



θ
21



(
i
)


+
λ
-
δ

)







)








Equation





318







In this case, k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1.


Focusing on poor reception points, if Equations 313 through 318 satisfy the following conditions,

Math 380
ej(θ11(x)-θ21(x))≠ej(θ11(y)-θ21(y)) for ∀x,∀y (x≠y; x, y=0,1,2, . . . , N−2, N−1)  Condition #64

(x is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; y is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; and x≠y)

Math 381
ej(θ11(x)-θ21(x)-δ)≠ej(θ11(y)-θ21(y)-δ) for ∀x,∀y (x≠y; x, y=0,1,2, . . . , N−2, N−1)  Condition #65

(x is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; y is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; and x≠y)

Math 382
θ11(x)=θ11(x+N) for ∀x (x=0,1,2, . . . , N−2, N−1)
and
θ21(y)=θ21(y+N) for ∀y (y=0,1,2, . . . , N−2, N−1)  Condition #66

then excellent data reception quality is achieved. Note that in Embodiment 8, Condition #39 and Condition #40 should be satisfied.


Focusing on Xk and Yk, if Equations 313 through 318 satisfy the following conditions,

Math 383
Xa≠Xb+2×s×π for ∀a,∀b (a≠b; a,b=0,1,2, . . . ,M−2,M−1)  Condition #67

(a is 0, 1, 2, . . . , M−2, M−1; b is 0, 1, 2, . . . , M−2, M−1; and a≠b) (Here, s is an integer)

Math 384
Ya≠Yb+2×u×π for ∀a,∀b (a≠b; a,b=0,1,2, . . . ,M−2,M−1)  Condition #68

(a is 0, 1, 2, . . . , M−2, M−1; b is 0, 1, 2, . . . , M−2, M−1; and a≠b) (Here, u is an integer),


then excellent data reception quality is achieved. Note that in Embodiment 8, Condition #42 should be satisfied. In Equations 313 and 318, when 0 radians ≤δ<2π radians, the matrices are a unitary matrix when δ=π radians and are a non-unitary matrix when δ≠π radians. In the present scheme, use of a non-unitary matrix for π/2 radians ≤|δ|<π radians is one characteristic structure, and excellent data reception quality is obtained, but use of a unitary matrix is also possible.


The following provides an example of precoding matrices in the precoding hopping scheme of the present embodiment. The following matrices are considered when N=5, M=2 as an example of the 2×N×M period (cycle) precoding matrices based on Equations 313 through 318:









Math





385












F


[

i
=
0

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j





0






e

j





π





)






Equatio





n





319






Math





386












F


[

i
=
1

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j






(


2
5


π

)







e

j


(



2
5






π

+
π

)






)






Equatio





n





320






Math





387












F


[

i
=
2

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j






(


4
5


π

)







e

j


(



4
5






π

+
π

)






)






Equatio





n





321






Math





388












F


[

i
=
3

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j






(


6
5


π

)







e

j


(



6
5






π

+
π

)






)






Equatio





n





322






Math





389












F


[

i
=
4

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j






(


8
5


π

)







e

j


(



8
5






π

+
π

)






)






Equatio





n





323






Math





390












F


[

i
=
5

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




α
×

e

j





0






e

j





π







e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0






)






Equatio





n





324






Math





391












F


[

i
=
6

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




α
×

e

j






2
5


π






e

j






(


2
5


π
×
π

)








e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0






)






Equatio





n





325






Math





392












F


[

i
=
7

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




α
×

e

j






4
5


π






e

j






(


4
5


π
×
π

)








e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0






)






Equatio





n





326






Math





393












F


[

i
=
8

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




α
×

e

j






6
5


π






e

j






(


6
5


π
×
π

)








e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0






)






Equatio





n





327






Math





394












F


[

i
=
9

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




α
×

e

j






8
5


π






e

j






(


8
5


π
×
π

)








e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0






)






Equatio





n





328






Math





395












F


[

i
=
10

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j






(

0
+
π

)







e

j


(

π
+
π

)






)






Equatio





n





329






Math





396












F


[

i
=
11

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j






(



2
5


π

+
π

)







e

j


(



2
5


π

+
π
+
π

)






)






Equatio





n





330






Math





397












F


[

i
=
12

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j






(



4
5


π

+
π

)







e

j


(



4
5


π

+
π
+
π

)






)






Equatio





n





331






Math





398












F


[

i
=
13

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j






(



6
5


π

+
π

)







e

j


(



6
5


π

+
π
+
π

)






)






Equatio





n





332






Math





399












F


[

i
=
14

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j






(



8
5


π

+
π

)







e

j


(



8
5


π

+
π
+
π

)






)






Equatio





n





333






Math





400












F


[

i
=
15

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




α
×

e

j





0






e

j





π







e

j






(

0
+
π

)






α
×

e

j


(

0
+
π

)







)






Equatio





n





334






Math





401












F


[

i
=
16

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




α
×

e

j






2
5


π






e

j


(



2
5


π

+
π

)








e

j






(

0
+
π

)






α
×

e

j


(

0
+
π

)







)






Equatio





n





335






Math





402












F


[

i
=
17

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




α
×

e

j






4
5


π






e

j


(



4
5


π

+
π

)








e

j






(

0
+
π

)






α
×

e

j


(

0
+
π

)







)






Equatio





n





336






Math





403












F


[

i
=
18

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




α
×

e

j






6
5


π






e

j


(



6
5


π

+
π

)








e

j






(

0
+
π

)






α
×

e

j


(

0
+
π

)







)






Equatio





n





337






Math





404












F


[

i
=
19

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




α
×

e

j






8
5


π






e

j


(



8
5


π

+
π

)








e

j






(

0
+
π

)






α
×

e

j


(

0
+
π

)







)






Equatio





n





338







In this way, in the above example, in order to restrict the calculation scale of the above precoding in the transmission device, λ=0 radians, δ=π radians, X1=0 radians, and X2=π radians are set in Equation 313, and λ=0 radians, δ=π radians, Y1=0 radians, and Y2=π radians are set in Equation 314. In this case, however, in Equations 313 and 314, λ may be set as a value that varies depending on i, or may be set as the same value. That is to say, in Equations 313 and 314, λ in F[i=x] and λ in F[i=y] (x≠y) may be the same value or may be different values. As another scheme, λ is set as a fixed value in Equation 313, λ is set as a fixed value in Equation 314, and the fixed values of λ in Equations 313 and 314 are set as different values. (As still another scheme, the fixed values of λ in Equations 313 and 314 are used.)


As the value to which α is set, the set value described in Embodiment 18 is one of effective values. However, not limited to this, α may be set, for example, for each value of i in the precoding matrix F[i] as described in Embodiment 17. (That is to say, in F[i], α is not necessarily be always set to a constant value for i.)


In the present embodiment, as one example of the case where λ is treated as a fixed value, a case where λ=0 radians is described. However, in view of the mapping according to the modulation scheme, λ may be set to a fixed value defined as λ=π/2 radians, λ=π radians, or λ=(3π)/2 radians. (For example, λ may be set to a fixed value defined as λ=π radians in the precoding matrices of the precoding scheme in which hopping between precoding matrices is performed regularly.) With this structure, as is the case where λ is set to a value defined as λ=0 radians, a reduction in circuit size is achieved.


Embodiment 21

The present embodiment describes an example of the precoding scheme of Embodiment 18 in which hopping between precoding matrices is performed regularly.


As an example of the precoding matrices prepared for the N slots based on Equation 269, the following matrices are considered:









Math





405












F


[

i
=
0

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j





0






e

j





π





)






Equatio





n





339






Math





406












F


[

i
=
1

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j






2
9


π






e

j






(



2
9


π

+
π

)






)






Equatio





n





340






Math





407












F


[

i
=
2

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j






4
9


π






e

j






(



4
9


π

+
π

)






)






Equatio





n





341






Math





408












F


[

i
=
3

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j






6
9


π






e

j






(



6
9


π

+
π

)






)






Equatio





n





342






Math





409












F


[

i
=
4

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j






8
9


π






e

j






(



8
9


π

+
π

)






)






Equatio





n





343






Math





410












F


[

i
=
5

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j






10
9


π






e

j






(



10
9


π

+
π

)






)






Equatio





n





344






Math





411












F


[

i
=
6

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j






12
9


π






e

j






(



12
9


π

+
π

)






)






Equatio





n





345






Math





412












F


[

i
=
7

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j






14
9


π






e

j






(



14
9


π

+
π

)






)






Equatio





n





346






Math





413












F


[

i
=
8

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j






16
9


π






e

j






(



16
9


π

+
π

)






)






Equatio





n





347







In the above equations, there is a special case where a can be set to 1. In this case, Equations 339 through 347 are represented as follows.









Math





414












F


[

i
=
0

]


=


1

2




(




e

j





0





e

j





0







e

j





0





e

j





π





)






Equatio





n





348






Math





415












F


[

i
=
1

]


=


1

2




(




e

j





0





e

j





0







e

j






2
9


π





e

j






(



2
9


π

+
π

)






)






Equatio





n





349






Math





416












F


[

i
=
2

]


=


1

2




(




e

j





0





e

j





0







e

j






4
9


π





e

j






(



4
9


π

+
π

)






)






Equatio





n





350






Math





417












F


[

i
=
3

]


=


1

2




(




e

j





0





e

j





0







e

j






6
9


π





e

j






(



6
9


π

+
π

)






)






Equatio





n





351






Math





418












F


[

i
=
4

]


=


1

2




(




e

j





0





e

j





0







e

j






8
9


π





e

j






(



8
9


π

+
π

)






)






Equatio





n





352






Math





419












F


[

i
=
5

]


=


1

2




(




e

j





0





e

j





0







e

j






10
9


π





e

j






(



10
9


π

+
π

)






)






Equatio





n





353






Math





420












F


[

i
=
6

]


=


1

2




(




e

j





0





e

j





0







e

j






12
9


π





e

j






(



12
9


π

+
π

)






)






Equatio





n





354






Math





421












F


[

i
=
7

]


=


1

2




(




e

j





0





e

j





0







e

j






14
9


π





e

j






(



14
9


π

+
π

)






)






Equatio





n





355






Math





422












F


[

i
=
8

]


=


1

2




(




e

j





0





e

j





0







e

j






16
9


π





e

j






(



16
9


π

+
π

)






)






Equatio





n





356







As another example, as an example of the precoding matrices prepared for the N slots based on Equation 269, the following matrices are considered when N=15:









Math





423












F


[

i
=
0

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j





0






e

j





π





)






Equatio





n





357






Math





424












F


[

i
=
1

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j






2
15


π






e

j






(



2
15


π

+
π

)






)






Equatio





n





358






Math





425












F


[

i
=
2

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j






4
15


π






e

j






(



4
15


π

+
π

)






)






Equatio





n





359






Math





426












F


[

i
=
3

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j






6
15


π






e

j






(



6
15


π

+
π

)






)






Equatio





n





360






Math





427












F


[

i
=
4

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j






8
15


π






e

j






(



8
15


π

+
π

)






)






Equatio





n





361






Math





428












F


[

i
=
5

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j






10
15


π






e

j






(



10
15


π

+
π

)






)






Equatio





n





362






Math





429












F


[

i
=
6

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j






12
15


π






e

j






(



12
15


π

+
π

)






)






Equatio





n





363






Math





430












F


[

i
=
7

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j






14
15


π






e

j






(



14
15


π

+
π

)






)






Equatio





n





364






Math





431












F


[

i
=
8

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j






16
15


π






e

j






(



16
15


π

+
π

)






)






Equatio





n





365






Math





432












F


[

i
=
9

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j






18
15


π






e

j






(



18
15


π

+
π

)






)






Equatio





n





366






Math





433












F


[

i
=
10

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j






20
15


π






e

j






(



20
15


π

+
π

)






)






Equatio





n





367






Math





434












F


[

i
=
11

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j






22
15


π






e

j






(



22
15


π

+
π

)






)






Equatio





n





368






Math





435












F


[

i
=
12

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j






24
9


π






e

j






(



24
9


π

+
π

)






)






Equatio





n





369






Math





436












F


[

i
=
13

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j






26
15


π






e

j






(



26
15


π

+
π

)






)






Equatio





n





370






Math





437












F


[

i
=
14

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j






28
15


π






e

j






(



28
15


π

+
π

)






)






Equatio





n





371







In the above equations, there is a special case where a can be set to 1. In this case, Equations 357 through 371 are represented as follows.









Math





438












F


[

i
=
0

]


=


1

2




(




e

j





0





e

j





0







e

j





0





e

j





π





)






Equatio





n





372






Math





439












F


[

i
=
1

]


=


1

2




(




e

j





0





e

j





0







e

j


2
15


π





e

j


(



2
15


π

+
π

)






)






Equatio





n





373






Math





440












F


[

i
=
2

]


=


1

2




(




e

j





0





e

j





0







e

j


4
15


π





e

j


(



4
15


π

+
π

)






)






Equatio





n





374






Math





441












F


[

i
=
3

]


=


1

2




(




e

j





0





e

j





0







e

j


6
15


π





e

j


(



6
15


π

+
π

)






)






Equatio





n





375






Math





442












F


[

i
=
4

]


=


1

2




(




e

j





0





e

j





0







e

j


8
15


π





e

j


(



8
15


π

+
π

)






)






Equatio





n





376






Math





443












F


[

i
=
5

]


=


1

2




(




e

j





0





e

j





0







e

j


10
15


π





e

j


(



10
15


π

+
π

)






)






Equatio





n





377






Math





444












F


[

i
=
6

]


=


1

2




(




e

j





0





e

j





0







e

j


12
15


π





e

j


(



12
15


π

+
π

)






)






Equatio





n





378






Math





445












F


[

i
=
7

]


=


1

2




(




e

j





0





e

j





0







e

j


14
15


π





e

j


(



14
15


π

+
π

)






)






Equatio





n





379






Math





446












F


[

i
=
8

]


=


1

2




(




e

j





0





e

j





0







e

j


16
15


π





e

j


(



16
15


π

+
π

)






)






Equatio





n





380






Math





447












F


[

i
=
9

]


=


1

2




(




e

j





0





e

j





0







e

j


18
15


π





e

j


(



18
15


π

+
π

)






)






Equatio





n





381






Math





448












F


[

i
=
10

]


=


1

2




(




e

j





0





e

j





0







e

j


20
15


π





e

j


(



20
15


π

+
π

)






)






Equatio





n





382






Math





449












F


[

i
=
11

]


=


1

2




(




e

j





0





e

j





0







e

j


22
15


π





e

j


(



22
15


π

+
π

)






)






Equatio





n





383






Math





450












F


[

i
=
12

]


=


1

2




(




e

j





0





e

j





0







e

j


24
9


π





e

j


(



24
9


π

+
π

)






)






Equatio





n





384






Math





451












F


[

i
=
13

]


=


1

2




(




e

j





0





e

j





0







e

j


26
15


π





e

j


(



26
15


π

+
π

)






)






Equatio





n





385






Math





452












F


[

i
=
14

]


=


1

2




(




e

j





0





e

j





0







e

j


28
15


π





e

j


(



28
15


π

+
π

)






)






Equatio





n





386







In the present example, α is set to 1. However, the value to which α is set is not limited to this. For example, the set value of α may be applied to the following case. That is to say, as shown in FIG. 3 or the like, the encoder performs an error correction coding. The value of α may be varied depending on the coding rate for error correction coding used in the error correction coding. For example, there is considered a scheme in which α is set to 1 when the coding rate is ½, and to a value other than 1 such as a value satisfying the relationship α>1 (or α<1) when the coding rate is ⅔. With this structure, in the reception device, excellent data reception quality may be achieved regardless of the coding rate. (Excellent data reception quality may be achieved even if α is set as a fixed value.)


As another example, as described in Embodiment 17, α may be set for each value of i in the precoding matrix F[i]. (That is to say, in F[i], α is not necessarily be always set to a constant value for i.)


In the present embodiment, the scheme of structuring N different precoding matrices for a precoding hopping scheme with an N-slot time period (cycle) has been described. In this case, as the N different precoding matrices, F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[N−2], F[N−1] are prepared. In the single carrier transmission scheme, symbols are arranged in the order F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[N−2], F[N−1] in the time domain (or the frequency domain in the case of the multi-carrier transmission scheme). The present invention is not, however, limited in this way, and the N different precoding matrices F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[N−2], F[N−1] generated in the present embodiment may be adapted to a multi-carrier transmission scheme such as an OFDM transmission scheme or the like. As in Embodiment 1, as a scheme of adaptation in this case, precoding weights may be changed by arranging symbols in the frequency domain and in the frequency-time domain. Note that a precoding hopping scheme with an N-slot time period (cycle) has been described, but the same advantageous effects may be obtained by randomly using N different precoding matrices. In other words, the N different precoding matrices do not necessarily need to be used in a regular period (cycle).


Embodiment 22

The present embodiment describes an example of the precoding scheme of Embodiment 19 in which hopping between precoding matrices is performed regularly.


As an example of the precoding matrices prepared for the 2N slots based on Equations 279 and 280, the following matrices are considered when N=9:









Math





453












F


[

i
=
0

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j





0






e

j





π





)






Equation





387






Math





454












F


[

i
=
1

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j






2
9


π






e

j






(



2
9


π

+
π

)






)






Equation





388






Math





455












F


[

i
=
2

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j






4
9


π






e

j






(



4
9


π

+
π

)






)






Equation





389






Math





456












F


[

i
=
3

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j






6
9


π






e

j






(



6
9


π

+
π

)






)






Equation





390






Math





457












F


[

i
=
4

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j






8
9


π






e

j






(



8
9


π

+
π

)






)






Equation





391






Math





458












F


[

i
=
5

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j






10
9


π






e

j






(



10
9


π

+
π

)






)






Equation





392






Math





459












F


[

i
=
6

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j






12
9


π






e

j






(



12
9


π

+
π

)






)






Equation





393






Math





460












F


[

i
=
7

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j






14
9


π






e

j






(



14
9


π

+
π

)






)






Equation





394






Math





461












F


[

i
=
8

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j






16
9


π






e

j






(



16
9


π

+
π

)






)






Equation





395






Math





462












F


[

i
=
9

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




α
×

e

j





0






e

j





π







e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0






)






Equation





396






Math





463












F


[

i
=
10

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




α
×

e

j






2
9


π






e

j






(



2
9


π

+
π

)








e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0






)






Equation





397






Math





464












F


[

i
=
11

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




α
×

e

j






4
9


π






e

j






(



4
9


π

+
π

)








e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0






)






Equation





398






Math





465












F


[

i
=
12

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




α
×

e

j






6
9


π






e

j






(



6
9


π

+
π

)








e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0






)






Equation





399






Math





466












F


[

i
=
13

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




α
×

e

j






8
9


π






e

j






(



8
9


π

+
π

)








e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0






)






Equation





400






Math





467












F


[

i
=
14

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




α
×

e

j






10
9


π






e

j






(



10
9


π

+
π

)








e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0






)






Equation





401






Math





468












F


[

i
=
15

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




α
×

e

j






12
9


π






e

j






(



12
9


π

+
π

)








e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0






)






Equation





402






Math





469












F


[

i
=
16

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




α
×

e

j






14
9


π






e

j






(



14
9


π

+
π

)








e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0






)






Equation





403






Math





470












F


[

i
=
17

]


=


1



α
2

+
1





(




α
×

e

j






16
9


π






e

j






(



16
9


π

+
π

)








e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0






)






Equation





404







In the above equations, there is a special case where a can be set to 1. In this case, Equations 387 through 404 are represented as follows.









Math





471












F


[

i
=
0

]


=


1

2




(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j





0






e

j





π





)






Equation





405






Math





472












F


[

i
=
1

]


=


1

2




(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j






2
9


π






e

j






(



2
9


π

+
π

)






)






Equation





406






Math





473












F


[

i
=
2

]


=


1

2




(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j






4
9


π






e

j






(



4
9


π

+
π

)






)






Equation





407






Math





474












F


[

i
=
3

]


=


1

2




(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j






6
9


π






e

j






(



6
9


π

+
π

)






)






Equation





408






Math





475












F


[

i
=
4

]


=


1

2




(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j






8
9


π






e

j






(



8
9


π

+
π

)






)






Equation





409






Math





476












F


[

i
=
5

]


=


1

2




(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j






10
9


π






e

j






(



10
9


π

+
π

)






)






Equation





410






Math





477












F


[

i
=
6

]


=


1

2




(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j






12
9


π






e

j






(



12
9


π

+
π

)






)






Equation





411






Math





478












F


[

i
=
7

]


=


1

2




(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j






14
9


π






e

j






(



14
9


π

+
π

)






)






Equation





412






Math





479












F


[

i
=
8

]


=


1

2




(




e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0








α
×

e

j






16
9


π






e

j






(



16
9


π

+
π

)






)






Equation





413






Math





480












F


[

i
=
9

]


=


1

2




(




α
×

e

j





0






e

j





π







e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0






)






Equation





414






Math





481












F


[

i
=
10

]


=


1

2




(




α
×

e

j






2
9


π






e

j






(



2
9


π

+
π

)








e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0






)






Equation





415






Math





482












F


[

i
=
11

]


=


1

2




(




α
×

e

j






4
9


π






e

j






(



4
9


π

+
π

)








e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0






)






Equation





416






Math





483












F


[

i
=
12

]


=


1

2




(




α
×

e

j






6
9


π






e

j






(



6
9


π

+
π

)








e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0






)






Equation





417






Math





484












F


[

i
=
13

]


=


1

2




(




α
×

e

j






8
9


π






e

j






(



8
9


π

+
π

)








e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0






)






Equation





418






Math





485












F


[

i
=
14

]


=


1

2




(




α
×

e

j






10
9


π






e

j






(



10
9


π

+
π

)








e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0






)






Equation





419






Math





486












F


[

i
=
15

]


=


1

2




(




α
×

e

j






12
9


π






e

j






(



12
9


π

+
π

)








e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0






)






Equation





420






Math





487












F


[

i
=
16

]


=


1

2




(




α
×

e

j






14
9


π






e

j






(



14
9


π

+
π

)








e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0






)






Equation





421






Math





488












F


[

i
=
17

]


=


1

2




(




α
×

e

j






16
9


π






e

j






(



16
9


π

+
π

)








e

j





0





α
×

e

j





0






)






Equation





422







Also, α may be set to 1 in Equations 281 through 310 presented in Embodiment 19. As the value to which α is set, the above-described set value is one of effective values. However, not limited to this, α may be set, for example, for each value of i in the precoding matrix F[i] as described in Embodiment 17. (That is to say, in F[i], α is not necessarily be always set to a constant value for i.)


In the present embodiment, the scheme of structuring 2N different precoding matrices for a precoding hopping scheme with a 2N-slot time period (cycle) has been described. In this case, as the 2N different precoding matrices, F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[2N−2], F[2N−1] are prepared. In the single carrier transmission scheme, symbols are arranged in the order F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[2N−2], F[2N−1] in the time domain (or the frequency domain in the case of the multi-carrier transmission scheme). The present invention is not, however, limited in this way, and the 2N different precoding matrices F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[2N−2], F[2N−1] generated in the present embodiment may be adapted to a multi-carrier transmission scheme such as an OFDM transmission scheme or the like. As in Embodiment 1, as a scheme of adaptation in this case, precoding weights may be changed by arranging symbols in the frequency domain and in the frequency-time domain. Note that a precoding hopping scheme with a 2N-slot time period (cycle) has been described, but the same advantageous effects may be obtained by randomly using 2N different precoding matrices. In other words, the 2N different precoding matrices do not necessarily need to be used in a regular period (cycle).


Furthermore, in the precoding matrix hopping scheme over an H-slot period (cycle) (H being a natural number larger than the number of slots 2N in the period (cycle) of the above scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices), when the 2N different precoding matrices of the present embodiment are included, the probability of excellent reception quality increases.


Embodiment 23

In Embodiment 9, a scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices with use of a unitary matrix has been described. In the present embodiment, a scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices with use of a matrix different from that in Embodiment 9 is described.


First, a precoding matrix F, a basic precoding matrix, is expressed by the following equation.









Math





489











F
=

(




A
×

e

j






μ
11







B
×

e

j






μ
12









C
×

e

j






μ
21






0



)





Equation





423







In Equation 423, A, B, and C are real numbers, μ11, μ12, and μ21 are real numbers, and the units of them are radians. In the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices over a period (cycle) with N slots, the precoding matrices prepared for the N slots are represented as follows.









Math





490












F


[
i
]


=

(




A
×

e

j






(


μ
11

+


θ
11



(
i
)



)







B
×

e

j


(


μ
12

+


θ
11



(
i
)



)









C
×

e

j


(


μ
21

+


θ
21



(
i
)



)






0



)





Equation





424







In this case, i=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1. Also, A, B, and C are fixed values regardless of i, and μ11, μ12, and μ21 are fixed values regardless of i. If a matrix represented by the format of Equation 424 is treated as a precoding matrix, “0” is present as one element of the precoding matrix, thus it has an advantageous effect that the poor reception points described in other embodiments can be reduced.


Also, another basic precoding matrix different from that expressed by Equation 423 is expressed by the following equation.









Math





491











F
=

(




A
×

e

j






μ
11







B
×

e

j






μ
12








0



D
×

e

j






μ
22







)





Equation





425







In Equation 425, A, B, and C are real numbers, μ11, μ12, and μ22 are real numbers, and the units of them are radians. In the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices over a period (cycle) with N slots, the precoding matrices prepared for the N slots are represented as follows.









Math





492












F


[
i
]


=

(




A
×

e

j






(


μ
11

+


θ
11



(
i
)



)







B
×

e

j


(


μ
12

+


θ
11



(
i
)



)








0



D
×

e

j


(


μ
22

+


θ
21



(
i
)



)







)





Equation





426







In this case, i=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1. Also, A, B, and D are fixed values regardless of i, and μ11, μ12, and μ22 are fixed values regardless of i. If a matrix represented by the format of Equation 426 is treated as a precoding matrix, “0” is present as one element of the precoding matrix, thus it has an advantageous effect that the poor reception points described in other embodiments can be reduced.


Also, another basic precoding matrix different from those expressed by Equations 423 and 425 is expressed by the following equation.









Math





493











F
=

(




A
×

e

j






μ
11






0





C
×

e

j






μ
21







D
×

e

j






μ
22







)





Equation





427







In Equation 427, A, C, and D are real numbers, μ11, μ21, and μ22 are real numbers, and the units of them are radians. In the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices over a period (cycle) with N slots, the precoding matrices prepared for the N slots are represented as follows.









Math





494












F


[
i
]


=

(




A
×

e

j






(


μ
11

+


θ
11



(
i
)



)






0





C
×

e

j


(


μ
21

+


θ
21



(
i
)



)







D
×

e

j


(


μ
22

+


θ
21



(
i
)



)







)





Equation





428







In this case, i=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1. Also, A, C, and D are fixed values regardless of i, and μ11, μ21, and μ22 are fixed values regardless of i. If a matrix represented by the format of Equation 428 is treated as a precoding matrix, “0” is present as one element of the precoding matrix, thus it has an advantageous effect that the poor reception points described in other embodiments can be reduced.


Also, another basic precoding matrix different from those expressed by Equations 423, 425, and 427 is expressed by the following equation.









Math





495











F
=

(



0



B
×

e

j






μ
12









C
×

e

j






μ
21







D
×

e

j






μ
22







)





Equation





429







In Equation 429, B, C, and D are real numbers, μ12, μ21, and μ22 are real numbers, and the units of them are radians. In the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices over a period (cycle) with N slots, the precoding matrices prepared for the N slots are represented as follows.









Math





496












F


[
i
]


=

(



0



B
×

e

j


(


μ
12

+


θ
11



(
i
)



)









C
×

e

j


(


μ
21

+


θ
21



(
i
)



)







D
×

e

j


(


μ
22

+


θ
21



(
i
)



)







)





Equation





430







In this case, i=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1. Also, B, C, and D are fixed values regardless of i, and μ12, μ21, and μ22 are fixed values regardless of i. If a matrix represented by the format of Equation 430 is treated as a precoding matrix, “0” is present as one element of the precoding matrix, thus it has an advantageous effect that the poor reception points described in other embodiments can be reduced. From Condition #5 (Math 106) and Condition #6 (Math 107) in Embodiment 3, the following conditions are important for achieving excellent data reception quality.

Math 497
ej(θ11(x)-θ21(x))≠ej(θ11(y)-θ21(y)) for ∀x,∀y (x≠y; x, y=0,1,2, . . . , N−2, N−1)  Condition #69

(x is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; y is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; and x≠y)

Math 498
ej(θ11(x)-θ21(x)-π)≠ej(θ11(y)-θ21(y)-π) for ∀x,∀y (x≠y; x, y=0,1,2, . . . , N−2, N−1)  Condition #70

(x is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; y is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; and x≠y)


In order to distribute the poor reception points evenly with regards to phase in the complex plane, as described in Embodiment 6, Condition #71 and Condition #72 are provided.









Math





499














e

j


(



θ
11



(

x
+
1

)


-


θ
21



(

x
+
1

)



)




e

j


(



θ
11



(
x
)


-


θ
21



(
x
)



)




=


e

j


(


2

π

N

)








for














x


(


x
=
0

,
1
,
2
,





,

N
-
2


)







Condition





#71






Math





500














e

j


(



θ
11



(

x
+
1

)


-


θ
21



(

x
+
1

)



)




e

j


(



θ
11



(
x
)


-


θ
21



(
x
)



)




=


e

j


(

-


2

π

N


)








for














x


(


x
=
0

,
1
,
2
,





,

N
-
2


)







Condition





#72







With this structure, the reception device can avoid poor reception points in the LOS environment, and thus can obtain the advantageous effect of improving the data reception quality.


Note that, as an example of the above-described scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices, there is a scheme for fixing θ11(i) to 0 radians (θ11(i) is set to a constant value regardless of i. In this case, θ11(i) may be set to a value other than 0 radians) so that θ11(i) and θ21(i) satisfy the above-described conditions. Also, there is a scheme for not fixing θ11(i) to 0 radians, but fixing θ21(i) to 0 radians (θ21(i) is set to a constant value regardless of i. In this case, θ21(i) may be set to a value other than 0 radians) so that θ11(i) and θ21(i) satisfy the above-described conditions.


The present embodiment describes the scheme of structuring N different precoding matrices for a precoding hopping scheme with an N-slot time period (cycle). In this case, as the N different precoding matrices, F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[N−2], F[N−1] are prepared. In a single carrier transmission scheme, symbols are arranged in the order F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[N−2], F[N−1] in the time domain (or the frequency domain in the case of multi-carrier transmission scheme). However, this is not the only example, and the N different precoding matrices F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[N−2], F[N−1] generated according to the present embodiment may be adapted to a multi-carrier transmission scheme such as an OFDM transmission scheme or the like. As in Embodiment 1, as a scheme of adaption in this case, precoding weights may be changed by arranging symbols in the frequency domain or in the frequency-time domains. Note that a precoding hopping scheme with an N-slot time period (cycle) has been described, but the same advantageous effects may be obtained by randomly using N different precoding matrices. In other words, the N different precoding matrices do not necessarily need to be used in a regular period (cycle).


Furthermore, in the precoding matrix hopping scheme over an H-slot period (cycle) (H being a natural number larger than the number of slots N in the period (cycle) of the above scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices), when the N different precoding matrices of the present embodiment are included, the probability of excellent reception quality increases. In this case, Condition #69 and Condition #70 can be replaced by the following conditions. (The number of slots in the period (cycle) is considered to be N)

Math 501
ej(θ11(x)-θ21(x))≠ej(θ11(y)-θ21(y)) for ∃x,∃y (x≠y; x, y=0,1,2, . . . , N−2, N−1)  Condition #73


(x is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; y is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; and x≠y)

Math 502
ej(θ11(x)-θ21(x)-π)≠ej(θ11(y)-θ21(y)-π) for ∃x,∃y (x≠y; x, y=0,1,2, . . . , N−2, N−1)  Condition #74


(x is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; y is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; and x≠y)


Embodiment 24

In Embodiment 10, the scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices using a unitary matrix is described. However, the present embodiment describes a scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices using a matrix different from that used in Embodiment 10.


In the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices over a period (cycle) with 2N slots, the precoding matrices prepared for the 2N slots are represented as follows.









Math





503












Here
,

i
=
0

,
1
,
2
,





,

N
-
2

,

N
-
1.









F


[
i
]


=

(




A
×

e

j






(


μ
11

+


θ
11



(
i
)



)







B
×

e

j


(


μ
12

+


θ
11



(
i
)



)









C
×

e

j


(


μ
21

+


θ
21



(
i
)



)






0



)






Equation





431







Here, let A, B, and C be real numbers, and μ11, μ12, and μ21 be real numbers expressed in radians. In addition, A, B, and C are fixed values not depending on i. Similarly, μ11, μ12, and μ21 are fixed values not depending on i.









Math





504












For
,

i
=
N

,

N
+
1

,

N
+
2

,





,


2

N

-
2

,


2

N

-

1


:











F


[
i
]


=

(




α
×

e

j






(


v
11

+


ψ
11



(
i
)



)







β
×

e

j


(


v
12

+


ψ
11



(
i
)



)








0



δ
×

e

j


(


v
22

+


ψ
21



(
i
)



)







)






Equation





432







Here, let α, β, and δ be real numbers, and ν11, ν12, and ν22 be real numbers expressed in radians. In addition, α, β, and δ are fixed values not depending on i. Similarly, ν11, ν12, and ν22 are fixed values not depending on i.


The precoding matrices prepared for the 2N slots different from those in Equations 431 and 432 are represented by the following equations.









Math





505












For
,

i
=
0

,
1
,
2
,





,

N
-
2

,

N
-

1


:











F


[
i
]


=

(




A
×

e

j






(


μ
11

+


θ
11



(
i
)



)







B
×

e

j


(


μ
12

+


θ
11



(
i
)



)









C
×

e

j


(


μ
21

+


θ
21



(
i
)



)






0



)






Equation





433







Here, let A, B, and C be real numbers, and μ11, μ12, and μ21 be real numbers expressed in radians. In addition, A, B, and C are fixed values not depending on i. Similarly, μ11, μ12, and μ21 are fixed values not depending on i.










Math





506








F

or

,

i
=
N

,

N
+
1

,

N
+
2

,





,


2

N

-
2

,


2

N

-

1


:
















F


[
i
]


=

(



0



β
×

e

j


(


v
12

+


ψ
11



(
i
)



)









γ
×

e

j


(


v
21

+


ψ
21



(
i
)



)







δ
×

e

j


(


v
22

+


ψ
21



(
i
)



)







)





Equation





434







Here, let β, γ, and δ be real numbers, and ν12, ν21, and ν22 be real numbers expressed in radians. In addition, β, γ, and δ are fixed values not depending on i. Similarly, ν12, ν21, and ν22 are fixed values not depending on i.


The precoding matrices prepared for the 2N slots different from those described above are represented by the following equations.










Math





507








F

or

,

i
=
0

,
1
,
2
,





,

N
-
2

,

N
-

1


:
















F


[
i
]


=

(




A
×

e

j


(


μ
11

+


θ
11



(
i
)



)






0





C
×

e

j


(


μ
21

+


θ
21



(
i
)



)







D
×

e

j


(


μ
22

+


θ
21



(
i
)



)







)





Equation





435







Here, let A, C, and D be real numbers, and μ11, μ21, and μ22 be real numbers expressed in radians. In addition, A, C, and D are fixed values not depending on i. Similarly, μ11, μ21, and μ22 are fixed values not depending on i.










Math





508








F

or

,

i
=
N

,

N
+
1

,

N
+
2

,





,


2

N

-
2

,


2

N

-

1


:
















F


[
i
]


=

(




α
×

e

j


(


v
11

+


ψ
11



(
i
)



)







β
×

e

j


(


v
12

+


ψ
11



(
i
)



)








0



δ
×

e

j


(


v
22

+


ψ
21



(
i
)



)







)





Equation





436







Here, let α, β, and δ be real numbers, and ν11, ν12, and ν22 be real numbers expressed in radians. In addition, α, β, and δ are fixed values not depending on i. Similarly, ν11, ν12, and ν22 are fixed values not depending on i.


The precoding matrices prepared for the 2N slots different from those described above are represented by the following equations.










Math





509








F

or

,

i
=
0

,
1
,
2
,





,

N
-
2

,

N
-

1


:
















F


[
i
]


=

(




A
×

e

j


(


μ
11

+


θ
11



(
i
)



)






0





C
×

e

j


(


μ
21

+


θ
21



(
i
)



)







D
×

e

j


(


μ
22

+


θ
21



(
i
)



)







)





Equation





437







Here, let A, C, and D be real numbers, and μ11, μ21, and μ22 be real numbers expressed in radians. In addition, A, C, and D are fixed values not depending on i. Similarly, μ11, μ21, and μ22 are fixed values not depending on i.










Math





510








F

or

,

i
=
N

,

N
+
1

,

N
+
2

,





,


2

N

-
2

,


2

N

-

1


:
















F


[
i
]


=

(



0



β
×

e

j


(


v
12

+


ψ
11



(
i
)



)









γ
×

e

j


(


v
21

+


ψ
21



(
i
)



)







δ
×

e

j


(


v
22

+


ψ
21



(
i
)



)







)





Equation





438







Here, let β, γ, and δ be real numbers, and ν12, ν21, and ν22 be real numbers expressed in radians. In addition, β, γ, and δ are fixed values not depending on i. Similarly, ν12, ν21, and ν22 are fixed values not depending on i.


Making the same considerations as in Condition #5 (Math 106) and Condition #6 (Math 107) of Embodiment 3, the following conditions are important for achieving excellent data reception quality.

Math 511
ej(θ11(x)-θ21(x))≠ej(θ11(y)-θ21(y)) for ∀x,∀y (x≠y; x, y=0,1,2, . . . , N−2, N−1)  Condition #75


(x is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; y is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; and x≠y)

Math 512
ej(Ψ11(x)-Ψ21(x))≠ej(Ψ11(y)-Ψ21(y)) for ∀x,∀y (x≠y; x, y=N,N+1,N+2, . . . ,2N−2,2N−1)  Condition #76


(x is N, N+1, N+2, . . . , 2N−2, 2N−1; y is N, N+1, N+2, . . . , 2N−2, 2N−1; and x≠y)


Next, in order to distribute the poor reception points evenly with regards to phase in the complex plane, as described in Embodiment 6, Condition #77 or Condition #78 is provided.









Math





513














e

j


(



θ
11



(

x
+
1

)


-


θ
21



(

x
+
1

)



)




e

j


(



θ
11



(
x
)


-


θ
21



(
x
)



)




=

e

j


(


2

π

N

)














for








x


(


x
=
0

,
1
,
2
,





,

N
-
2


)








Condition





#77






Math





514














e

j


(



θ
11



(

x
+
1

)


-


θ
21



(

x
+
1

)



)




e

j


(



θ
11



(
x
)


-


θ
21



(
x
)



)




=

e

j


(

-


2

π

N


)














for








x


(


x
=
0

,
1
,
2
,





,

N
-
2


)








Condition





#78







Similarly, in order to distribute the poor reception points evenly with regards to phase in the complex plane, Condition #79 or Condition #80 is provided.









Math





515














e

j


(



ψ
11



(

x
+
1

)


-


ψ
21



(

x
+
1

)



)




e

j


(



ψ
11



(
x
)


-


ψ
21



(
x
)



)




=

e

j


(


2

π

N

)














for








x


(


x
=
N

,

N
+
1

,

N
+
2

,





,


2

N

-
2


)








Condition





#79






Math





516














e

j


(



ψ
11



(

x
+
1

)


-


ψ
21



(

x
+
1

)



)




e

j


(



ψ
11



(
x
)


-


ψ
21



(
x
)



)




=

e

j


(

-


2

π

N


)














for








x


(


x
=
N

,

N
+
1

,

N
+
2

,





,


2

N

-
2


)








Condition





#80







The above arrangement ensures to reduce the number of poor reception points described in the other embodiments because one of the elements of precoding matrices is “0”. In addition, the reception device is enabled to improve reception quality because poor reception points are effectively avoided especially in an LOS environment.


In an alternative scheme to the above-described precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices, θ11(i) is fixed, for example, to 0 radians (a fixed value not depending on i, and a value other than 0 radians may be applicable) and θ11(i) and θ21(i) satisfy the conditions described above. In another alternative scheme, θ21(i) instead of θ11(i) is fixed, for example, to 0 radians (a fixed value not depending on i, and a value other than 0 radians may be applicable) and θ11(i) and θ21(i) satisfy the conditions described above.


Similarly, in another alternative scheme, Ψ11(i) is fixed, for example, to 0 radians (a fixed value not depending on i, and a value other than 0 radians may be applicable) and Ψ11(i) and Ψ21(i) satisfy the conditions described above. Similarly, in another alternative scheme, Ψ21(i) instead of Ψ11(i) is fixed, for example, to 0 radians (a fixed value not depending on i, and a value other than 0 radians may be applicable) and Ψ11(i) and Ψ21(i) satisfy the conditions described above.


The present embodiment describes the scheme of structuring 2N different precoding matrices for a precoding hopping scheme with a 2N-slot time period (cycle). In this case, as the 2N different precoding matrices, F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[2N−2], F[2N−1] are prepared. In a single carrier transmission scheme, symbols are arranged in the order F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[2N−2], F[2N−1] in the time domain (or the frequency domain in the case of multi-carrier). However, this is not the only example, and the 2N different precoding matrices F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[2N−2], F[2N−1] generated in the present embodiment may be adapted to a multi-carrier transmission scheme such as an OFDM transmission scheme or the like. As in Embodiment 1, as a scheme of adaption in this case, precoding weights may be changed by arranging symbols in the frequency domain or in the frequency-time domain. Note that a precoding hopping scheme with a 2N-slot time period (cycle) has been described, but the same advantageous effects may be obtained by randomly using 2N different precoding matrices. In other words, the 2N different precoding matrices do not necessarily need to be used in a regular period (cycle).


Furthermore, in the precoding matrix hopping scheme over an H-slot period (cycle) (H being a natural number larger than the number of slots 2N in the period (cycle) of the above scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices), when the 2N different precoding matrices of the present embodiment are included, the probability of excellent reception quality increases.


Embodiment 25

The present embodiment describes a scheme for increasing the period (cycle) size of precoding hops between the precoding matrices, by applying Embodiment 17 to the precoding matrices described in Embodiment 23.


As described in Embodiment 23, in the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices over a period (cycle) with N slots, the precoding matrices prepared for the N slots are represented as follows.









Math





517












F


[
i
]


=

(




A
×

e

j


(


μ
11

+


θ
11



(
i
)



)







B
×

e

j


(


μ
12

+


θ
11



(
i
)



)









C
×

e

j


(


μ
21

+


θ
21



(
i
)



)






0



)





Equation





439







Here, i=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1. In addition, A, B, and C are fixed values not depending on i. Similarly, μ11, μ12, and μ21 are fixed values not depending on i. Furthermore, the N×M period (cycle) precoding matrices based on Equation 439 are represented by the following equation.














Math





518













F


[


N
×
k

+
i

]


=

(




A
×

e

j


(


μ
11

+


θ
11



(
i
)



)







B
×

e

j


(


μ
12

+


θ
11



(
i
)



)









C
×

e

j


(


μ
21

+


θ
21



(
i
)


+

X
k


)






0



)





Equation





440







Here, i=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1, and k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1. Precoding matrices F[0] to F[N×M−1] are thus generated (the precoding matrices F[0] to F[N×M−1] may be in any order for the N×M slots in the period (cycle)). Symbol number N×M×i may be precoded using F[0], symbol number N×M×i+1 may be precoded using F[1], . . . , and symbol number N×M×i+h may be precoded using F[h], for example (h=0, 1, 2, . . . , N×M−2, N×M−1). (In this case, as described in previous embodiments, precoding matrices need not be hopped between regularly.)


Generating the precoding matrices in this way achieves a precoding matrix hopping scheme with a large period (cycle), allowing for the position of poor reception points to be easily changed, which may lead to improved data reception quality. Note that while the N×M period (cycle) precoding matrices have been set to Equation 440, the N×M period (cycle) precoding matrices may be set to the following equation, as described above.














Math





519













F


[


N
×
k

+
i

]


=

(




A
×

e

j


(


μ
11

+


θ
11



(
i
)


+

X
k


)







B
×

e

j


(


μ
12

+


θ
11



(
i
)


+

X
k


)









C
×

e

j


(


μ
21

+


θ
21



(
i
)



)






0



)





Equation





441







Here, i=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1, and k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1.


As described in Embodiment 23, in the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices over a period (cycle) with N slots that is different from the above-described N slots, the precoding matrices prepared for the N slots are represented as follows.









Math





520












F


[
i
]


=

(




A
×

e

j


(


μ
11

+


θ
11



(
i
)



)







B
×

e

j


(


μ
12

+


θ
11



(
i
)



)








0



D
×

e

j


(


μ
22

+


θ
21



(
i
)



)







)





Equation





442







Here, i=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1. In addition, A, B, and D are fixed values not depending on i. Similarly, μ11, μ12, and μ22 are fixed values not depending on i. Furthermore, the N×M period (cycle) precoding matrices based on Equation 441 are represented by the following equation.














Math





521













F


[


N
×
k

+
i

]


=

(




A
×

e

j


(


μ
11

+


θ
11



(
i
)



)







B
×

e

j


(


μ
12

+


θ
11



(
i
)



)








0



D
×

e

j


(


μ
22

+


θ
21



(
i
)


+

X
k


)







)





Equation





443







Here, i=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1, and k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1.


Precoding matrices F[0] to F[N×M−1] are thus generated (the precoding matrices F[0] to F[N×M−1] may be in any order for the N×M slots in the period (cycle)). Symbol number N×M×i may be precoded using F[0], symbol number N×M×i+1 may be precoded using F[1], . . . , and symbol number N×M×i+h may be precoded using F[h], for example (h=0, 1, 2, . . . , N×M−2, N×M−1). (In this case, as described in previous embodiments, precoding matrices need not be hopped between regularly.)


Generating the precoding matrices in this way achieves a precoding matrix hopping scheme with a large period (cycle), allowing for the position of poor reception points to be easily changed, which may lead to improved data reception quality. Note that while the N×M period (cycle) precoding matrices have been set to Equation 443, the N×M period (cycle) precoding matrices may be set to the following equation, as described above.














Math





522













F


[


N
×
k

+
i

]


=

(




A
×

e

j


(


μ
11

+


θ
11



(
i
)


+

X
k


)







B
×

e

j


(


μ
12

+


θ
11



(
i
)


+

X
k


)








0



D
×

e

j


(


μ
22

+


θ
21



(
i
)



)







)





Equation





444







Here, i=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1, and k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1.


As described in Embodiment 23, in the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices over a period (cycle) with N slots that is different from the above-described N slots, the precoding matrices prepared for the N slots are represented as follows.









Math





523












F


[
i
]


=

(




A
×

e

j


(


μ
11

+


θ
11



(
i
)



)






0





C
×

e

j


(


μ
21

+


θ
21



(
i
)



)







D
×

e

j


(


μ
22

+


θ
21



(
i
)



)







)





Equation





445







Here, i=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1. In addition, A, C, and D are fixed values not depending on i. Similarly, μ11, μ21, and μ22 are fixed values not depending on i. Furthermore, the N×M period (cycle) precoding matrices based on Equation 445 are represented by the following equation.














Math





524













F


[


N
×
k

+
i

]


=

(




A
×

e

j


(


μ
11

+


θ
11



(
i
)



)






0





C
×

e

j


(


μ
21

+


θ
21



(
i
)


+

X
k


)







D
×

e

j


(


μ
22

+


θ
21



(
i
)


+

X
k


)







)





Equation





446







Here, i=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1, and k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1.


Precoding matrices F[0] to F[N×M−1] are thus generated (the precoding matrices F[0] to F[N×M−1] may be in any order for the N×M slots in the period (cycle)). Symbol number N×M×i may be precoded using F[0], symbol number N×M×i+1 may be precoded using F[1], . . . , and symbol number N×M×i+h may be precoded using F[h], for example (h=0, 1, 2, . . . , N×M−2, N×M−1). (In this case, as described in previous embodiments, precoding matrices need not be hopped between regularly.)


Generating the precoding matrices in this way achieves a precoding matrix hopping scheme with a large period (cycle), allowing for the position of poor reception points to be easily changed, which may lead to improved data reception quality. Note that while the N×M period (cycle) precoding matrices have been set to Equation 446, the N×M period (cycle) precoding matrices may be set to the following equation, as described above.









Math





525












F


[


N
×
k

+
i

]


=

(




A
×

e

j


(


μ
11

+

θ
11

(
i
)


+

X
k


)






0





C
×

e

j


(


μ
21

+

θ
21

(
i
)



)







D
×

e

j


(


μ
22

+

θ
21

(
i
)



)







)





Equation





447







Here, i=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1, and k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1.


As described in Embodiment 23, in the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices over a period (cycle) with N slots that is different from the above-described N slots, the precoding matrices prepared for the N slots are represented as follows.









Math





526












F


[
i
]


=

(



0



B
×

e

j


(


μ
12

+

θ
11

(
i
)



)









C
×

e

j


(


μ
21

+

θ
21

(
i
)



)







D
×

e

j


(


μ
22

+

θ
21

(
i
)



)







)





Equation





448







Here, i=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1. In addition, B, C, and D are fixed values not depending on i. Similarly, μ11, μ12, μ21, and μ22 are fixed values not depending on i. Furthermore, the N×M period (cycle) precoding matrices based on Equation 448 are represented by the following equation.














Math





527













F


[


N
×
k

+
i

]


=

(



0



B
×

e

j


(


μ
12

+

θ
11

(
i
)



)









C
×

e

j


(


μ
21

+

θ
21

(
i
)


+

X
k


)







D
×

e

j


(


μ
22

+

θ
21

(
i
)


+

X
k


)







)





Equation





449







Here, i=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1, and k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1.


Precoding matrices F[0] to F[N×M−1] are thus generated (the precoding matrices F[0] to F[N×M−1] may be in any order for the N×M slots in the period (cycle)). Symbol number N×M×i may be precoded using F[0], symbol number N×M×i+1 may be precoded using F[1], . . . , and symbol number N×M×i+h may be precoded using F[h], for example (h=0, 1, 2, . . . , N×M−2, N×M−1). (In this case, as described in previous embodiments, precoding matrices need not be hopped between regularly.)


Generating the precoding matrices in this way achieves a precoding matrix hopping scheme with a large period (cycle), allowing for the position of poor reception points to be easily changed, which may lead to improved data reception quality. Note that while the N×M period (cycle) precoding matrices have been set to Equation 449, the N×M period (cycle) precoding matrices may be set to the following equation, as described above.









Math





528












F


[


N
×
k

+
i

]


=

(



0



B
×

e

j


(


μ
12

+

θ
11

(
i
)


+

X
k


)









C
×

e

j


(


μ
21

+

θ
21

(
i
)



)







D
×

e

j


(


μ
22

+

θ
21

(
i
)



)







)





Equation





450







Here, i=0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1, and k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1.


The present embodiment describes the scheme of structuring N×M different precoding matrices for a precoding hopping scheme with N×M slots in the time period (cycle). In this case, as the N×M different precoding matrices, F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[N×M−2], F[N×M−1] are prepared. In a single carrier transmission scheme, symbols are arranged in the order F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[N×M−2], F[N×M−1] in the time domain (or the frequency domain in the case of multi-carrier). However, this is not the only example, and the N×M different precoding matrices F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[N×M−2], F[N×M−1] generated in the present embodiment may be adapted to a multi-carrier transmission scheme such as an OFDM transmission scheme or the like. As in Embodiment 1, as a scheme of adaption in this case, precoding weights may be changed by arranging symbols in the frequency domain or in the frequency-time domain. Note that a precoding hopping scheme with N×M slots in the time period (cycle) has been described, but the same advantageous effects may be obtained by randomly using N×M different precoding matrices. In other words, the N×M different precoding matrices do not necessarily need to be used in a regular period (cycle).


Furthermore, in the precoding matrix hopping scheme over an H-slot period (cycle) (H being a natural number larger than the number of slots N×M in the period (cycle) of the above scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices), when the N×M different precoding matrices of the present embodiment are included, the probability of excellent reception quality increases.


Embodiment 26

The present embodiment describes a scheme for increasing the period (cycle) size of precoding hops between the precoding matrices, by applying Embodiment 20 to the precoding matrices described in Embodiment 24.


In the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices over a period (cycle) with 2N slots, the precoding matrices prepared for the 2N slots are represented as follows.









Math





529













For





i

=
0

,
1
,
2
,

,

N
-
2

,

N
-

1


:







Equation





451







F


[
i
]


=

(




A
×

e

j


(


μ
11

+

θ
11

(
i
)



)







B
×

e

j


(


μ
12

+

θ
11

(
i
)



)









C
×

e

j


(


μ
21

+

θ
21

(
i
)



)






0



)













Here, let A, B, and C be real numbers, and μ11, μ12, and μ21 be real numbers expressed in radians. In addition, A, B, and C are fixed values not depending on i. Similarly, μ11, μ12, and μ21 are fixed values not depending on i.









Math





530













For





i

=
N

,

N
+
1

,

N
+
2

,

,


2

N

-
2

,


2

N

-

1


:







Equation





452







F


[
i
]


=

(




α
×

e

j


(


v
11

+

ψ
11

(
i
)



)







β
×

e

j


(


v
12

+

ψ
11

(
i
)



)








0



δ
×

e

j


(


v
22

+

ψ
21

(
i
)



)







)













Here, let α, β, and δ be real numbers, and ν11, ν12, and ν22 be real numbers expressed in radians. In addition, α, β, and δ are fixed values not depending on i. Similarly, ν11, ν12, and ν22 are fixed values not depending on i. Furthermore, the 2×N×M period (cycle) precoding matrices based on Equations 451 and 452 are represented by the following equation.














Math





531



















For





i

=
0

,
1
,
2
,

,

N
-
2

,

N
-

1


:








Equation





453







F


[


2
×
N
×
k

+
i

]


=

(




A
×

e

j


(


μ
11

+

θ
11

(
i
)



)







B
×

e

j


(


μ
12

+

θ
11

(
i
)



)









C
×

e

j


(


μ
21

+

θ
21

(
i
)


+

X
k


)






0



)













Here, k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1.














Math





532



















For





i

=
N

,

N
+
1

,

N
+
2

,

,


2

N

-
2

,


2

N

-

1


:








Equation





454







F


[


2
×
N
×
k

+
i

]


=

(




α
×

e

j


(


v
11

+

ψ
11

(
i
)



)







β
×

e

j


(


v
12

+

ψ
11

(
i
)



)








0



δ
×

e

j


(


v
22

+

ψ
21

(
i
)


+

Y
k


)







)













Here, k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1. In addition, Xk=Yk may be true or Xk≠Yk may be true.


Precoding matrices F[0] to F[2×N×M−1] are thus generated (the precoding matrices F[0] to F[2×N×M−1] may be in any order for the 2×N×M slots in the period (cycle)). Symbol number 2×N×M×i may be precoded using F[0], symbol number 2×N×M×i+1 may be precoded using F[1], . . . , and symbol number 2×N×M×i+h may be precoded using F[h], for example (h=0, 1, 2, . . . , 2×N×M−2, 2×N×M−1). (In this case, as described in previous embodiments, precoding matrices need not be hopped between regularly.)


Generating the precoding matrices in this way achieves a precoding matrix hopping scheme with a large period (cycle), allowing for the position of poor reception points to be easily changed, which may lead to improved data reception quality.


The 2×N×M period (cycle) precoding matrices in Equation 453 may be changed to the following equation.














Math





533



















For





i

=
0

,
1
,
2
,

,

N
-
2

,

N
-

1


:








Equation





455







F


[


2
×
N
×
k

+
i

]


=

(




A
×

e

j


(


μ
11

+

θ
11

(
i
)


+

X
k


)







B
×

e

j


(


μ
12

+

θ
11

(
i
)


+

X
k


)









C
×

e

j


(


μ
21

+

θ
21

(
i
)



)






0



)













Here, k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1.


The 2×N×M period (cycle) precoding matrices in Equation 454 may be changed to the following equation.














Math





534



















For





i

=
N

,

N
+
1

,

N
+
2

,

,


2

N

-
2

,


2

N

-

1


:








Equation





456







F


[


2
×
N
×
k

+
i

]


=

(




α
×

e

j


(


v
11

+

ψ
11

(
i
)


+

Y
k


)







β
×

e

j


(


v
12

+

ψ
11

(
i
)


+

Y
k


)








0



δ
×

e

j


(


v
22

+

ψ
21

(
i
)



)







)













Here, k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1.


Another example is shown below. In the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices over a period (cycle) with 2N slots, the precoding matrices prepared for the 2N slots are represented as follows.









Math





535













For





i

=
0

,
1
,
2
,

,

N
-
2

,

N
-

1


:







Equation





457







F


[
i
]


=

(




A
×

e

j


(


μ
11

+

θ
11

(
i
)



)







B
×

e

j


(


μ
12

+

θ
11

(
i
)



)









C
×

e

j


(


μ
21

+

θ
21

(
i
)



)






0



)













Here, let A, B, and C be real numbers, and μ11, μ12, and μ21 be real numbers expressed in radians. In addition, A, B, and C are fixed values not depending on i. Similarly, μ11, μ12, and μ21 are fixed values not depending on i.









Math





536













For





i

=
N

,

N
+
1

,

N
+
2

,

,


2

N

-
2

,


2

N

-

1


:







Equation





458







F


[
i
]


=

(



0



β
×

e

j


(


v
12

+

ψ
11

(
i
)



)









γ
×

e

j


(


v
21

+

ψ
21

(
i
)



)







D
×

e

j


(


v
22

+

ψ
21

(
i
)



)







)













Here, let β, γ, and δ be real numbers, and ν12, ν21, and ν22 be real numbers expressed in radians. In addition, β, γ, and δ are fixed values not depending on i. Similarly, ν12, ν21, and ν22 are fixed values not depending on i. Furthermore, the 2×N×M period (cycle) precoding matrices based on Equations 457 and 458 are represented by the following equation.














Math





537



















For





i

=
0

,
1
,
2
,

,

N
-
2

,

N
-

1


:








Equation





459







F


[


2
×
N
×
k

+
i

]


=

(




A
×

e

j


(


μ
11

+

θ
11

(
i
)



)







B
×

e

j


(


μ
12

+

θ
11

(
i
)



)









C
×

e

j


(


μ
21

+

θ
21

(
i
)


+

X
k


)






0



)













Here, k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1.














Math





538



















For





i

=
N

,

N
+
1

,

N
+
2

,

,


2

N

-
2

,


2

N

-

1


:








Equation





460







F


[


2
×
N
×
k

+
i

]


=

(



0



β
×

e

j


(


v
12

+

ψ
11

(
i
)



)









γ
×

e

j


(


v
21

+

ψ
21

(
i
)


+

Y
k


)







δ
×

e

j


(


v
22

+

ψ
21

(
i
)


+

Y
k


)







)













Here, k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1. Furthermore, Xk=Yk may be true, or Xk≠Yk may be true.


Precoding matrices F[0] to F[2×N×M−1] are thus generated (the precoding matrices F[0] to F[2×N×M−1] may be in any order for the 2×N×M slots in the period (cycle)). Symbol number 2×N×M×i may be precoded using F[0], symbol number 2×N×M×i+1 may be precoded using F[1], . . . , and symbol number 2×N×M×i+h may be precoded using F[h], for example (h=0, 1, 2, . . . , 2×N×M−2, 2×N×M−1). (In this case, as described in previous embodiments, precoding matrices need not be hopped between regularly.)


Generating the precoding matrices in this way achieves a precoding matrix hopping scheme with a large period (cycle), allowing for the position of poor reception points to be easily changed, which may lead to improved data reception quality.


The 2×N×M period (cycle) precoding matrices in Equation 459 may be changed to the following equation.














Math





539



















For





i

=
0

,
1
,
2
,

,

N
-
2

,

N
-

1


:








Equation





461







F


[


2
×
N
×
k

+
i

]


=

(




A
×

e

j


(


μ
11

+

θ
11

(
i
)


+

X
k


)







B
×

e

j


(


μ
12

+

θ
11

(
i
)


+

X
k


)









C
×

e

j


(


μ
21

+

θ
21

(
i
)



)






0



)













Here, k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1.


The 2×N×M period (cycle) precoding matrices in Equation 460 may be changed to the following equation.














Math





540



















For





i

=
N

,

N
+
1

,

N
+
2

,





,


2

N

-
2

,




2

N

-
1

:





F


[


2
×
N
×
k

+
i

]



=

(



0



β
×

e

j


(


v
12

+


ψ
11



(
i
)


+

Y
k


)









γ
×

e

j


(


v
21

+


ψ
21



(
i
)



)







δ
×

e

j


(


v
22

+


ψ
21



(
i
)



)







)







Equation





462







Here, k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1.


Another example is shown below. In the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices over a period (cycle) with 2N slots, the precoding matrices prepared for the 2N slots are represented as follows.









Math





541













For





i

=
0

,
1
,
2
,





,

N
-
2

,



N
-
1

:





F


[
i
]



=

(




A
×

e

j


(


μ
11

+


θ
11



(
i
)



)






0





C
×

e

j


(


μ
21

+


θ
21



(
i
)



)







D
×

e

j


(


μ
22

+


θ
21



(
i
)



)







)






Equation





463







Here, let A, C, and D be real numbers, and μ11, μ21, and μ22 be real numbers expressed in radians. In addition, A, C, and D are fixed values not depending on i. Similarly, μ11, μ21, and μ22 are fixed values not depending on i.









Math





542













For





i

=
N

,

N
+
1

,

N
+
2

,





,


2

N

-
2

,




2

N

-
1

:





F


[
i
]



=

(




α
×

e

j


(


v
11

+


ψ
11



(
i
)



)







β
×

e

j


(


v
12

+


ψ
11



(
i
)



)








0



δ
×

e

j


(


v
22

+


ψ
21



(
i
)



)







)






Equation





464







Here, let α, β, and δ be real numbers, and ν11, ν12, and ν22 be real numbers expressed in radians. In addition, α, β, and δ are fixed values not depending on i. Similarly, ν11, ν12, and ν22 are fixed values not depending on i. Furthermore, the 2×N×M period (cycle) precoding matrices based on Equations 463 and 464 are represented by the following equation.














Math





543



















For





i

=
0

,
1
,
2
,





,

N
-
2

,



N
-
1

:





F


[


2
×
N
×
k

+
i

]



=

(




A
×

e

j


(


μ
11

+


θ
11



(
i
)



)






0





C
×

e

j


(


μ
21

+


θ
21



(
i
)


+

X
k


)







D
×

e

j


(


μ
22

+


θ
21



(
i
)


+

X
k


)







)







Equation





465







Here, k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1.














Math





544



















For





i

=
N

,

N
+
1

,

N
+
2

,





,


2

N

-
2

,




2

N

-
1

:





F


[


2
×
N
×
k

+
i

]



=

(




α
×

e

j


(


v
11

+


ψ
11



(
i
)



)







β
×

e

j


(


v
12

+


ψ
11



(
i
)



)








0



δ
×

e

j


(


v
22

+


ψ
21



(
i
)


+

Y
k


)







)







Equation





466







Here, k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1. Furthermore, Xk=Yk may be true, or Xk≠Yk may be true.


Precoding matrices F[0] to F[2×N×M−1] are thus generated (the precoding matrices F[0] to F[2×N×M−1] may be in any order for the 2×N×M slots in the period (cycle)). Symbol number 2×N×M×i may be precoded using F[0], symbol number 2×N×M×i+1 may be precoded using F[1], . . . , and symbol number 2×N×M×i+h may be precoded using F[h], for example (h=0, 1, 2, . . . , 2×N×M−2, 2×N×M−1). (In this case, as described in previous embodiments, precoding matrices need not be hopped between regularly.)


Generating the precoding matrices in this way achieves a precoding matrix hopping scheme with a large period (cycle), allowing for the position of poor reception points to be easily changed, which may lead to improved data reception quality.


The 2×N×M period (cycle) precoding matrices in Equation 465 may be changed to the following equation.














Math





545



















For





i

=
0

,
1
,
2
,





,

N
-
2

,



N
-
1

:





F


[


2
×
N
×
k

+
i

]



=

(




A
×

e

j


(


μ
11

+


θ
11



(
i
)


+

X
k


)






0





C
×

e

j


(


μ
21

+


θ
21



(
i
)



)







D
×

e

j


(


μ
22

+


θ
21



(
i
)



)







)







Equation





467







Here, k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1.


The 2×N×M period (cycle) precoding matrices in Equation 466 may be changed to the following equation.














Math





546



















For





i

=
N

,

N
+
1

,

N
+
2

,





,


2

N

-
2

,




2

N

-
1

:





F


[


2
×
N
×
k

+
i

]



=

(




α
×

e

j


(


v
11

+


ψ
11



(
i
)


+

Y
k


)







β
×

e

j


(


v
12

+


ψ
11



(
i
)


+

Y
k


)








0



δ
×

e

j


(


v
22

+


ψ
21



(
i
)



)







)







Equation





468







Here, k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1.


Another example is shown below. In the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices over a period (cycle) with 2N slots, the precoding matrices prepared for the 2N slots are represented as follows.









Math





547













For





i

=
0

,
1
,
2
,





,

N
-
2

,



N
-
1

:





F


[
i
]



=

(




A
×

e

j


(


μ
11

+


θ
11



(
i
)



)






0





C
×

e

j


(


μ
21

+


θ
21



(
i
)



)







D
×

e

j


(


μ
22

+


θ
21



(
i
)



)







)






Equation





469







Here, let A, C, and D be real numbers, and μ11, μ21, and μ22 be real numbers expressed in radians. In addition, A, C, and D are fixed values not depending on i. Similarly, μ11, μ21, and μ22 are fixed values not depending on i.









Math





548













For





i

=
N

,

N
+
1

,

N
+
2

,





,


2

N

-
2

,




2

N

-
1

:





F


[
i
]



=

(



0



β
×

e

j


(


v
12

+


ψ
11



(
i
)



)









γ
×

e

j


(


v
21

+


ψ
21



(
i
)



)







δ
×

e

j


(


v
22

+


ψ
21



(
i
)



)







)






Equation





470







Here, let β, γ, and δ be real numbers, and ν12, ν21, and ν22 be real numbers expressed in radians. In addition, β, γ, and δ are fixed values not depending on i. Similarly, ν12, ν21, and ν22 are fixed values not depending on i. Furthermore, the 2×N×M period (cycle) precoding matrices based on Equations 469 and 470 are represented by the following equation.














Math





549



















For





i

=
0

,
1
,
2
,





,

N
-
2

,



N
-
1

:





F


[


2
×
N
×
k

+
i

]



=

(




A
×

e

j


(


μ
11

+


θ
11



(
i
)



)






0





C
×

e

j


(


μ
21

+


θ
21



(
i
)


+

X
k


)







D
×

e

j


(


μ
22

+


θ
21



(
i
)


+

X
k


)







)







Equation





471







Here, k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1.














Math





550



















For





i

=
N

,

N
+
1

,

N
+
2

,





,


2

N

-
2

,




2

N

-
1

:





F


[


2
×
N
×
k

+
i

]



=

(



0



β
×

e

j


(


v
12

+


ψ
11



(
i
)



)









γ
×

e

j


(


v
21

+


ψ
21



(
i
)


+

Y
k


)







δ
×

e

j


(


v
22

+


ψ
21



(
i
)


+

Y
k


)







)







Equation





472







Here, k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1. Furthermore, Xk=Yk may be true, or Xk≠Yk may be true.


Precoding matrices F[0] to F[2×N×M−1] are thus generated (the precoding matrices F[0] to F[2×N×M−1] may be in any order for the 2×N×M slots in the period (cycle)). Symbol number 2×N×M×i may be precoded using F[0], symbol number 2×N×M×i+1 may be precoded using F[1], . . . , and symbol number 2×N×M×i+h may be precoded using F[h], for example (h=0, 1, 2, . . . , 2×N×M−2, 2×N×M−1). (In this case, as described in previous embodiments, precoding matrices need not be hopped between regularly.)


Generating the precoding matrices in this way achieves a precoding matrix hopping scheme with a large period (cycle), allowing for the position of poor reception points to be easily changed, which may lead to improved data reception quality.


The 2×N×M period (cycle) precoding matrices in Equation 471 may be changed to the following equation.














Math





551



















For





i

=
0

,
1
,
2
,





,

N
-
2

,



N
-
1

:





F


[


2
×
N
×
k

+
i

]



=

(




A
×

e

j


(


μ
1

+


θ
11



(
i
)


+

X
k


)






0





C
×

e

j


(


μ
21

+


θ
21



(
i
)



)







D
×

e

j


(


μ
22

+


θ
21



(
i
)



)







)







Equation





473







Here, k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1.


The 2×N×M period (cycle) precoding matrices in Equation 472 may be changed to the following equation.














Math





552



















For





i

=
N

,

N
+
1

,

N
+
2

,





,


2

N

-
2

,




2

N

-
1

:





F


[


2
×
N
×
k

+
i

]



=

(



0



β
×

e

j


(


v
12

+


ψ
11



(
i
)


+

Y
k


)









γ
×

e

j


(


v
21

+


ψ
21



(
i
)



)







δ
×

e

j


(


v
22

+


ψ
21



(
i
)



)







)







Equation





474







Here, k=0, 1, . . . , M−2, M−1.


Focusing on poor reception points in the above examples, the following conditions are important.

Math 553
ej(θ11(x)-θ21(x))≠ej(θ11(y)-θ21(y)) for ∀x,∀y (x≠y; x, y=0,1,2, . . . , N−2, N−1)  Condition #81


(x is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; y is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; and x≠y)

Math 554
ej(Ψ11(x)-Ψ21(x))≠ej(Ψ11(y)-Ψ21(y)) for ∀x,∀y (x≠y; x, y=N, N+1, N+2, . . . , 2N−2, 2N−1)   Condition #82


(x is N, N+1, N+2, . . . , 2N−2, 2N−1; y is N, N+1, N+2, . . . 2N−2, 2N−1; and x≠y)

Math 555
θ11(x)=θ11(x+N) for ∀x (x=0,1,2, . . . , N−2, N−1)
and
θ21(y)=θ21(y+N) for ∀y (y=0,1,2, . . . , N−2, N−1)  Condition #83
Math 556
Ψ11(x)=Ψ11(x+N) for ∀x (x=N, N+1, N+2, . . . , 2N−2, 2N−1)
and
Ψ21(y)=Ψ21(y+N) for ∀y (y=N, N+1, N+2, . . . , 2N−2, 2N−1)  Condition #84


By satisfying the conditions shown above, excellent data reception quality is achieved. Furthermore, the following conditions should be satisfied (See Embodiment 24).

Math 557
ej(θ11(x)-θ21(x))≠ej(θ11(y)-θ21(y)) for ∀x,∀y (x≠y; x, y=0,1,2, . . . , N−2, N−1)  Condition #85


(x is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; y is 0, 1, 2, . . . , N−2, N−1; and x≠y)

Math 558
ej(Ψ11(x)-Ψ21(x))≠ej(Ψ11(y)-Ψ21(y)) for ∀x,∀y (x≠y;x,y=N,N+1,N+2, . . . ,2N−2,2N−1)  Condition #86


(x is N,N+1, N+2, . . . , 2N−2, 2N−1; y is N,N+1, N+2, . . . 2N−2, 2N−1; and x≠y)


Focusing on Xk and Yk, the following conditions are noted.

Math 559
Xa≠Xb+2×s×π for ∀a,∀b (a≠b; a,b=0,1,2, . . . ,M−2,M−1)  Condition #87


(a is 0, 1, 2, . . . , M−2, M−1; b is 0, 1, 2, . . . , M−2, M−1; and a≠b.)


Here, s is an integer.

Math 560
Ya≠Yb+2×u×π for ∀a,∀b(a≠b; a,b=0,1,2, . . . ,M−2,M−1)  Condition #88


(a is 0, 1, 2, . . . , M−2, M−1; b is 0, 1, 2, . . . , M−2, M−1; and a≠b.)


(Here, u is an integer)


By satisfying the two conditions shown above, excellent data reception quality is achieved. In Embodiment 25, Condition #87 should be satisfied.


The present embodiment describes the scheme of structuring 2×N×M different precoding matrices for a precoding hopping scheme with 2N×M slots in the time period (cycle). In this case, as the 2×N×M different precoding matrices, F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[2×N×M−2], F[2×N×M−1] are prepared. In a single carrier transmission scheme, symbols are arranged in the order F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[2×N×M−2], F[2×N×M−1] in the time domain (or the frequency domain in the case of multi-carrier). However, this is not the only example, and the 2×N×M different precoding matrices F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[2×N×M−2], F[2×N×M−1] generated in the present embodiment may be adapted to a multi-carrier transmission scheme such as an OFDM transmission scheme or the like.


As in Embodiment 1, as a scheme of adaption in this case, precoding weights may be changed by arranging symbols in the frequency domain or in the frequency-time domain. Note that a precoding hopping scheme with 2×N×M slots the time period (cycle) has been described, but the same advantageous effects may be obtained by randomly using 2×N×M different precoding matrices. In other words, the 2×N×M different precoding matrices do not necessarily need to be used in a regular period (cycle).


Furthermore, in the precoding matrix hopping scheme over an H-slot period (cycle) (H being a natural number larger than the number of slots 2×N×M in the period (cycle) of the above scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices), when the 2×N×M different precoding matrices of the present embodiment are included, the probability of excellent reception quality increases.


Embodiment A1

In the present embodiment, a detailed description is given of a scheme for adapting the above-described transmission schemes that regularly hops between precoding matrices to a communications system compliant with the DVB (Digital Video Broadcasting)-T2 (T:Terrestrial) standard (DVB for a second generation digital terrestrial television broadcasting system).



FIG. 61 is an overview of the frame structure of a signal a signal transmitted by a broadcast station according to the DVB-T2 standard. According to the DVB-T2 standard, an OFDM scheme is employed. Thus, frames are structured in the time and frequency domains. FIG. 61 shows the frame structure in the time and frequency domains. The frame is composed of P1 Signalling data (6101), L1 Pre-Signalling data (6102), L1 Post-Signalling data (6103), Common PLP (6104), and PLPs #1 to #N (6105_1 to 6105_N) (PLP: Physical Layer Pipe). (Here, L1 Pre-Signalling data (6102) and L1 Post-Signalling data (6103) are referred to as P2 symbols.) As above, the frame composed of P1 Signalling data (6101), L1 Pre-Signalling data (6102), L1 Post-Signalling data (6103), Common PLP (6104), and PLPs #1 to #N (6105_1 to 6105_N) is referred to as a T2 frame, which is a unit of frame structure.


The P1 Signalling data (6101) is a symbol for use by a reception device for signal detection and frequency synchronization (including frequency offset estimation). Also, the P1 Signalling data (6101) transmits information including information indicating the FFT (Fast Fourier Transform) size, and information indicating which of SISO (Single-Input Single-Output) and MISO (Multiple-Input Single-Output) is employed to transmit a modulated signal. (The SISO scheme is for transmitting one modulated signal, whereas the MISO scheme is for transmitting a plurality of modulated signals using space-time block coding.)


The L1 Pre-Signalling data (6102) transmits information including: information about the guard interval used in transmitted frames; information about PAPR (Peak to Average Power Ratio) method; information about the modulation scheme, error correction scheme (FEC: Forward Error Correction), and coding rate of the error correction scheme all used in transmitting L1 Post-Signalling data; information about the size of L1 Post-Signalling data and the information size; information about the pilot pattern; information about the cell (frequency region) unique number; and information indicating which of the normal mode and extended mode (the respective modes differs in the number of subcarriers used in data transmission) is used.


The L1 Post-Signalling data (6103) transmits information including: information about the number of PLPs; information about the frequency region used; information about the unique number of each PLP; information about the modulation scheme, error correction scheme, coding rate of the error correction scheme all used in transmitting the PLPs; and information about the number of blocks transmitted in each PLP.


The Common PLP (6104) and PLPs #1 to #N (6105_1 to 6105N) are fields used for transmitting data.


In the frame structure shown in FIG. 61, the P1 Signalling data (6101), L1 Pre-Signalling data (6102), L1 Post-Signalling data (6103), Common PLP (6104), and PLPs #1 to #N (6105_1 to 6105_N) are illustrated as being transmitted by time-sharing. In practice, however, two or more of the signals are concurrently present. FIG. 62 shows such an example. As shown in FIG. 62, L1 Pre-Signalling data, L1 Post-Signalling data, and Common PLP may be present at the same time, and PLP #1 and PLP #2 may be present at the same time. That is, the signals constitute a frame using both time-sharing and frequency-sharing.



FIG. 63 shows an example of the structure of a transmission device obtained by applying the above-described schemes of regularly hopping between precoding matrices to a transmission device compliant with the DVB-T2 standard (i.e., to a transmission device of a broadcast station). A PLP signal generating unit 6302 receives PLP transmission data (transmission data for a plurality of PLPs) 6301 and a control signal 6309 as input, performs mapping of each PLP according to the error correction scheme and modulation scheme indicated for the PLP by the information included in the control signal 6309, and outputs a (quadrature) baseband signal 6303 carrying a plurality of PLPs.


A P2 symbol signal generating unit 6305 receives P2 symbol transmission data 6304 and the control signal 6309 as input, performs mapping according to the error correction scheme and modulation scheme indicated for each P2 symbol by the information included in the control signal 6309, and outputs a (quadrature) baseband signal 6306 carrying the P2 symbols.


A control signal generating unit 6308 receives P1 symbol transmission data 6307 and P2 symbol transmission data 6304 as input, and then outputs, as the control signal 6309, information about the transmission scheme (the error correction scheme, coding rate of the error correction, modulation scheme, block length, frame structure, selected transmission schemes including a transmission scheme that regularly hops between precoding matrices, pilot symbol insertion scheme, IFFT (Inverse Fast Fourier Transform)/FFT, method of reducing PAPR, and guard interval insertion scheme) of each symbol group shown in FIG. 61 (P1 Signalling data (6101), L1 Pre-Signalling data (6102), L1 Post-Signalling data (6103), Common PLP (6104), PLPs #1 to #N (6105_1 to 6105_N)).


A frame structuring unit 6310 receives, as input, the baseband signal 6303 carrying PLPs, the baseband signal 6306 carrying P2 symbols, and the control signal 630. On receipt of the input, the frame structuring unit 6310 changes the order of input data in frequency domain and time domain based on the information about frame structure included in the control signal, and outputs a (quadrature) baseband signal 6311_1 corresponding to stream 1 and a (quadrature) baseband signal 6311_2 corresponding to stream 2 both in accordance with the frame structure.


A signal processing unit 6312 receives, as input, the baseband signal 6311_1 corresponding to stream 1, the baseband signal 6311_2 corresponding to stream 2, and the control signal 6309 and outputs a modulated signal 1 (6313_1) and a modulated signal 2 (6313_2) each obtained as a result of signal processing based on the transmission scheme indicated by information included in the control signal 6309. The characteristic feature noted here lies in the following. That is, when a transmission scheme that regularly hops between precoding matrices is selected, the signal processing unit hops between precoding matrices and performs weighting (precoding) in a manner similar to FIGS. 6, 22, 23, and 26. Thus, precoded signals so obtained are the modulated signal 1 (6313_1) and modulated signal 2 (6313_2) obtained as a result of the signal processing.


A pilot inserting unit 6314_1 receives, as input, the modulated signal 1 (6313_1) obtained as a result of the signal processing and the control signal 6309, inserts pilot symbols into the received modulated signal 1 (6313_1), and outputs a modulated signal 6315_1 obtained as a result of the pilot signal insertion. Note that the pilot symbol insertion is carried out based on information indicating the pilot symbol insertion scheme included the control signal 6309.


A pilot inserting unit 6314_2 receives, as input, the modulated signal 2 (6313_2) obtained as a result of the signal processing and the control signal 6309, inserts pilot symbols into the received modulated signal 2 (6313_2), and outputs a modulated signal 6315_2 obtained as a result of the pilot symbol insertion. Note that the pilot symbol insertion is carried out based on information indicating the pilot symbol insertion scheme included the control signal 6309.


An IFFT (Inverse Fast Fourier Transform) unit 6316_1 receives, as input, the modulated signal 6315_1 obtained as a result of the pilot symbol insertion and the control signal 6309, and applies IFFT based on the information about the IFFT method included in the control signal 6309, and outputs a signal 6317_1 obtained as a result of the IFFT.


An IFFT unit 6316_2 receives, as input, the modulated signal 6315_2 obtained as a result of the pilot symbol insertion and the control signal 6309, and applies IFFT based on the information about the IFFT method included in the control signal 6309, and outputs a signal 6317_2 obtained as a result of the IFFT.


A PAPR reducing unit 6318_1 receives, as input, the signal 6317_1 obtained as a result of the IFFT and the control signal 6309, performs processing to reduce PAPR on the received signal 6317_1, and outputs a signal 6319_1 obtained as a result of the PAPR reduction processing. Note that the PAPR reduction processing is performed based on the information about the PAPR reduction included in the control signal 6309.


A PAPR reducing unit 6318_2 receives, as input, the signal 6317_2 obtained as a result of the IFFT and the control signal 6309, performs processing to reduce PAPR on the received signal 6317_2, and outputs a signal 6319_2 obtained as a result of the PAPR reduction processing. Note that the PAPR reduction processing is carried out based on the information about the PAPR reduction included in the control signal 6309.


A guard interval inserting unit 6320_1 receives, as input, the signal 6319_1 obtained as a result of the PAPR reduction processing and the control signal 6309, inserts guard intervals into the received signal 6319_1, and outputs a signal 6321_1 obtained as a result of the guard interval insertion. Note that the guard interval insertion is carried out based on the information about the guard interval insertion scheme included in the control signal 6309.


A guard interval inserting unit 6320_2 receives, as input, the signal 6319_2 obtained as a result of the PAPR reduction processing and the control signal 6309, inserts guard intervals into the received signal 6319_2, and outputs a signal 6321_2 obtained as a result of the guard interval insertion. Note that the guard interval insertion is carried out based on the information about the guard interval insertion scheme included in the control signal 6309.


A P1 symbol inserting unit 6322 receives, as input, the signal 6321_1 obtained as a result of the guard interval insertion, the signal 6321_2 obtained as a result of the guard interval insertion, and the P1 symbol transmission data 6307, generates a P1 symbol signal from the P1 symbol transmission data 6307, adds the P1 symbol to the signal 6321_1 obtained as a result of the guard interval insertion, and adds the P1 symbol to the signal 6321_2 obtained as a result of the guard interval insertion. Then, the P1 symbol inserting unit 6322 outputs a signal 6323_1 obtained as a result of the processing related to P1 symbol and a signal 6323_2 obtained as a result of the processing related to P1 symbol. Note that a P1 symbol signal may be added to both the signals 6323_1 and 6323_2 or to one of the signals 6323_1 and 6323_2. In the case where the P1 symbol signal is added to one of the signals 6323_1 and 6323_2, the following is noted. For purposes of description, an interval of the signal to which a P1 symbol is added is referred to as a P1 symbol interval. Then, the signal to which a P1 signal is not added includes, as a baseband signal, a zero signal in an interval corresponding to the P1 symbol interval of the other signal. A wireless processing unit 6324_1 receives the signal 6323_1 obtained as a result of the processing related to P1 symbol, performs processing such as frequency conversion, amplification, and the like, and outputs a transmission signal 6325_1. The transmission signal 6325_1 is then output as a radio wave from an antenna 6326_1.


A wireless processing unit 6324_2 receives the signal 6323_2 obtained as a result of the processing related to P1 symbol, performs processing such as frequency conversion, amplification, and the like, and outputs a transmission signal 6325_2. The transmission signal 6325_2 is then output as a radio wave from an antenna 6326_2.


Next, a detailed description is given of the frame structure of a transmission signal and the transmission scheme of control information (information carried by the P1 symbol and P2 symbols) employed by a broadcast station (base station) in the case where the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices is adapted to a DVB-T2 system.



FIG. 64 shows an example of the frame structure in the time and frequency domains, in the case where a plurality of PLPs are transmitted after transmission of P1 symbol, P2 symbols, and Common PLP. In FIG. 64, stream s1 uses subcarriers #1 to #M in the frequency domain. Similarly, stream s2 uses subcarriers #1 to #M in the frequency domain. Therefore, when streams s1 and s2 both have a symbol in the same subcarrier and at the same time, symbols of the two streams are present at the same frequency. In the case where precoding performed includes the precoding according to the scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices as described in the other embodiments, streams s1 and s2 are subjected to weighting performed using the precoding matrices and z1 and z2 are output from the respective antennas.


As shown in FIG. 64, in interval 1, a symbol group 6401 of PLP #1 is transmitted using streams s1 and s2, and the data transmission is carried out using the spatial multiplexing MIMO system shown in FIG. 49 or the MIMO system with a fixed precoding matrix.


In interval 2, a symbol group 6402 of PLP #2 is transmitted using stream s1, and the data transmission is carried out by transmitting one modulated signal.


In interval 3, a symbol group 6403 of PLP #3 is transmitted using streams s1 and s2, and the data transmission is carried out using a precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices.


In interval 4, a symbol group 6404 of PLP #4 is transmitted using streams s1 and s2, and the data transmission is carried out using space-time block coding shown in FIG. 50. Note that the symbol arrangement used in space-time block coding is not limited to the arrangement in the time domain. Alternatively, the symbol arrangement may be in the frequency domain or in symbol groups formed in the time and frequency domains. In addition, the space-time block coding is not limited to the one shown in FIG. 50.


In the case where a broadcast station transmits PLPs in the frame structure shown in FIG. 64, a reception device receiving the transmission signal shown in FIG. 64 needs to know the transmission scheme used for each PLP. As has been already described above, it is therefore necessary to transmit information indicating the transmission scheme for each PLP, using L1 Post-Signalling data (6103 shown in FIG. 61), which is a P2 symbol. The following describes an example of the scheme of structuring a P1 symbol used herein and the scheme of structuring a P2 symbol used herein.


Table 3 shows a specific example of control information transmitted using a P1 symbol.










TABLE 3







S1
000: T2_SISO (One modulated signal transmission compliant



with DVB-T2 standard)



001: T2_MISO (Transmission using space-time block coding



compliant with DVB-T2 standard)



010: NOT_T2 (compliant with standard other than DVB-T2)









According to the DVB-T2 standard, the control information S1 (three bits) enables the reception device to determine whether or not the DVB-T2 standard is used and also to determine, if DVB-T2 is used, which transmission scheme is used. If the three bits are set to “000”, the S1 information indicates that the modulated signal transmitted in accordance with “transmission of a modulated signal compliant with the DVB-T2 standard”.


If the three bits are set to “001”, the S1 information indicates that the modulated signal transmitted is in accordance with “transmission using space-time block coding compliant with the DVB-T2 standard”.


In the DVB-T2 standard, the bit sets “010” to “111” are “Reserved” for future use. In order to adapt the present invention in a manner to establish compatibility with the DVB-T2, the three bits constituting the S1 information may be set to “010” (or any bit set other than “000” and “001”) to indicate that the modulated signal transmitted is compliant with a standard other than DVB-T2. On determining that the S1 information received is set to “010”, the reception device is informed that the modulated signal transmitted from the broadcast station is compliant with a standard other than DVB-T2.


Next, a description is given of examples of the scheme of structuring a P2 symbol in the case where a modulated signal transmitted by the broadcast station is compliant with a standard other than DVB-T2. The first example is directed to a scheme in which P2 symbol compliant with the DVB-T2 standard is used.


Table 4 shows a first example of control information transmitted using L1 Post-Signalling data, which is one of P2 symbols.










TABLE 4







PLP_MODE
00: SISO/SIMO


(2 bits)
01: MISO/MIMO (Space-time block code)



10: MIMO (Precoding scheme of regularly hopping



between precoding matrices)



11: MIMO (MIMO system with fixed precoding matrix



or Spatial multiplexing MIMO system)









SISO: Single-Input Single-Output (one modulated signal is transmitted and receive with one antenna)


SIMO: Single-Input Multiple-Output (one modulated signal is transmitted and received with a plurality of antennas)


MISO: Multiple-Input Single-Output (a plurality of modulated signals are transmitted from a plurality of antennas and received with one antenna)


MIMO: Multiple-Input Multiple-Output (a plurality of modulated signals are transmitted from a plurality of antennas and received with a plurality of antennas)


The 2-bit information “PLP_MODE” shown in Table 4 is control information used to indicate the transmission scheme used for each PLP as shown in FIG. 64 (PLPs #1 to #4 in FIG. 64). That is, a separate piece of “PLP_MODE” information is provided for each PLP. That is, in the example shown in FIG. 64, PLP_MODE for PLP #1, PLP_MODE for PLP #2, PLP_MODE for PLP #3, PLP_MODE for PLP #4 . . . are transmitted from the broadcast station. As a matter of course, by demodulating (and also performing error correction) those pieces of information, the terminal at the receiving end is enabled to recognize the transmission scheme that the broadcast station used for transmitting each PLP.


When the PLP_MODE is set to “00”, the data transmission by a corresponding PLP is carried out by “transmitting one modulated signal”. When the PLP_MODE is set to “01”, the data transmission by a corresponding PLP is carried out by “transmitting a plurality of modulated signals obtained by space-time block coding”. When the PLP_MODE is set to “10”, the data transmission by a corresponding PLP is carried out using a “precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices”. When the PLP_MODE is set to “11”, the data transmission by a corresponding PLP is carried out using a “MIMO system with a fixed precoding matrix or spatial multiplexing MIMO system”.


Note that when the PLP_MODE is set to “01” to “11”, the information indicating the specific processing conducted by the broadcast station (for example, the specific hopping scheme used in the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices, the specific space-time block coding scheme used, and the structure of precoding matrices used) needs to be notified to the terminal. The following describes the scheme of structuring control information that includes such information and that is different from the example shown in Table 4.


Table 5 shows a second example of control information transmitted using L1 Post-Signalling data, which is one of P2 symbols. The second example shown in Table 5 is different from the first example shown in Table 4.










TABLE 5







PLP_MODE
0: SISO/SIMO


(1 bit)
1: MISO/MIMO



(Space-time block coding, or



Precoding scheme of regularly hopping between



precoding matrices, or



MIMO system with fixed precoding matrix, or



Spatial multiplexing MIMO system)


MIMO_MODE
0: Precoding scheme of regularly hopping


(1 bit)
between precoding matrices --- OFF



1: Precoding scheme of regularly hopping



between precoding matrices --- ON


MIMO_PATTERN #1
00: Space-time block coding


(2 bits)
01: MIMO system with fixed precoding matrix



and Precoding matrix #1



10: MIMO system with fixed precoding matrix



and Precoding matrix #2



11: Spatial multiplexing MIMO system


MIMO_PATTERN #2
00: Precoding scheme of regularly hopping


(2 bits)
between precoding matrices, using precoding



matrix hopping scheme #1



01: Precoding scheme of regularly hopping



between precoding matrices, using precoding



matrix hopping scheme #2



10: Precoding scheme of regularly hopping



between recoding matrices, using precoding



matrix hopping scheme #3



11: Precoding scheme of regularly hopping



between precoding matrices, using precoding



matrix hopping scheme #4









As shown in Table 5, the control information includes “PLP_MODE” which is one bit long, “MIMO_MODE” which is one bit long, “MIMO_PATTERN #1” which is two bits long, and “MIMO_PATTERN #2” which is two bits long. As shown in FIG. 64, these four pieces of control information is to notify the transmission scheme of a corresponding one of PLPs (PLPs #1 to #4 in the example shown in FIG. 64). Thus, a set of four pieces of information is provided for each PLP. That is, in the example shown in FIG. 64, the broadcast station transmits a set of PLP_MODE information, MIMO_MODE information, MIMO_PATTERN #1 information, and MIMO_PATTERN #2 information for PLP #1, a set of PLP_MODE information, MIMO_MODE information, MIMO_PATTERN #1 information, and MIMO_PATTERN #2 information for PLP #2, a set of PLP_MODE information, MIMO_MODE information, MIMO_PATTERN #1 information, and MIMO_PATTERN #2 information for PLP #3, a set of PLP_MODE information, MIMO_MODE information, MIMO_PATTERN #1 information, and MIMO_PATTERN #2 information for PLP #4 . . . . As a matter of course, by demodulating (and also performing error correction) those pieces of information, the terminal at the receiving end is enabled to recognize the transmission scheme that the broadcast station used for transmitting each PLP.


With the PLP_MODE set to “0”, the data transmission by a corresponding PLP is carried out by “transmitting one modulated signal”. With the PLP_MODE set to “1”, the data transmission by a corresponding PLP is carried out by “transmitting a plurality of modulated signals obtained by space-time block coding”, “precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices”, “MIMO system with a fixed precoding matrix”, or “spatial multiplexing MIMO system”.


With the “PLP_MODE” set to “1”, the “MIMO_MODE” information is made effective. With “MIMO_MODE” set to “0”, data transmission is carried out by a scheme other than the “precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices”. With “MIMO_MODE” set to “1”, on the other hand, data transmission is carried out by the “precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices”.


With “PLP_MODE” set to “1” and “MIMO_MODE” set to “0”, the “MIMO_PATTERN #1” information is made effective. With “MIMO_PATTERN #1” set to “00”, data transmission is carried out using space-time block coding. With “MIMO_PATTERN” set to “01”, data transmission is carried out using a precoding scheme in which weighting is performed using a fixed precoding matrix #1. With “MIMO_PATTERN” set to “10”, data transmission is carried out using a precoding scheme in which weighting is performed using a fixed precoding matrix #2 (Note that the precoding matrix #1 and precoding matrix #2 are mutually different). When “MIMO_PATTERN” set to “11”, data transmission is carried out using spatial multiplexing MIMO system (Naturally, it may be construed that Scheme 1 shown in FIG. 49 is selected here).


With “PLP_MODE” set to “1” and “MIMO_MODE” set to “1”, the “MIMO_PATTERN #2” information is made effective. Then, with “MIMO_PATTERN #2” set to “00”, data transmission is carried out using the precoding matrix hopping scheme #1 according to which precoding matrices are regularly hopped. With “MIMO_PATTERN #2” set to “01”, data transmission is carried out using the precoding matrix hopping scheme #2 according to which precoding matrices are regularly hopped. With “MIMO_PATTERN #2” set to “10”, data transmission is carried out using the precoding matrix hopping scheme #3 according to which precoding matrices are regularly hopped. With “MIMO_PATTERN #2” set to “11”, data transmission is carried out using the precoding matrix hopping scheme #4 according to which precoding matrices are regularly hopped. Note that the precoding matrix hopping schemes #1 to #4 are mutually different. Here, to define a scheme being different, it is supposed that #A and #B are mutually different schemes and then one of the following is true.

    • The precoding matrices used in #A include the same matrices used in #b but the periods (cycles) of the matrices are different.
    • The precoding matrices used in #A include precoding matrices not used in #B.
    • None of the precoding matrices used in #A is used in #B.


In the above description, the control information shown in Tables 4 and 5 is transmitted on L1 Post-Signalling data, which is one of P2 symbols. According to the DVB-T2 standard, however, the amount of information that can be transmitted as P2 symbols is limited. Therefore, addition of information shown in Tables 4 and 5 to the information required in the DVB-T2 standard to be transmitted using P2 symbols may result in an amount exceeding the maximum amount that can be transmitted as P2 symbols. In such a case, Signalling PLP (6501) may be provided as shown in FIG. 65 to transmit control information required by a standard other than the DVB-T2 standard (that is, data transmission is carried out using both L1 Post-Signalling data and Signalling PLP). In the example shown in FIG. 65, the same frame structure as shown in FIG. 61 is used. However, the frame structure is not limited to this specific example. For example, similarly to L1 Pre-signalling data and other data shown in FIG. 62, Signalling PLP may be allocated to a specific carrier range in a specific time domain in the time and frequency domains. In short, Signalling PLP may be allocated in the time and frequency domains in any way.


As described above, the present embodiment allows for choice of a scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices while using a multi-carrier scheme, such as an OFDM scheme, without compromising the compatibility with the DVB-T2 standard. This offers the advantages of obtaining high reception quality, as well as high transmission speed, in an LOS environment. While in the present embodiment, the transmission schemes to which a carrier group can be set are “a spatial multiplexing MIMO system, a MIMO scheme using a fixed precoding matrix, a MIMO scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices, space-time block coding, or a transmission scheme for transmitting only stream s1”, but the transmission schemes are not limited in this way. Furthermore, the MIMO scheme using a fixed precoding matrix limited to scheme #2 in FIG. 49, as any structure with a fixed precoding matrix is acceptable.


Furthermore, the above description is directed to a scheme in which the schemes selectable by the broadcast station are “a spatial multiplexing MIMO system, a MIMO scheme using a fixed precoding matrix, a MIMO scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices, space-time block coding, or a transmission scheme for transmitting only stream s1”. However, it is not necessary that all of the transmission schemes are selectable. Any of the following examples is also possible.

    • A transmission scheme in which any of the following is selectable: a MIMO scheme using a fixed precoding matrix, a MIMO scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices, space-time block coding, and a transmission scheme for transmitting only stream s1.
    • A transmission scheme in which any of the following is selectable: a MIMO scheme using a fixed precoding matrix, a MIMO scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices, and space-time block coding.
    • A transmission scheme in which any of the following is selectable: a MIMO scheme using a fixed precoding matrix, a MIMO scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices, and a transmission scheme for transmitting only stream s1.
    • A transmission scheme in which any of the following is selectable: a MIMO scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices, space-time block coding, and a transmission scheme for transmitting only stream s1.
    • A transmission scheme in which any of the following is selectable: a MIMO scheme using a fixed precoding matrix, and a MIMO scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices.
    • A transmission scheme in which any of the following is selectable: a MIMO scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices, and space-time block coding.
    • A transmission scheme in which any of the following is selectable: a MIMO scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices, and a transmission scheme for transmitting only stream s1.


      As listed above, as long as a MIMO scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices is included as a selectable scheme, the advantageous effects of high-speed data transmission is obtained in an LOS environment, in addition to excellent reception quality for the reception device.


Here, it is necessary to set the control information S1 in P1 symbols as described above. In addition, as P2 symbols, the control information may be set differently from a scheme (the scheme for setting the transmission scheme of each PLP) shown in Table 4. Table 6 shows one example of such a scheme.










TABLE 6







PLP-MODE
00: SISO/SIMO


(2 bits)
01: MISO/MIMO (Space-time block code)



10: MIMO (Precoding scheme of regularly hopping



between precoding matrices)



11: Reserved









Table 6 differs from Table 4 in that the “PLP_MODE” set to “11” is “Reserved.” In this way, the number of bits constituting the “PLP_MODE” shown in Tables 4 and 6 may be increased or decreased depending on the number of selectable PLP transmission schemes, in the case where the selectable transmission schemes are as shown in the above examples.


The same holds with respect to Table 5. For example, if the only MIMO scheme supported is a precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices, the control information “MIMO_MODE” is no longer necessary. Furthermore, the control information “MIMO_PATTERN #1” may not be necessary in the case, for example, where a MIMO scheme using a fixed precoding matrix is not supported. Furthermore, the control information “MIMO_PATTERN #1” may be one bit long instead of two bits long, in the case where, for example, no more than one precoding matrix is required for a MIMO scheme using a fixed precoding matrix. Furthermore, the control information “MIMO_PATTERN #1” may be two bits long or more in the case where a plurality of precoding matrices are selectable.


The same applies to “MIMO_PATTERN #2”. That is, the control information “MIMO_PATTERN #2” may be one bit long instead of two bits long, in the case where no more than one precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices is available. Alternatively, the control information “MIMO_PATTERN #2” may be two bits long or more in the case where a plurality of precoding schemes of regularly hopping between precoding matrices are selectable.


In the present embodiment, the description is directed to the transmission device having two antennas, but the number of antennas is not limited to two. With a transmission device having more than two antennas, the control information may be transmitted in the same manner. Yet, to enable the modulated signal transmission with the use of four antennas in addition to the modulated signal transmission with the use of two antennas, there may be a case where the number of bits constituting respective pieces of control information needs to be increased. In such a modification, it still holds that the control information is transmitted by the P1 symbol and the control information is transmitted by P2 symbols as set forth above.


The above description is directed to the frame structure of PLP symbol groups transmitted by a broadcast station in a time-sharing transmission scheme as shown in FIG. 64.



FIG. 66 shows another example of a symbol arranging scheme in the time and frequency domains, which is different from the symbol arranging scheme shown in FIG. 64. The symbols shown in FIG. 66 are of the stream s1 and s2 and to be transmitted after the transmission of P1 symbol, P2 symbols, and Common PLP. In FIG. 66, each symbol denoted by “#1” represents one symbol of the symbol group of PLP #1 shown in FIG. 64. Similarly, each symbol denoted as “#2” represents one symbol of the symbol group of PLP #2 shown in FIG. 64, each symbol denoted as “#3” represents one symbol of the symbol group of PLP #3 shown in FIG. 64, and each symbol denoted as “#4” represents one symbol of the symbol group of PLP #4 shown in FIG. 64. Similarly to FIG. 64, PLP #1 transmits data using spatial multiplexing MIMO system shown in FIG. 49 or the MIMO system with a fixed precoding matrix. In addition, PLP #2 transmits data thereby to transmit one modulated signal. PLP #3 transmits data using a precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices. PLP #4 transmits data using space-time block coding shown in FIG. 50. Note that the symbol arrangement used in space-time block coding is not limited to the arrangement in the time domain. Alternatively, the symbol arrangement may be in the frequency domain or in symbol groups formed in the time and frequency domains. In addition, space-time block coding is not limited to the one shown in FIG. 50.


In FIG. 66, where streams s1 and s2 both have a symbol in the same subcarrier and at the same time, symbols of the two streams are present at the same frequency. In the case where precoding performed includes the precoding according to the scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices as described in the other embodiments, streams s1 and s2 are subjected to weighting performed using the precoding matrices, and z1 and z2 are output from the respective antennas.



FIG. 66 differs from FIG. 64 in the following points. That is, the example shown in FIG. 64 is an arrangement of a plurality of PLPs using time-sharing, whereas the example shown in FIG. 66 is an arrangement of a plurality of PLPs using both time-sharing and frequency-sharing. That is, for example, at time 1, a symbol of PLP #1 and a symbol of PLP #2 are both present. Similarly, at time 3, a symbol of PLP #3 and a symbol of PLP #4 are both present. In this way, PLP symbols having different index numbers (#X; X=1, 2 . . . ) may be allocated on a symbol-by-symbol basis (for each symbol composed of one subcarrier per time).


For the sake of simplicity, FIG. 66 only shows symbols denoted by “#1” and “#2” at time 1. However, this is not a limiting example, and PLP symbols having any index numbers other than “#1” and “#2” may be present at time 1. In addition, the relation between subcarriers present at time 1 and PLP index numbers are not limited to that shown in FIG. 66. Alternatively, a PLP symbol having any index number may be allocated to any subcarrier. Similarly, in addition, a PLP symbol having any index number may be allocated to any subcarrier at any time other than time 1.



FIG. 67 shows another example of a symbol arranging scheme in the time and frequency domains, which is different from the symbol arranging scheme shown in FIG. 64. The symbols shown in FIG. 67 are of the stream s1 and s2 and to be transmitted after the transmission of P1 symbol, P2 symbols, and Common PLP. The characterizing feature of the example shown in FIG. 67 is that the “transmission scheme for transmitting only stream s1” is not selectable in the case where PLP transmission for T2 frames is carried out basically with a plurality of antennas.


Therefore, data transmission by the symbol group 6701 of PLP #1 shown in FIG. 67 is carried out by “a spatial multiplexing MIMO system or a MIMO scheme using a fixed precoding matrix”. Data transmission by the symbol group 6702 of PLP #2 is carried out using “a precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices”. Data transmission by the symbol group 6703 of PLP #3 is carried out by “space-time block coding”. Note that data transmission by the PLP symbol group 6703 of PLP #3 and the following symbol groups in T2 frame is carried out by using one of “a spatial multiplexing MIMO system or a MIMO scheme using a fixed precoding matrix,” “a precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices” and “space-time block coding”.



FIG. 68 shows another example of a symbol arranging scheme in the time and frequency domains, which is different from the symbol arranging scheme shown in FIG. 66. The symbols shown in FIG. 66 are of the stream s1 and s2 and to be transmitted after the transmission of P1 symbol, P2 symbols, and Common PLP. In FIG. 68, each symbol denoted by “#1” represents one symbol of the symbol group of PLP #1 shown in FIG. 67. Similarly, each symbol denoted as “#2” represents one symbol of the symbol group of PLP #2 shown in FIG. 67, each symbol denoted as “#3” represents one symbol of the symbol group of PLP #3 shown in FIG. 67, and each symbol denoted as “#4” represents one symbol of the symbol group of PLP #4 shown in FIG. 67. Similarly to FIG. 67, PLP #1 transmits data using spatial multiplexing MIMO system shown in FIG. 49 or the MIMO system with a fixed precoding matrix. PLP #2 transmits data using a precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices. PLP #3 transmits data using space-time block coding shown in FIG. 50. Note that the symbol arrangement used in the space-time block coding is not limited to the arrangement in the time domain. Alternatively, the symbol arrangement may be in the frequency domain or in symbol groups formed in the time and frequency domains. In addition, the space-time block coding is not limited to the one shown in FIG. 50.


In FIG. 68, where streams s1 and s2 both have a symbol in the same subcarrier and at the same time, symbols of the two streams are present at the same frequency. In the case where precoding performed includes the precoding according to the scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices as described in the other embodiments, streams s1 and s2 are subjected to weighting performed using the precoding matrices and z1 and z2 are output from the respective antennas.



FIG. 68 differs from FIG. 67 in the following points. That is, the example shown in FIG. 67 is an arrangement of a plurality of PLPs using time-sharing, whereas the example shown in FIG. 68 is an arrangement of a plurality of PLPs using both time-sharing and frequency-sharing. That is, for example, at time 1, a symbol of PLP #1 and a symbol of PLP #2 are both present. In this way, PLP symbols having different index numbers (#X; X=1, 2 . . . ) may be allocated on a symbol-by-symbol basis (for each symbol composed of one subcarrier per time).


For the sake of simplicity, FIG. 68 only shows symbols denoted by “#1” and “#2” at time 1. However, this is not a limiting example, and PLP symbols having any index numbers other than “#1” and “#2” may be present at time 1. In addition, the relation between subcarriers present at time 1 and PLP index numbers are not limited to that shown in FIG. 68. Alternatively, a PLP symbol having any index number may be allocated to any subcarrier. Similarly, in addition, a PLP symbol having any index number may be allocated to any subcarrier at any time other than time 1. Alternatively, on the other hand, only one PLP symbol may be allocated at a specific time as at time t3. That is, in a framing scheme of arranging PLP symbols in the time and frequency domains, any allocation is applicable.


As set forth above, no PLPs using “a transmission scheme for transmitting only stream s1” exist in the T2 frame, so that the dynamic range of a signal received by the terminal is ensured to be narrow. As a result, the advantageous effect is achieved that the probability of excellent reception quality increases.


Note that the description of FIG. 68 is described using an example in which the transmission scheme selected is one of “spatial multiplexing MIMO system or a MIMO scheme using a fixed precoding matrix”, “a precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices”, and “space-time block coding”. Yet, it is not necessary that all of these transmission schemes be selectable. For example, the following combinations of the transmission schemes may be made selectable.

    • “a precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices”, “space-time block coding”, and “a MIMO scheme using a fixed precoding matrix” are selectable.
    • “a precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices” and “space-time block coding” are selectable.
    • “a precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices” and “a MIMO scheme using a fixed precoding matrix” are selectable.


The above description relates to an example in which the T2 frame includes a plurality of PLPs. The following describes an example in which T2 frame includes one PLP only.



FIG. 69 shows an example of frame structure in the time and frequency domains for stream s1 and s2 in the case where only one PLP exits in T2 frame. In FIG. 69, the denotation “control symbol” represents a symbol such as P1 symbol, P2 symbol, or the like. In the example shown in FIG. 69, the first T2 frame is transmitted using interval 1. Similarly, the second T2 frame is transmitted using interval 2, the third T2 frame is transmitted using interval 3, and the fourth T2 frame is transmitted using interval 4.


In the example shown in FIG. 69, in the first T2 frame, a symbol group 6801 for PLP #1-1 is transmitted and the transmission scheme selected is “spatial multiplexing MIMO system or MIMO scheme using a fixed precoding matrix”.


In the second T2 frame, a symbol group 6802 for PLP #2-1 is transmitted and the transmission scheme selected is “a scheme for transmitting one modulated signal”.


In the third T2 frame, a symbol group 6803 for PLP #3-1 is transmitted and the transmission scheme selected is “a precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices”.


In the fourth T2 frame, a symbol group 6804 for PLP #4-1 is transmitted and the transmission scheme selected is “space-time block coding”. Note that the symbol arrangement used in the space-time block coding is not limited to the arrangement in the time domain. Alternatively, the symbol arrangement may be in the frequency domain or in symbol groups formed in the time and frequency domains. In addition, the space-time block coding is not limited to the one shown in FIG. 50.


In FIG. 69, where streams s1 and s2 both have a symbol in the same subcarrier and at the same time, symbols of the two streams are present at the same frequency. In the case where precoding performed includes the precoding according to the scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices as described in the other embodiments, streams s1 and s2 are subjected to weighting performed using the precoding matrices and z1 and z2 are output from the respective antennas.


In the above manner, a transmission scheme may be set for each PLP in consideration of the data transmission speed and the data reception quality at the receiving terminal, so that increase in data transmission seeped and excellent reception quality are both achieved. As an example scheme of structuring control information, the control information indicating, for example, the transmission scheme and other information of P1 symbol and P2 symbols (and also Signalling PLP where applicable) may be configured in a similar manner to Tables 3-6. The difference is as follows. In the frame structure shown, for example, in FIG. 64, one T2 frame includes a plurality of PLPs. Thus, it is necessary to provide the control information indicating the transmission scheme and the like for each PLP. On the other hand, in the frame structure shown, for example, in FIG. 69, one T2 frame includes one PLP only. Thus, it is sufficient to provide the control information indicating the transmission scheme and the like only for the one PLP.


Although the above description is directed to the scheme of transmitting information about the PLP transmission scheme using P1 symbol and P2 symbols (and Signalling PLPs where applicable), the following describes in particular the scheme of transmitting information about the PLP transmission scheme without using P2 symbols.



FIG. 70 shows a frame structure in the time and frequency domains for the case where a terminal at a receiving end of data broadcasting by a broadcast station supporting a standard other than the DVB-T2 standard. In FIG. 70, the same reference signs are used to denote the blocks that operate in a similar way to those shown in FIG. 61. The frame shown in FIG. 70 is composed of P1 Signalling data (6101), first Signalling data (7001), second Signalling data (7002), Common PLP (6104), and PLPs #1 to N (6105_1 to 6105_N) (PLP: Physical Layer Pipe). In this way, a frame composed of P1 Signalling data (6101), first Signalling data (7001), second Signalling data (7002), Common PLP (6104), PLPs #1 to N (6105_1 to 6105_N) constitutes one frame unit.


By the P1 Signalling data (6101), data indicating that the symbol is for a reception device to perform signal detection and frequency synchronization (including frequency offset estimation) is transmitted. In this example, in addition, data identifying whether or not the frame supports the DVB-T2 standard needs to be transmitted. For example, by S1 shown in Table 3, data indicating whether or not the signal supports the DVB-T2 standard needs to be transmitted.


By the first 1 Signalling data (7001), the following information may be transmitted for example: information about the guard interval used in the transmission frame; information about the method of PAPR (Peak to Average Power Ratio); information about the modulation scheme, error correction scheme, coding rate of the error correction scheme all of which are used in transmitting the second Signalling data; information about the size of the second Signalling data and about information size; information about the pilot pattern; information about the cell (frequency domain) unique number; and information indicating which of the norm mode and extended mode is used. Here, it is not necessary that the first Signalling data (7001) transmits data supporting the DVB-T2 standard. By L2 Post-Signalling data (7002), the following information may be transmitted for example: information about the number of PLPs; information about the frequency domain used; information about the unique number of each PLP; information about the modulation scheme, error correction scheme, coding rate of the error correction scheme all of which are used in transmitting the PLPs; and information about the number of blocks transmitted in each PLP.


In the frame structure shown in FIG. 70, first Signalling data (7001), second Signalling data (7002), L1 Post-Signalling data (6103), Common PLP (6104), PLPs #1 to #N (6105_1 to 6105_N) are appear to be transmitted by time sharing. In practice, however, two or more of the signals are concurrently present. FIG. 71 shows such an example. As shown in FIG. 71, first Signalling data, second Signalling data, and Common PLP may be present at the same time, and PLP #1 and PLP #2 may be present at the same time. That is, the signals constitute a frame using both time-sharing and frequency-sharing.



FIG. 72 shows an example of the structure of a transmission device obtained by applying the above-described schemes of regularly hopping between precoding matrices to a transmission device (of a broadcast station, for example) that is compliant with a standard other than the DVB-T2 standard. In FIG. 72, the same reference signs are used to denote the components that operate in a similar way to those shown in FIG. 63 and the description of such components are the same as above. A control signal generating unit 6308 receives transmission data 7201 for the first and second Signalling data, transmission data 6307 for P1 symbol as input. As output, the control signal generating unit 6308 outputs a control signal 6309 carrying information about the transmission scheme of each symbol group shown in FIG. 70. (The information about the transmission scheme output herein includes: error correction coding, coding rate of the error correction, modulation scheme, block length, frame structure, the selected transmission schemes including a transmission scheme that regularly hops between precoding matrices, pilot symbol insertion scheme, information about IFFT (Inverse Fast Fourier Transform)/FFT and the like, information about the method of reducing PAPR, and information about guard interval insertion scheme.)


The control signal generating unit 7202 receives the control signal 6309 and the transmission data 7201 for first and second Signalling data as input. The control signal generating unit 7202 then performs error correction coding and mapping based on the modulation scheme, according to the information carried in the control signal 6309 (namely, information about the error correction of the first and second Signalling data, information about the modulation scheme) and outputs a (quadrature) baseband signal 7203 of the first and second Signalling data.


Next, a detailed description is given of the frame structure of a transmission signal and the transmission scheme of control information (information carried by the P1 symbol and first and second 2 Signalling data) employed by a broadcast station (base station) in the case where the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices is adapted to a system compliant with a standard other than the DVB-T2 standard.



FIG. 64 shows an example of the frame structure in the time and frequency domains, in the case where a plurality of PLPs are transmitted after transmission of P1 symbol, first and second 2 Signalling data, and Common PLP. In FIG. 64, stream s1 uses subcarriers #1 to #M in the frequency domain. Similarly, stream s2 uses subcarriers #1 to #M in the frequency domain. Therefore, when streams s1 and s2 both have a symbol in the same subcarrier and at the same time, symbols of the two streams are present at the same frequency. In the case where precoding performed includes the precoding according to the scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices as described in the other embodiments, streams s1 and s2 are subjected to weighting performed using the precoding matrices and z1 and z2 are output from the respective antennas.


As shown in FIG. 64, in interval 1, a symbol group 6401 of PLP #1 is transmitted using streams s1 and s2, and the data transmission is carried out using the spatial multiplexing MIMO system shown in FIG. 49 or the MIMO system with a fixed precoding matrix.


In interval 2, a symbol group 6402 of PLP #2 is transmitted using stream s1, and the data transmission is carried out by transmitting one modulated signal.


In interval 3, a symbol group 6403 of PLP #3 is transmitted using streams s1 and s2, and the data transmission is carried out using a precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices.


In interval 4, a symbol group 6404 of PLP #4 is transmitted using streams s1 and s2, and the data transmission is carried out using the space-time block coding shown in FIG. 50. Note that the symbol arrangement used in the space-time block coding is not limited to the arrangement in the time domain. Alternatively, the symbol arrangement may be in the frequency domain or in symbol groups formed in the time and frequency domains. In addition, the space-time block coding is not limited to the one shown in FIG. 50.


In the case where a broadcast station transmits PLPs in the frame structure shown in FIG. 64, a reception device receiving the transmission signal shown in FIG. 64 needs to know the transmission scheme used for each PLP. As has been already described above, it is therefore necessary to transmit information indicating the transmission scheme for each PLP, using the first and second Signalling data. The following describes an example of the scheme of structuring a P1 symbol used herein and the scheme of structuring first and second Signalling data used herein. Specific examples of control information transmitted using a P1 symbol are as shown in Table 3.


According to the DVB-T2 standard, the control information S1 (three bits) enables the reception device to determine whether or not the DVB-T2 standard is used and also determine, if DVB-T2 is used, the transmission scheme used. If the three bits are set to “000”, the S1 information indicates that the modulated signal transmitted is in compliant with “transmission of a modulated signal compliant with the DVB-T2 standard”.


If the three bits are set to “001”, the S1 information indicates that the modulated signal transmitted is in compliant with “transmission using space-time block coding compliant with the DVB-T2 standard”.


In the DVB-T2 standard, the bit sets “010” to “111” are “Reserved” for future use. In order to adapt the present invention in a manner to establish compatibility with the DVB-T2, the three bits constituting the S1 information may be set to “010” (or any bit set other than “000” and “001”) to indicate that the modulated signal transmitted is compliant with a standard other than DVB-T2. On determining that the S1 information received is set to “010”, the reception device is informed that the modulated signal transmitted from the broadcast station is compliant with a standard other than DVB-T2.


Next, a description is given of examples of the scheme of structuring first and second Signalling data in the case where a modulated signal transmitted by the broadcast station is compliant with a standard other than DVB-T2. A first example of the control information for the first and second Signalling data is as shown in Table 4.


The 2-bit information “PLP_MODE” shown in Table 4 is control information used to indicate the transmission scheme used for each PLP as shown in FIG. 64 (PLPs #1 to #4 in FIG. 64). That is, a separate piece of “PLP_MODE” information is provided for each PLP. That is, in the example shown in FIG. 64, PLP_MODE for PLP #1, PLP_MODE for PLP #2, PLP_MODE for PLP #3, PLP_MODE for PLP #4 . . . are transmitted from the broadcast station. As a matter of course, by demodulating (and also performing error correction) those pieces of information, the terminal at the receiving end is enabled to recognize the transmission scheme that the broadcast station used for transmitting each PLP.


With the PLP_MODE set to “00”, the data transmission by a corresponding PLP is carried out by “transmitting one modulated signal”. When the PLP_MODE is set to “01”, the data transmission by a corresponding PLP is carried out by “transmitting a plurality of modulated signals obtained by space-time block coding”. When the PLP_MODE is set to “10”, the data transmission by a corresponding PLP is carried out using a “precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices”. When the PLP_MODE is set to “11”, the data transmission by a corresponding PLP is carried out using a “MIMO system with a fixed precoding matrix or spatial multiplexing MIMO system”.


Note that when the PLP_MODE is set to “01” to “11”, the information indicating the specific processing conducted by the broadcast station (for example, the specific hopping scheme used in the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices, the specific space-time block coding scheme used, and the structure of precoding matrices used) needs to be notified to the terminal. The following describes the scheme of structuring control information that includes such information and that is different from the example shown in Table 4.


A second example of the control information for the first and second Signalling data is as shown in Table 5.


As shown in Table 5, the control information includes “PLP_MODE” which is one bit long, “MIMO_MODE” which is one bit long, “MIMO_PATTERN #1” which is two bits long, and “MIMO_PATTERN #2” which is two bits long. As shown in FIG. 64, these four pieces of control information is to notify the transmission scheme of a corresponding one of PLPs (PLPs #1 to #4 in the example shown in FIG. 64). Thus, a set of four pieces of information is provided for each PLP. That is, in the example shown in FIG. 64, the broadcast station transmits a set of PLP_MODE information, MIMO_MODE information, MIMO_PATTERN #1 information, and MIMO_PATTERN #2 information for PLP #1, a set of PLP_MODE information, MIMO_MODE information, MIMO_PATTERN #1 information, and MIMO_PATTERN #2 information for PLP #2, a set of PLP_MODE information, MIMO_MODE information, MIMO_PATTERN #1 information, and MIMO_PATTERN #2 information for PLP #3, a set of PLP_MODE information, MIMO_MODE information, MIMO_PATTERN #1 information, and MIMO_PATTERN #2 information for PLP #4 . . . . As a matter of course, by demodulating (and also performing error correction) those pieces of information, the terminal at the receiving end is enabled to recognize the transmission scheme that the broadcast station used for transmitting each PLP.


With the PLP_MODE set to “0”, the data transmission by a corresponding PLP is carried out by “transmitting one modulated signal”. With the PLP_MODE set to “1”, the data transmission by a corresponding PLP is carried out by “transmitting a plurality of modulated signals obtained by space-time block coding”, “precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices”, “MIMO system with a fixed precoding matrix or spatial multiplexing MIMO system”, or “spatial multiplexing MIMO system”.


With the “PLP_MODE” set to “1”, the “MIMO_MODE” information is made effective. With “MIMO_MODE” set to “0”, data transmission is carried out by a scheme other than the “precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices”. With “MIMO_MODE” set to “1”, on the other hand, data transmission is carried out by the “precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices”.


With “PLP_MODE” set to “1” and “MIMO_MODE” set to “0”, the “MIMO_PATTERN #1” information is made effective. With “MIMO_PATTERN #1” set to “00”, data transmission is carried out using space-time block coding. With “MIMO_PATTERN” set to “01”, data transmission is carried out using a precoding scheme in which weighting is performed using a fixed precoding matrix #1. With “MIMO_PATTERN” set to “10”, data transmission is carried out using a precoding scheme in which weighting is performed using a fixed precoding matrix #2 (Note that the precoding matrix #1 and precoding matrix #2 are mutually different). When “MIMO_PATTERN” set to “11”, data transmission is carried out using spatial multiplexing MIMO system (Naturally, it may be construed that Scheme 1 shown in FIG. 49 is selected here).


With “PLP_MODE” set to “1” and “MIMO_MODE” set to “1”, the “MIMO_PATTERN #2” information is made effective. With “MIMO_PATTERN #2” set to “00”, data transmission is carried out using the precoding matrix hopping scheme #1 according to which precoding matrices are regularly hopped. With “MIMO_PATTERN #2” set to “01”, data transmission is carried out using the precoding matrix hopping scheme #2 according to which precoding matrices are regularly hopped. With “MIMO_PATTERN #3” set to “10”, data transmission is carried out using the precoding matrix hopping scheme #2 according to which precoding matrices are regularly hopped. With “MIMO_PATTERN #4” set to “11”, data transmission is carried out using the precoding matrix hopping scheme #2 according to which precoding matrices are regularly hopped. Note that the precoding matrix hopping schemes #1 to #4 are mutually different. Here, to define a scheme being different, it is supposed that #A and #B are mutually different schemes. Then one of the following is true.

    • The precoding matrices used in #A include the same matrices used in #b but the periods (cycles) of the matrices are different.
    • The precoding matrices used in #A include precoding matrices not used in #B.
    • None of the precoding matrices used in #A is used in #B.


In the above description, the control information shown in Tables 4 and 5 is transmitted by first and second Signalling data. In this case, the advantage of eliminating the need to specifically use PLPs to transmit control information is achieved.


As described above, the present embodiment allows for choice of a scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices while using a multi-carrier scheme, such as an OFDM scheme and while allowing a standard other than DVB-T2 to be distinguished from DVB-T2. This offers the advantages of obtaining high reception quality, as well as high transmission speed, in an LOS environment. While in the present embodiment, the transmission schemes to which a carrier group can be set are “a spatial multiplexing MIMO system, a MIMO scheme using a fixed precoding matrix, a MIMO scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices, space-time block coding, or a transmission scheme for transmitting only stream s1”, but the transmission schemes are not limited in this way. Furthermore, the MIMO scheme using a fixed precoding matrix limited to scheme #2 in FIG. 49, as any structure with a fixed precoding matrix is acceptable.


Furthermore, the above description is directed to a scheme in which the schemes selectable by the broadcast station are “a spatial multiplexing MIMO system, a MIMO scheme using a fixed precoding matrix, a MIMO scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices, space-time block coding, or a transmission scheme for transmitting only stream s1”. However, it is not necessary that all of the transmission schemes are selectable. Any of the following examples is also possible.

    • A transmission scheme in which any of the following is selectable: a MIMO scheme using a fixed precoding matrix, a MIMO scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices, space-time block coding, and a transmission scheme for transmitting only stream s1.
    • A transmission scheme in which any of the following is selectable: a MIMO scheme using a fixed precoding matrix, a MIMO scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices, and space-time block coding.
    • A transmission scheme in which any of the following is selectable: a MIMO scheme using a fixed precoding matrix, a MIMO scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices, and a transmission scheme for transmitting only stream s1.
    • A transmission scheme in which any of the following is selectable: a MIMO scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices, space-time block coding, and a transmission scheme for transmitting only stream s1.
    • A transmission scheme in which any of the following is selectable: a MIMO scheme using a fixed precoding matrix, and a MIMO scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices.
    • A transmission scheme in which any of the following is selectable: a MIMO scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices, and space-time block coding.
    • A transmission scheme in which any of the following is selectable: a MIMO scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices, and a transmission scheme for transmitting only stream s1.


As listed above, as long as a MIMO scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices is included as a selectable scheme, the advantageous effects of high-speed data transmission is obtained in an LOS environment, in addition to excellent reception quality for the reception device.


Here, it is necessary to set the control information S1 in P1 symbols as described above. In addition, as first and second Signalling data, the control information may be set differently from a scheme (the scheme for setting the transmission scheme of each PLP) shown in Table 4. Table 6 shows one example of such a scheme.


Table 6 differs from Table 4 in that the “PLP_MODE” set to “11” is “Reserved” In this way, the number of bits constituting the “PLP_MODE” shown in Tables 4 and 6 may be increased or decreased depending on the number of selectable PLP transmission schemes, which varies as in the examples listed above.


The same holds with respect to Table 5. For example, if the only MIMO scheme supported is a precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices, the control information “MIMO_MODE” is no longer necessary. Furthermore, the control information “MIMO_PATTERN #1” may not be necessary in the case, for example, where a MIMO scheme using a fixed precoding matrix is not supported. Furthermore, the control information “MIMO_PATTERN #1” may not necessarily be two bits long and may alternatively be one bit long in the case where, for example, no more than one precoding matrix is required for such a MIMO scheme using a fixed precoding matrix. Furthermore, the control information “MIMO_PATTERN #1” may be two bits long or more in the case where a plurality of precoding matrices are selectable.


The same applies to “MIMO_PATTERN #2”. That is, the control information “MIMO_PATTERN #2” may be one bit long instead of two bits long, in the case where no more than one precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices is available. Alternatively, the control information “MIMO_PATTERN #2” may be two bits long or more in the case where a plurality of precoding schemes of regularly hopping between precoding matrices are selectable.


In the present embodiment, the description is directed to the transmission device having two antennas, but the number of antennas is not limited to two. With a transmission device having more than two antennas, the control information may be transmitted in the same manner. Yet, to enable the modulated signal transmission with the use of four antennas in addition to the modulated signal transmission with the use of two antennas may require that the number of bits constituting respective pieces of control information needs to be increased. In such a modification, it still holds that the control information is transmitted by the P1 symbol and the control information is transmitted by first and second Signalling data as set forth above.


The above description is directed to the frame structure of PLP symbol groups transmitted by a broadcast station in a time-sharing transmission scheme as shown in FIG. 64.



FIG. 66 shows another example of a symbol arranging scheme in the time and frequency domains, which is different from the symbol arranging scheme shown in FIG. 64. The symbols shown in FIG. 66 are of the stream s1 and s2 and to be transmitted after the transmission of the P1 symbol, first and second Signalling data, and Common PLP.


In FIG. 66, each symbol denoted by “#1” represents one symbol of the symbol group of PLP #1 shown in FIG. 67. Similarly, each symbol denoted as “#2” represents one symbol of the symbol group of PLP #2 shown in FIG. 64, each symbol denoted as “#3” represents one symbol of the symbol group of PLP #3 shown in FIG. 64, and each symbol denoted as “#4” represents one symbol of the symbol group of PLP #4 shown in FIG. 64. Similarly to FIG. 64, PLP #1 transmits data using spatial multiplexing MIMO system shown in FIG. 49 or the MIMO system with a fixed precoding matrix. In addition, PLP #2 transmits data thereby to transmit one modulated signal. PLP #3 transmits data using a precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices. PLP #4 transmits data using space-time block coding shown in FIG. 50. Note that the symbol arrangement used in the space-time block coding is not limited to the arrangement in the time domain. Alternatively, the symbol arrangement may be in the frequency domain or in symbol groups formed in the time and frequency domains. In addition, the space-time block coding is not limited to the one shown in FIG. 50.


In FIG. 66, where streams s1 and s2 both have a symbol in the same subcarrier and at the same time, symbols of the two streams are present at the same frequency. In the case where precoding performed includes the precoding according to the scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices as described in the other embodiments, streams s1 and s2 are subjected to weighting performed using the precoding matrices and z1 and z2 are output from the respective antennas.



FIG. 66 differs from FIG. 64 in the following points. That is, the example shown in FIG. 64 is an arrangement of a plurality of PLPs using time-sharing, whereas the example shown in FIG. 66 is an arrangement of a plurality of PLPs using both time-sharing and frequency-sharing. That is, for example, at time 1, a symbol of PLP #1 and a symbol of PLP #2 are both present. Similarly, at time 3, a symbol of PLP #3 and a symbol of PLP #4 are both present. In this way, PLP symbols having different index numbers (#X; X=1, 2 . . . ) may be allocated on a symbol-by-symbol basis (for each symbol composed of one subcarrier per time).


For the sake of simplicity, FIG. 66 only shows symbols denoted by “#1” and “#2” at time 1. However, this is not a limiting example, and PLP symbols having any index numbers other than “#1” and “#2” may be present at time 1. In addition, the relation between subcarriers present at time 1 and PLP index numbers are not limited to that shown in FIG. 66. Alternatively, a PLP symbol having any index number may be allocated to any subcarrier. Similarly, in addition, a PLP symbol having any index number may be allocated to any subcarrier at any time other than time 1.



FIG. 67 shows another example of a symbol arranging scheme in the time and frequency domains, which is different from the symbol arranging scheme shown in FIG. 64. The symbols shown in FIG. 67 are of the stream s1 and s2 and to be transmitted after the transmission of the P1 symbol, first and second Signalling data, and Common PLP. The characterizing feature of the example shown in FIG. 67 is that the “transmission scheme for transmitting only stream s1” is not selectable in the case where PLP transmission for T2 frames is carried out basically with a plurality of antennas.


Therefore, data transmission by the symbol group 6701 of PLP #1 shown in FIG. 67 is carried out by “a spatial multiplexing MIMO system or a MIMO scheme using a fixed precoding matrix”. Data transmission by the symbol group 6702 of PLP #2 is carried out using “a precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices”. Data transmission by the symbol group 6703 of PLP #3 is carried out by “space-time block coding”. Note that data transmission by the PLP symbol group 6703 of PLP #3 and the following symbol groups in unit frame is carried out by using one of “a spatial multiplexing MIMO system or a MIMO scheme using a fixed precoding matrix,” “a precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices” and “space-time block coding”.



FIG. 68 shows another example of a symbol arranging scheme in the time and frequency domains, which is different from the symbol arranging scheme shown in FIG. 66. The symbols shown in FIG. 68 are of the stream s1 and s2 and to be transmitted after the transmission of the P1 symbol, first and second Signalling data, and Common PLP.


In FIG. 68, each symbol denoted by “#1” represents one symbol of the symbol group of PLP #1 shown in FIG. 67. Similarly, each symbol denoted as “#2” represents one symbol of the symbol group of PLP #2 shown in FIG. 67, each symbol denoted as “#3” represents one symbol of the symbol group of PLP #3 shown in FIG. 67, and each symbol denoted as “#4” represents one symbol of the symbol group of PLP #4 shown in FIG. 67. Similarly to FIG. 67, PLP #1 transmits data using spatial multiplexing MIMO system shown in FIG. 49 or the MIMO system with a fixed precoding matrix. PLP #2 transmits data using a precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices. PLP #3 transmits data using space-time block coding shown in FIG. 50. Note that the symbol arrangement used in the space-time block coding is not limited to the arrangement in the time domain. Alternatively, the symbol arrangement may be in the frequency domain or in symbol groups formed in the time and frequency domains. In addition, the space-time block coding is not limited to the one shown in FIG. 50.


In FIG. 68, where streams s1 and s2 both have a symbol in the same subcarrier and at the same time, symbols of the two streams are present at the same frequency. In the case where precoding performed includes the precoding according to the scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices as described in the other embodiments, streams s1 and s2 are subjected to weighting performed using the precoding matrices and z1 and z2 are output from the respective antennas.



FIG. 68 differs from FIG. 67 in the following points. That is, the example shown in FIG. 67 is an arrangement of a plurality of PLPs using time-sharing, whereas the example shown in FIG. 68 is an arrangement of a plurality of PLPs using both time-sharing and frequency-sharing. That is, for example, at time 1, a symbol of PLP #1 and a symbol of PLP #2 are both present. In this way, PLP symbols having different index numbers (#X; X=1, 2 . . . ) may be allocated on a symbol-by-symbol basis (for each symbol composed of one subcarrier per time).


For the sake of simplicity, FIG. 68 only shows symbols denoted by “#1” and “#2” at time 1. However, this is not a limiting example, and PLP symbols having any index numbers other than “#1” and “#2” may be present at time 1. In addition, the relation between subcarriers present at time 1 and PLP index numbers are not limited to that shown in FIG. 68. Alternatively, a PLP symbol having any index number may be allocated to any subcarrier. Similarly, in addition, a PLP symbol having any index number may be allocated to any subcarrier at any time other than time 1. Alternatively, on the other hand, only one PLP symbol may be allocated at a specific time as at time t3. That is, in a framing scheme of arranging PLP symbols in the time and frequency domains, any allocation is applicable.


As set forth above, no PLPs using “a transmission scheme for transmitting only stream s1” exist in a unit frame, so that the dynamic range of a signal received by the terminal is ensured to be narrow. As a result, the advantageous effect is achieved that the probability of excellent reception quality increases.


Note that the description of FIG. 68 is described using an example in which the transmission scheme selected is one of “spatial multiplexing MIMO system or a MIMO scheme using a fixed precoding matrix”, “a precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices”, and “space-time block coding”. Yet, it is not necessary that all of these transmission schemes are selectable. For example, the following combinations of the transmission schemes may be made selectable.

    • A “precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices”, “space-time block coding”, and “MIMO scheme using a fixed precoding matrix” are selectable.
    • A “precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices” and “space-time block coding” are selectable.
    • A “precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices” and “MIMO scheme using a fixed precoding matrix” are selectable.


The above description relates to an example in which a unit frame includes a plurality of PLPs. The following describes an example in which a unit frame includes one PLP only.



FIG. 69 shows an example of frame structure in the time and frequency domains for stream s1 and s2 in the case where only one PLP exits in a unit frame.


In FIG. 69, the denotation “control symbol” represents a symbol such as P1 symbol, first and second Signalling data, or the like. In the example shown in FIG. 69, the first unit frame is transmitted using interval 1. Similarly, the second unit frame is transmitted using interval 2, the third unit frame is transmitted using interval 3, and the fourth unit frame is transmitted using interval 4.


In the example shown in FIG. 69, in the first unit frame, a symbol group 6801 for PLP #1-1 is transmitted and the transmission scheme selected is “spatial multiplexing MIMO system or MIMO scheme using a fixed precoding matrix”.


In the second unit frame, a symbol group 6802 for PLP #2-1 is transmitted and the transmission scheme selected is “a scheme for transmitting one modulated signal.”


In the third unit frame, a symbol group 6803 for PLP #3-1 is transmitted and the transmission scheme selected is “a precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices”.


In the fourth unit frame, a symbol group 6804 for PLP #4-1 is transmitted and the transmission scheme selected is “space-time block coding”. Note that the symbol arrangement used in the space-time block coding is not limited to the arrangement in the time domain. Alternatively, the symbols may be arranged in the frequency domain or in symbol groups formed in the time and frequency domains. In addition, the space-time block coding is not limited to the one shown in FIG. 50.


In FIG. 69, where streams s1 and s2 both have a symbol in the same subcarrier and at the same time, symbols of the two streams are present at the same frequency. In the case where precoding performed includes the precoding according to the scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices as described in the other embodiments, streams s1 and s2 are subjected to weighting performed using the precoding matrices and z1 and z2 are output from the respective antennas.


In the above manner, a transmission scheme may be set for each PLP in consideration of the data transmission speed and the data reception quality at the receiving terminal, so that increase in data transmission seeped and excellent reception quality are both achieved. As an example scheme of structuring control information, the control information indicating, for example, the transmission scheme and other information of the P1 symbol and first and second Signalling data may be configured in a similar manner to Tables 3-6. The difference is as follows. In the frame structure shown, for example, in FIG. 64, one unit frame includes a plurality of PLPs. Thus, it is necessary to provide the control information indicating the transmission scheme and the like for each PLP. On the other hand, in the frame structure shown, for example, in FIG. 69, one unit frame includes one PLP only. Thus, it is sufficient to provide the control information indicating the transmission scheme and the like only for the one PLP.


The present embodiment has described how a precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices is applied to a system compliant with the DVB standard. Embodiments 1 to 16 have described examples of the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices. However, the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices is not limited to the schemes described in Embodiments 1 to 16. The present embodiment can be implemented in the same manner by using a scheme comprising the steps of (i) preparing a plurality of precoding matrices, (ii) selecting, from among the prepared plurality of precoding matrices, one precoding matrix for each slot, and (iii) performing the precoding while regularly hopping between precoding matrices to be used for each slot.


Although control information has unique names in the present embodiment, the names of the control information do not influence the present invention.


Embodiment A2

The present embodiment provides detailed descriptions of a reception scheme and the structure of a reception device used in a case where a scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices is applied to a communication system compliant with the DVB-T2 standard, which is described in Embodiment A1.



FIG. 73 shows, by way of example, the structure of a reception device of a terminal used in a case where the transmission device of the broadcast station shown in



FIG. 63 has adopted a scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices. In FIG. 73, the elements that operate in the same manner as in FIGS. 7 and 56 have the same reference signs thereas.


Referring to FIG. 73, a P1 symbol detection/demodulation unit 7301 performs signal detection and temporal frequency synchronization by receiving a signal transmitted by a broadcast station and detecting a P1 symbol based on the inputs, namely signals 704_X and 704_Y that have been subjected to signal processing. The P1 symbol detection/demodulation unit 7301 also obtains control information included in the P1 symbol (by applying demodulation and error correction decoding) and outputs P1 symbol control information 7302. The P1 symbol control information 7302 is input to OFDM related processors 5600_X and 5600_Y. Based on the input information, the OFDM related processors 5600_X and 5600_Y change a signal processing scheme for the OFDM scheme (this is because, as described in Embodiment A1, the P1 symbol includes information on a scheme for transmitting the signal transmitted by the broadcast station).


Signals 704_X and 704_Y that have been subjected to signal processing, as well as the P1 symbol control information 7302, are input to a P2 symbol demodulation unit 7303 (note, a P2 symbol may include a signalling PLP). The P2 symbol demodulation unit 7303 performs signal processing and demodulation (including error correction decoding) based on the P1 symbol control information, and outputs P2 symbol control information 7304.


The P1 symbol control information 7302 and the P2 symbol control information 7304 are input to a control signal generating unit 7305. The control signal generating unit 7305 forms a set of pieces of control information (relating to receiving operations) and outputs the same as a control signal 7306. As illustrated in FIG. 73, the control signal 7306 is input to each unit.


A signal processing unit 711 receives, as inputs, the signals 706_1, 706_2, 708_1, 708_2, 704_X, 704_Y, and the control signal 7306. Based on the information included in the control signal 7306 on the transmission scheme, modulation scheme, error correction coding scheme, coding rate for error correction coding, block size of error correction codes, and the like used to transmit each PLP, the signal processing unit 711 performs demodulation processing and decoding processing, and outputs received data 712.


Here, the signal processing unit 711 may perform demodulation processing by using Equation 41 of Math 41 and Equation 143 of Math 153 in a case where any of the following transmission schemes is used for to transmit each PLP: a spatial multiplexing MIMO system; a MIMO scheme employing a fixed precoding matrix; and a precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices. Note that the channel matrix (H) can be obtained from the resultant outputs from channel fluctuation estimating units (705_1, 705_2, 707_1 and 707_2). The matrix structure of the precoding matrix (F or W) differs depending on the transmission scheme actually used. Especially, when the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices is used, the precoding matrices to be used are hopped between and demodulation is performed every time. Also, when space-time block coding is used, demodulation is performed by using values obtained from channel estimation and a received (baseband) signal.



FIG. 74 shows, by way of example, the structure of a reception device of a terminal used in a case where the transmission device of the broadcast station shown in FIG. 72 has adopted a scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices. In FIG. 74, the elements that operate in the same manner as in FIGS. 7, 56 and 73 have the same reference signs thereas.


The reception device shown in FIG. 74 and the reception device shown in FIG. 73 are different in that the reception device shown in FIG. 73 can obtain data by receiving signals conforming to the DVB-T2 standard and signals conforming to standards other than the DVB-T2 standard, whereas the reception device shown in FIG. 74 can obtain data by receiving only signals conforming to standards other than the DVB-T2 standard.


Referring to FIG. 74, a P1 symbol detection/demodulation unit 7301 performs signal detection and temporal frequency synchronization by receiving a signal transmitted by a broadcast station and detecting a P1 symbol based on the inputs, namely signals 704_X and 704_Y that have been subjected to signal processing. The P1 symbol detection/demodulation unit 7301 also obtains control information included in the P1 symbol (by applying demodulation and error correction decoding) and outputs P1 symbol control information 7302. The P1 symbol control information 7302 is input to OFDM related processors 5600_X and 5600_Y. Based on the input information, the OFDM related processors 5600_X and 5600_Y change a signal processing scheme for the OFDM scheme. (This is because, as described in Embodiment A1, the P1 symbol includes information on a scheme for transmitting the signal transmitted by the broadcast station.)


Signals 704_X and 704_Y that have been subjected to signal processing, as well as the P1 symbol control information 7302, are input to a first/second signalling data demodulation unit 7401. The first/second signalling data demodulation unit 7401 performs signal processing and demodulation (including error correction decoding) based on the P1 symbol control information, and outputs first/second signalling data control information 7402.


The P1 symbol control information 7302 and the first/second signalling data control information 7402 are input to a control signal generating unit 7305. The control signal generating unit 7305 forms a set of pieces of control information (relating to receiving operations) and outputs the same as a control signal 7306. As illustrated in FIG. 74, the control signal 7306 is input to each unit.


A signal processing unit 711 receives, as inputs, the signals 706_1, 706_2, 708_1, 708_2, 704_X, 704_Y, and the control signal 7306. Based on the information included in the control signal 7306 on the transmission scheme, modulation scheme, error correction coding scheme, coding rate for error correction coding, block size of error correction codes, and the like used to transmit each PLP, the signal processing unit 711 performs demodulation processing and decoding processing, and outputs received data 712.


Here, the signal processing unit 711 may perform demodulation processing by using Equation 41 of Math 41 and Equation 143 of Math 153 in a case where any of the following transmission schemes is used to transmit each PLP: a spatial multiplexing MIMO system; a MIMO scheme employing a fixed precoding matrix; and a precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices. Note that the channel matrix (H) can be obtained from the resultant outputs from channel fluctuation estimating units (705_1, 705_2, 707_1 and 707_2). The matrix structure of the precoding matrix (F or W) differs depending on the transmission scheme actually used. Especially, when the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices is used, the precoding matrices to be used are hopped between and demodulation is performed every time. Also, when space-time block coding is used, demodulation is performed by using values obtained from channel estimation and a received (baseband) signal.



FIG. 75 shows the structure of a reception device of a terminal compliant with both the DVB-T2 standard and standards other than the DVB-T2 standard. In FIG. 75, the elements that operate in the same manner as in FIGS. 7, 56 and 73 have the same reference signs thereas.


The reception device shown in FIG. 75 is different from the reception devices shown in FIGS. 73 and 74 in that the reception device shown in FIG. 75 comprises a P2 symbol or first/second signalling data demodulation unit 7501 so as to be able to demodulate both signals compliant with the DVB-T2 standard and signals compliant with standards other than the DVB-T2 standard.


Signals 704_X and 704_Y that have been subjected to signal processing, as well as P1 symbol control information 7302, are input to the P2 symbol or first/second signalling data demodulation unit 7501. Based on the P1 symbol control information, the P2 symbol or first/second signalling data demodulation unit 7501 judges whether the received signal is compliant with the DVB-T2 standard or with a standard other than the DVB-T2 standard (this judgment can be made with use of, for example, Table 3), performs signal processing and demodulation (including error correction decoding), and outputs control information 7502 that includes information indicating the standard with which the received signal is compliant. Other operations are similar to FIGS. 73 and 74.


As set forth above, the structure of the reception device described in the present embodiment allows obtaining data with high reception quality by receiving the signal transmitted by the transmission device of the broadcast station, which has been described in Embodiment A1, and by performing appropriate signal processing. Especially, when receiving a signal associated with a precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices, both the data transmission efficiency and the data reception quality can be improved in an LOS environment.


As the present embodiment has described the structure of the reception device that corresponds to the transmission scheme used by the broadcast station described in Embodiment A1, the reception device is provided with two receive antennas in the present embodiment. However, the number of antennas provided in the reception device is not limited to two. The present embodiment can be implemented in the same manner when the reception device is provided with three or more antennas. In this case, the data reception quality can be improved due to an increase in the diversity gain. Furthermore, when the transmission device of the broadcast station is provided with three or more transmit antennas and transmits three or more modulated signals, the present embodiment can be implemented in the same manner by increasing the number of receive antennas provided in the reception device of the terminal. In this case, it is preferable that the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices be used as a transmission scheme.


Note that Embodiments 1 to 16 have described examples of the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices. However, the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices is not limited to the schemes described in Embodiments 1 to 16. The present embodiment can be implemented in the same manner by using a scheme comprising the steps of (i) preparing a plurality of precoding matrices, (ii) selecting, from among the prepared plurality of precoding matrices, one precoding matrix for each slot, and (iii) performing the precoding while regularly hopping between precoding matrices to be used for each slot.


Embodiment A3

In the system described in Embodiment A1 where the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices is applied to the DVB-T2 standard, there is control information for designating a pilot insertion pattern in L1 pre-signalling. The present embodiment describes how to apply the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices when the pilot insertion pattern is changed in the L1 pre-signalling.



FIGS. 76A, 76B, 77A and 77B show examples of a frame structure represented in a frequency-time domain for the DVB-T2 standard in a case where a plurality of modulated signals are transmitted from a plurality of antennas using the same frequency bandwidth. In each of FIGS. 76A to 77B, the horizontal axis represents frequency and carrier numbers are shown therealong, whereas the vertical axis represents time. FIGS. 76A and 77A each show a frame structure for a modulated signal z1 pertaining to the embodiments that have been described so far. FIGS. 76B and 77B each show a frame structure for a modulated signal z2 pertaining to the embodiments that have been described so far. Indexes “f0, f1, f2, . . . ” are assigned as carrier numbers, and indexes “t1, t2, t3, . . . ” are assigned as time. In FIGS. 76A to 77B, symbols that are assigned the same carrier number and the same time exist over the same frequency at the same time.



FIGS. 76A to 77B show examples of positions in which pilot symbols are inserted according to the DVB-T2 standard (when a plurality of modulated signals are transmitted by using a plurality of antennas according to the DVB-T2, there are eight schemes regarding the positions in which pilots are inserted; FIGS. 76A to 77B show two of such schemes). FIGS. 76A to 77B show two types of symbols, namely, symbols as pilots and symbols for data transmission (“data transmission symbols”). As described in other embodiments, when a precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices or a precoding scheme employing a fixed precoding matrix is used, data transmission symbols in the modulated signal z1 are obtained as a result of performing weighting on the streams s1 and s2, and data transmission symbols in the modulated signal z2 are obtained as a result of performing weighting on the streams s1 and s2. When the space-time block coding or the spatial multiplexing MIMO system is used, data transmission symbols in the modulated signal z1 are either for the stream s1 or for the stream s2, and data transmission symbols in the modulated signal z2 are either for the stream s1 or for the stream s2. In FIGS. 76A to 77B, the symbols as pilots are each assigned an index “PP1” or “PP2”. A pilot symbol with the index “PP1” and a pilot symbol with the index “PP2” are structured by using different schemes. As mentioned earlier, according to the DVB-T2 standard, the broadcast station can designate one of the eight pilot insertion schemes (that differ from one another in the frequency of insertion of pilot symbols in a frame). FIGS. 76A to 77B show two of the eight pilot insertion schemes. Information on one of the eight pilot insertion schemes selected by the broadcast station is transmitted to a transmission destination (terminal) as L1 pre-signalling data of P2 symbols, which has been described in embodiment A1.


Next, a description is given of how to apply the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices in association with a pilot insertion scheme. By way of example, it is assumed here that 10 different types of precoding matrices F are prepared for the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices, and these 10 different types of precoding matrices F are expressed as F[0], F[1], F[2], F[3], F[4], F[5], F[6], F[7], F[8], and F[9]. FIGS. 78A and 78B show the result of allocating the precoding matrices to the frame structure represented in the frequency-time domains shown in FIGS. 76A and 76B when the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices is applied. FIGS. 79A and 79B show the result of allocating the precoding matrices to the frame structure represented in the frequency-time domains shown in FIGS. 77A and 77B when the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices is applied. For example, in both of the frame structure for the modulated signal z1 shown in FIG. 78A and the frame structure for the modulated signal z2 shown in FIG. 78B, a symbol at the carrier f1 and the time t1 shows “#1”. This means that precoding is performed on this symbol by using the precoding matrix F[1]. Likewise, in FIGS. 78A to 79B, a symbol at the carrier fx and the time ty showing “#Z” denotes that precoding is performed on this symbol by using the precoding matrix F[Z] (here, x=0, 1, 2, . . . , and y=1, 2, 3, . . . ).


It should be naturally appreciated that different schemes for inserting pilot symbols (different insertion intervals) are used for the frame structure represented in the frequency-time domain shown in FIGS. 78A and 78B and the frame structure represented in the frequency-time domain shown in FIGS. 79A and 79B. Furthermore, the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between the coding matrices is not applied to pilot symbols. For this reason, even if all of the signals shown in FIGS. 78A to 79B are subjected to the same precoding scheme that regularly hops between precoding matrices over a certain period (cycle) (i.e., the same number of different precoding matrices are prepared for this scheme applied to all of the signals shown in FIGS. 78A to 79B), a precoding matrix allocated to a symbol at a certain carrier and a certain time in FIGS. 78A and 78B may be different from a precoding matrix allocated to the corresponding symbol in FIGS. 79A and 79B. This is apparent from FIGS. 78A to 79B. For example, in FIGS. 78A and 78B, a symbol at the carrier f5 and the time t2 shows “#7”, meaning that precoding is performed thereon by using the precoding matrix F[7]. On the other hand, in FIGS. 79A and 79B, a symbol at the carrier f5 and the time t2 shows “#8”, meaning that precoding is performed thereon by using the precoding matrix F[8].


Therefore, the broadcast station transmits control information indicating a pilot pattern (pilot insertion scheme) using the L1 pre-signalling data. Note, when the broadcast station has selected the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices as a scheme for transmitting each PLP based on control information shown in Table 4 or 5, the control information indicating the pilot pattern (pilot insertion scheme) may additionally indicate a scheme for allocating the precoding matrices (hereinafter “precoding matrix allocation scheme”) prepared for the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices. Hence, the reception device of the terminal that receives modulated signals transmitted by the broadcast station can acknowledge the precoding matrix allocation scheme used in the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices by obtaining the control information indicating the pilot pattern, which is included in the L1 pre-signalling data (on the premise that the broadcast station has selected the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices as a scheme for transmitting each PLP based on control information shown in Table 4 or 5). Although the description of the present embodiment has been given with reference to L1 pre-signalling data, in the case of the frame structure shown in FIG. 70 where no P2 symbol exists, the control information indicating the pilot pattern and the precoding matrix allocation scheme used in the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices is included in first signalling data and second signalling data.


The following describes another example. For example, the above description is also true of a case where the precoding matrices used in the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices are determined at the same time as designation of a modulation scheme, as shown in Table 2. In this case, by transmitting only the pieces of control information indicating a pilot pattern, a scheme for transmitting each PLP and a modulation scheme from P2 symbols, the reception device of the terminal can estimate, via obtainment of these pieces of control information, the precoding matrix allocation scheme used in the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices (note, the allocation is performed in the frequency-time domain). Assume a case where the precoding matrices used in the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices are determined at the same time as designation of a modulation scheme and an error correction coding scheme, as shown in Table 1B. In this case also, by transmitting only the pieces of control information indicating a pilot pattern, a scheme for transmitting each PLP and a modulation scheme, as well as an error correction coding scheme, from P2 symbols, the reception device of the terminal can estimate, via obtainment of these pieces of information, the precoding matrix allocation scheme used in the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices (note, the allocation is performed in the frequency-time domain).


However, unlike the cases of Tables 1B and 2, a precoding matrix hopping scheme used in the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices is transmitted, as indicated by Table 5, in any of the following situations (i) to (iii): (i) when one of two or more different schemes of regularly hopping between precoding matrices can be selected even if the modulation scheme is determined (examples of such two or more different schemes include: precoding schemes that regularly hop between precoding matrices over different periods (cycles); and precoding schemes that regularly hop between precoding matrices, where the precoding matrices used in one scheme is different from those used in another; (ii) when one of two or more different schemes of regularly hopping between precoding matrices can be selected even if the modulation scheme and the error correction scheme are determined; and (iii) when one of two or more different schemes of regularly hopping between precoding matrices can be selected even if the error correction scheme is determined. In any of these situations (i) to (iii), it is permissible to transmit information on the precoding matrix allocation scheme used in the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices, in addition to the precoding matrix hopping scheme used in the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices (note, the allocation is performed in the frequency-time domain).


Table 7 shows an example of the structure of control information for the information on the precoding matrix allocation scheme used in the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices (note, the allocation is performed in the frequency-time domain).










TABLE 7







MATRIX_FRAME_ARRANGEMENT
00: Precoding matrix allo-


(2 bits)
cation scheme #1 in frames



01: Precoding matrix allo-



cation scheme #2 in frames



10: Precoding matrix allo-



cation scheme #3 in frames



11: Precoding matrix allo-



cation scheme #4 in frames









By way of example, assume a case where the transmission device of the broadcast station has selected the pilot insertion pattern shown in FIGS. 76A and 76B, and selected a scheme A as the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices. In this case, the transmission device of the broadcast station can select either the precoding matrix allocation scheme shown in FIGS. 78A and 78B or the precoding matrix allocation scheme shown in FIGS. 80A and 80B (note, the allocation is performed in the frequency-time domain). For example, when the transmission device of the broadcast station has selected the precoding matrix allocation scheme shown in FIGS. 78A and 78B, “MATRIX_FRAME_ARRANGEMENT” in Table 7 is set to “00”. On the other hand, when the transmission device has selected the precoding matrix allocation scheme shown in FIGS. 80A and 80B, “MATRIX_FRAME_ARRANGEMENT” in Table 7 is set to “01”. Then, the reception device of the terminal can acknowledge the precoding matrix allocation scheme by obtaining the control information shown in Table 7 (note, the allocation is performed in the frequency-time domain). Note that the control information shown in Table 7 can be transmitted by using P2 symbols, or by using first signalling data and second signalling data.


As set forth above, by implementing the precoding matrix allocation scheme used in the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices based on the pilot insertion scheme, and by properly transmitting the information indicative of the precoding matrix allocation scheme to the transmission destination (terminal), the reception device of the terminal can achieve the advantageous effect of improving both the data transmission efficiency and the data reception quality.


The present embodiment has described a case where the broadcast station transmits two signals. However, the present embodiment can be implemented in the same manner when the transmission device of the broadcast station is provided with three or more transmit antennas and transmits three or more modulated signals. Embodiments 1 to 16 have described examples of the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices. However, the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices is not limited to the schemes described in Embodiments 1 to 16. The present embodiment can be implemented in the same manner by using a scheme comprising the steps of (i) preparing a plurality of precoding matrices, (ii) selecting, from among the prepared plurality of precoding matrices, one precoding matrix for each slot, and (iii) performing the precoding while regularly hopping between precoding matrices to be used for each slot.


Embodiment A4

In the present embodiment, a description is given of a repetition scheme used in a precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices in order to improve the data reception quality.



FIGS. 3, 4, 13, 40 and 53 each show the structure of a transmission device employing the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices. On the other hand, the present embodiment describes the examples where repetition is used in the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices.



FIG. 81 shows an example of the structure of the signal processing unit pertaining to a case where repetition is used in the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices. In light of FIG. 53, the structure of FIG. 81 corresponds to the signal processing unit 5308.


A baseband signal 8101_1 shown in FIG. 81 corresponds to the baseband signal 5307_1 shown in FIG. 53. The baseband signal 8101_1 is obtained as a result of mapping, and constitutes the stream s1. Likewise, a baseband signal 8101_2 shown in FIG. 81 corresponds to the baseband signal 5307_2 shown in FIG. 53. The baseband signal 8101_2 is obtained as a result of mapping, and constitutes the stream s2.


The baseband signal 8101_1 and a control signal 8104 are input to a signal processing unit (duplicating unit) 8102_1. The signal processing unit (duplicating unit) 8102_1 generates duplicates of the baseband signal in accordance with the information on the number of repetitions included in the control signal 8104. For example, in a case where the information on the number of repetitions included in the control signal 8104 indicates four repetitions, provided that the baseband signal 8101_1 includes signals s11, s12, s13, s14, . . . arranged in the stated order along the time axis, the signal processing unit (duplicating unit) 8102_1 generates a duplicate of each signal four times, and outputs the resultant duplicates. That is, after the four repetitions, the signal processing unit (duplicating unit) 8102_1 outputs, as the baseband signal 8103_1, four pieces of s11 (i.e., s11, s11, s11, s11), four pieces of s12 (i.e., s12, s12, s12, s12), four pieces of s13 (i.e., s13, s13, s13, s13), four pieces of s14 (i.e., s14, s14, s14, s14) and so on, in the stated order along the time axis.


The baseband signal 8101_2 and the control signal 8104 are input to a signal processing unit (duplicating unit) 8102_2. The signal processing unit (duplicating unit) 8102_2 generates duplicates of the baseband signal in accordance with the information on the number of repetitions included in the control signal 8104. For example, in a case where the information on the number of repetitions included in the control signal 8104 indicates four repetitions, provided that the baseband signal 8101_2 includes signals s21, s22, s23, s24, . . . arranged in the stated order along the time axis, the signal processing unit (duplicating unit) 8102_2 generates a duplicate of each signal four times, and outputs the resultant duplicates. That is, after the four repetitions, the signal processing unit (duplicating unit) 8102_2 outputs, as the baseband signal 8103_2, four pieces of s21 (i.e., s21, s21, s21, s21), four pieces of s22 (i.e., s22, s22, s22, s22), four pieces of s23 (i.e., s23, s23, s23, s13), four pieces of s24 (i.e., s14, s24, s24, s24) and so on, in the stated order along the time axis.


The baseband signals 8103_1 and 8103_2 obtained as a result of repetitions, as well as the control signal 8104, are input to a weighting unit (precoding operation unit) 8105. The weighting unit (precoding operation unit) 8105 performs precoding based on the information on the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices, which is included in the control signal 8104. More specifically, the weighting unit (precoding operation unit) 8105 performs weighting on the baseband signals 8103_1 and 8103_2 obtained as a result of repetitions, and outputs baseband signals 8106_1 and 8106_2 on which the precoding has been performed (here, the baseband signals 8106_1 and 8106_2 are respectively expressed as z1(i) and z2(i), where i represents the order (along time or frequency)).


Provided that the baseband signals 8103_1 and 8103_2 obtained as a result of repetitions are respectively y1(i) and y2(i) and the precoding matrix is F(i), the following relationship is satisfied.









Math





651












(




z





1


(
i
)







z





2


(
i
)





)

=


F


(
i
)




(




y





1


(
i
)







y





2


(
i
)





)






Equation





475







Provided that N precoding matrices prepared for the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices are F[0], F[1], F[2], F[3], . . . , F[N−1] (where N is an integer larger than or equal to two), one of the precoding matrices F[0], F[1], F[2], F[3], . . . , F[N−1] is used as F(i) in Equation 475.


By way of example, assume that i=0, 1, 2, 3; y1(i) represents four duplicated baseband signals s11, s11, s11, s11; and y2(i) represents four duplicated baseband signals s21, s21, s21, s21. Under this assumption, it is important that the following condition be met.

Math 562
For αβ, the relationship F(α)≠F(β) is satisfied (for α,β=0, 1, 2, 3 and α≠β).


The following description is derived by generalizing the above. Assume that the number of repetitions is K; i=g0, g1, g2, . . . , gK-1 (i.e., gj where j is an integer in a range of 0 to K−1); and y1(i) represents s11. Under this assumption, it is important that the following condition be met.

Math 563
For αβ, the relationship F(α)≠F(β) is satisfied (for α, β=gj (j being an integer in a range of 0 to K−1) and α≠β).


Likewise, assume that the number of repetitions is K; i=h0, h1, h2, . . . , hK-1 (i.e., where j is an integer in a range of 0 to K−1); and y2(i) represents s21. Under this assumption, it is important that the following condition be met.

Math 564
For αβ, the relationship F(α)≠F(β) is satisfied (for α,β=hj (j being an integer in a range of 0 to K−1) and α≠β).


Here, the relationship gj=hj may be or may not be satisfied. This way, the identical streams generated through the repetitions are transmitted while using different precoding matrices therefor, and thus the advantageous effect of improving the data reception quality is achieved.


The present embodiment has described a case where the broadcast station transmits two signals. However, the present embodiment can be implemented in the same manner when the transmission device of the broadcast station is provided with three or more transmit antennas and transmits three or more modulated signals. Assume that the number of transmitted signals is Q; the number of repetitions is K; i=g0, g1, g2, . . . , gK-1 (i.e., gj where j is an integer in a range of 0 to K−1); and yb(i) represents sb1 (where b is an integer in a range of 1 to Q). Under this assumption, it is important that the following condition be met.

Math 565
For αβ, the relationship F(α)≠F(β) is satisfied (for α,β=gj (j being an integer in a range of 0 to K−1) and α≠β).


Note that F(i) is a precoding matrix pertaining to a case where the number of transmitted signals is Q.


Next, an embodiment different from the embodiment illustrated in FIG. 81 is described with reference to FIG. 82. In FIG. 82, the elements that operate in the same manner as in FIG. 81 have the same reference signs thereas. The structure shown in FIG. 82 is different from the structure shown in FIG. 81 in that data pieces are reorders so as to transmit identical data pieces from different antennas.


A baseband signal 8101_1 shown in FIG. 82 corresponds to the baseband signal 5307_1 shown in FIG. 53. The baseband signal 8101_1 is obtained as a result of mapping, and constitutes the s1 stream. Similarly, a baseband signal 8101_2 shown in FIG. 81 corresponds to the baseband signal 5307_2 shown in FIG. 53. The baseband signal 8101_2 is obtained as a result of mapping, and constitutes the s2 stream. The baseband signal 8101_1 and the control signal 8104 are input to a signal processing unit (duplicating unit) 8102_1. The signal processing unit (duplicating unit) 8102_1 generates duplicates of the baseband signal in accordance with the information on the number of repetitions included in the control signal 8104. For example, in a case where the information on the number of repetitions included in the control signal 8104 indicates four repetitions, provided that the baseband signal 8101_1 includes signals s11, s12, s13, s14, . . . arranged in the stated order along the time axis, the signal processing unit (duplicating unit) 8102_1 generates a duplicate of each signal four times, and outputs the resultant duplicates. That is, after the four repetitions, the signal processing unit (duplicating unit) 8102_1 outputs, as the baseband signal 8103_1, four pieces of s11 (i.e., s11, s11, s11, s11), four pieces of s12 (i.e., s12, s12, s12, s12), four pieces of s13 (i.e., s13, s13, s13, s13), four pieces of s14 (i.e., s14, s14, s14, s14) and so on, in the stated order along the time axis.


The baseband signal 8101_2 and the control signal 8104 are input to a signal processing unit (duplicating unit) 8102_2. The signal processing unit (duplicating unit) 8102_2 generates duplicates of the baseband signal in accordance with the information on the number of repetitions included in the control signal 8104. For example, in a case where the information on the number of repetitions included in the control signal 8104 indicates four repetitions, provided that the baseband signal 8101_2 includes signals s21, s22, s23, s24, . . . arranged in the stated order along the time axis, the signal processing unit (duplicating unit) 8102_1 generates a duplicate of each signal four times, and outputs the resultant duplicates. That is, after the four repetitions, the signal processing unit (duplicating unit) 8102_2 outputs, as the baseband signal 8103_2, four pieces of s21 (i.e., s21, s21, s21, s21), four pieces of s22 (i.e., s22, s22, s22, s22), four pieces of s23 (i.e., s23, s23, s23, s23), four pieces of s24 (i.e., s24, s24, s24, s24) and so on, in the stated order along the time axis.


The baseband signals 8103_1 and 8103_2 obtained as a result of repetitions, as well as the control signal 8104, are input to a reordering unit 8201. The reordering unit 8201 reorders the data pieces in accordance with information on a repetition scheme included in the control signal 8104, and outputs baseband signals 8202_1 and 8202_2 obtained as a result of reordering. For example, assume that the baseband signal 8103_1 obtained as a result of repetitions is composed of four pieces of s11 (s11, s11, s11, s11) arranged along the time axis, and the baseband signal 8103_2 obtained as a result of repetitions is composed of four pieces of s21 (s21, s21, s21, s21) arranged along the time axis. In FIG. 82, s11 is output as both y1(i) and y2(i) of Equation 475, and s21 is similarly output as both y1(i) and y2(i) of Equation 475. Likewise, the reordering similar to the reordering performed on s11 is performed on s12, s13, . . . , and the reordering similar to the reordering performed on s21 is performed on s22, s23, . . . . Hence, the baseband signal 8202_1 obtained as a result of reordering includes s11, s21, s11, s21, s12, s22, s12, s22, s13, s23, s13, s23, . . . arranged in the stated order, which are equivalent to y1(i) of Equation 475. Although the pieces of s11 and s21 are arranged in the order s11, s21, s11 and s21 in the above description, the pieces of s11 and s21 are not limited to being arranged in this way, but may be arranged in any order. Similarly, the pieces of s12 and s22, as well as the pieces of s13 and s23, may be arranged in any order. The baseband signal 8202_2 obtained as a result of reordering includes s21, s11, s21, s11, s22, s12, s22, s12, s23, s13, s23, s13, . . . in the stated order, which are equivalent to y2(i) of Equation 475. Although the pieces of s11 and s21 are arranged in the order s21, s11, s21 and s11 in the above description, the pieces of s11 and s21 are not limited to being arranged in this way, but may be arranged in any order. Similarly, the pieces of s12 and s22, as well as the pieces of s13 and s23, may be arranged in any order.


The baseband signals 8202_1 and 8202_2 obtained as a result of reordering, as well as the control signal 8104, are input to a weighting unit (precoding operation unit) 8105. The weighting unit (precoding operation unit) 8105 performs precoding based on the information on the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices, which is included in the control signal 8104. More specifically, the weighting unit (precoding operation unit) 8105 performs weighting on the baseband signals 8202_1 and 8202_2 obtained as a result of reordering, and outputs baseband signals 8106_1 and 8106_2 on which the precoding has been performed (here, the baseband signals 8106_1 and 8106_2 are respectively expressed as z1(i) and z2(i), where i represents the order (along time or frequency)).


As described earlier, under the assumption that the baseband signals 8202_1 and 8202_2 obtained as a result of reordering are respectively y1(i) and y2(i) and the precoding matrix is F(i), the relationship in Equation 475 is satisfied.


Provided that N precoding matrices prepared for the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices are F[0], F[1], F[2], F[3], . . . , F[N−1] (where N is an integer larger than or equal to two), one of the precoding matrices F[0], F[1], F[2], F[3], . . . , F[N−1] is used as F(i) in Equation 475.


Although it has been described above that four repetitions are performed, the number of repetitions is not limited to four. As with the structure shown in FIG. 81, the structure shown in FIG. 82 also achieves high reception quality when the relationships set out in Math 304 to Math 307 are satisfied.


The structure of the reception device is illustrated in FIGS. 7 and 56. By taking advantage of fulfillment of the relationships set out in Equation 144 and Equation 475, the signal processing unit demodulates bits transmitted by each of s11, s12, s13, s14, . . . , and bits transmitted by each of s21, s22, s23, s24, . . . . Note that each bit may be calculated as a log-likelihood ratio or as a hard-decision value. Furthermore, by taking advantage of the fact that K repetitions are performed on s11, it is possible to obtain highly reliable estimate values for bits transmitted by s1. Likewise, by taking advantage of the fact that K repetitions are performed on s12, s13, . . . , and on s21, s22, s23, . . . , it is possible to obtain highly reliable estimate values for bits transmitted by s12, s13, . . . , and by s21, s22, s23, . . . .


The present embodiment has described a scheme for applying a precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices in the case where the repetitions are performed. When there are two types of slots, i.e., slots over which data is transmitted after performing the repetitions, and slots over which data is transmitted without performing the repetitions, either of a precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices or a precoding scheme employing a fixed precoding matrix may be used as a transmission scheme for the slots over which data is transmitted without performing the repetitions. Put another way, in order for the reception device to achieve high data reception quality, it is important that the transmission scheme pertaining to the present embodiment be used for the slots over which data is transmitted after performing the repetitions.


In the systems associated with the DVB standard that have been described in Embodiments A1 through A3, it is necessary to secure higher reception qualities for P2 symbols, first signalling data and second signalling data than for PLPs. When P2 symbols, first signalling data and second signalling data are transmitted by using the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices described in the present embodiment, which incorporates the repetitions, the reception quality of control information improves in the reception device. This is important for stable operations of the systems.


Embodiments 1 to 16 have provided examples of the precoding scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices described in the present embodiment. However, the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices is not limited to the schemes described in Embodiments 1 to 16. The present embodiment can be implemented in the same manner by using a scheme comprising the steps of (i) preparing a plurality of precoding matrices, (ii) selecting, from among the prepared plurality of precoding matrices, one precoding matrix for each slot, and (iii) performing the precoding while regularly hopping between precoding matrices for each slot.


Embodiment A5

The present embodiment describes a scheme for transmitting modulated signals by applying common amplification to the transmission scheme described in Embodiment A1.



FIG. 83 shows an example of the structure of a transmission device. In FIG. 83, the elements that operate in the same manner as in FIG. 52 have the same reference signs thereas.


Modulated signal generating units #1 to #M (i.e., 5201_1 to 5201_M) shown in FIG. 83 generate the signals 6323_1 and 6323_2 from the input signals (input data), the signals 6323_1 and 6323_2 being subjected to processing for a P1 symbol and shown in FIG. 63 or 72. The modulated signal generating units #1 to #M output modulated signals z1 (5202_1 to 5202_M) and modulated signals z2 (5203_1 to 5203_M).


The modulated signals z1 (5202_1 to 5202_M) are input to a wireless processing unit 8301_1 shown in FIG. 83. The wireless processing unit 8301_1 performs signal processing (e.g., frequency conversion) and amplification, and outputs a modulated signal 8302_1. Thereafter, the modulated signal 8302_1 is output from an antenna 8303_1 as a radio wave.


Similarly, the modulated signals z2 (5203_1 to 5203_M) are input to a wireless processing unit 8301_2. The wireless processing unit 8301_2 performs signal processing (e.g., frequency conversion) and amplification, and outputs a modulated signal 8302_2. Thereafter, the modulated signal 8302_2 is output from an antenna 8303_2 as a radio wave.


As set forth above, it is permissible to use the transmission scheme described in Embodiment A1 while performing frequency conversion and amplification simultaneously on modulated signals having different frequency bandwidths.


Embodiment B1

The following describes a structural example of an application of the transmission schemes and reception schemes shown in the above embodiments and a system using the application.



FIG. 84 shows an example of the structure of a system that includes devices implementing the transmission schemes and reception schemes described in the above embodiments. The transmission scheme and reception scheme described in the above embodiments are implemented in a digital broadcasting system 8400, as shown in FIG. 84, that includes a broadcasting station and a variety of reception devices such as a television 8411, a DVD recorder 8412, a Set Top Box (STB) 8413, a computer 8420, an in-car television 8441, and a mobile phone 8430. Specifically, the broadcasting station 8401 transmits multiplexed data, in which video data, audio data, and the like are multiplexed, using the transmission schemes in the above embodiments over a predetermined broadcasting band.


An antenna (for example, antennas 8560 and 8440) internal to each reception device, or provided externally and connected to the reception device, receives the signal transmitted from the broadcasting station 8401. Each reception device obtains the multiplexed data by using the reception schemes in the above embodiments to demodulate the signal received by the antenna. In this way, the digital broadcasting system 8400 obtains the advantageous effects of the present invention described in the above embodiments.


The video data included in the multiplexed data has been coded with a moving picture coding method compliant with a standard such as Moving Picture Experts Group (MPEG)-2, MPEG-4 Advanced Video Coding (AVC), VC-1, or the like. The audio data included in the multiplexed data has been encoded with an audio coding method compliant with a standard such as Dolby Audio Coding (AC)-3, Dolby Digital Plus, Meridian Lossless Packing (MLP), Digital Theater Systems (DTS), DTS-HD, Linear Pulse-Code Modulation (PCM), or the like.



FIG. 85 is a schematic view illustrating an exemplary structure of a reception device 8500 for carrying out the reception schemes described in the above embodiments. As illustrated in FIG. 85, in one exemplary structure, the reception device 8500 may be composed of a modem portion implemented on a single LSI (or a single chip set) and a codec portion implemented on another single LSI (or another single chip set). The reception device 8500 shown in FIG. 85 corresponds to a component that is included, for example, in the television 8411, the DVD recorder 8412, the STB 8413, the computer 8420, the in-car television 8441, the mobile phone 8430, or the like illustrated in FIG. 84. The reception device 8500 includes a tuner 8501, for transforming a high-frequency signal received by an antenna 8560 into a baseband signal, and a demodulation unit 8502, for demodulating multiplexed data from the baseband signal obtained by frequency conversion. The reception schemes described in the above embodiments are implemented in the demodulation unit 8502, thus obtaining the advantageous effects of the present invention described in the above embodiments.


The reception device 8500 includes a stream input/output unit 8520, a signal processing unit 8504, an audio output unit 8506, and a video display unit 8507. The stream input/output unit 8520 demultiplexes video and audio data from multiplexed data obtained by the demodulation unit 8502. The signal processing unit 8504 decodes the demultiplexed video data into a video signal using an appropriate method picture decoding method and decodes the demultiplexed audio data into an audio signal using an appropriate audio decoding scheme. The audio output unit 8506, such as a speaker, produces audio output according to the decoded audio signal. The video display unit 8507, such as a display monitor, produces video output according to the decoded video signal.


For example, the user may operate the remote control 8550 to select a channel (of a TV program or audio broadcast), so that information indicative of the selected channel is transmitted to an operation input unit 8510. In response, the reception device 8500 demodulates, from among signals received with the antenna 8560, a signal carried on the selected channel and applies error correction decoding, so that reception data is extracted. At this time, the reception device 8500 receives control symbols included in a signal corresponding to the selected channel and containing information indicating the transmission scheme (the transmission scheme, modulation scheme, error correction scheme, and the like in the above embodiments) of the signal (exactly as described in Embodiments A1 through A4 and as shown in FIGS. 5 and 41). With this information, the reception device 8500 is enabled to make appropriate settings for the receiving operations, demodulation scheme, scheme of error correction decoding, and the like to duly receive data included in data symbols transmitted from a broadcasting station (base station). Although the above description is directed to an example in which the user selects a channel using the remote control 8550, the same description applies to an example in which the user selects a channel using a selection key provided on the reception device 8500.


With the above structure, the user can view a broadcast program that the reception device 8500 receives by the reception schemes described in the above embodiments.


The reception device 8500 according to this embodiment may additionally include a recording unit (drive) 8508 for recording various data onto a recording medium, such as a magnetic disk, optical disc, or a non-volatile semiconductor memory. Examples of data to be recorded by the recording unit 8508 include data contained in multiplexed data that is obtained as a result of demodulation and error correction decoding by the demodulation unit 8502, data equivalent to such data (for example, data obtained by compressing the data), and data obtained by processing the moving pictures and/or audio. (Note here that there may be a case where no error correction decoding is applied to a signal obtained as a result of demodulation by the demodulation unit 8502 and where the reception device 8500 conducts further signal processing after error correction decoding. The same holds in the following description where similar wording appears.) Note that the term “optical disc” used herein refers to a recording medium, such as Digital Versatile Disc (DVD) or BD (Blu-ray Disc), that is readable and writable with the use of a laser beam. Further, the term “magnetic disk” used herein refers to a recording medium, such as a floppy disk (FD, registered trademark) or hard disk, that is writable by magnetizing a magnetic substance with magnetic flux. Still further, the term “non-volatile semiconductor memory” refers to a recording medium, such as flash memory or ferroelectric random access memory, composed of semiconductor element(s). Specific examples of non-volatile semiconductor memory include an SD card using flash memory and a flash Solid State Drive (SSD). It should be naturally appreciated that the specific types of recording media mentioned herein are merely examples, and any other types of recording mediums may be usable.


With the above structure, the user can record a broadcast program that the reception device 8500 receives with any of the reception schemes described in the above embodiments, and time-shift viewing of the recorded broadcast program is possible anytime after the broadcast.


In the above description of the reception device 8500, the recording unit 8508 records multiplexed data obtained as a result of demodulation and error correction decoding by the demodulation unit 8502. However, the recording unit 8508 may record part of data extracted from the data contained in the multiplexed data. For example, the multiplexed data obtained as a result of demodulation and error correction decoding by the demodulation unit 8502 may contain contents of data broadcast service, in addition to video data and audio data. In this case, new multiplexed data may be generated by multiplexing the video data and audio data, without the contents of broadcast service, extracted from the multiplexed data demodulated by the demodulation unit 8502, and the recording unit 8508 may record the newly generated multiplexed data. Alternatively, new multiplexed data may be generated by multiplexing either of the video data and audio data contained in the multiplexed data obtained as a result of demodulation and error correction decoding by the demodulation unit 8502, and the recording unit 8508 may record the newly generated multiplexed data. The recording unit 8508 may also record the contents of data broadcast service included, as described above, in the multiplexed data.


The reception device 8500 described in this embodiment may be included in a television, a recorder (such as DVD recorder, Blu-ray recorder, HDD recorder, SD card recorder, or the like), or a mobile telephone. In such a case, the multiplexed data obtained as a result of demodulation and error correction decoding by the demodulation unit 8502 may contain data for correcting errors (bugs) in software used to operate the television or recorder or in software used to prevent disclosure of personal or confidential information. If such data is contained, the data is installed on the television or recorder to correct the software errors. Further, if data for correcting errors (bugs) in software installed in the reception device 8500 is contained, such data is used to correct errors that the reception device 8500 may have. This arrangement ensures more stable operation of the TV, recorder, or mobile phone in which the reception device 8500 is implemented.


Note that it may be the stream input/output unit 8503 that handles extraction of data from the whole data contained in multiplexed data obtained as a result of demodulation and error correction decoding by the demodulation unit 8502 and multiplexing of the extracted data. More specifically, under instructions given from a control unit not illustrated in the figures, such as a CPU, the stream input/output unit 8503 demultiplexes video data, audio data, contents of data broadcast service etc. from the multiplexed data demodulated by the demodulation unit 8502, extracts specific pieces of data from the demultiplexed data, and multiplexes the extracted data pieces to generate new multiplexed data. The data pieces to be extracted from demultiplexed data may be determined by the user or determined in advance for the respective types of recording mediums.


With the above structure, the reception device 8500 is enabled to extract and record only data necessary to view a recorded broadcast program, which is effective to reduce the size of data to be recorded.


In the above description, the recording unit 8508 records multiplexed data obtained as a result of demodulation and error correction decoding by the demodulation unit 8502. Alternatively, however, the recording unit 8508 may record new multiplexed data generated by multiplexing video data newly yielded by encoding the original video data contained in the multiplexed data obtained as a result of demodulation and error correction decoding by the demodulation unit 8502. Here, the moving picture coding method to be employed may be different from that used to encode the original video data, so that the data size or bit rate of the new video data is smaller than the original video data. Here, the moving picture coding method used to generate new video data may be of a different standard from that used to generate the original video data. Alternatively, the same moving picture coding method may be used but with different parameters. Similarly, the recording unit 8508 may record new multiplexed data generated by multiplexing audio data newly obtained by encoding the original audio data contained in the multiplexed data obtained as a result of demodulation and error correction decoding by the demodulation unit 8502. Here, the audio coding method to be employed may be different from that used to encode the original audio data, such that the data size or bit rate of the new audio data is smaller than the original audio data.


The process of converting the original video or audio data contained in the multiplexed data obtained as a result of demodulation and error correction decoding by the demodulation unit 8502 into the video or audio data of a different data size of bit rate is performed, for example, by the stream input/output unit 8503 and the signal processing unit 8504. More specifically, under instructions given from the control unit such as the CPU, the stream input/output unit 8503 demultiplexes video data, audio data, contents of data broadcast service etc. from the multiplexed data obtained as a result of demodulation and error correction decoding by the demodulation unit 8502. Under instructions given from the control unit, the signal processing unit 8504 converts the demultiplexed video data and audio data respectively using a moving picture coding method and an audio coding method each different from the method that was used in the conversion applied to obtain the video and audio data. Under instructions given from the control unit, the stream input/output unit 8503 multiplexes the newly converted video data and audio data to generate new multiplexed data. Note that the signal processing unit 8504 may perform the conversion of either or both of the video or audio data according to instructions given from the control unit. In addition, the sizes of video data and audio data to be obtained by encoding may be specified by a user or determined in advance for the types of recording mediums.


With the above arrangement, the reception device 8500 is enabled to record video and audio data after converting the data to a size recordable on the recording medium or to a size or bit rate that matches the read or write rate of the recording unit 8508. This arrangement enables the recoding unit to duly record a program, even if the size recordable on the recording medium is smaller than the data size of the multiplexed data obtained as a result of demodulation and error correction decoding by the demodulation unit 8502, or if the rate at which the recording unit records or reads is lower than the bit rate of the multiplexed data. Consequently, time-shift viewing of the recorded program by the user is possible anytime after the broadcast.


Furthermore, the reception device 8500 additionally includes a stream output interface (IF) 8509 for transmitting multiplexed data demodulated by the demodulation unit 8502 to an external device via a transport medium 8530. In one example, the stream output IF 8509 may be a wireless communication device that transmits multiplexed data via a wireless medium (equivalent to the transport medium 8530) to an external device by modulating the multiplexed data in accordance with a wireless communication scheme compliant with a wireless communication standard such as Wi-Fi (registered trademark, a set of standards including IEEE 802.11a, IEEE 802.11b, IEEE 802.11g, and IEEE 802.11n), WiGiG, Wireless HD, Bluetooth, ZigBee, or the like. The stream output IF 8509 may also be a wired communication device that transmits multiplexed data via a transmission line (equivalent to the transport medium 8530) physically connected to the stream output IF 8509 to an external device, modulating the multiplexed data using a communication scheme compliant with wired communication standards, such as Ethernet (registered trademark), Universal Serial Bus (USB), Power Line Communication (PLC), or High-Definition Multimedia Interface (HDMI).


With the above structure, the user can use, on an external device, multiplexed data received by the reception device 8500 using the reception scheme described according to the above embodiments. The usage of multiplexed data by the user mentioned herein includes use of the multiplexed data for real-time viewing on an external device, recording of the multiplexed data by a recording unit included in an external device, and transmission of the multiplexed data from an external device to a yet another external device.


In the above description of the reception device 8500, the stream output IF 8509 outputs multiplexed data obtained as a result of demodulation and error correction decoding by the demodulation unit 8502. However, the reception device 8500 may output data extracted from data contained in the multiplexed data, rather than the whole data contained in the multiplexed data. For example, the multiplexed data obtained as a result of demodulation and error correction decoding by the demodulation unit 8502 may contain contents of data broadcast service, in addition to video data and audio data. In this case, the stream output IF 8509 may output multiplexed data newly generated by multiplexing video and audio data extracted from the multiplexed data obtained as a result of demodulation and error correction decoding by the demodulation unit 8502. In another example, the stream output IF 8509 may output multiplexed data newly generated by multiplexing either of the video data and audio data contained in the multiplexed data obtained as a result of demodulation and error correction decoding by the demodulation unit 8502.


Note that it may be the stream input/output unit 8503 that handles extraction of data from the whole data contained in multiplexed data obtained as a result of demodulation and error correction decoding by the demodulation unit 8502 and multiplexing of the extracted data. More specifically, under instructions given from a control unit not illustrated in the figures, such as a Central Processing Unit (CPU), the stream input/output unit 8503 demultiplexes video data, audio data, contents of data broadcast service etc. from the multiplexed data demodulated by the demodulation unit 8502, extracts specific pieces of data from the demultiplexed data, and multiplexes the extracted data pieces to generate new multiplexed data. The data pieces to be extracted from demultiplexed data may be determined by the user or determined in advance for the respective types of the stream output IF 8509.


With the above structure, the reception device 8500 is enabled to extract and output only data necessary for an external device, which is effective to reduce the communication bandwidth used to output the multiplexed data.


In the above description, the stream output IF 8509 outputs multiplexed data obtained as a result of demodulation and error correction decoding by the demodulation unit 8502. Alternatively, however, the stream output IF 8509 may output new multiplexed data generated by multiplexing video data newly yielded by encoding the original video data contained in the multiplexed data obtained as a result of demodulation and error correction decoding by the demodulation unit 8502. The new video data is encoded with a moving picture coding method different from that used to encode the original video data, so that the data size or bit rate of the new video data is smaller than the original video data. Here, the moving picture coding method used to generate new video data may be of a different standard from that used to generate the original video data. Alternatively, the same moving picture coding method may be used but with different parameters. Similarly, the stream output IF 8509 may output new multiplexed data generated by multiplexing audio data newly obtained by encoding the original audio data contained in the multiplexed data obtained as a result of demodulation and error correction decoding by the demodulation unit 8502. The new audio data is encoded with an audio coding method different from that used to encode the original audio data, such that the data size or bit rate of the new audio data is smaller than the original audio data.


The process of converting the original video or audio data contained in the multiplexed data obtained as a result of demodulation and error correction decoding by the demodulation unit 8502 into the video or audio data of a different data size of bit rate is performed, for example, by the stream input/output unit 8503 and the signal processing unit 8504. More specifically, under instructions given from the control unit, the stream input/output unit 8503 demultiplexes video data, audio data, contents of data broadcast service etc. from the multiplexed data obtained as a result of demodulation and error correction decoding by the demodulation unit 8502. Under instructions given from the control unit, the signal processing unit 8504 converts the demultiplexed video data and audio data respectively using a moving picture coding method and an audio coding method each different from the method that was used in the conversion applied to obtain the video and audio data. Under instructions given from the control unit, the stream input/output unit 8503 multiplexes the newly converted video data and audio data to generate new multiplexed data. Note that the signal processing unit 8504 may perform the conversion of either or both of the video or audio data according to instructions given from the control unit. In addition, the sizes of video data and audio data to be obtained by conversion may be specified by the user or determined in advance for the types of the stream output IF 8509.


With the above structure, the reception device 8500 is enabled to output video and audio data after converting the data to a bit rate that matches the transfer rate between the reception device 8500 and an external device. This arrangement ensures that even if multiplexed data obtained as a result of demodulation and error correction decoding by the demodulation unit 8502 is higher in bit rate than the data transfer rate to an external device, the stream output IF duly outputs new multiplexed data at an appropriate bit rate to the external device. Consequently, the user can use the new multiplexed data on another communication device.


Furthermore, the reception device 8500 also includes an audio and visual output interface (hereinafter, AV output IF) 8511 that outputs video and audio signals decoded by the signal processing unit 8504 to an external device via an external transport medium. In one example, the AV output IF 8511 may be a wireless communication device that transmits modulated video and audio signals via a wireless medium to an external device, using a wireless communication scheme compliant with wireless communication standards, such as Wi-Fi (registered trademark), which is a set of standards including IEEE 802.11a, IEEE 802.11b, IEEE 802.11g, and IEEE 802.11n,


WiGiG, Wireless HD, Bluetooth, ZigBee, or the like. In another example, the stream output IF 8509 may be a wired communication device that transmits modulated video and audio signals via a transmission line physically connected to the stream output IF 8509 to an external device, using a communication scheme compliant with wired communication standards, such as Ethernet (registered trademark), USB, PLC, HDMI, or the like. In yet another example, the stream output IF 8509 may be a terminal for connecting a cable to output the video and audio signals in analog form.


With the above structure, the user is allowed to use, on an external device, the video and audio signals decoded by the signal processing unit 8504.


Furthermore, the reception device 8500 additionally includes an operation input unit 8510 for receiving a user operation. According to control signals indicative of user operations input to the operation input unit 8510, the reception device 8500 performs various operations, such as switching the power ON or OFF, switching the reception channel, switching the display of subtitle text ON or OFF, switching the display of subtitle text to another language, changing the volume of audio output of the audio output unit 8506, and changing the settings of channels that can be received.


Additionally, the reception device 8500 may have a function of displaying the antenna level indicating the quality of the signal being received by the reception device 8500. Note that the antenna level is an indicator of the reception quality calculated based on, for example, the Received Signal Strength Indication, Received Signal Strength Indicator (RSSI), received field strength, Carrier-to-noise power ratio (C/N), Bit Error Rate (BER), packet error rate, frame error rate, and channel state information of the signal received on the reception device 8500. In other words, the antenna level is a signal indicating the level and quality of the received signal. In this case, the demodulation unit 8502 also includes a reception quality measuring unit for measuring the received signal characteristics, such as RSSI, received field strength, C/N, BER, packet error rate, frame error rate, and channel state information. In response to a user operation, the reception device 8500 displays the antenna level (i.e., signal indicating the level and quality of the received signal) on the video display unit 8507 in a manner identifiable by the user. The antenna level (i.e., signal indicating the level and quality of the received signal) may be numerically displayed using a number that represents RSSI, received field strength, C/N, BER, packet error rate, frame error rate, channel state information or the like. Alternatively, the antenna level may be displayed using an image representing RSSI, received field strength, C/N, BER, packet error rate, frame error rate, channel state information or the like. Furthermore, the reception device 8500 may display a plurality of antenna levels (signals indicating the level and quality of the received signal) calculated for each of the plurality of streams s1, s2, . . . received and separated using the reception schemes shown in the above embodiments, or one antenna level (signal indicating the level and quality of the received signal) calculated from the plurality of streams s1, s2, . . . . When video data and audio data composing a program are transmitted hierarchically, the reception device 8500 may also display the signal level (signal indicating the level and quality of the received signal) for each hierarchical level.


With the above structure, users are able to grasp the antenna level (signal indicating the level and quality of the received signal) numerically or visually during reception with the reception schemes shown in the above embodiments.


Although the reception device 8500 is described above as having the audio output unit 8506, video display unit 8507, recording unit 8508, stream output IF 8509, and AV output IF 8511, it is not necessary for the reception device 8500 to have all of these units. As long as the reception device 8500 is provided with at least one of the units described above, the user is enabled to use multiplexed data obtained as a result of demodulation and error correction decoding by the demodulation unit 8502. The reception device 8300 may therefore include any combination of the above-described units depending on its intended use.


(Multiplexed Data)


The following is a detailed description of an exemplary structure of multiplexed data. The data structure typically used in broadcasting is an MPEG2 transport stream (TS), so therefore the following description is given by way of an example related to MPEG2-TS. It should be naturally appreciated, however, that the data structure of multiplexed data transmitted by the transmission and reception schemes described in the above embodiments is not limited to MPEG2-TS and the advantageous effects of the above embodiments are achieved even if any other data structure is employed.



FIG. 86 is a view illustrating an exemplary multiplexed data structure. As illustrated in FIG. 86, multiplexed data is obtained by multiplexing one or more elementary streams, which are elements constituting a broadcast program (program or an event which is part of a program) currently provided through respective services. Examples of elementary streams include a video stream, audio stream, presentation graphics (PG) stream, and interactive graphics (IG) stream. In the case where a broadcast program carried by multiplexed data is a movie, the video streams represent main video and sub video of the movie, the audio streams represent main audio of the movie and sub audio to be mixed with the main audio, and the PG stream represents subtitles of the movie. The term “main video” used herein refers to video images normally presented on a screen, whereas “sub video” refers to video images (for example, images of text explaining the outline of the movie) to be presented in a small window inserted within the video images. The IG stream represents an interactive display constituted by presenting GUI components on a screen.


Each stream contained in multiplexed data is identified by an identifier called PID uniquely assigned to the stream. For example, the video stream carrying main video images of a movie is assigned with “0x1011”, each audio stream is assigned with a different one of “0x1100” to “0x111F”, each PG stream is assigned with a different one of “0x1200” to “0x121F”, each IG stream is assigned with a different one of “0x1400” to “0x141F”, each video stream carrying sub video images of the movie is assigned with a different one of “0x1B00” to “0x1B1F”, each audio stream of sub-audio to be mixed with the main audio is assigned with a different one of “0x1A00” to “0x1A1F”.



FIG. 87 is a schematic view illustrating an example of how the respective streams are multiplexed into multiplexed data. First, a video stream 8701 composed of a plurality of video frames is converted into a PES packet sequence 8702 and then into a TS packet sequence 8703, whereas an audio stream 8704 composed of a plurality of audio frames is converted into a PES packet sequence 8705 and then into a TS packet sequence 8706. Similarly, the PG stream 8711 is first converted into a PES packet sequence 8712 and then into a TS packet sequence 8713, whereas the IG stream 8714 is converted into a PES packet sequence 8715 and then into a TS packet sequence 8716. The multiplexed data 8717 is obtained by multiplexing the TS packet sequences (8703, 8706, 8713 and 8716) into one stream.



FIG. 88 illustrates the details of how a video stream is divided into a sequence of PES packets. In FIG. 88, the first tier shows a sequence of video frames included in a video stream. The second tier shows a sequence of PES packets. As indicated by arrows yy1, yy2, yy3, and yy4 shown in FIG. 88, a plurality of video presentation units, namely I pictures, B pictures, and P pictures, of a video stream are separately stored into the payloads of PES packets on a picture-by-picture basis. Each PES packet has a PES header and the PES header stores a Presentation Time-Stamp (PTS) and Decoding Time-Stamp (DTS) indicating the display time and decoding time of a corresponding picture.



FIG. 89 illustrates the format of a TS packet to be eventually written as multiplexed data. The TS packet is a fixed length packet of 188 bytes and has a 4-byte TS header containing such information as PID identifying the stream and a 184-byte TS payload carrying actual data. The PES packets described above are divided to be stored into the TS payloads of TS packets. In the case of BD-ROM, each TS packet is attached with a TP_Extra_Header of 4 bytes to build a 192-byte source packet, which is to be written as multiplexed data. The TP_Extra_Header contains such information as an Arrival_Time_Stamp (ATS). The ATS indicates a time for starring transfer of the TS packet to the PID filter of a decoder. As shown on the lowest tier in FIG. 89, multiplexed data includes a sequence of source packets each bearing a source packet number (SPN), which is a number incrementing sequentially from the start of the multiplexed data.


In addition to the TS packets storing streams such as video, audio, and PG streams, multiplexed data also includes TS packets storing a Program Association Table (PAT), a Program Map Table (PMT), and a Program Clock Reference (PCR). The PAT in multiplexed data indicates the PID of a PMT used in the multiplexed data, and the PID of the PAT is “0”. The PMT includes PIDs identifying the respective streams, such as video, audio and subtitles, contained in multiplexed data and attribute information (frame rate, aspect ratio, and the like) of the streams identified by the respective PIDs. In addition, the PMT includes various types of descriptors relating to the multiplexed data. One of such descriptors may be copy control information indicating whether or not copying of the multiplexed data is permitted. The PCR includes information for synchronizing the Arrival Time Clock (ATC), which is the time axis of ATS, with the System Time Clock (STC), which is the time axis of PTS and DTS. More specifically, the PCR packet includes information indicating an STC time corresponding to the ATS at which the PCR packet is to be transferred.



FIG. 90 is a view illustrating the data structure of the PMT in detail. The PMT starts with a PMT header indicating, for example, the length of data contained in the PMT. Following the PMT header, descriptors relating to the multiplexed data are disposed. One example of a descriptor included in the PMT is copy control information described above. Following the descriptors, pieces of stream information relating to the respective streams included in the multiplexed data are arranged. Each piece of stream information is composed of stream descriptors indicating a stream type identifying a compression codec employed for a corresponding stream, a PID of the stream, and attribute information (frame rate, aspect ratio, and the like) of the stream. The PMT includes as many stream descriptors as the number of streams included in the multiplexed data.


When recorded onto a recoding medium, for example, the multiplexed data is recorded along with a multiplexed data information file.



FIG. 91 is a view illustrating the structure of the multiplexed data file information. As illustrated in FIG. 91, the multiplexed data information file is management information of corresponding multiplexed data and is composed of multiplexed data information, stream attribute information, and an entry map. Note that multiplexed data information files and multiplexed data are in a one-to-one relationship.


As illustrated in FIG. 91, the multiplexed data information is composed of a system rate, playback start time, and playback end time. The system rate indicates the maximum transfer rate of the multiplexed data to the PID filter of a system target decoder, which is described later. The multiplexed data includes ATSs at intervals set so as not to exceed the system rate. The playback start time is set to the time specified by the PTS of the first video frame in the multiplexed data, whereas the playback end time is set to the time calculated by adding the playback period of one frame to the PTS of the last video frame in the multiplexed data.



FIG. 92 illustrates the structure of stream attribute information contained in multiplexed data file information. As illustrated in FIG. 92, the stream attribute information includes pieces of attribute information of the respective streams included in multiplexed data, and each piece of attribute information is registered with a corresponding PID. That is, different pieces of attribute information are provided for different streams, namely a video stream, an audio stream, a PG stream and an IG stream. The video stream attribute information indicates the compression codec employed to compress the video stream, the resolutions of individual pictures constituting the video stream, the aspect ratio, the frame rate, and so on. The audio stream attribute information indicates the compression codec employed to compress the audio stream, the number of channels included in the audio stream, the language of the audio stream, the sampling frequency, and so on. These pieces of information are used to initialize a decoder before playback by a player.


In the present embodiment, from among the pieces of information included in the multiplexed data, the stream type included in the PMT is used. In the case where the multiplexed data is recorded on a recording medium, the video stream attribute information included in the multiplexed data information is used. More specifically, the moving picture coding method and device described in any of the above embodiments may be modified to additionally include a step or unit of setting a specific piece of information in the stream type included in the PMT or in the video stream attribute information. The specific piece of information is for indicating that the video data is generated by the moving picture coding method and device described in the embodiment. With the above structure, video data generated by the moving picture coding method and device described in any of the above embodiments is distinguishable from video data compliant with other standards.



FIG. 93 illustrates an exemplary structure of a video and audio output device 9300 that includes a reception device 9304 for receiving a modulated signal carrying video and audio data or data for data broadcasting from a broadcasting station (base station). Note that the structure of the reception device 9304 corresponds to the reception device 8500 illustrated in FIG. 85. The video and audio output device 9300 is installed with an Operating System (OS), for example, and also with a communication device 9306 (a communication device for a wireless Local Area Network (LAN) or Ethernet, for example) for establishing an Internet connection. With this structure, hypertext (World Wide Web (WWW)) 9303 provided over the Internet can be displayed on a display area 9301 simultaneously with images 9302 reproduced on the display area 9301 from the video and audio data or data provided by data broadcasting.


By operating a remote control (which may be a mobile phone or keyboard) 9307, the user can make a selection on the images 9302 reproduced from data provided by data broadcasting or the hypertext 9303 provided over the Internet to change the operation of the video and audio output device 9300. For example, by operating the remote control to make a selection on the hypertext 9303 provided over the Internet, the user can change the WWW site currently displayed to another site. Alternatively, by operating the remote control 9307 to make a selection on the images 9302 reproduced from the video or audio data or data provided by the data broadcasting, the user can transmit information indicating a selected channel (such as a selected broadcast program or audio broadcasting). In response, an interface (IF) 9305 acquires information transmitted from the remote control, so that the reception device 9304 operates to obtain reception data by demodulation and error correction decoding of a signal carried on the selected channel. At this time, the reception device 9304 receives control symbols included in a signal corresponding to the selected channel and containing information indicating the transmission scheme of the signal (exactly as described in Embodiments A1 through A4 and as shown in FIGS. 5 and 41). With this information, the reception device 9304 is enabled to make appropriate settings for the receiving operations, demodulation scheme, scheme of error correction decoding, and the like to duly receive data included in data symbols transmitted from a broadcasting station (base station). Although the above description is directed to an example in which the user selects a channel using the remote control 9307, the same description applies to an example in which the user selects a channel using a selection key provided on the video and audio output device 9300.


In addition, the video and audio output device 9300 may be operated via the Internet. For example, a terminal connected to the Internet may be used to make settings on the video and audio output device 9300 for pre-programmed recording (storing). (The video and audio output device 9300 therefore would have the recording unit 8508 as illustrated in FIG. 85.) In this case, before starting the pre-programmed recording, the video and audio output device 9300 selects the channel, so that the reception device 9304 operates to obtain reception data by demodulation and error correction decoding of a signal carried on the selected channel. At this time, the reception device 9304 receives control symbols included in a signal corresponding to the selected channel and containing information indicating the transmission scheme (the transmission scheme, modulation scheme, error correction scheme, and the like in the above embodiments) of the signal (exactly as described in Embodiments A1 through A4 and as shown in FIGS. 5 and 41). With this information, the reception device 9304 is enabled to make appropriate settings for the receiving operations, demodulation scheme, scheme of error correction decoding, and the like to duly receive data included in data symbols transmitted from a broadcasting station (base station).


Supplementary Explanation


In the present description, it is considered that a communication/broadcasting device such as a broadcast station, a base station, an access point, a terminal, a mobile phone, or the like is provided with the transmission device, and that a communication device such as a television, radio, terminal, personal computer, mobile phone, access point, base station, or the like is provided with the reception device. Additionally, it is considered that the transmission device and the reception device in the present invention have a communication function and are capable of being connected via some sort of interface (such as a USB) to a device for executing applications for a television, radio, personal computer, mobile phone, or the like.


Furthermore, in the present embodiment, symbols other than data symbols, such as pilot symbols (preamble, unique word, postamble, reference symbol, and the like), symbols for control information, and the like may be arranged in the frame in any way. While the terms “pilot symbol” and “symbols for control information” have been used here, any term may be used, since the function itself is what is important.


It suffices for a pilot symbol, for example, to be a known symbol modulated with PSK modulation in the transmission and reception devices (or for the reception device to be able to synchronize in order to know the symbol transmitted by the transmission device). The reception device uses this symbol for frequency synchronization, time synchronization, channel estimation (estimation of Channel State Information (CSI) for each modulated signal), detection of signals, and the like.


A symbol for control information is for transmitting information other than data (of applications or the like) that needs to be transmitted to the communication partner for achieving communication (for example, the modulation scheme, error correction coding scheme, coding rate of the error correction coding scheme, setting information in the upper layer, and the like).


Note that the present invention is not limited to the above Embodiments 1-5 and may be embodied with a variety of modifications. For example, the above embodiments describe communication devices, but the present invention is not limited to these devices and may be implemented as software for the corresponding communication scheme.


Furthermore, a precoding hopping scheme used in a scheme of transmitting two modulated signals from two antennas has been described, but the present invention is not limited in this way. The present invention may be also embodied as a precoding hopping scheme for similarly changing precoding weights (matrices) in the context of a scheme whereby four mapped signals are precoded to generate four modulated signals that are transmitted from four antennas, or more generally, whereby N mapped signals are precoded to generate N modulated signals that are transmitted from N antennas.


In the present description, the terms “precoding”, “precoding weight”, “precoding matrix” and the like are used, but any term may be used (such as “codebook”, for example) since the signal processing itself is what is important in the present invention.


Furthermore, in the present description, the reception device has been described as using ML calculation, APP, Max-log APP, ZF, MMSE, or the like, which yields soft decision results (log-likelihood, log-likelihood ratio) or hard decision results (“0” or “1”) for each bit of data transmitted by the transmission device. This process may be referred to as detection, demodulation, estimation, or separation.


Different data may be transmitted in streams s1(t) and s2(t), or the same data may be transmitted.


Assume that precoded baseband signals z1(i), z2(i) (where i represents the order in terms of time or frequency (carrier)) are generated by precoding baseband signals s1 (i) and s2(i) for two streams while regularly hopping between precoding matrices. Let the in-phase component I and the quadrature component Q of the precoded baseband signal z1(i) be I1(i) and Q1(i) respectively, and let the in-phase component I and the quadrature component Q of the precoded baseband signal z2(i) be I2(i) and Q2(i) respectively. In this case, the baseband components may be switched, and modulated signals corresponding to the switched baseband signal r1 (i) and the switched baseband signal r2(i) may be transmitted from different antennas at the same time and over the same frequency by transmitting a modulated signal corresponding to the switched baseband signal r1(i) from transmit antenna 1 and a modulated signal corresponding to the switched baseband signal r2(i) from transmit antenna 2 at the same time and over the same frequency. Baseband components may be switched as follows.


Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r1(i) be I1(i) and Q2(i) respectively, and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r2(i) be I2(i) and Q1(i) respectively.


Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r1(i) be I1(i) and I2(i) respectively, and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r2(i) be Q1(i) and Q2(i) respectively.


Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r1(i) be I2(i) and I1(i) respectively, and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r2(i) be Q1(i) and Q2(i) respectively.


Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r1(i) be I1(i) and I2(i) respectively, and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r2(i) be Q2(i) and Q1(i) respectively.


Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r1(i) be I2(i) and I1(i) respectively, and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r2(i) be Q2(i) and Q1(i) respectively.


Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r1(i) be I1(i) and Q2(i) respectively, and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r2(i) be Q1(i) and I2(i) respectively.


Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r1(i) be Q2(i) and I1(i) respectively, and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r2(i) be I2(i) and Q1(i) respectively.


Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r1(i) be Q2(i) and I1(i) respectively, and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r2(i) be Q1(i) and I2(i) respectively.


Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r2(i) be I1(i) and I2(i) respectively, and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r1(i) be Q1(i) and Q2(i) respectively.


Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r2(i) be I2(i) and I1(i) respectively, and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r1(i) be Q1(i) and Q2(i) respectively.


Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r2(i) be I1(i) and I2(i) respectively, and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r1(i) be Q2(i) and Q1(i) respectively.


Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r2(i) be I2(i) and I1(i) respectively, and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r1(i) be Q2(i) and Q1(i) respectively.


Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r2(i) be I1(i) and Q2(i) respectively, and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r1(i) be I2(i) and Q1(i) respectively.


Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r2(i) be I1(i) and Q2(i) respectively, and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r1(i) be Q1(i) and I2(i) respectively.


Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r2(i) be Q2(i) and I1(i) respectively, and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r1(i) be I2(i) and Q1(i) respectively.


Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r2(i) be Q2(i) and I1(i) respectively, and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r1(i) be Q1(i) and I2(i) respectively. In the above description, signals in two streams are precoded, and in-phase components and quadrature components of the precoded signals are switched, but the present invention is not limited in this way. Signals in more than two streams may be precoded, and the in-phase components and quadrature components of the precoded signals may be switched.


Each of the transmit antennas of the transmission device and the receive antennas of the reception device shown in the figures may be formed by a plurality of antennas.


In this description, the symbol “∀” represents the universal quantifier, and the symbol “∃” represents the existential quantifier.


Furthermore, in this description, the units of phase, such as argument, in the complex plane are radians.


When using the complex plane, complex numbers may be shown in polar form by polar coordinates. If a complex number z=a+jb (where a and b are real numbers and j is an imaginary unit) corresponds to a point (a, b) on the complex plane, and this point is represented in polar coordinates as [r, θ], then the following math is satisfied.

a=r×cos θ
b=r×sin θ
Math 566
r=√{square root over (a2+b2)}


r is the absolute value of z (r=|z|), and θ is the argument. Furthermore, z=a+jb is represented as re.


In the description of the present invention, the baseband signal, modulated signal s1, modulated signal s2, modulated signal z1, and modulated signal z2 are complex signals. Complex signals are represented as I+jQ (where j is an imaginary unit), I being the in-phase signal, and Q being the quadrature signal. In this case, I may be zero, or Q may be zero.



FIG. 59 shows an example of a broadcasting system that uses the scheme of regularly hopping between precoding matrices described in this description. In FIG. 59, a video encoder 5901 receives video images as input, encodes the video images, and outputs encoded video images as data 5902. An audio encoder 5903 receives audio as input, encodes the audio, and outputs encoded audio as data 5904. A data encoder 5905 receives data as input, encodes the data (for example by data compression), and outputs encoded data as data 5906. Together, these encoders are referred to as information source encoders 5900.


A transmission unit 5907 receives, as input, the data 5902 of the encoded video, the data 5904 of the encoded audio, and the data 5906 of the encoded data, sets some or all of these pieces of data as transmission data, and outputs transmission signals 5908_1 through 5908_N after performing processing such as error correction encoding, modulation, and precoding (for example, the signal processing of the transmission device in FIG. 3). The transmission signals 5908_1 through 5908_N are transmitted by antennas 5909_1 through 5909_N as radio waves.


A reception unit 5912 receives, as input, received signals 5911_1 through 5911_M received by antennas 5910_1 through 5910_M, performs processing such as frequency conversion, decoding of precoding, log-likelihood ratio calculation, and error correction decoding (processing by the reception device in FIG. 7, for example), and outputs received data 5913, 5915, and 5917. Information source decoders 5919 receive, as input, the received data 5913, 5915, and 5917. A video decoder 5914 receives, as input, the received data 5913, performs video decoding, and outputs a video signal. Video images are then shown on a television or display monitor. Furthermore, an audio decoder 5916 receives, as input, the received data 5915, performs audio decoding, and outputs an audio signal. Audio is then produced by a speaker. A data encoder 5918 receives, as input, the received data 5917, performs data decoding, and outputs information in the data.


In the above embodiments describing the present invention, the number of encoders in the transmission device when using a multi-carrier transmission scheme such as OFDM may be any number, as described above. Therefore, as in FIG. 4, for example, it is of course possible for the transmission device to have one encoder and to adapt a scheme of distributing output to a multi-carrier transmission scheme such as OFDM. In this case, the wireless units 310A and 310B in FIG. 4 are replaced by the OFDM related processors 1301A and 1301B in FIG. 13. The description of the OFDM related processors is as per Embodiment 1.


The symbol arrangement scheme described in Embodiments A1 through A5 may be similarly implemented as a precoding scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices using a plurality of different precoding matrices, the precoding scheme differing from the “scheme for hopping between different precoding matrices” in the present description.


Programs for executing the above communication scheme may, for example, be stored in advance in ROM (Read Only Memory) and be caused to operate by a CPU (Central Processing Unit).


Furthermore, the programs for executing the above communication scheme may be stored in a computer-readable recording medium, the programs stored in the recording medium may be loaded in the RAM (Random Access Memory) of the computer, and the computer may be caused to operate in accordance with the programs.


The components in the above embodiments and the like may be typically assembled as an LSI (Large Scale Integration), a type of integrated circuit. Individual components may respectively be made into discrete chips, or part or all of the components in each embodiment may be made into one chip. While an LSI has been referred to, the terms IC (Integrated Circuit), system LSI, super LSI, or ultra LSI may be used depending on the degree of integration. Furthermore, the scheme for assembling integrated circuits is not limited to LSI, and a dedicated circuit or a general-purpose processor may be used. A FPGA (Field Programmable Gate Array), which is programmable after the LSI is manufactured, or a reconfigurable processor, which allows reconfiguration of the connections and settings of circuit cells inside the LSI, may be used.


Furthermore, if technology for forming integrated circuits that replaces LSIs emerges, owing to advances in semiconductor technology or to another derivative technology, the integration of functional blocks may naturally be accomplished using such technology. The application of biotechnology or the like is possible.


Supplementary Explanation 2


Assume that precoded baseband signals z1(i), z2(i) (where i represents the order in terms of time or frequency (carrier)) are generated by precoding baseband signals s1(i) and s2(i) for two streams (baseband signals after mapping with a certain modulation scheme) while regularly hopping between precoding matrices. Let the in-phase component I and the quadrature component Q of the precoded baseband signal z1(i) be I1(i) and Q1(i) respectively, and let the in-phase component I and the quadrature component Q of the precoded baseband signal z2(i) be I2(i) and Q2(i) respectively. In this case, the baseband components may be switched, and modulated signals corresponding to the switched baseband signal r1(i) and the switched baseband signal r2(i) may be transmitted from different antennas at the same time and over the same frequency by transmitting a modulated signal corresponding to the switched baseband signal r1(i) from transmit antenna 1 and a modulated signal corresponding to the switched baseband signal r2(i) from transmit antenna 2 at the same time and over the same frequency. Baseband components may be switched as follows.


Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r1(i) be I1(i) and Q2(i) respectively, and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r2(i) be I2(i) and Q1(i) respectively.


Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r1(i) be I1(i) and I2(i) respectively, and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r2(i) be Q1(i) and Q2(i) respectively.


Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r1(i) be I2(i) and I1(i) respectively, and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r2(i) be Q1(i) and Q2(i) respectively.


Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r1(i) be I1(i) and I2(i) respectively, and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r2(i) be Q2(i) and Q1(i) respectively.


Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r1(i) be I2(i) and I1(i) respectively, and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r2(i) be Q2(i) and Q1(i) respectively.


Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r1(i) be I1(i) and Q2(i) respectively, and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r2(i) be Q1(i) and I2(i) respectively.


Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r1(i) be Q2(i) and I1(i) respectively, and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r2(i) be I2(i) and Q1(i) respectively.


Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r1(i) be Q2(i) and I1(i) respectively, and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r2(i) be Q1(i) and I2(i) respectively.


Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r2(i) be I1(i) and I2(i) respectively, and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r1(i) be Q1(i) and Q2(i) respectively.


Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r2(i) be I2(i) and I1(i) respectively, and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r1(i) be Q1(i) and Q2(i) respectively.


Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r2(i) be I1(i) and I2(i) respectively, and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r1(i) be Q2(i) and Q1(i) respectively.


Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r2(i) be I2(i) and I1(i) respectively, and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r1(i) be Q2(i) and Q1(i) respectively.


Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r2(i) be I1(i) and Q2(i) respectively, and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r1(i) be I2(i) and Q1(i) respectively.


Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r2(i) be I1(i) and Q2(i) respectively, and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r1(i) be Q1(i) and I2(i) respectively.


Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r2(i) be Q2(i) and I1(i) respectively, and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r1(i) be I2(i) and Q1(i) respectively.


Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r2(i) be Q2(i) and I1(i) respectively, and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r1(i) be Q1(i) and I2(i) respectively. In the above description, signals in two streams are precoded, and in-phase components and quadrature components of the precoded signals are switched, but the present invention is not limited in this way. Signals in more than two streams may be precoded, and the in-phase components and quadrature components of the precoded signals may be switched.


In the above-mentioned example, switching between baseband signals at the same time (at the same frequency ((sub)carrier)) has been described, but the present invention is not limited to the switching between baseband signals at the same time. As an example, the following description can be made.


Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r1(i) be I1(i+v) and Q2(i+w) respectively, and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r2(i) be I2(i+w) and Q1(i+v) respectively.


Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r1(i) be I1(i+v) and I2(i+w) respectively, and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r2(i) be Q1(i+v) and Q2(i+w) respectively.


Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r1(i) be I2(i+w) and I1(i+v) respectively, and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r2(i) be Q1(i+v) and Q2(i+w) respectively.


Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r1(i) be I1(i+v) and I2(i+w) respectively, and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r2(i) be Q2(i+w) and Q1(i+v) respectively.


Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r1(i) be I2(i+w) and I1(i+v) respectively, and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r2(i) be Q2(i+w) and Q1(i+v) respectively.


Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r1(i) be I1(i+v) and Q2(i+w) respectively, and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r2(i) be Q1(i+v) and I2(i+w) respectively.


Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r1(i) be Q2(i+w) and I1(i+v) respectively, and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r2(i) be I2(i+w) and Q1(i+v) respectively.


Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r1(i) be Q2(i+w) and I1(i+v) respectively, and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r2(i) be Q1(i+v) and I2(i+w) respectively.


Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r2(i) be I1(i+v) and I2(i+w) respectively, and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r1(i) be Q1(i+v) and Q2(i+w) respectively.


Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r2(i) be I2(i+w) and I1(i+v) respectively, and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r1(i) be Q1(i+v) and Q2(i+w) respectively.


Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r2(i) be I1(i+v) and I2(i+w) respectively, and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r1(i) be Q2(i+w) and Q1(i+v) respectively.


Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r2(i) be I2(i+w) and I1(i+v) respectively, and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r1(i) be Q2(i+w) and Q1(i+v) respectively.


Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r2(i) be I1(i+v) and Q2(i+w) respectively, and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r1(i) be I2(i+w) and Q1(i+v) respectively.


Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r2(i) be I1(i+v) and Q2(i+w) respectively, and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r1(i) be Q1(i+v) and I2(i+w) respectively.


Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r2(i) be Q2(i+w) and I1(i+v) respectively, and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r1(i) be I2(i+w) and Q1(i+v) respectively.


Let the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r2(i) be Q2(i+w) and I1(i+v) respectively, and the in-phase component and the quadrature component of the switched baseband signal r1(i) be Q1(i+v) and I2(i+w) respectively.



FIG. 96 shows a baseband signal hopping unit 9402 to explain the above description. As shown in FIG. 96, for precoded baseband signals z1(i) 9401_01 and z2(i) 9401_02, let the in-phase component I and the quadrature component Q of the precoded baseband signal z1(i) 9401_01 be I1(i) and Q1(i) respectively, and the in-phase component I and the quadrature component Q of the precoded baseband signal z2(i) 9401_02 be I2(i) and Q2(i) respectively. Then, let the in-phase component I and the quadrature component Q of the switched baseband signal r1(i) 9403_01 be Ir1(i) and Qr1(i) respectively, and the in-phase component I and the quadrature component Q of the switched baseband signal r2(i) 9403_02 be Ir2(i) and Qr2(i) respectively. The in-phase component Ir1(i) and the quadrature component Qr1(i) of the switched baseband signal r1(i) 9403_01 and the in-phase component Ir2(i) and the quadrature component Qr2(i) of the switched baseband signal r2(i) are represented by any of the above descriptions. Note that, in this example, switching between precoded baseband signals at the same time (at the same frequency ((sub)carrier)) has been described, but the present invention may be switching between precoded baseband signals at different times (at different frequencies ((sub)carrier)), as described above.


In this case, modulated signals corresponding to the switched baseband signal r1(i) 9403_01 and the switched baseband signal r2(i) 9403_02 may be transmitted from different antennas at the same time and over the same frequency by transmitting a modulated signal corresponding to the switched baseband signal r1(i) 9403_01 from transmit antenna 1 and a modulated signal corresponding to the switched baseband signal r2(i) 9403_02 from transmit antenna 2 at the same time and over the same frequency.


The symbol arrangement scheme described in Embodiments A1 through A5 and in Embodiment 1 may be similarly implemented as a precoding scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices using a plurality of different precoding matrices, the precoding scheme differing from the “scheme for hopping between different precoding matrices” in the present description. The same holds true for other embodiments as well. The following is a supplementary explanation regarding a plurality of different precoding matrices.


Let N precoding matrices be represented as F[0], F[1], F[2], . . . , F[N−3], F[N−2], F[N−1] for a precoding scheme for regularly hopping between precoding matrices. In this case, the “plurality of different precoding matrices” referred to above are assumed to satisfy the following two conditions (Condition *1 and Condition *2).

Math 567
F[x]≠F[y] for ∀x,∀y (x, y=0,1,2, . . . , N−3, N−2, N−1; x≠y)  Condition *1


Here, x is an integer from 0 to N−1, y is an integer from 0 to N−1 and x≠y. With respect to all x and all y satisfying the above, the relationship F[x]≠F[y] holds.

Math 568
F[x]=k×F[y]  Condition *2


Letting x be an integer from 0 to N−1, y be an integer from 0 to N−1, and x≠y, for all x and all y, no real or complex number k satisfying the above equation exists.


The following is a supplementary explanation using a 2×2 matrix as an example. Let 2×2 matrices R and S be represented as follows:









Math





569











R
=

(



a


b




c


d



)












Math





570











S
=

(



e


f




g


h



)













Let a=Aejδ11, b=Bejδ12, c=Cejδ21, and d=Dejδ22, and e=Eejδ11, f=Fejδ12, g=Gejδ21 and h=Hejδ22. A, B, C, D, E, F, G, and H are real numbers 0 or greater, and δ11, δ12, δ21, δ22, γ11, γ12, γ21, and γ22 are expressed in radians. In this case, R≠S means that at least one of the following holds: (1) a≠e, (2) b≠f, (3) c≠g and (4) d≠h.


A precoding matrix may be the matrix R wherein one of a, b, c, and d is zero. In other words, the precoding matrix may be such that (1) a is zero, and b, c, and d are not zero; (2) b is zero, and a, c, and d are not zero; (3) c is zero, and a, b, and d are not zero; or (4) d is zero, and a, b, and c are not zero.


In the system example in the description of the present invention, a communication system using a MIMO scheme was described, wherein two modulated signals are transmitted from two antennas and are received by two antennas. The present invention may, however, of course also be adopted in a communication system using a MISO (Multiple Input Single Output) scheme. In the case of the MISO scheme, adoption of a precoding scheme for regularly hopping between a plurality of precoding matrices in the transmission device is the same as described above. On the other hand, the reception device is not provided with the antenna 701_Y, the wireless unit 703_Y, the channel fluctuation estimating unit 707_1 for the modulated signal z1, or the channel fluctuation estimating unit 707_2 for the modulated signal z2 in the structure shown in FIG. 7. In this case as well, however, the processing detailed in the present description may be performed to estimate data transmitted by the transmission device. Note that it is widely known that a plurality of signals transmitted at the same frequency and the same time can be received by one antenna and decoded (for one antenna reception, it suffices to perform calculation such as ML calculation (Max-log APP or the like)). In the present invention, it suffices for the signal processing unit 711 in FIG. 7 to perform demodulation (detection) taking into consideration the precoding scheme for regularly hopping that is used at the transmitting end.


INDUSTRIAL APPLICABILITY

The present invention is widely applicable to wireless systems that transmit different modulated signals from a plurality of antennas, such as an OFDM-MIMO system. Furthermore, in a wired communication system with a plurality of transmission locations (such as a Power Line Communication (PLC) system, optical communication system, or Digital Subscriber Line (DSL) system), the present invention may be adapted to MIMO, in which case a plurality of transmission locations are used to transmit a plurality of modulated signals as described by the present invention. A modulated signal may also be transmitted from a plurality of transmission locations.


REFERENCE SIGNS LIST




  • 302A, 302B encoder


  • 304A, 304B interleaver


  • 306A,306B mapping unit


  • 314 weighting information generating unit


  • 308A,308B weighting unit


  • 310A,310B wireless unit


  • 312A,312B antenna


  • 402 encoder


  • 404 distribution unit


  • 504#1,504#2 transmit antenna


  • 505#1,505#2 transmit antenna


  • 600 weighting unit


  • 703_X wireless unit


  • 701_X antenna


  • 705_1 channel fluctuation estimating unit


  • 705_2 channel fluctuation estimating unit


  • 707_1 channel fluctuation estimating unit


  • 707_2 channel fluctuation estimating unit


  • 709 control information decoding unit


  • 711 signal processing unit


  • 803 INNER MIMO detector


  • 805A,805B log-likelihood calculating unit


  • 807A,807B deinterleaver


  • 809A,809B log-likelihood ratio calculating unit


  • 811A,811B soft-in/soft-out decoder


  • 813A,813B interleaver


  • 815 storage unit


  • 819 weighting coefficient generating unit


  • 901 soft-in/soft-out decoder


  • 903 distribution unit


  • 1301A,1301B OFDM related processor


  • 1402A,1402A serial/parallel converter


  • 1404A,1404B reordering unit


  • 1406A,1406B inverse Fast Fourier transformer


  • 1408A,1408B wireless unit


  • 2200 precoding weight generating unit


  • 2300 reordering unit


  • 4002 encoder group


Claims
  • 1. A transmission method, comprising: modulating a first data sequence to a first modulation symbol sequence s1(t) and a second data sequence to a second modulation symbol sequence s2(t), wherein t is an integer no less than 0;selecting whether to perform a precoding process;generating a first transmission symbol sequence z1(t) and a second transmission symbol sequence z2(t) by using the first modulation symbol sequence s1(t) and the second modulation symbol sequence s2(t); andtransmitting the first transmission symbol sequence z1(t) and the second transmission symbol sequence z2(t) from a first transmission antenna and a second transmission antenna respectively in the same frequency at the same time, whereinin a case where the result of the selecting indicates that the precoding process is performed, the first transmission symbol sequence z1(t) and the second transmission symbol sequence z2(t) are generated by performing the precoding process using N matrices F[i] on the first modulation symbol sequence s1(t) and the second modulation symbol sequence s2(t),the N matrices F[i] have one or more matrix elements that changes according to i, wherein i is an integer no less than 0 and no more than N−1, i varies according to t, and N is an integer 2 or greater,the first transmission symbol sequence z1(t) includes the first modulation symbol sequence s1(t) to which the precoding process is not applied and the second modulation symbol sequence s2(t) to which the precoding process is not applied, andthe second transmission symbol sequence z2(t) includes the first modulation symbol sequence s1(t) to which the precoding process is applied and the second modulation symbol sequence s2(t) to which the precoding process is applied.
  • 2. A transmission apparatus comprising: signal processing circuitry, which in operation, modulates a first data sequence to a first modulation symbol sequence s1(t) and a second data sequence to a second modulation symbol sequence s2(t);selects whether to perform a precoding process,generates a first transmission symbol sequence z1(t) and a second transmission symbol sequence z2(t) by using a first modulation symbol sequence s1(t) and a second modulation symbol sequence s2(t), wherein t is an integer no less than 0; andtransmission circuitry, which in operation, transmits the first transmission symbol sequence z1(t) and the second transmission symbol sequence z2(t) from a first transmission antenna and a second transmission antenna respectively in the same frequency at the same time, whereinin a case where the result of the selecting indicates that the precoding process is performed, the first transmission symbol sequence z1(t) and the second transmission symbol sequence z2(t) are generated by performing the precoding process using N matrices F[i] on the first modulation symbol sequence s1(t) and the second modulation symbol sequence s2(t); andthe N matrices F[i] have one or more matrix elements that changes according to i,
  • 3. A reception method comprising: receiving a plurality of signals transmitted from a plurality of transmission antennas in the same frequency at the same time, the plurality of signals including one or more control signals related to generation of a first transmission symbol sequence z1(t) and a second transmission symbol sequence z2(t), wherein t is an integer no less than 0; andgenerating a first data sequence and a second data sequence by demodulating the first transmission symbol sequence z1(t) and the second transmission symbol sequence z2(t) based on the one or more control signals, whereinin a case where the one or more control signals indicates that the precoding process is performed, the plurality of signals are transmitted based on the first transmission symbol sequence z1(t) and the second transmission symbol sequence z2(t) that are generated by performing the precoding process using N matrices F[i] on a first modulation symbol sequence s1(t) and a second modulation symbol sequence s2(t),the N matrices F[i] have one or more matrix elements that changes according to i, wherein i is an integer no less than 0 and no more than N−1, i varies according to t, and N is an integer 2 or greater,the first transmission symbol sequence z1(t) includes the first modulation symbol sequence s1(t) to which the precoding process is not applied and the second modulation symbol sequence s2(t) to which the precoding process is not applied, andthe second transmission symbol sequence z2(t) includes the first modulation symbol sequence s1(t) to which the precoding process is applied and the second modulation symbol sequence s2(t) to which the precoding process is applied.
  • 4. A reception apparatus comprising: reception circuitry, which in operation, receives a plurality of signals transmitted from a plurality of transmission antennas in the same frequency at the same time, the plurality of signals including one or more control signals related to generation of a first transmission symbol sequence z1(t) and a second transmission symbol sequence z2(t), wherein t is an integer no less than 0;signal processing circuitry, which in operation, generates a first data sequence and a second data sequence by demodulating the first transmission symbol sequence z1(t) and the second transmission symbol sequence z2(t) based on the one or more control signals, whereinin a case where the one or more control signals indicates that the precoding process is performed, the plurality of signals are transmitted based on the first transmission symbol sequence z1(t) and the second transmission symbol sequence z2(t) that are generated by performing the precoding process using N matrices F[i] on a first modulation symbol sequence s1(t) and a second modulation symbol sequence s2(t), wherein t is an integer no less than 0,the N matrices F[i] have one or more matrix elements that changes according to i, wherein i is an integer no less than 0 and no more than N−1, i varies according to t, and N is an integer 2 or greater,the first transmission symbol sequence z1(t) includes the first modulation symbol sequence s1(t) to which the precoding process is not applied and the second modulation symbol sequence s2(t) to which the precoding process is not applied, andthe second transmission symbol sequence z2(t) includes the first modulation symbol sequence s1(t) to which the precoding process is applied and the second modulation symbol sequence s2(t) to which the precoding process is applied.
Priority Claims (6)
Number Date Country Kind
2010-138532 Jun 2010 JP national
2010-152503 Jul 2010 JP national
2010-177310 Aug 2010 JP national
2010-250331 Nov 2010 JP national
2010-275165 Dec 2010 JP national
2010-276456 Dec 2010 JP national
US Referenced Citations (9)
Number Name Date Kind
20070140377 Murakami et al. Jun 2007 A1
20090052578 Sawai Feb 2009 A1
20100046658 Yosoku et al. Feb 2010 A1
20100135432 Miyoshi Jun 2010 A1
20110044412 Murakami et al. Feb 2011 A1
20150010104 Park Jan 2015 A1
20160269215 Choi Sep 2016 A1
20160374060 Lim Dec 2016 A1
20170366381 Zoellner Dec 2017 A1
Foreign Referenced Citations (11)
Number Date Country
101374032 Feb 2009 CN
2008-543215 Nov 2008 JP
2009-171155 Jul 2009 JP
2010-514377 Apr 2010 JP
2010-518757 May 2010 JP
2005050885 Jun 2005 WO
2006129958 Dec 2006 WO
2008077056 Jun 2008 WO
2008088066 Jul 2008 WO
2008098093 Aug 2008 WO
2019038317 Mar 2009 WO
Non-Patent Literature Citations (25)
Entry
International Search Report dated Jul. 12, 2011 in International (PCT) Application No. PCT/JP2011/003384.
Supplementary European Search Report dated Mar. 15, 2012 in Application No. EP 11 79 5404.
Tareq Y. Al-Naffouri et al., “Opportunistic Beamforming with Precoding for Spatially Correlated Channels”, Information Theory, 2009, CWIT 2009, 11th Canadian Workshop on, May 15, 2009.
Magnus Sandell et al., “Pseudo-Random Scrambling for Quasi-Static MIMO Channels”, The 18th Annual IEEE International Symposium on Personal, Indoor and Mobile Radio Communications, 2007, PIMRC 2007, Sep. 7, 2007.
Bertrand M. Hochwald et al., “Achieving Near-Capacity on a Multiple-Antenna Channel”, IEEE Transactions on Communications, vol. 51, No. 3, pp. 389-399, Mar. 2003.
Ben Lu et al., “Performance Analysis and Design Optimization of LDPC-Coded MIMO OFDM Systems”, IEEE Transactions on Signal Processing, vol. 52, No. 2, pp. 348-361, Feb. 2004.
Yutaka Murakami et al., “BER Performance Evaluation in 2×2 MIMO Spatial Multiplexing Systems under Rician Fading Channels”, IEICE Trans. Fundamentals, vol. E91-A, No. 10, pp. 2798-2807, Oct. 2008.
Hangjun Chen et al., “Turbo Space-Time Codes with Time Varying Linear Transformations”, IEEE Transactions on Wireless Communications, vol. 6, No. 2, pp. 486-493, Feb. 2007.
Hiroyuki Kawai et al., “Likelihood Function for QRM-MLD Suitable for Soft-Decision Turbo Decoding and Its Performance for OFCDM MIMO Multiplexing in Multipath Fading Channel”, IEICE Trans. Commun., vol. E88-B, No. 1, pp. 47-57, Jan. 2005.
A tutorial on “parallel concatenated (Turbo) coding”, “Turbo (iterative) decoding”and related topics, The Institute of Electronics, Information and Communication Engineers, Technical Report of IEICE, IT98-51 (Dec. 1998).
S. Galli et al., “Advanced Signal Processing for PLCs: Wavelet-OFDM,” Proc. of IEEE International Symposium on ISPLC 2008, pp. 187-192, 2008.
David J. Love et al., “Limited Feedback Unitary Precoding for Spatial Multiplexing Systems”, IEEE Transactions on Information Theory, vol. 51, No. 8, pp. 2967-2976, Aug. 2005.
DVB Document A122, Frame structure channel coding and modulation for a second generation digital terrestrial television broadcasting system (DVB-T2), Jun. 2008.
Lorenzo Vangelista et al., “Key Technologies for Next-Generation Terrestrial Digital Television Standard DVB-T2”, IEEE Communications Magazine, vol. 47, No. 10, pp. 146-153, Oct. 2009.
Takeo Ohgane et al., “Applications of Space Division Multiplexing and Those Performance in a MIMO Channel”, IEICE Trans. Commun., vol. E88-B, No. 5, pp. 1843-1851, May 2005.
R. G. Gallager, “Low-Density Parity-Check Codes”, IRE Transactions on Information Theory, IT-8, pp. 21-28, 1962.
David J. C. MacKay, “Good Error-Correcting Codes Based on Very Sparse Matrices”, IEEE Transactions on Information Theory, vol. 45, No. 2, pp. 399-431, Mar. 1999.
ETSI EN 302 307, “Digital Video Broadcasting (DVB); Second generation framing structure, channel coding and modulation systems for Broadcasting, Interactive Services, News Gathering and other broadband satellite applications”, V1.1.2, Jun. 2006.
Yeong-Luh Ueng et al., “A Fast-Convergence Decoding Method and Memory-Efficient VLSI Decoder Architecture for Irregular LDPC Codes in the IEEE 802. 16e Standards”, IEEE VTC-2007 Fall, pp. 1255-1259.
Kenichi Kobayashi et al., “MIMO System with Relative Phase Difference Time-Shift Modulation for Rician Fading Environment”, IEICE Trans. Commun., Communications Society, Tokyo, JP, vol. E91B, No. 2, Feb. 2008, pp. 459-465.
Kenichi Kobayashi et al., “MIMO System with Relative Phase Difference Time-Shift Modulation for Rician Fading Environments”, IEEE International Conference on Communications 2008: ICC'08; May 19-23, 2008, Beijing, China, IEEE, Piscataway, NJ, USA, May 19, 2008, pp. 732-736.
Yutaka Murakami et al., “Design of Transmission Technique Utilizing Linear Combination Diversity in Consideration of LOS Environments in MIMO Systems”, IEICE Transactions on Fundamentals of Electronics, Communications and Computer Sciences, Engineering Sciences Society, Tokyo, JP, vol. E88-A, No. 11, Nov. 1, 2005, pp. 3127-3133.
J. Klutto Milleth et al., “Performance Enhancement of Space-Time Trellis Codes When Encountering AWGN and Ricean Channels”, IEEE Transactions on Vehicular Technology, IEEE Service Center, Piscataway, NJ, US, vol. 54, No. 4, Jul. 1, 2005, pp. 1352-1360.
Office Action dated Dec. 3, 2014 in Chinese Application No. 201180029416.0, with Partial English translation.
NTT DoCoMo et al., “Downlink MIMO Scheme for Shared Data Channel in E-UTRA”, 3GPP TSG RAN WG1 Meeting #47 R1-063310, Nov. 6-10, 2006.
Related Publications (1)
Number Date Country
20190207659 A1 Jul 2019 US
Divisions (2)
Number Date Country
Parent 15429337 Feb 2017 US
Child 15804209 US
Parent 13704134 US
Child 14454314 US
Continuations (3)
Number Date Country
Parent 15804209 Nov 2017 US
Child 16353208 US
Parent 15143664 May 2016 US
Child 15429337 US
Parent 14454314 Aug 2014 US
Child 15143664 US